SC9S08AW48RCFGE [NXP]

RELAXED IDD SPEC 9S08AW4;
SC9S08AW48RCFGE
型号: SC9S08AW48RCFGE
厂家: NXP    NXP
描述:

RELAXED IDD SPEC 9S08AW4

文件: 总324页 (文件大小:3579K)
中文:  中文翻译
下载:  下载PDF数据表文档文件
MC9S08AW60  
MC9S08AW48  
MC9S08AW32  
MC9S08AW16  
Data Sheet  
HCS08  
Microcontrollers  
MC9S08AW60  
Rev 2  
12/2006  
freescale.com  
MC9S08AW60 Features  
IIC — Inter-integrated circuit bus module to  
operate at up to 100 kbps with maximum bus  
loading; capable of higher baud rates with  
reduced loading  
Timers — One 2-channel and one 6-channel  
16-bit timer/pulse-width modulator (TPM)  
module: Selectable input capture, output  
compare, and edge-aligned PWM capability on  
each channel. Each timer module may be  
configured for buffered, centered PWM  
(CPWM) on all channels  
8-Bit HCS08 Central Processor Unit (CPU)  
40-MHz HCS08 CPU (central processor unit)  
20-MHz internal bus frequency  
HC08 instruction set with added BGND  
instruction  
Single-wire background debug mode interface  
Breakpoint capability to allow single breakpoint  
setting during in-circuit debugging (plus two  
more breakpoints in on-chip debug module)  
On-chip real-time in-circuit emulation (ICE) with  
two comparators (plus one in BDM), nine  
trigger modes, and on-chip bus capture buffer.  
Typically shows approximately 50 instructions  
before or after the trigger point.  
KBI — Up to 8-pin keyboard interrupt module  
Input/Output  
Up to 54 general-purpose input/output (I/O)  
pins  
Software-selectable pullups on ports when  
used as inputs  
Software-selectable slew rate control on ports  
when used as outputs  
Support for up to 32 interrupt/reset sources  
Memory Options  
Up to 60 KB of on-chip in-circuit programmable  
FLASH memory with block protection and  
security options  
Software-selectable drive strength on ports  
when used as outputs  
Up to 2 KB of on-chip RAM  
Clock Source Options  
Master reset pin and power-on reset (POR)  
Internal pullup on RESET, IRQ, and BKGD/MS  
pins to reduce customer system cost  
Clock source options include crystal, resonator,  
external clock, or internally generated clock  
with precision NVM trimming  
Package Options  
MC9S08AW60/48/32  
System Protection  
Optional computer operating properly (COP)  
64-pin quad flat package (QFP)  
reset  
64-pin low-profile quad flat package (LQFP)  
48-pin low-profile quad flat package (QFN)  
44-pin low-profile quad flat package (LQFP)  
Low-voltage detection with reset or interrupt  
Illegal opcode detection with reset  
Illegal address detection with reset (some  
devices don’t have illegal addresses)  
MC9S08AW16  
48-pin low-profile quad flat package (QFN)  
44-pin low-profile quad flat package (LQFP)  
Power-Saving Modes  
Wait plus two stops  
Peripherals  
ADC — Up to 16-channel, 10-bit  
analog-to-digital converter with automatic  
compare function  
SCI Two serial communications interface  
modules with optional 13-bit break  
SPI — Serial peripheral interface module  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet  
Covers: MC9S08AW60  
MC9S08AW48  
MC9S08AW32  
MC9S08AW16  
MC9S08AW60  
Rev 2  
12/2006  
Revision History  
To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our documents on the World Wide Web will be  
the most current. Your printed copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information  
available, refer to:  
http://freescale.com/  
The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in this document. For your  
convenience, the page number designators have been linked to the appropriate location.  
Revision  
Number  
Revision  
Date  
Description of Changes  
1
1/2006  
Initial external release.  
Includes KBI block changes; new V / I figures; RI spec changes; SC part  
OL OL  
DD  
numbers with ICG trim modifications; addition of Temp Sensor to ADC. Resolved  
the stop IDD issues, added RTI figure, bandgap information, and incorporated  
electricals edits and any ProjectSync issues.  
2
12/2006  
This product incorporates SuperFlash® technology licensed from SST.  
Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.  
© Freescale Semiconductor, Inc., 2006. All rights reserved.  
List of Chapters  
Chapter  
Title  
Page  
Chapter 1  
Chapter 2  
Chapter 3  
Chapter 4  
Chapter 5  
Chapter 6  
Chapter 7  
Chapter 8  
Chapter 9  
Chapter 10  
Chapter 11  
Chapter 12  
Chapter 13  
Chapter 14  
Chapter 15  
Appendix A  
Appendix B  
Introduction......................................................................................19  
Pins and Connections.....................................................................23  
Modes of Operation.........................................................................33  
Memory.............................................................................................39  
Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration .............................65  
Parallel Input/Output .......................................................................81  
Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)............................................109  
Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)..........................................129  
Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)....................................................157  
Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2) ...............................................................165  
Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2).............................181  
Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3) ........................................199  
Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)...............................................215  
Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)................................233  
Development Support ...................................................................261  
Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications ................283  
Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings........................309  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
7
Contents  
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
Chapter 1  
Introduction  
1.1 Overview .........................................................................................................................................19  
1.2 MCU Block Diagrams .....................................................................................................................19  
1.3 System Clock Distribution ..............................................................................................................21  
Chapter 2  
Pins and Connections  
2.1 Introduction .....................................................................................................................................23  
2.2 Device Pin Assignment ...................................................................................................................24  
2.3 Recommended System Connections ...............................................................................................26  
2.3.1  
2.3.2  
2.3.3  
2.3.4  
2.3.5  
2.3.6  
2.3.7  
Power (V , 2 x V , V  
, V  
) .........................................................................28  
DD  
SS  
DDAD  
SSAD  
Oscillator (XTAL, EXTAL) ............................................................................................28  
RESET Pin ......................................................................................................................29  
Background/Mode Select (BKGD/MS) .........................................................................29  
ADC Reference Pins (V  
, V  
) ...........................................................................29  
REFH  
REFL  
External Interrupt Pin (IRQ) ...........................................................................................29  
General-Purpose I/O and Peripheral Ports .....................................................................30  
Chapter 3  
Modes of Operation  
3.1 Introduction .....................................................................................................................................33  
3.2 Features ...........................................................................................................................................33  
3.3 Run Mode ........................................................................................................................................33  
3.4 Active Background Mode ................................................................................................................33  
3.5 Wait Mode .......................................................................................................................................34  
3.6 Stop Modes ......................................................................................................................................34  
3.6.1  
3.6.2  
3.6.3  
3.6.4  
3.6.5  
Stop2 Mode ....................................................................................................................35  
Stop3 Mode ....................................................................................................................36  
Active BDM Enabled in Stop Mode ...............................................................................36  
LVD Enabled in Stop Mode ...........................................................................................37  
On-Chip Peripheral Modules in Stop Modes .................................................................37  
Chapter 4  
Memory  
4.1 MC9S08AW60 Series Memory Map ..............................................................................................39  
4.1.1  
Reset and Interrupt Vector Assignments ........................................................................42  
4.2 Register Addresses and Bit Assignments ........................................................................................43  
4.3 RAM ................................................................................................................................................49  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
9
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
4.4 FLASH ............................................................................................................................................50  
4.4.1  
4.4.2  
4.4.3  
4.4.4  
4.4.5  
4.4.6  
4.4.7  
Features ...........................................................................................................................51  
Program and Erase Times ...............................................................................................51  
Program and Erase Command Execution .......................................................................52  
Burst Program Execution ...............................................................................................53  
Access Errors ..................................................................................................................55  
FLASH Block Protection ...............................................................................................55  
Vector Redirection ..........................................................................................................56  
4.5 Security ............................................................................................................................................56  
4.6 FLASH Registers and Control Bits .................................................................................................58  
4.6.1  
4.6.2  
4.6.3  
4.6.4  
4.6.5  
4.6.6  
FLASH Clock Divider Register (FCDIV) ......................................................................58  
FLASH Options Register (FOPT and NVOPT) .............................................................59  
FLASH Configuration Register (FCNFG) .....................................................................60  
FLASH Protection Register (FPROT and NVPROT) ....................................................61  
FLASH Status Register (FSTAT) ...................................................................................61  
FLASH Command Register (FCMD) ............................................................................63  
Chapter 5  
Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
5.1 Introduction .....................................................................................................................................65  
5.2 Features ...........................................................................................................................................65  
5.3 MCU Reset ......................................................................................................................................65  
5.4 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Watchdog .............................................................................66  
5.5 Interrupts .........................................................................................................................................66  
5.5.1  
5.5.2  
5.5.3  
Interrupt Stack Frame .....................................................................................................67  
External Interrupt Request (IRQ) Pin .............................................................................68  
Interrupt Vectors, Sources, and Local Masks .................................................................69  
5.6 Low-Voltage Detect (LVD) System ................................................................................................71  
5.6.1  
5.6.2  
5.6.3  
5.6.4  
Power-On Reset Operation .............................................................................................71  
LVD Reset Operation .....................................................................................................71  
LVD Interrupt Operation ................................................................................................71  
Low-Voltage Warning (LVW) ........................................................................................71  
5.7 Real-Time Interrupt (RTI) ...............................................................................................................71  
5.8 MCLK Output .................................................................................................................................72  
5.9 Reset, Interrupt, and System Control Registers and Control Bits ...................................................72  
5.9.1  
5.9.2  
5.9.3  
5.9.4  
5.9.5  
5.9.6  
5.9.7  
Interrupt Pin Request Status and Control Register (IRQSC) .........................................73  
System Reset Status Register (SRS) ...............................................................................74  
System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) ..........................................75  
System Options Register (SOPT) ...................................................................................75  
System MCLK Control Register (SMCLK) ...................................................................76  
System Device Identification Register (SDIDH, SDIDL) ..............................................77  
System Real-Time Interrupt Status and Control Register (SRTISC) .............................78  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
10  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
5.9.8  
5.9.9  
System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1) .........................79  
System Power Management Status and Control 2 Register (SPMSC2) .........................80  
Chapter 6  
Parallel Input/Output  
6.1 Introduction .....................................................................................................................................81  
6.2 Features ...........................................................................................................................................81  
6.3 Pin Descriptions ..............................................................................................................................82  
6.3.1  
6.3.2  
6.3.3  
6.3.4  
6.3.5  
6.3.6  
6.3.7  
Port A ..............................................................................................................................82  
Port B ..............................................................................................................................82  
Port C ..............................................................................................................................83  
Port D ..............................................................................................................................83  
Port E ..............................................................................................................................84  
Port F ..............................................................................................................................85  
Port G ..............................................................................................................................85  
6.4 Parallel I/O Control .........................................................................................................................86  
6.5 Pin Control ......................................................................................................................................87  
6.5.1  
6.5.2  
6.5.3  
Internal Pullup Enable ....................................................................................................87  
Output Slew Rate Control Enable ..................................................................................87  
Output Drive Strength Select ..........................................................................................87  
6.6 Pin Behavior in Stop Modes ............................................................................................................88  
6.7 Parallel I/O and Pin Control Registers ............................................................................................88  
6.7.1  
6.7.2  
6.7.3  
6.7.4  
6.7.5  
6.7.6  
6.7.7  
6.7.8  
6.7.9  
Port A I/O Registers (PTAD and PTADD) .....................................................................88  
Port A Pin Control Registers (PTAPE, PTASE, PTADS) ..............................................89  
Port B I/O Registers (PTBD and PTBDD) .....................................................................91  
Port B Pin Control Registers (PTBPE, PTBSE, PTBDS) ..............................................92  
Port C I/O Registers (PTCD and PTCDD) .....................................................................94  
Port C Pin Control Registers (PTCPE, PTCSE, PTCDS) ..............................................95  
Port D I/O Registers (PTDD and PTDDD) ....................................................................97  
Port D Pin Control Registers (PTDPE, PTDSE, PTDDS) .............................................98  
Port E I/O Registers (PTED and PTEDD) ....................................................................100  
6.7.10 Port E Pin Control Registers (PTEPE, PTESE, PTEDS) .............................................101  
6.7.11 Port F I/O Registers (PTFD and PTFDD) ....................................................................103  
6.7.12 Port F Pin Control Registers (PTFPE, PTFSE, PTFDS) ..............................................104  
6.7.13 Port G I/O Registers (PTGD and PTGDD) ..................................................................106  
6.7.14 Port G Pin Control Registers (PTGPE, PTGSE, PTGDS) ...........................................107  
Chapter 7  
Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................109  
7.1.1  
Features .........................................................................................................................109  
7.2 Programmer’s Model and CPU Registers .....................................................................................110  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
11  
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
7.2.1  
7.2.2  
7.2.3  
7.2.4  
7.2.5  
Accumulator (A) ...........................................................................................................110  
Index Register (H:X) ....................................................................................................110  
Stack Pointer (SP) .........................................................................................................111  
Program Counter (PC) ..................................................................................................111  
Condition Code Register (CCR) ...................................................................................111  
7.3 Addressing Modes .........................................................................................................................113  
7.3.1  
7.3.2  
7.3.3  
7.3.4  
7.3.5  
7.3.6  
Inherent Addressing Mode (INH) ................................................................................113  
Relative Addressing Mode (REL) ................................................................................113  
Immediate Addressing Mode (IMM) ...........................................................................113  
Direct Addressing Mode (DIR) ....................................................................................113  
Extended Addressing Mode (EXT) ..............................................................................114  
Indexed Addressing Mode ............................................................................................114  
7.4 Special Operations .........................................................................................................................115  
7.4.1  
7.4.2  
7.4.3  
7.4.4  
7.4.5  
Reset Sequence .............................................................................................................115  
Interrupt Sequence ........................................................................................................115  
Wait Mode Operation ...................................................................................................116  
Stop Mode Operation ...................................................................................................116  
BGND Instruction ........................................................................................................117  
7.5 HCS08 Instruction Set Summary ..................................................................................................118  
Chapter 8  
Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................131  
8.1.1  
8.1.2  
8.1.3  
Features .........................................................................................................................131  
Modes of Operation ......................................................................................................132  
Block Diagram ..............................................................................................................133  
8.2 External Signal Description ..........................................................................................................133  
8.2.1  
8.2.2  
8.2.3  
8.2.4  
EXTAL — External Reference Clock / Oscillator Input ..............................................133  
XTAL — Oscillator Output ..........................................................................................133  
External Clock Connections .........................................................................................134  
External Crystal/Resonator Connections ......................................................................134  
8.3 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................135  
8.3.1  
8.3.2  
8.3.3  
8.3.4  
8.3.5  
8.3.6  
ICG Control Register 1 (ICGC1) .................................................................................135  
ICG Control Register 2 (ICGC2) .................................................................................137  
ICG Status Register 1 (ICGS1) ....................................................................................138  
ICG Status Register 2 (ICGS2) ....................................................................................139  
ICG Filter Registers (ICGFLTU, ICGFLTL) ...............................................................139  
ICG Trim Register (ICGTRM) .....................................................................................140  
8.4 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................140  
8.4.1  
8.4.2  
8.4.3  
Off Mode (Off) .............................................................................................................141  
Self-Clocked Mode (SCM) ...........................................................................................141  
FLL Engaged, Internal Clock (FEI) Mode ...................................................................142  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
12  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
8.4.4  
8.4.5  
8.4.6  
8.4.7  
8.4.8  
8.4.9  
FLL Engaged Internal Unlocked ..................................................................................143  
FLL Engaged Internal Locked ......................................................................................143  
FLL Bypassed, External Clock (FBE) Mode ...............................................................143  
FLL Engaged, External Clock (FEE) Mode .................................................................143  
FLL Lock and Loss-of-Lock Detection ........................................................................144  
FLL Loss-of-Clock Detection ......................................................................................145  
8.4.10 Clock Mode Requirements ...........................................................................................146  
8.4.11 Fixed Frequency Clock .................................................................................................147  
8.4.12 High Gain Oscillator .....................................................................................................147  
8.5 Initialization/Application Information ..........................................................................................147  
8.5.1  
8.5.2  
8.5.3  
8.5.4  
8.5.5  
Introduction ..................................................................................................................147  
Example #1: External Crystal = 32 kHz, Bus Frequency = 4.19 MHz ........................149  
Example #2: External Crystal = 4 MHz, Bus Frequency = 20 MHz ............................151  
Example #3: No External Crystal Connection, 5.4 MHz Bus Frequency ....................153  
Example #4: Internal Clock Generator Trim ................................................................155  
Chapter 9  
Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)  
9.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................157  
9.2 Keyboard Pin Sharing ....................................................................................................................157  
9.3 Features .........................................................................................................................................158  
9.3.1  
KBI Block Diagram ......................................................................................................160  
9.4 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................160  
9.4.1  
9.4.2  
KBI Status and Control Register (KBI1SC) .................................................................161  
KBI Pin Enable Register (KBI1PE) .............................................................................162  
9.5 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................162  
9.5.1  
9.5.2  
9.5.3  
Pin Enables ...................................................................................................................162  
Edge and Level Sensitivity ...........................................................................................162  
KBI Interrupt Controls .................................................................................................163  
Chapter 10  
Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)  
10.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................165  
10.2 Features .........................................................................................................................................165  
10.2.1 Features .........................................................................................................................167  
10.2.2 Block Diagram ..............................................................................................................167  
10.3 External Signal Description ..........................................................................................................169  
10.3.1 External TPM Clock Sources .......................................................................................169  
10.3.2 TPMxCHn — TPMx Channel n I/O Pins .....................................................................169  
10.4 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................169  
10.4.1 Timer x Status and Control Register (TPMxSC) ..........................................................170  
10.4.2 Timer x Counter Registers (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL) .............................................171  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
13  
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
10.4.3 Timer x Counter Modulo Registers (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL) .............................172  
10.4.4 Timer x Channel n Status and Control Register (TPMxCnSC) ....................................173  
10.4.5 Timer x Channel Value Registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) ....................................174  
10.5 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................175  
10.5.1 Counter .........................................................................................................................175  
10.5.2 Channel Mode Selection ...............................................................................................176  
10.5.3 Center-Aligned PWM Mode ........................................................................................178  
10.6 TPM Interrupts ..............................................................................................................................179  
10.6.1 Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags .....................................................................................179  
10.6.2 Timer Overflow Interrupt Description ..........................................................................179  
10.6.3 Channel Event Interrupt Description ............................................................................180  
10.6.4 PWM End-of-Duty-Cycle Events .................................................................................180  
Chapter 11  
Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
11.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................181  
11.1.1 Features .........................................................................................................................183  
11.1.2 Modes of Operation ......................................................................................................183  
11.1.3 Block Diagram ..............................................................................................................183  
11.2 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................185  
11.2.1 SCI Baud Rate Registers (SCIxBDH, SCIxBHL) ........................................................186  
11.2.2 SCI Control Register 1 (SCIxC1) .................................................................................187  
11.2.3 SCI Control Register 2 (SCIxC2) .................................................................................188  
11.2.4 SCI Status Register 1 (SCIxS1) ....................................................................................189  
11.2.5 SCI Status Register 2 (SCIxS2) ....................................................................................191  
11.2.6 SCI Control Register 3 (SCIxC3) .................................................................................191  
11.2.7 SCI Data Register (SCIxD) ..........................................................................................192  
11.3 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................192  
11.3.1 Baud Rate Generation ...................................................................................................193  
11.3.2 Transmitter Functional Description ..............................................................................193  
11.3.3 Receiver Functional Description ..................................................................................194  
11.3.4 Interrupts and Status Flags ...........................................................................................196  
11.3.5 Additional SCI Functions .............................................................................................197  
Chapter 12  
Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
12.0.1 Features .........................................................................................................................201  
12.0.2 Block Diagrams ............................................................................................................201  
12.0.3 SPI Baud Rate Generation ............................................................................................203  
12.1 External Signal Description ..........................................................................................................204  
12.1.1 SPSCK — SPI Serial Clock .........................................................................................204  
12.1.2 MOSI — Master Data Out, Slave Data In ....................................................................204  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
14  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
12.1.3 MISO — Master Data In, Slave Data Out ....................................................................204  
12.1.4 SS — Slave Select ........................................................................................................204  
12.2 Modes of Operation .......................................................................................................................205  
12.2.1 SPI in Stop Modes ........................................................................................................205  
12.3 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................205  
12.3.1 SPI Control Register 1 (SPI1C1) ..................................................................................205  
12.3.2 SPI Control Register 2 (SPI1C2) ..................................................................................206  
12.3.3 SPI Baud Rate Register (SPI1BR) ...............................................................................207  
12.3.4 SPI Status Register (SPI1S) ..........................................................................................208  
12.3.5 SPI Data Register (SPI1D) ...........................................................................................209  
12.4 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................210  
12.4.1 SPI Clock Formats ........................................................................................................210  
12.4.2 SPI Interrupts ................................................................................................................213  
12.4.3 Mode Fault Detection ...................................................................................................213  
Chapter 13  
Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................215  
13.1.1 Features .........................................................................................................................217  
13.1.2 Modes of Operation ......................................................................................................217  
13.1.3 Block Diagram ..............................................................................................................218  
13.2 External Signal Description ..........................................................................................................218  
13.2.1 SCL — Serial Clock Line .............................................................................................218  
13.2.2 SDA — Serial Data Line ..............................................................................................218  
13.3 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................218  
13.3.1 IIC Address Register (IIC1A) .......................................................................................219  
13.3.2 IIC Frequency Divider Register (IIC1F) ......................................................................219  
13.3.3 IIC Control Register (IIC1C) ........................................................................................222  
13.3.4 IIC Status Register (IIC1S) ..........................................................................................223  
13.3.5 IIC Data I/O Register (IIC1D) ......................................................................................224  
13.4 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................225  
13.4.1 IIC Protocol ..................................................................................................................225  
13.5 Resets ............................................................................................................................................228  
13.6 Interrupts .......................................................................................................................................228  
13.6.1 Byte Transfer Interrupt .................................................................................................229  
13.6.2 Address Detect Interrupt ...............................................................................................229  
13.6.3 Arbitration Lost Interrupt .............................................................................................229  
13.7 Initialization/Application Information ..........................................................................................230  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
15  
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
Chapter 14  
Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
14.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................................233  
14.2 Channel Assignments ....................................................................................................................233  
14.2.1 Alternate Clock .............................................................................................................234  
14.2.2 Hardware Trigger ..........................................................................................................234  
14.2.3 Temperature Sensor ......................................................................................................235  
14.2.4 Features .........................................................................................................................237  
14.2.5 Block Diagram ..............................................................................................................237  
14.3 External Signal Description ..........................................................................................................238  
14.3.1 Analog Power (V  
) ................................................................................................239  
DDAD  
14.3.2 Analog Ground (V  
) ..............................................................................................239  
SSAD  
14.3.3 Voltage Reference High (V  
) .................................................................................239  
REFH  
14.3.4 Voltage Reference Low (V  
) ..................................................................................239  
REFL  
14.3.5 Analog Channel Inputs (ADx) ......................................................................................239  
14.4 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................239  
14.4.1 Status and Control Register 1 (ADC1SC1) ..................................................................239  
14.4.2 Status and Control Register 2 (ADC1SC2) ..................................................................241  
14.4.3 Data Result High Register (ADC1RH) ........................................................................242  
14.4.4 Data Result Low Register (ADC1RL) ..........................................................................242  
14.4.5 Compare Value High Register (ADC1CVH) ................................................................243  
14.4.6 Compare Value Low Register (ADC1CVL) .................................................................243  
14.4.7 Configuration Register (ADC1CFG) ............................................................................243  
14.4.8 Pin Control 1 Register (APCTL1) ................................................................................245  
14.4.9 Pin Control 2 Register (APCTL2) ................................................................................246  
14.4.10 Pin Control 3 Register (APCTL3) ................................................................................247  
14.5 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................248  
14.5.1 Clock Select and Divide Control ..................................................................................248  
14.5.2 Input Select and Pin Control .........................................................................................249  
14.5.3 Hardware Trigger ..........................................................................................................249  
14.5.4 Conversion Control .......................................................................................................249  
14.5.5 Automatic Compare Function ......................................................................................252  
14.5.6 MCU Wait Mode Operation .........................................................................................252  
14.5.7 MCU Stop3 Mode Operation .......................................................................................252  
14.5.8 MCU Stop1 and Stop2 Mode Operation ......................................................................253  
14.6 Initialization Information ..............................................................................................................253  
14.6.1 ADC Module Initialization Example ...........................................................................253  
14.7 Application Information ................................................................................................................255  
14.7.1 External Pins and Routing ............................................................................................255  
14.7.2 Sources of Error ............................................................................................................257  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
16  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
Chapter 15  
Development Support  
15.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................261  
15.1.1 Features .........................................................................................................................262  
15.2 Background Debug Controller (BDC) ..........................................................................................262  
15.2.1 BKGD Pin Description .................................................................................................263  
15.2.2 Communication Details ................................................................................................264  
15.2.3 BDC Commands ...........................................................................................................268  
15.2.4 BDC Hardware Breakpoint ..........................................................................................270  
15.3 On-Chip Debug System (DBG) ....................................................................................................271  
15.3.1 Comparators A and B ...................................................................................................271  
15.3.2 Bus Capture Information and FIFO Operation .............................................................271  
15.3.3 Change-of-Flow Information ........................................................................................272  
15.3.4 Tag vs. Force Breakpoints and Triggers .......................................................................272  
15.3.5 Trigger Modes ..............................................................................................................273  
15.3.6 Hardware Breakpoints ..................................................................................................275  
15.4 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................275  
15.4.1 BDC Registers and Control Bits ...................................................................................275  
15.4.2 System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) ........................................277  
15.4.3 DBG Registers and Control Bits ..................................................................................278  
Appendix A  
Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................283  
A.2 Parameter Classification.................................................................................................................283  
A.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings...........................................................................................................283  
A.4 Thermal Characteristics..................................................................................................................285  
A.5 ESD Protection and Latch-Up Immunity.......................................................................................286  
A.6 DC Characteristics..........................................................................................................................287  
A.7 Supply Current Characteristics.......................................................................................................291  
A.8 ADC Characteristics.......................................................................................................................293  
A.9 Internal Clock Generation Module Characteristics........................................................................296  
A.9.1 ICG Frequency Specifications.......................................................................................297  
A.10 AC Characteristics..........................................................................................................................300  
A.10.1 Control Timing..............................................................................................................300  
A.10.2 Timer/PWM (TPM) Module Timing.............................................................................302  
A.11 SPI Characteristics .........................................................................................................................303  
A.12 FLASH Specifications....................................................................................................................306  
A.13 EMC Performance..........................................................................................................................307  
A.13.1 Radiated Emissions .......................................................................................................307  
A.13.2 Conducted Transient Susceptibility...............................................................................307  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
17  
Section Number  
Title  
Page  
Appendix B  
Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings  
B.1 Ordering Information .....................................................................................................................309  
B.2 Orderable Part Numbering System ................................................................................................310  
B.2.1 Consumer and Industrial Orderable Part Numbering System .......................................310  
B.2.2 Automotive Orderable Part Numbering System............................................................310  
B.3 Mechanical Drawings.....................................................................................................................310  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
18  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 1  
Introduction  
1.1  
Overview  
The MC9S08AW60, MC9S08AW48, MC9S08AW32, and MC9S08AW16 are members of the low-cost,  
high-performance HCS08 family of 8-bit microcontroller units (MCUs). All MCUs in the family use the  
enhanced HCS08 core and are available with a variety of modules, memory sizes, memory types, and  
package types. Refer to Table 1-1 for memory sizes and package types.  
Table 1-2 summarizes the peripheral availability per package type for the devices available in the  
MC9S08AW60 Series.  
Table 1-1. Devices in the MC9S08AW60 Series  
Device  
FLASH  
RAM  
Package  
MC9S08AW60  
MC9S08AW48  
63,280  
49,152  
32,768  
64 QFP  
64 LQFP  
48 QFN  
44 LQFP  
2048  
MC9S08AW32  
MC9S08AW16  
48 QFN  
44 LQFP  
16,384  
1024  
Table 1-2. Peripherals Available per Package Type  
Package Options  
Feature  
64-pin  
48-pin  
44-pin  
ADC  
IIC  
16-channel  
8-channel  
8-channel  
yes  
yes  
yes  
yes  
yes  
yes  
IRQ  
KBI1  
8
7
6
SCI1  
yes  
yes  
yes  
SCI2  
yes  
yes  
yes  
SPI1  
yes  
yes  
yes  
TPM1  
TPM1CLK  
TPM2  
TPM2CLK  
I/O pins  
6-channel  
yes  
4-channel  
no  
4-channel  
no  
2-channel  
yes  
2-channel  
no  
2-channel  
no  
54  
38  
34  
1.2  
MCU Block Diagrams  
The block diagram shows the structure of the MC9S08AW60 Series.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
19  
Chapter 1 Introduction  
HCS08 CORE  
DEBUG  
MODULE (DBG)  
8
PTA7– PTA0  
BKGD/MS  
BDC  
CPU  
8
PTB7/AD1P7–  
PTB0/AD1P0  
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL  
RESET  
IRQ  
PTC6  
RESETS AND INTERRUPTS  
MODES OF OPERATION  
POWER MANAGEMENT  
RxD2  
TxD2  
PTC5/RxD2  
PTC4  
PTC3/TxD2  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI2)  
PTC2/MCLK  
PTC1/SDA1  
SDA1  
SCL1  
RTI  
COP  
LVD  
IIC MODULE (IIC1)  
PTC0/SCL1  
IRQ  
AD1P7–AD1P0  
8
V
DDAD  
8
10-BIT  
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL  
CONVERTER (ADC1)  
AD1P15–AD1P8  
V
SSAD  
V
REFL  
PTD7/AD1P15/KBI1P7  
PTD6/AD1P14/TPM1CLK  
PTD5/AD1P13  
PTD4/AD1P12/TPM2CLK  
PTD3/AD1P11/KBI1P6  
PTD2/AD1P10/KBI1P5  
PTD1/AD1P9  
V
REFH  
USER FLASH  
(AW60 = 63,280 BYTES)  
(AW48 = 49,152 BYTES)  
(AW32 = 32,768 BYTES)  
(AW16 = 16,384 BYTES)  
PTD0/AD1P8  
SPSCK1  
PTE7/SPSCK1  
PTE6/MOSI1  
MOSI1  
SERIAL PERIPHERAL  
USER RAM  
MISO1  
SS1  
INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1)  
PTE5/MISO1  
PTE4/SS1  
AW60/48/32 = 2048 BYTES  
AW16 = 1024 BYTES  
TPM1CLK  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM1)  
TPM1CH5–  
TPM1CH0  
INTERNAL CLOCK  
GENERATOR (ICG)  
6
RxD1  
TxD1  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTF7  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI1)  
LOW-POWER OSCILLATOR  
PTF6  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
TPM2CLK  
V
DD  
VOLTAGE  
REGULATOR  
2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM2)  
TPM2CH1–TPM2CH0  
V
SS  
2
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
KBI1P7–KBI1P5  
3
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
8-BIT KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI1)  
KBI1P4–KBI1P0  
5
EXTAL  
XTAL  
PTG6/EXTAL  
PTG5/XTAL  
NOTES:  
PTG4/KBI1P4  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
PTG2/KBI1P2  
PTG1/KBI1P1  
PTG0/KBI1P0  
1. Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port.  
2. Pin contains software-configurable pullup/pulldown device if IRQ is enabled  
(IRQPE = 1). Pulldown is enabled if rising edge detect is selected (IRQEDG = 1)  
3. IRQ does not have a clamp diode to VDD. IRQ should not be driven above VDD  
4. Pin contains integrated pullup device.  
.
5. Pins PTD7, PTD3, PTD2, and PTG4 contain both pullup and pulldown devices.  
Pulldown enabled when KBI is enabled (KBIPEn = 1) and rising edge is selected  
(KBEDGn = 1).  
Figure 1-1. MC9S08AW60 Series Block Diagram  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
20  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 1 Introduction  
Table 1-3 lists the functional versions of the on-chip modules.  
Table 1-3. Versions of On-Chip Modules  
Module  
Version  
Analog-to-Digital Converter  
Internal Clock Generator  
Inter-Integrated Circuit  
Keyboard Interrupt  
(S08ADC10)  
(S08ICG)  
(S08IIC)  
1
4
1
1
2
3
2
2
2
(S08KBI)  
(S08SCI)  
(S08SPI)  
(S08TPM)  
(S08CPU)  
(DBG)  
Serial Communications Interface  
Serial Peripheral Interface  
Timer Pulse-Width Modulator  
Central Processing Unit  
Debug Module  
1.3  
System Clock Distribution  
SYSTEM  
CONTROL  
LOGIC  
TPM1  
TPM2  
IIC1  
SCI1  
SCI2  
SPI1  
ICGERCLK  
FFE  
RTI  
÷2  
ICG  
FIXED FREQ CLOCK (XCLK)  
BUSCLK  
ICGOUT  
÷2  
ICGLCLK*  
CPU  
BDC  
RAM  
FLASH  
ADC1  
ADC has min and max  
frequency requirements.  
See Chapter 14,  
FLASH has frequency  
requirements for program  
and erase operation.  
* ICGLCLK is the alternate BDC clock source for the MC9S08AW60 Series.  
“Analog-to-Digital Converter  
(S08ADC10V1) and  
See Appendix A, “Electrical  
Characteristics and Timing  
Specifications.  
Appendix A, “Electrical  
Characteristics and Timing  
Specifications  
Figure 1-2. System Clock Distribution Diagram  
Some of the modules inside the MCU have clock source choices. Figure 1-2 shows a simplified clock  
connection diagram. The ICG supplies the clock sources:  
ICGOUT is an output of the ICG module. It is one of the following:  
— The external crystal oscillator  
— An external clock source  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
21  
Chapter 1 Introduction  
— The output of the digitally-controlled oscillator (DCO) in the frequency-locked loop  
sub-module  
— Control bits inside the ICG determine which source is connected.  
FFE is a control signal generated inside the ICG. If the frequency of ICGOUT > 4 × the frequency  
of ICGERCLK, this signal is a logic 1 and the fixed-frequency clock will be ICGERCLK/2.  
Otherwise the fixed-frequency clock will be BUSCLK.  
ICGLCLK — Development tools can select this internal self-clocked source (~ 8 MHz) to speed  
up BDC communications in systems where the bus clock is slow.  
ICGERCLK — External reference clock can be selected as the real-time interrupt clock source.  
Can also be used as the ALTCLK input to the ADC module.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
22  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 2  
Pins and Connections  
2.1  
Introduction  
This chapter describes signals that connect to package pins. It includes a pinout diagram, a table of signal  
properties, and detailed discussion of signals.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
23  
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections  
2.2  
Device Pin Assignment  
64  
49  
63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50  
PTC4  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
48  
1
PTD3/KBI1P6/AD1P11  
47  
46  
45  
IRQ  
RESET  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
PTD2/KBI1P5/AD1P10  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
PTC6  
V
SSAD  
44  
43  
42  
41  
40  
39  
38  
37  
V
DDAD  
PTD1/AD1P9  
PTD0/AD1P8  
PTB7/AD1P7  
PTB6/AD1P6  
PTB5/AD1P5  
64-Pin QFP  
64-Pin LQFP  
PTF7  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTB4/AD1P4  
PTB3/AD1P3  
PTB2/AD1P2  
PTF6  
PTE0/TxD1  
36  
35  
34  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTB1/AD1P1  
PTB0/AD1P0  
PTA7  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
16  
33  
23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31  
18 19 20 21 22  
32  
17  
Figure 2-1. MC9S08AW60 Series in 64-Pin QFP/LQFP Package  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
24  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections  
36 PTG3/KBI1P3  
1
PTC4  
IRQ  
35 PTD3/KBI1P6/AD1P11  
34 PTD2/KBI1P5/AD1P10  
2
3
RESET  
33  
32  
V
V
4
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF6  
SSAD  
DDAD  
5
6
31 PTD1/AD1P9  
30 PTD0/AD1P8  
29 PTB3/AD1P3  
28 PTB2/AD1P2  
48-Pin QFN  
7
8
9
PTE0/TxD1  
10  
11  
12  
PTE1/RxD1  
27  
PTB1/AD1P1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
26 PTB0/AD1P0  
25 PTA7  
Figure 2-2. MC9S08AW60 Series in 48-Pin QFN Package  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
25  
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections  
34  
44  
43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35  
PTC4  
1
PTG3/KBI1P3  
33  
IRQ  
RESET  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
32  
31  
30  
29  
PTD3/KBI1P6/AD1P11  
PTD2/KBI1P5/AD1P10  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
V
SSAD  
V
DDAD  
44-Pin LQFP  
28  
27  
26  
PTD1/AD1P9  
PTD0/AD1P8  
PTB3/AD1P3  
PTB2/AD1P2  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTE1/RxD1  
25  
24  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
10  
PTB1/AD1P1  
PTB0/AD1P0  
11  
23  
18 19 20 21  
13 14 15 16 17  
22  
12  
Figure 2-3. MC9S08AW60 Series in 44-Pin LQFP Package  
2.3  
Recommended System Connections  
Figure 2-4 shows pin connections that are common to almost all MC9S08AW60 Series application  
systems.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
26  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections  
V
V
REFH  
MC9S08AW60  
DDAD  
C
BYAD  
PTA0  
PTA1  
PTA2  
PTA3  
PTA4  
PTA5  
PTA6  
PTA7  
0.1 μF  
V
V
SSAD  
V
+
DD  
SYSTEM  
POWER  
REFL  
V
DD  
PORT  
A
+
C
C
BY  
BLK  
5 V  
0.1 μF  
10 μF  
V
(x2)  
SS  
NOTE 1  
R
F
PTB0/AD1P0  
PTB1/AD1P1  
PTB2/AD1P2  
PTB3/AD1P3  
PTB4/AD1P4  
PTB5/AD1P5  
R
S
XTAL  
NOTE 2  
C2  
C1  
X1  
EXTAL  
NOTE 2  
PORT  
B
BACKGROUND HEADER  
I/O AND  
PERIPHERAL  
INTERFACE TO  
APPLICATION  
SYSTEM  
PTB6/AD1P6  
PTB7/AD1P7  
1
V
DD  
BKGD/MS  
PTC0/SCL1  
PTC1/SDA1  
PTC2/MCLK  
PTC3/TxD2  
PTC4  
V
DD  
4.7 kΩ–10 kΩ  
PORT  
C
RESET  
NOTE 3  
0.1 μF V  
DD  
PTC5/RxD2  
PTC6  
OPTIONAL  
MANUAL  
RESET  
4.7 kΩ–  
10 kΩ  
ASYNCHRONOUS  
INTERRUPT  
IRQ  
INPUT  
0.1 μF  
NOTE 3  
PTD0/AD1P8  
PTD1/AD1P9  
PTG0/KBI1P0  
PTD2/AD1P10/KBI1P5  
PTD3/AD1P11/KBI1P6  
PTD4/AD1P12/TPM2CLK  
PTD5/AD1P13  
PTG1/KBI1P1  
PTG2/KBI1P2  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
PORT  
PORT  
D
G
PTG4/KBI1P4  
PTG5/XTAL  
PTD6/AD1P14/TPM1CLK  
PTD7/AD1P15/KBI1P7  
PTG6/EXTAL  
NOTES:  
1. Not required if  
using the internal  
clock option.  
2. These are the  
same pins as  
PTG5 and PTG6  
3. RC filters on  
RESET and IRQ  
are recommended  
for EMC-sensitive  
applications.  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
PTE4/SS1  
PORT  
E
PORT  
F
PTE5/MISO1  
PTE6/MOSI1  
PTE7/SPSCK1  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF6  
PTF7  
Figure 2-4. Basic System Connections  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
27  
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections  
2.3.1  
Power (VDD, 2 x VSS, VDDAD, VSSAD)  
V
and V are the primary power supply pins for the MCU. This voltage source supplies power to all  
SS  
DD  
I/O buffer circuitry and to an internal voltage regulator. The internal voltage regulator provides regulated  
lower-voltage source to the CPU and other internal circuitry of the MCU.  
Typically, application systems have two separate capacitors across the power pins. In this case, there  
should be a bulk electrolytic capacitor, such as a 10-μF tantalum capacitor, to provide bulk charge storage  
for the overall system and a 0.1-μF ceramic bypass capacitor located as near to the paired V and V  
DD  
SS  
power pins as practical to suppress high-frequency noise. The MC9S08AW60 has a second V pin. This  
SS  
pin should be connected to the system ground plane or to the primary V pin through a low-impedance  
SS  
connection.  
V
and V  
are the analog power supply pins for the MCU. This voltage source supplies power to  
SSAD  
DDAD  
the ADC module. A 0.1-μF ceramic bypass capacitor should be located as near to the analog power pins  
as practical to suppress high-frequency noise.  
2.3.2  
Oscillator (XTAL, EXTAL)  
Out of reset, the MCU uses an internally generated clock (self-clocked mode — f  
) equivalent to  
Self_reset  
about 8-MHz crystal rate. This frequency source is used during reset startup and can be enabled as the  
clock source for stop recovery to avoid the need for a long crystal startup delay. This MCU also contains  
a trimmable internal clock generator (ICG) module that can be used to run the MCU. For more information  
on the ICG, see the Chapter 8, “Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4).”  
The oscillator amplitude on XTAL and EXTAL is gain limited for low-power oscillation. Typically, these  
pins have a 1-V peak-to-peak signal. For noisy environments, the high gain output (HGO) bit can be set to  
enable rail-to-rail oscillation.  
The oscillator in this MCU is a Pierce oscillator that can accommodate a crystal or ceramic resonator in  
either of two frequency ranges selected by the RANGE bit in the ICGC1 register. Rather than a crystal or  
ceramic resonator, an external oscillator can be connected to the EXTAL input pin.  
Refer to Figure 2-4 for the following discussion. R (when used) and R should be low-inductance  
S
F
resistors such as carbon composition resistors. Wire-wound resistors, and some metal film resistors, have  
too much inductance. C1 and C2 normally should be high-quality ceramic capacitors that are specifically  
designed for high-frequency applications.  
R is used to provide a bias path to keep the EXTAL input in its linear range during crystal startup and its  
F
value is not generally critical. Typical systems use 1 MΩ to 10 MΩ. Higher values are sensitive to humidity  
and lower values reduce gain and (in extreme cases) could prevent startup.  
C1 and C2 are typically in the 5-pF to 25-pF range and are chosen to match the requirements of a specific  
crystal or resonator. Be sure to take into account printed circuit board (PCB) capacitance and MCU pin  
capacitance when sizing C1 and C2. The crystal manufacturer typically specifies a load capacitance which  
is the series combination of C1 and C2 which are usually the same size. As a first-order approximation,  
use 10 pF as an estimate of combined pin and PCB capacitance for each oscillator pin (EXTAL and  
XTAL).  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
28  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections  
2.3.3  
RESET Pin  
RESET is a dedicated pin with a pullup device built in. It has input hysteresis, a high current output driver,  
and no output slew rate control. Internal power-on reset and low-voltage reset circuitry typically make  
external reset circuitry unnecessary. This pin is normally connected to the standard 6-pin background  
debug connector so a development system can directly reset the MCU system. If desired, a manual external  
reset can be added by supplying a simple switch to ground (pull reset pin low to force a reset).  
Whenever any reset is initiated (whether from an external signal or from an internal system), the reset pin  
is driven low for approximately 34 bus cycles, released, and sampled again approximately 38 bus cycles  
later. If reset was caused by an internal source such as low-voltage reset or watchdog timeout, the circuitry  
expects the reset pin sample to return a logic 1. The reset circuitry decodes the cause of reset and records  
it by setting a corresponding bit in the system control reset status register (SRS).  
In EMC-sensitive applications, an external RC filter is recommended on the reset pin. See Figure 2-4 for  
an example.  
2.3.4  
Background/Mode Select (BKGD/MS)  
While in reset, the BKGD/MS pin functions as a mode select pin. Immediately after reset rises the pin  
functions as the background pin and can be used for background debug communication. While functioning  
as a background/mode select pin, the pin includes an internal pullup device, input hysteresis, a standard  
output driver, and no output slew rate control.  
If nothing is connected to this pin, the MCU will enter normal operating mode at the rising edge of reset.  
If a debug system is connected to the 6-pin standard background debug header, it can hold BKGD/MS low  
during the rising edge of reset which forces the MCU to active background mode.  
The BKGD pin is used primarily for background debug controller (BDC) communications using a custom  
protocol that uses 16 clock cycles of the target MCU’s BDC clock per bit time. The target MCU’s BDC  
clock could be as fast as the bus clock rate, so there should never be any significant capacitance connected  
to the BKGD/MS pin that could interfere with background serial communications.  
Although the BKGD pin is a pseudo open-drain pin, the background debug communication protocol  
provides brief, actively driven, high speedup pulses to ensure fast rise times. Small capacitances from  
cables and the absolute value of the internal pullup device play almost no role in determining rise and fall  
times on the BKGD pin.  
2.3.5  
ADC Reference Pins (VREFH, VREFL)  
The V  
and V  
pins are the voltage reference high and voltage reference low inputs respectively  
REFH  
REFL  
for the ADC module.  
2.3.6  
External Interrupt Pin (IRQ)  
The IRQ pin is the input source for the IRQ interrupt and is also the input for the BIH and BIL instructions.  
If the IRQ function is not enabled, this pin does not perform any function.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
29  
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections  
When IRQ is configured as the IRQ input and is set to detect rising edges, a pulldown device rather than  
a pullup device is enabled.  
In EMC-sensitive applications, an external RC filter is recommended on the IRQ pin. See Figure 2-4 for  
an example.  
2.3.7  
General-Purpose I/O and Peripheral Ports  
The remaining pins are shared among general-purpose I/O and on-chip peripheral functions such as timers  
and serial I/O systems. Immediately after reset, all of these pins are configured as high-impedance  
general-purpose inputs with internal pullup devices disabled.  
NOTE  
To avoid extra current drain from floating input pins, the reset initialization  
routine in the application program should either enable on-chip pullup  
devices or change the direction of unused pins to outputs so the pins do not  
float.  
For information about controlling these pins as general-purpose I/O pins, see Chapter 6, “Parallel  
Input/Output.” For information about how and when on-chip peripheral systems use these pins, refer to the  
appropriate chapter from Table 2-1.  
Table 2-1. Pin Sharing Priority  
Lowest <- Pin Function Priority -> Highest  
Reference1  
Port Pins  
Alternate Function  
Alternate Function  
PTB7–PTB0  
PTC5, PTC3  
PTC2  
AD1P7–AD1P0  
RxD2–TxD2  
MCLK  
Chapter 14, “Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)”  
Chapter 11, “Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)”  
Chapter 5, “Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration”  
Chapter 13, “Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)”  
PTC1–PTC0  
PTD7  
SCL1–SDA1  
KBI1P7  
AD1P15  
AD1P14  
Chapter 14, “Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)”  
Chapter 9, “Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)”  
PTD6  
TPM1CLK  
Chapter 14, “Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)”  
Chapter 10, “Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)”  
PTD5  
PTD4  
AD1P13  
AD1P13  
AD1P12  
Chapter 14, “Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)”  
TPM2CLK  
Chapter 14, “Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)”  
Chapter 10, “Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)”  
PTD3–PTD2  
PTD1–PTD0  
KBI1P6–KBI1P5  
AD1P11–AD1P10  
Chapter 14, “Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)”  
Chapter 9, “Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)”  
AD1P9–AD1P8  
Chapter 14, “Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)”  
Chapter 12, “Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)”  
PTE7  
PTE6  
PTE5  
PTE4  
SPSCK1  
MOSI1  
MISO1  
SS1  
PTE3–PTE2  
TPM1CH1–  
TPM1CH0  
Chapter 10, “Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)”  
PTE1–PTE0  
PTF5–PTF4  
RxD1–TxD1  
Chapter 11, “Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)”  
Chapter 10, “Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)”  
TPM2CH1–  
TPM2CH0  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
30  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections  
Table 2-1. Pin Sharing Priority  
Lowest <- Pin Function Priority -> Highest  
Reference1  
Port Pins  
Alternate Function  
Alternate Function  
PTF3–PTF0  
TPM1CH5–  
TPM1CH2  
Chapter 10, “Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)”  
PTG4–PTG0  
PTG6–PTG5  
KBI1P4–KBI1P0  
EXTAL–XTAL  
Chapter 9, “Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)”  
Chapter 8, “Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)”  
1
See the listed chapter for information about modules that share these pins.  
When an on-chip peripheral system is controlling a pin, data direction control bits still determine what is  
read from port data registers even though the peripheral module controls the pin direction by controlling  
the enable for the pin’s output buffer. See the Chapter 6, “Parallel Input/Output” chapter for more details.  
Pullup enable bits for each input pin control whether on-chip pullup devices are enabled whenever the pin  
is acting as an input even if it is being controlled by an on-chip peripheral module. When the PTD7, PTD3,  
PTD2, and PTG4 pins are controlled by the KBI module and are configured for rising-edge/high-level  
sensitivity, the pullup enable control bits enable pulldown devices rather than pullup devices.  
NOTE  
When an alternative function is first enabled it is possible to get a spurious  
edge to the module, user software should clear out any associated flags  
before interrupts are enabled. Table 2-1 illustrates the priority if multiple  
modules are enabled. The highest priority module will have control over the  
pin. Selecting a higher priority pin function with a lower priority function  
already enabled can cause spurious edges to the lower priority module. It is  
recommended that all modules that share a pin be disabled before enabling  
another module.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
31  
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
32  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 3  
Modes of Operation  
3.1  
Introduction  
The operating modes of the MC9S08AW60 Series are described in this chapter. Entry into each mode, exit  
from each mode, and functionality while in each of the modes are described.  
3.2  
Features  
Active background mode for code development  
Wait mode:  
— CPU shuts down to conserve power  
— System clocks running  
— Full voltage regulation maintained  
Stop modes:  
— System clocks stopped; voltage regulator in standby  
— Stop2 — Partial power down of internal circuits, RAM contents retained  
— Stop3 — All internal circuits powered for fast recovery  
3.3  
Run Mode  
This is the normal operating mode for the MC9S08AW60 Series. This mode is selected when the  
BKGD/MS pin is high at the rising edge of reset. In this mode, the CPU executes code from internal  
memory with execution beginning at the address fetched from memory at $FFFE:$FFFF after reset.  
3.4  
Active Background Mode  
The active background mode functions are managed through the background debug controller (BDC) in  
the HCS08 core. The BDC, together with the on-chip debug module (DBG), provide the means for  
analyzing MCU operation during software development.  
Active background mode is entered in any of five ways:  
When the BKGD/MS pin is low at the rising edge of reset  
When a BACKGROUND command is received through the BKGD pin  
When a BGND instruction is executed  
When encountering a BDC breakpoint  
When encountering a DBG breakpoint  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
33  
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation  
After entering active background mode, the CPU is held in a suspended state waiting for serial background  
commands rather than executing instructions from the user’s application program.  
Background commands are of two types:  
Non-intrusive commands, defined as commands that can be issued while the user program is  
running. Non-intrusive commands can be issued through the BKGD pin while the MCU is in run  
mode; non-intrusive commands can also be executed when the MCU is in the active background  
mode. Non-intrusive commands include:  
— Memory access commands  
— Memory-access-with-status commands  
— BDC register access commands  
— The BACKGROUND command  
Active background commands, which can only be executed while the MCU is in active background  
mode. Active background commands include commands to:  
— Read or write CPU registers  
— Trace one user program instruction at a time  
— Leave active background mode to return to the user’s application program (GO)  
The active background mode is used to program a bootloader or user application program into the FLASH  
program memory before the MCU is operated in run mode for the first time. When the MC9S08AW60  
Series is shipped from the Freescale Semiconductor factory, the FLASH program memory is erased by  
default unless specifically noted so there is no program that could be executed in run mode until the  
FLASH memory is initially programmed. The active background mode can also be used to erase and  
reprogram the FLASH memory after it has been previously programmed.  
For additional information about the active background mode, refer to Chapter 15, “Development  
Support.”  
3.5  
Wait Mode  
Wait mode is entered by executing a WAIT instruction. Upon execution of the WAIT instruction, the CPU  
enters a low-power state in which it is not clocked. The I bit in CCR is cleared when the CPU enters the  
wait mode, enabling interrupts. When an interrupt request occurs, the CPU exits the wait mode and  
resumes processing, beginning with the stacking operations leading to the interrupt service routine.  
While the MCU is in wait mode, there are some restrictions on which background debug commands can  
be used. Only the BACKGROUND command and memory-access-with-status commands are available  
when the MCU is in wait mode. The memory-access-with-status commands do not allow memory access,  
but they report an error indicating that the MCU is in either stop or wait mode. The BACKGROUND  
command can be used to wake the MCU from wait mode and enter active background mode.  
3.6  
Stop Modes  
One of two stop modes is entered upon execution of a STOP instruction when the STOPE bit in the system  
option register is set. In both stop modes, all internal clocks are halted. If the STOPE bit is not set when  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
34  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation  
the CPU executes a STOP instruction, the MCU will not enter either of the stop modes and an illegal  
opcode reset is forced. The stop modes are selected by setting the appropriate bits in SPMSC2.  
HCS08 devices that are designed for low voltage operation (1.8V to 3.6V) also include stop1 mode. The  
MC9S08AW60 Series family of devices does not include stop1 mode.  
Table 3-1 summarizes the behavior of the MCU in each of the stop modes.  
Table 3-1. Stop Mode Behavior  
CPU, Digital  
Mode  
PPDC Peripherals,  
FLASH  
RAM  
ICG  
ADC1  
Regulator  
I/O Pins  
RTI  
Stop2  
Stop3  
1
0
Off  
Standby  
Standby  
Off  
Disabled  
Standby  
Standby  
States  
held  
Optionally on  
Optionally on  
Standby  
Off1  
Optionally on  
States  
held  
1
Crystal oscillator can be configured to run in stop3. Please see the ICG registers.  
3.6.1  
Stop2 Mode  
The stop2 mode provides very low standby power consumption and maintains the contents of RAM and  
the current state of all of the I/O pins. To enter stop2, the user must execute a STOP instruction with stop2  
selected (PPDC = 1) and stop mode enabled (STOPE = 1). In addition, the LVD must not be enabled to  
operate in stop (LVDSE = 0 or LVDE = 0). If the LVD is enabled in stop, then the MCU enters stop3 upon  
the execution of the STOP instruction regardless of the state of PPDC.  
Before entering stop2 mode, the user must save the contents of the I/O port registers, as well as any other  
memory-mapped registers which they want to restore after exit of stop2, to locations in RAM. Upon exit  
of stop2, these values can be restored by user software before pin latches are opened.  
When the MCU is in stop2 mode, all internal circuits that are powered from the voltage regulator are turned  
off, except for the RAM. The voltage regulator is in a low-power standby state, as is the ADC. Upon entry  
into stop2, the states of the I/O pins are latched. The states are held while in stop2 mode and after exiting  
stop2 mode until a logic 1 is written to PPDACK in SPMSC2.  
Exit from stop2 is done by asserting either of the wake-up pins: RESET or IRQ, or by an RTI interrupt.  
IRQ is always an active low input when the MCU is in stop2, regardless of how it was configured before  
entering stop2.  
NOTE  
Although this IRQ pin is automatically configured as active low input, the  
pullup associated with the IRQ pin is not automatically enabled. Therefore,  
if an external pullup is not used, the internal pullup must be enabled by  
setting IRQPE in IRQSC.  
Upon wake-up from stop2 mode, the MCU will start up as from a power-on reset (POR) except pin states  
remain latched. The CPU will take the reset vector. The system and all peripherals will be in their default  
reset states and must be initialized.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
35  
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation  
After waking up from stop2, the PPDF bit in SPMSC2 is set. This flag may be used to direct user code to  
go to a stop2 recovery routine. PPDF remains set and the I/O pin states remain latched until a logic 1 is  
written to PPDACK in SPMSC2.  
To maintain I/O state for pins that were configured as general-purpose I/O, the user must restore the  
contents of the I/O port registers, which have been saved in RAM, to the port registers before writing to  
the PPDACK bit. If the port registers are not restored from RAM before writing to PPDACK, then the  
register bits will assume their reset states when the I/O pin latches are opened and the I/O pins will switch  
to their reset states.  
For pins that were configured as peripheral I/O, the user must reconfigure the peripheral module that  
interfaces to the pin before writing to the PPDACK bit. If the peripheral module is not enabled before  
writing to PPDACK, the pins will be controlled by their associated port control registers when the I/O  
latches are opened.  
3.6.2  
Stop3 Mode  
Stop3 mode is entered by executing a STOP instruction under the conditions as shown in Table 3-1. The  
states of all of the internal registers and logic, RAM contents, and I/O pin states are maintained.  
Stop3 can be exited by asserting RESET, or by an interrupt from one of the following sources: the real-time  
interrupt (RTI), LVD, ADC, IRQ, or the KBI.  
If stop3 is exited by means of the RESET pin, then the MCU is reset and operation will resume after taking  
the reset vector. Exit by means of one of the internal interrupt sources results in the MCU taking the  
appropriate interrupt vector.  
3.6.3  
Active BDM Enabled in Stop Mode  
Entry into the active background mode from run mode is enabled if the ENBDM bit in BDCSCR is set.  
This register is described in Chapter 15, “Development Support” of this data sheet. If ENBDM is set when  
the CPU executes a STOP instruction, the system clocks to the background debug logic remain active when  
the MCU enters stop mode so background debug communication is still possible. In addition, the voltage  
regulator does not enter its low-power standby state but maintains full internal regulation. If the user  
attempts to enter stop2 with ENBDM set, the MCU will instead enter stop3.  
Most background commands are not available in stop mode. The memory-access-with-status commands  
do not allow memory access, but they report an error indicating that the MCU is in either stop or wait  
mode. The BACKGROUND command can be used to wake the MCU from stop and enter active  
background mode if the ENBDM bit is set. After entering background debug mode, all background  
commands are available. Table 3-2 summarizes the behavior of the MCU in stop when entry into the  
background debug mode is enabled.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
36  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation  
Table 3-2. BDM Enabled Stop Mode Behavior  
CPU, Digital  
Mode  
PPDC Peripherals,  
FLASH  
RAM  
ICG  
ADC1  
Regulator  
I/O Pins  
RTI  
Stop3  
0
Standby  
Standby  
Active Optionally on  
Active  
States  
held  
Optionally on  
3.6.4  
LVD Enabled in Stop Mode  
The LVD system is capable of generating either an interrupt or a reset when the supply voltage drops below  
the LVD voltage. If the LVD is enabled in stop by setting the LVDE and the LVDSE bits, then the voltage  
regulator remains active during stop mode. If the user attempts to enter stop2 with the LVD enabled for  
stop, the MCU will instead enter stop3. Table 3-3 summarizes the behavior of the MCU in stop when the  
LVD is enabled.  
Table 3-3. LVD Enabled Stop Mode Behavior  
CPU, Digital  
Mode  
PPDC Peripherals,  
FLASH  
RAM  
ICG  
ADC1  
Regulator  
I/O Pins  
RTI  
Stop3  
0
Standby  
Standby  
Off1  
Optionally on  
Active  
States  
held  
Optionally on  
1
Crystal oscillator can be configured to run in stop3. Please see the ICG registers.  
3.6.5  
On-Chip Peripheral Modules in Stop Modes  
When the MCU enters any stop mode, system clocks to the internal peripheral modules are stopped. Even  
in the exception case (ENBDM = 1), where clocks to the background debug logic continue to operate,  
clocks to the peripheral systems are halted to reduce power consumption. Refer to Section 3.6.1, “Stop2  
Mode,” and Section 3.6.2, “Stop3 Mode,” for specific information on system behavior in stop modes.  
Table 3-4. Stop Mode Behavior  
Mode  
Peripheral  
Stop2  
Stop3  
CPU  
Off  
Standby  
Off  
Standby  
Standby  
RAM  
FLASH  
Standby  
Parallel Port Registers  
Off  
Standby  
ADC1  
ICG  
IIC  
Off  
Optionally On1  
Optionally On2  
Standby  
Off  
Off  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
37  
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation  
Table 3-4. Stop Mode Behavior (continued)  
Mode  
Peripheral  
Stop2  
Stop3  
KBI  
RTI  
SCI  
SPI  
TPM  
Off  
Optionally On4  
Off  
Optionally On3  
Optionally On4  
Standby  
Off  
Standby  
Off  
Standby  
Voltage Regulator  
I/O Pins  
Standby  
States Held  
Standby  
States Held  
1
2
3
4
Requires the asynchronous ADC clock and LVD to be enabled, else in  
standby.  
OSCSTEN set in ICSC1, else in standby. For high frequency range (RANGE  
in ICSC2 set) requires the LVD to also be enabled in stop3.  
During stop3, KBI pins that are enabled continue to function as interrupt  
sources that are capable of waking the MCU from stop3.  
This RTI can be enabled to run in stop2 or stop3 with the internal RTI clock  
source (RTICLKS = 0, in SRTISC). The RTI also can be enabled to run in  
stop3 with the external clock source (RTICLKS = 1 and OSCSTEN = 1).  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
38  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4  
Memory  
4.1  
MC9S08AW60 Series Memory Map  
Figure 4-1 shows the memory map for the MC9S08AW60 and MC9S08AW48 MCUs. Figure 4-2 shows  
the memory map for the MC9S08AW32 and MC9S08AW16 MCUs. On-chip memory in the  
MC9S08AW60 Series of MCUs consists of RAM, FLASH program memory for nonvolatile data storage,  
plus I/O and control/status registers. The registers are divided into three groups:  
Direct-page registers ($0000 through $006F)  
High-page registers ($1800 through $185F)  
Nonvolatile registers ($FFB0 through $FFBF)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
39  
Chapter 4 Memory  
$0000  
$0000  
DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS  
DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS  
$006F  
$0070  
$006F  
$0070  
RAM  
RAM  
2048 BYTES  
2048 BYTES  
$086F  
$0870  
$086F  
$0870  
FLASH  
RESERVED  
3984 BYTES  
3984 BYTES  
$17FF  
$1800  
$17FF  
$1800  
HIGH PAGE REGISTERS  
HIGH PAGE REGISTERS  
$185F  
$1860  
$185F  
$1860  
RESERVED  
10,144 BYTES  
$3FFF  
$4000  
FLASH  
59,296 BYTES  
FLASH  
49,152 BYTES  
$FFFF  
$FFFF  
MC9S08AW48  
MC9S08AW60  
Figure 4-1. MC9S08AW60 and MC9S08AW48 Memory Map  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
40  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
$0000  
$0000  
DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS  
DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS  
$006F  
$0070  
$006F  
$0070  
RAM  
RAM  
1024 BYTES  
$046F  
$0470  
2048 BYTES  
$086F  
$0870  
RESERVED  
5008 BYTES  
RESERVED  
3984 BYTES  
$17FF  
$1800  
$17FF  
$1800  
HIGH PAGE REGISTERS  
HIGH PAGE REGISTERS  
$185F  
$1860  
$185F  
$1860  
RESERVED  
RESERVED  
42,912 BYTES  
26,528 BYTES  
$7FFF  
$8000  
$BFFF  
$C000  
FLASH  
FLASH  
16,384 BYTES  
32,768 BYTES  
$FFFF  
$FFFF  
MC9S08AW16  
MC9S08AW32  
Figure 4-2. MC9S08AW32 and MC9S08AW16 Memory Map  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
41  
Chapter 4 Memory  
4.1.1  
Reset and Interrupt Vector Assignments  
Figure 4-1 shows address assignments for reset and interrupt vectors. The vector names shown in this table  
are the labels used in the Freescale-provided equate file for the MC9S08AW60 Series. For more details  
about resets, interrupts, interrupt priority, and local interrupt mask controls, refer to Chapter 5, “Resets,  
Interrupts, and System Configuration.”  
Table 4-1. Reset and Interrupt Vectors  
Address  
(High/Low)  
Vector  
Vector Name  
$FFC0:FFC1  
Unused Vector Space  
(available for user program)  
$FFCA:FFCB  
$FFCC:FFCD  
$FFCE:FFCF  
$FFD0:FFD1  
$FFD2:FFD3  
$FFD4:FFD5  
$FFD6:FFD7  
$FFD8:FFD9  
$FFDA:FFDB  
$FFDC:FFDD  
$FFDE:FFDF  
$FFE0:FFE1  
$FFE2:FFE3  
$FFE4:FFE5  
$FFE6:FFE7  
$FFE8:FFE9  
$FFEA:FFEB  
$FFEC:FFED  
$FFEE:FFEF  
$FFF0:FFF1  
$FFF2:FFF3  
$FFF4:FFF5  
$FFF6:FFF7  
$FFF8:FFF9  
$FFFA:FFFB  
$FFFC:FFFD  
$FFFE:FFFF  
RTI  
IIC1  
Vrti  
Viic1  
ADC1 Conversion  
KBI1  
Vadc1  
Vkeyboard1  
Vsci2tx  
Vsci2rx  
Vsci2err  
Vsci1tx  
Vsci1rx  
Vsci1err  
Vspi1  
SCI2 Transmit  
SCI2 Receive  
SCI2 Error  
SCI1 Transmit  
SCI1 Receive  
SCI1 Error  
SPI1  
TPM2 Overflow  
TPM2 Channel 1  
TPM2 Channel 0  
TPM1 Overflow  
TPM1 Channel 5  
TPM1 Channel 4  
TPM1 Channel 3  
TPM1 Channel 2  
TPM1 Channel 1  
TPM1 Channel 0  
ICG  
Vtpm2ovf  
Vtpm2ch1  
Vtpm2ch0  
Vtpm1ovf  
Vtpm1ch5  
Vtpm1ch4  
Vtpm1ch3  
Vtpm1ch2  
Vtpm1ch1  
Vtpm1ch0  
Vicg  
Low Voltage Detect  
IRQ  
Vlvd  
Virq  
SWI  
Vswi  
Reset  
Vreset  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
42  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
4.2  
Register Addresses and Bit Assignments  
The registers in the MC9S08AW60 Series are divided into these three groups:  
Direct-page registers are located in the first 112 locations in the memory map, so they are  
accessible with efficient direct addressing mode instructions.  
High-page registers are used much less often, so they are located above $1800 in the memory map.  
This leaves more room in the direct page for more frequently used registers and variables.  
The nonvolatile register area consists of a block of 16 locations in FLASH memory at  
$FFB0–$FFBF.  
Nonvolatile register locations include:  
— Three values which are loaded into working registers at reset  
— An 8-byte backdoor comparison key which optionally allows a user to gain controlled access  
to secure memory  
Because the nonvolatile register locations are FLASH memory, they must be erased and  
programmed like other FLASH memory locations.  
Direct-page registers can be accessed with efficient direct addressing mode instructions. Bit manipulation  
instructions can be used to access any bit in any direct-page register. Table 4-2 is a summary of all  
user-accessible direct-page registers and control bits.  
The direct page registers in Table 4-2 can use the more efficient direct addressing mode which only  
requires the lower byte of the address. Because of this, the lower byte of the address in column one is  
shown in bold text. In Table 4-3 and Table 4-4 the whole address in column one is shown in bold. In  
Table 4-2, Table 4-3, and Table 4-4, the register names in column two are shown in bold to set them apart  
from the bit names to the right. Cells that are not associated with named bits are shaded. A shaded cell with  
a 0 indicates this unused bit always reads as a 0. Shaded cells with dashes indicate unused or reserved bit  
locations that could read as 1s or 0s.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
43  
Chapter 4 Memory  
Table 4-2. Direct-Page Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 3)  
Address Register Name  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
PTAD7  
PTADD7  
PTBD7  
PTAD6  
PTADD6  
PTBD6  
PTAD5  
PTADD5  
PTBD5  
PTAD4  
PTADD4  
PTBD4  
PTAD3  
PTADD3  
PTBD3  
PTAD2  
PTADD2  
PTBD2  
PTAD1  
PTADD1  
PTBD1  
PTAD0  
PTADD0  
PTBD0  
$0000  
$0001  
$0002  
$0003  
$0004  
$0005  
$0006  
$0007  
$0008  
$0009  
$000A  
$000B  
$000C  
$000D  
PTAD  
PTADD  
PTBD  
PTBDD7 PTBDD6 PTBDD5 PTBDD4 PTBDD3 PTBDD2 PTBDD1 PTBDD0  
PTBDD  
PTCD  
0
0
PTCD6  
PTCDD6 PTCDD5 PTCDD4 PTCDD3 PTCDD2 PTCDD1 PTCDD0  
PTDD6 PTDD5 PTDD4 PTDD3 PTDD2 PTDD1 PTDD0  
PTCD5  
PTCD4  
PTCD3  
PTCD2  
PTCD1  
PTCD0  
PTCDD  
PTDD  
PTDD7  
PTDDD7 PTDDD6 PTDDD5 PTDDD4 PTDDD3 PTDDD2 PTDDD1 PTDDD0  
PTED7 PTED6 PTED5 PTED4 PTED3 PTED2 PTED1 PTED0  
PTEDD7 PTEDD6 PTEDD5 PTEDD4 PTEDD3 PTEDD2 PTEDD1 PTEDD0  
PTFD7 PTFD6 PTFD5 PTFD4 PTFD3 PTFD2 PTFD1 PTFD0  
PTFDD7 PTFDD6 PTFDD5 PTFDD4 PTFDD3 PTFDD2 PTFDD1 PTFDD0  
PTDDD  
PTED  
PTEDD  
PTFD  
PTFDD  
PTGD  
0
0
PTGD6  
PTGD5  
PTGD4  
PTGD3  
PTGD2  
PTGD1  
PTGD0  
PTGDD6 PTGDD5 PTGDD4 PTGDD3 PTGDD2 PTGDD1 PTGDD0  
PTGDD  
$000E–  
$000F  
Reserved  
COCO  
ADACT  
0
AIEN  
ADTRG  
0
ADCO  
ACFE  
0
ADCH  
$0010  
$0011  
$0012  
$0013  
$0014  
$0015  
$0016  
$0017  
$0018  
$0019  
ADC1SC1  
ADC1SC2  
ADC1RH  
ADC1RL  
ADC1CVH  
ADC1CVL  
ADC1CFG  
APCTL1  
ACFGT  
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
ADR9  
ADR1  
ADCV9  
ADCV1  
ADR8  
ADR0  
ADCV8  
ADCV0  
ADR7  
0
ADR6  
0
ADR5  
0
ADR4  
0
ADR3  
0
ADR2  
0
ADCV7  
ADLPC  
ADPC7  
ADCV6  
ADCV5  
ADCV4  
ADLSMP  
ADPC4  
ADCV3  
ADCV2  
ADIV  
ADPC6  
MODE  
ADICLK  
ADPC5  
ADPC3  
ADPC2  
ADPC1  
ADPC9  
ADPC0  
ADPC8  
ADPC15 ADPC14 ADPC13 ADPC12 ADPC11 ADPC10  
APCTL2  
ADPC23 ADPC22 ADPC21 ADPC20 ADPC19 ADPC18 ADPC17 ADPC16  
APCTL3  
$001A–  
$001B  
Reserved  
0
0
IRQEDG  
IRQPE  
IRQF  
IRQACK  
IRQIE  
IRQMOD  
$001C  
$001D  
$001E  
$001F  
$0020  
$0021  
$0022  
$0023  
$0024  
$0025  
$0026  
$0027  
IRQSC  
KBACK  
KBIPE2  
PS2  
10  
Reserved  
KBEDG7 KBEDG6 KBEDG5 KBEDG4  
KBF  
KBIPE3  
CLKSA  
11  
KBIE  
KBIMOD  
KBIPE0  
PS0  
KBI1SC  
KBIPE7  
TOF  
KBIPE6  
KBIPE5  
KBIPE4  
KBIPE1  
KBI1PE  
TOIE  
CPWMS  
CLKSB  
PS1  
9
TPM1SC  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
14  
13  
5
12  
4
Bit 8  
TPM1CNTH  
TPM1CNTL  
TPM1MODH  
TPM1MODL  
TPM1C0SC  
TPM1C0VH  
TPM1C0VL  
6
14  
3
2
1
Bit 0  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
13  
5
12  
4
11  
10  
9
Bit 8  
6
3
2
1
Bit 0  
CH0F  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
CH0IE  
14  
MS0B  
13  
5
MS0A  
12  
4
ELS0B  
11  
ELS0A  
10  
0
0
9
Bit 8  
6
3
2
1
Bit 0  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
44  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
Bit 0  
Table 4-2. Direct-Page Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 3)  
Address Register Name  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
CH1F  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
CH2F  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
CH3F  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
CH4F  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
CH5F  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
CH1IE  
MS1B  
13  
MS1A  
12  
ELS1B  
11  
ELS1A  
10  
0
9
1
0
9
1
0
9
1
0
9
1
0
9
1
0
$0028  
$0029  
$002A  
$002B  
$002C  
$002D  
$002E  
$002F  
$0030  
$0031  
$0032  
$0033  
$0034  
$0035  
$0036  
$0037  
$0038  
$0039  
$003A  
$003B  
$003C  
$003D  
$003E  
$003F  
$0040  
$0041  
$0042  
$0043  
$0044  
$0045  
$0046  
$0047  
$0048  
$0049  
$004A  
$004B  
$004C  
$004D  
$004E  
$004F  
TPM1C1SC  
TPM1C1VH  
TPM1C1VL  
TPM1C2SC  
TPM1C2VH  
TPM1C2VL  
TPM1C3SC  
TPM1C3VH  
TPM1C3VL  
TPM1C4SC  
TPM1C4VH  
TPM1C4VL  
TPM1C5SC  
TPM1C5VH  
TPM1C5VL  
Reserved  
SCI1BDH  
SCI1BDL  
SCI1C1  
14  
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
0
6
5
4
3
2
CH2IE  
MS2B  
13  
MS2A  
12  
ELS2B  
11  
ELS2A  
10  
14  
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
0
6
5
4
3
2
CH3IE  
MS3B  
13  
MS3A  
12  
ELS3B  
11  
ELS3A  
10  
14  
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
0
6
5
4
3
2
CH4IE  
MS4B  
13  
MS4A  
12  
ELS4B  
11  
ELS4A  
10  
14  
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
0
6
5
4
3
2
CH5IE  
MS5B  
13  
MS5A  
12  
ELS5B  
11  
ELS5A  
10  
14  
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
6
5
4
3
2
SBR9  
SBR1  
PE  
SBR8  
SBR0  
PT  
0
0
0
SBR12  
SBR4  
M
SBR11  
SBR3  
WAKE  
TE  
SBR10  
SBR2  
ILT  
SBR7  
LOOPS  
TIE  
SBR6  
SBR5  
RSRC  
RIE  
RDRF  
0
SCISWAI  
TCIE  
ILIE  
IDLE  
0
RE  
RWU  
FE  
SBK  
PF  
SCI1C2  
TDRE  
0
TC  
OR  
NF  
SCI1S1  
0
0
BRK13  
NEIE  
2
0
RAF  
PEIE  
Bit 0  
SBR8  
SBR0  
PT  
SCI1S2  
R8  
T8  
TXDIR  
5
TXINV  
4
ORIE  
3
FEIE  
1
SCI1C3  
Bit 7  
0
6
0
SCI1D  
0
SBR12  
SBR4  
M
SBR11  
SBR3  
WAKE  
TE  
SBR10  
SBR2  
ILT  
SBR9  
SBR1  
PE  
SCI2BDH  
SCI2BDL  
SCI2C1  
SBR7  
LOOPS  
TIE  
SBR6  
SCISWAI  
TCIE  
TC  
SBR5  
RSRC  
RIE  
RDRF  
0
ILIE  
IDLE  
0
RE  
RWU  
FE  
SBK  
PF  
SCI2C2  
TDRE  
0
OR  
NF  
SCI2S1  
0
0
BRK13  
NEIE  
2
0
RAF  
PEIE  
Bit 0  
0
SCI2S2  
R8  
T8  
TXDIR  
5
TXINV  
4
ORIE  
3
FEIE  
1
SCI2C3  
Bit 7  
HGO  
LOLRE  
6
SCI2D  
RANGE  
REFS  
MFD  
REFST  
0
CLKS  
OSCSTEN  
LOCD  
RFD  
ERCS  
0
ICGC1  
LOCRE  
LOCK  
0
ICGC2  
CLKST  
LOLS  
LOCS  
0
ICGIF  
DCOS  
ICGS1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
ICGS2  
0
FLT  
ICGFLTU  
ICGFLTL  
ICGTRM  
Reserved  
FLT  
TRIM  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
45  
Chapter 4 Memory  
Table 4-2. Direct-Page Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 3)  
Address Register Name  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
SPIE  
0
SPE  
SPTIE  
MSTR  
CPOL  
CPHA  
SSOE  
LSBFE  
SPC0  
SPR0  
0
$0050  
$0051  
$0052  
$0053  
$0054  
$0055  
SPI1C1  
SPI1C2  
SPI1BR  
SPI1S  
0
0
SPPR1  
SPTEF  
0
MODFEN BIDIROE  
0
SPISWAI  
0
SPPR2  
SPPR0  
0
0
0
3
SPR2  
SPR1  
SPRF  
0
0
0
6
MODF  
0
0
2
0
0
1
0
4
0
Reserved  
SPI1D  
Bit 7  
5
Bit 0  
$0056–  
$0057  
Reserved  
ADDR  
0
$0058  
$0059  
$005A  
$005B  
$005C  
IIC1A  
IIC1F  
IIC1C  
IIC1S  
IIC1D  
MULT  
ICR  
IICEN  
TCF  
IICIE  
IAAS  
MST  
TX  
TXAK  
0
RSTA  
SRW  
0
0
BUSY  
ARBL  
IICIF  
RXAK  
DATA  
$005D–  
$005F  
Reserved  
TOF  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
TOIE  
CPWMS  
CLKSB  
CLKSA  
PS2  
PS1  
9
PS0  
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
0
$0060  
$0061  
$0062  
$0063  
$0064  
$0065  
$0066  
$0067  
$0068  
$0069  
$006A  
TPM2SC  
14  
13  
5
12  
4
11  
10  
TPM2CNTH  
TPM2CNTL  
TPM2MODH  
TPM2MODL  
TPM2C0SC  
TPM2C0VH  
TPM2C0VL  
TPM2C1SC  
TPM2C1VH  
TPM2C1VL  
6
14  
3
2
1
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
6
5
4
3
ELS0B  
11  
2
ELS0A  
10  
1
CH0F  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
CH0IE  
14  
MS0B  
13  
MS0A  
12  
0
9
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
CH1F  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
CH1IE  
14  
MS1B  
13  
MS1A  
12  
ELS1B  
11  
ELS1A  
10  
0
9
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
6
5
4
3
2
1
$006B–  
$006F  
Reserved  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
46  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
High-page registers, shown in Table 4-3, are accessed much less often than other I/O and control registers  
so they have been located outside the direct addressable memory space, starting at $1800.  
Table 4-3. High-Page Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 2)  
Address Register Name  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
POR  
PIN  
0
COP  
ILOP  
0
0
0
0
0
ICG  
0
LVD  
0
0
BDFR  
$1800  
$1801  
$1802  
$1803  
SRS  
0
COPE  
0
0
STOPE  
0
SBDFR  
SOPT  
SMCLK  
COPT  
0
0
MPE  
MCSEL  
$1804 –  
$1805  
Reserved  
REV3  
ID7  
REV2  
ID6  
REV1  
ID5  
REV0  
ID4  
ID11  
ID3  
ID10  
ID2  
ID9  
ID1  
RTIS1  
01  
ID8  
$1806  
$1807  
$1808  
$1809  
$180A  
SDIDH  
ID0  
SDIDL  
RTIF  
LVDF  
LVWF  
RTIACK RTICLKS  
RTIE  
0
RTIS2  
LVDE  
RTIS0  
BGBE  
PPDC  
SRTISC  
SPMSC1  
SPMSC2  
LVDACK  
LVWACK  
LVDIE  
LVDV  
LVDRE  
LVWV  
LVDSE  
PPDF  
PPDACK  
$180B–  
$180F  
Reserved  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
14  
6
13  
5
12  
11  
3
10  
2
9
Bit 8  
Bit 0  
$1810  
$1811  
$1812  
$1813  
$1814  
$1815  
$1816  
$1817  
$1818  
DBGCAH  
DBGCAL  
DBGCBH  
DBGCBL  
DBGFH  
DBGFL  
DBGC  
4
1
9
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
Bit 8  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
Bit 15  
Bit 7  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
Bit 8  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
DBGEN  
TRGSEL  
AF  
ARM  
BEGIN  
BF  
TAG  
0
BRKEN  
RWA  
TRG3  
CNT3  
RWAEN  
TRG2  
CNT2  
RWB  
TRG1  
CNT1  
RWBEN  
TRG0  
CNT0  
0
0
DBGT  
ARMF  
DBGS  
$1819–  
$181F  
Reserved  
DIVLD  
KEYEN  
PRDIV8  
FNORED  
DIV5  
0
DIV4  
0
DIV3  
DIV2  
0
DIV1  
SEC01  
DIV0  
SEC00  
$1820  
$1821  
$1822  
$1823  
$1824  
$1825  
$1826  
FCDIV  
FOPT  
0
Reserved  
FCNFG  
FPROT  
FSTAT  
FCMD  
0
0
KEYACC  
FPS5  
0
0
0
0
0
FPS7  
FCBEF  
FCMD7  
FPS6  
FCCF  
FCMD6  
FPS4  
FPS3  
0
FPS2  
FBLANK  
FCMD2  
FPS1  
0
FPDIS  
0
FPVIOL FACCERR  
FCMD5  
FCMD4  
FCMD3  
FCMD1  
FCMD0  
$1827–  
$183F  
Reserved  
PTAPE7  
PTASE7  
PTADS7  
PTAPE6  
PTASE6  
PTADS6  
PTAPE5  
PTASE5  
PTADS5  
PTAPE4  
PTASE4  
PTADS4  
PTAPE3  
PTASE3  
PTADS3  
PTAPE2  
PTASE2  
PTADS2  
PTAPE1  
PTASE1  
PTADS1  
PTAPE0  
PTASE0  
PTADS0  
$1840  
$1841  
$1842  
$1843  
$1844  
$1845  
PTAPE  
PTASE  
PTADS  
Reserved  
PTBPE  
PTBSE  
PTBPE7  
PTBSE7  
PTBPE6  
PTBSE6  
PTBPE5  
PTBSE5  
PTBPE4  
PTBSE4  
PTBPE3  
PTBSE3  
PTBPE2  
PTBSE2  
PTBPE1  
PTBSE1  
PTBPE0  
PTBSE0  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
47  
Chapter 4 Memory  
Table 4-3. High-Page Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 2)  
Address Register Name  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
PTBDS7 PTBDS6 PTBDS5 PTBDS4 PTBDS3 PTBDS2 PTBDS1 PTBDS0  
$1846  
$1847  
$1848  
$1849  
$184A  
$184B  
$184C  
$184D  
$184E  
$184F  
$1850  
$1851  
$1852  
$1853  
$1854  
$1855  
$1856  
$1857  
$1858  
$1859  
$185A  
PTBDS  
Reserved  
PTCPE  
PTCSE  
PTCDS  
Reserved  
PTDPE  
PTDSE  
PTDDS  
Reserved  
PTEPE  
PTESE  
PTEDS  
Reserved  
PTFPE  
0
PTCPE6 PTCPE5 PTCPE4 PTCPE3 PTCPE2 PTCPE1 PTCPE0  
PTCSE6 PTCSE5 PTCSE4 PTCSE3 PTCSE2 PTCSE1 PTCSE0  
PTCDS6 PTCDS5 PTCDS4 PTCDS3 PTCDS2 PTCDS1 PTCDS0  
0
0
PTDPE7 PTDPE6 PTDPE5 PTDPE4 PTDPE3 PTDPE2 PTDPE1 PTDPE0  
PTDSE7 PTDSE6 PTDSE5 PTDSE4 PTDSE3 PTDSE2 PTDSE1 PTDSE0  
PTDDS7 PTDDS6 PTDDS5 PTDDS4 PTDDS3 PTDDS2 PTDDS1 PTDDS0  
PTEPE7  
PTESE7  
PTEPE6  
PTESE6  
PTEPE5  
PTESE5  
PTEPE4  
PTESE4  
PTEPE3  
PTESE3  
PTEPE2  
PTESE2  
PTEPE1  
PTESE1  
PTEPE0  
PTESE0  
PTEDS7 PTEDS6 PTEDS5 PTEDS4 PTEDS3 PTEDS2 PTEDS1 PTEDS0  
PTFPE7  
PTFPE6  
PTFSE6  
PTFDS6  
PTFPE5  
PTFSE5  
PTFDS5  
PTFPE4  
PTFSE4  
PTFDS4  
PTFPE3  
PTFSE3  
PTFDS3  
PTFPE2  
PTFSE2  
PTFDS2  
PTFPE1  
PTFSE1  
PTFDS1  
PTFPE0  
PTFSE0  
PTFDS0  
PTFSE7  
PTFSE  
PTFDS7  
PTFDS  
Reserved  
PTGPE  
PTGSE  
PTGDS  
0
PTGPE6 PTGPE5 PTGPE4 PTGPE3 PTGPE2 PTGPE1 PTGPE0  
PTGSE6 PTGSE5 PTGSE4 PTGSE3 PTGSE2 PTGSE1 PTGSE0  
PTGDS6 PTGDS5 PTGDS4 PTGDS3 PTGDS2 PTGDS1 PTGDS0  
0
0
$185B–  
$185F  
Reserved  
1
This reserved bit must always be written to 0.  
Nonvolatile FLASH registers, shown in Table 4-4, are located in the FLASH memory. These registers  
include an 8-byte backdoor key which optionally can be used to gain access to secure memory resources.  
During reset events, the contents of NVPROT and NVOPT in the nonvolatile register area of the FLASH  
memory are transferred into corresponding FPROT and FOPT working registers in the high-page registers  
to control security and block protection options.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
48  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
Table 4-4. Nonvolatile Register Summary  
Address Register Name  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
$FFB0 – NVBACKKEY  
$FFB7  
8-Byte Comparison Key  
$FFB8 – Reserved  
$FFBB  
$FFBC  
Reserved for stor-  
age of 250 kHz  
ICGTRM value  
FPS7  
FPS6  
FPS5  
FPS4  
FPS3  
FPS2  
FPS1  
FPDIS  
$FFBD  
$FFBE  
NVPROT  
Reserved for stor-  
age of 243 kHz  
ICGTRM value  
KEYEN  
FNORED  
0
0
0
0
SEC01  
SEC00  
$FFBF  
NVOPT  
Provided the key enable (KEYEN) bit is 1, the 8-byte comparison key can be used to temporarily  
disengage memory security. This key mechanism can be accessed only through user code running in secure  
memory. (A security key cannot be entered directly through background debug commands.) This security  
key can be disabled completely by programming the KEYEN bit to 0. If the security key is disabled, the  
only way to disengage security is by mass erasing the FLASH if needed (normally through the background  
debug interface) and verifying that FLASH is blank. To avoid returning to secure mode after the next reset,  
program the security bits (SEC01:SEC00) to the unsecured state (1:0).  
4.3  
RAM  
The MC9S08AW60 Series includes static RAM. The locations in RAM below $0100 can be accessed  
using the more efficient direct addressing mode, and any single bit in this area can be accessed with the bit  
manipulation instructions (BCLR, BSET, BRCLR, and BRSET). Locating the most frequently accessed  
program variables in this area of RAM is preferred.  
The RAM retains data when the MCU is in low-power wait, stop2, or stop3 mode. At power-on, the  
contents of RAM are uninitialized. RAM data is unaffected by any reset provided that the supply voltage  
does not drop below the minimum value for RAM retention.  
For compatibility with older M68HC05 MCUs, the HCS08 resets the stack pointer to $00FF. In the  
MC9S08AW60 Series, it is usually best to re-initialize the stack pointer to the top of the RAM so the direct  
page RAM can be used for frequently accessed RAM variables and bit-addressable program variables.  
Include the following 2-instruction sequence in your reset initialization routine (where RamLast is equated  
to the highest address of the RAM in the Freescale-provided equate file).  
LDHX  
TXS  
#RamLast+1  
;point one past RAM  
;SP<-(H:X-1)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
49  
Chapter 4 Memory  
When security is enabled, the RAM is considered a secure memory resource and is not accessible through  
BDM or through code executing from non-secure memory. See Section 4.5, “Security” for a detailed  
description of the security feature.  
4.4  
FLASH  
The FLASH memory is intended primarily for program storage. In-circuit programming allows the  
operating program to be loaded into the FLASH memory after final assembly of the application product.  
It is possible to program the entire array through the single-wire background debug interface. Because no  
special voltages are needed for FLASH erase and programming operations, in-application programming  
is also possible through other software-controlled communication paths. For a more detailed discussion of  
in-circuit and in-application programming, refer to the HCS08 Family Reference Manual, Volume I,  
Freescale Semiconductor document order number HCS08RMv1/D.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
50  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
4.4.1  
Features  
Features of the FLASH memory include:  
FLASH Size  
— MC9S08AW60 — 63280 bytes (124 pages of 512 bytes each)  
— MC9S08AW48 — 49152 bytes (96 pages of 512 bytes each)  
— MC9S08AW32 — 32768 bytes (64 pages of 512 bytes each)  
— MC9S08AW16 — 16384 bytes (32 pages of 512 bytes each)  
Single power supply program and erase  
Command interface for fast program and erase operation  
Up to 100,000 program/erase cycles at typical voltage and temperature  
Flexible block protection  
Security feature for FLASH and RAM  
Auto power-down for low-frequency read accesses  
4.4.2  
Program and Erase Times  
Before any program or erase command can be accepted, the FLASH clock divider register (FCDIV) must  
be written to set the internal clock for the FLASH module to a frequency (f ) between 150 kHz and  
FCLK  
200 kHz (see Section 4.6.1, “FLASH Clock Divider Register (FCDIV)”). This register can be written only  
once, so normally this write is done during reset initialization. FCDIV cannot be written if the access error  
flag, FACCERR in FSTAT, is set. The user must ensure that FACCERR is not set before writing to the  
FCDIV register. One period of the resulting clock (1/f  
) is used by the command processor to time  
FCLK  
program and erase pulses. An integer number of these timing pulses are used by the command processor  
to complete a program or erase command.  
Table 4-5 shows program and erase times. The bus clock frequency and FCDIV determine the frequency  
of FCLK (f  
). The time for one cycle of FCLK is t  
= 1/f  
. The times are shown as a number  
FCLK  
FCLK  
FCLK  
of cycles of FCLK and as an absolute time for the case where t  
shown include overhead for the command state machine and enabling and disabling of program and erase  
voltages.  
= 5 μs. Program and erase times  
FCLK  
Table 4-5. Program and Erase Times  
Parameter  
Byte program  
Cycles of FCLK  
Time if FCLK = 200 kHz  
9
4
45 μs  
20 μs1  
20 ms2  
Byte program (burst)  
Page erase  
4000  
20,000  
Mass erase  
100 ms2  
1
2
Excluding start/end overhead  
Because the page and mass erase times can be longer than the COP watchdog timeout, the  
COP should be serviced during any software erase routine.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
51  
Chapter 4 Memory  
4.4.3  
Program and Erase Command Execution  
The steps for executing any of the commands are listed below. The FCDIV register must be initialized and  
any error flags cleared before beginning command execution. The command execution steps are:  
1. Write a data value to an address in the FLASH array. The address and data information from this  
write is latched into the FLASH interface. This write is a required first step in any command  
sequence. For erase and blank check commands, the value of the data is not important. For page  
erase commands, the address may be any address in the 512-byte page of FLASH to be erased. For  
mass erase and blank check commands, the address can be any address in the FLASH memory.  
Whole pages of 512 bytes are the smallest block of FLASH that may be erased. In the 60K version,  
there are two instances where the size of a block that is accessible to the user is less than 512 bytes:  
the first page following RAM, and the first page following the high page registers. These pages are  
overlapped by the RAM and high page registers respectively.  
NOTE  
Do not program any byte in the FLASH more than once after a successful  
erase operation. Reprogramming bits to a byte which is already  
programmed is not allowed without first erasing the page in which the byte  
resides or mass erasing the entire FLASH memory. Programming without  
first erasing may disturb data stored in the FLASH.  
2. Write the command code for the desired command to FCMD. The five valid commands are blank  
check ($05), byte program ($20), burst program ($25), page erase ($40), and mass erase ($41).  
The command code is latched into the command buffer.  
3. Write a 1 to the FCBEF bit in FSTAT to clear FCBEF and launch the command (including its  
address and data information).  
A partial command sequence can be aborted manually by writing a 0 to FCBEF any time after the write to  
the memory array and before writing the 1 that clears FCBEF and launches the complete command.  
Aborting a command in this way sets the FACCERR access error flag which must be cleared before  
starting a new command.  
A strictly monitored procedure must be obeyed or the command will not be accepted. This minimizes the  
possibility of any unintended changes to the FLASH memory contents. The command complete flag  
(FCCF) indicates when a command is complete. The command sequence must be completed by clearing  
FCBEF to launch the command. Figure 4-3 is a flowchart for executing all of the commands except for  
burst programming. The FCDIV register must be initialized before using any FLASH commands. This  
only must be done once following a reset.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
52  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
(Note 1)  
Note 1: Required only once after reset.  
WRITE TO FCDIV  
START  
FLASH PROGRAM AND  
ERASE FLOW  
0
FACCERR ?  
1
CLEAR ERROR  
WRITE TO FLASH  
TO BUFFER ADDRESS AND DATA  
WRITE COMMAND TO FCMD  
WRITE 1 TO FCBEF  
Note 2: Wait at least four bus cycles  
before checking FCBEF or FCCF.  
TO LAUNCH COMMAND  
(Note 2)  
AND CLEAR FCBEF  
YES  
FPVIOL OR  
FACCERR ?  
ERROR EXIT  
NO  
0
FCCF ?  
1
DONE  
Figure 4-3. FLASH Program and Erase Flowchart  
4.4.4  
Burst Program Execution  
The burst program command is used to program sequential bytes of data in less time than would be  
required using the standard program command. This is possible because the high voltage to the FLASH  
array does not need to be disabled between program operations. Ordinarily, when a program or erase  
command is issued, an internal charge pump associated with the FLASH memory must be enabled to  
supply high voltage to the array. Upon completion of the command, the charge pump is turned off. When  
a burst program command is issued, the charge pump is enabled and then remains enabled after completion  
of the burst program operation if these two conditions are met:  
The next burst program command has been queued before the current program operation has  
completed.  
The next sequential address selects a byte on the same physical row as the current byte being  
programmed. A row of FLASH memory consists of 64 bytes. A byte within a row is selected by  
addresses A5 through A0. A new row begins when addresses A5 through A0 are all zero.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
53  
Chapter 4 Memory  
The first byte of a series of sequential bytes being programmed in burst mode will take the same amount  
of time to program as a byte programmed in standard mode. Subsequent bytes will program in the burst  
program time provided that the conditions above are met. In the case the next sequential address is the  
beginning of a new row, the program time for that byte will be the standard time instead of the burst time.  
This is because the high voltage to the array must be disabled and then enabled again. If a new burst  
command has not been queued before the current command completes, then the charge pump will be  
disabled and high voltage removed from the array.  
(Note 1)  
Note 1: Required only once after reset.  
WRITE TO FCDIV  
FLASH BURST  
PROGRAM FLOW  
START  
0
FACCERR ?  
1
CLEAR ERROR  
0
FCBEF ?  
1
WRITE TO FLASH  
TO BUFFER ADDRESS AND DATA  
WRITE COMMAND ($25) TO FCMD  
WRITE 1 TO FCBEF  
Note 2: Wait at least four bus cycles before  
checking FCBEF or FCCF.  
TO LAUNCH COMMAND  
(Note 2)  
AND CLEAR FCBEF  
YES  
FPVIO OR  
FACCERR ?  
ERROR EXIT  
NO  
YES  
NEW BURST COMMAND ?  
NO  
0
FCCF ?  
1
DONE  
Figure 4-4. FLASH Burst Program Flowchart  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
54  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
4.4.5  
Access Errors  
An access error occurs whenever the command execution protocol is violated.  
Any of the following specific actions will cause the access error flag (FACCERR) in FSTAT to be set.  
FACCERR must be cleared by writing a 1 to FACCERR in FSTAT before any command can be processed.  
Writing to a FLASH address before the internal FLASH clock frequency has been set by writing  
to the FCDIV register  
Writing to a FLASH address while FCBEF is not set (A new command cannot be started until the  
command buffer is empty.)  
Writing a second time to a FLASH address before launching the previous command (There is only  
one write to FLASH for every command.)  
Writing a second time to FCMD before launching the previous command (There is only one write  
to FCMD for every command.)  
Writing to any FLASH control register other than FCMD after writing to a FLASH address  
Writing any command code other than the five allowed codes ($05, $20, $25, $40, or $41) to  
FCMD  
Accessing (read or write) any FLASH control register other than the write to FSTAT (to clear  
FCBEF and launch the command) after writing the command to FCMD.  
The MCU enters stop mode while a program or erase command is in progress (The command is  
aborted.)  
Writing the byte program, burst program, or page erase command code ($20, $25, or $40) with a  
background debug command while the MCU is secured (The background debug controller can  
only do blank check and mass erase commands when the MCU is secure.)  
Writing 0 to FCBEF to cancel a partial command  
4.4.6  
FLASH Block Protection  
The block protection feature prevents the protected region of FLASH from program or erase changes.  
Block protection is controlled through the FLASH Protection Register (FPROT). When enabled, block  
protection begins at any 512 byte boundary below the last address of FLASH, $FFFF. (see Section 4.6.4,  
“FLASH Protection Register (FPROT and NVPROT)”).  
After exit from reset, FPROT is loaded with the contents of the NVPROT location which is in the  
nonvolatile register block of the FLASH memory. FPROT cannot be changed directly from application  
software so a runaway program cannot alter the block protection settings. Since NVPROT is within the last  
512 bytes of FLASH, if any amount of memory is protected, NVPROT is itself protected and cannot be  
altered (intentionally or unintentionally) by the application software. FPROT can be written through  
background debug commands which allows a way to erase and reprogram a protected FLASH memory.  
The block protection mechanism is illustrated below. The FPS bits are used as the upper bits of the last  
address of unprotected memory. This address is formed by concatenating FPS7:FPS1 with logic 1 bits as  
shown. For example, in order to protect the last 8192 bytes of memory (addresses $E000 through $FFFF),  
the FPS bits must be set to 1101 111 which results in the value $DFFF as the last address of unprotected  
memory. In addition to programming the FPS bits to the appropriate value, FPDIS (bit 0 of NVPROT) must  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
55  
Chapter 4 Memory  
be programmed to logic 0 to enable block protection. Therefore the value $DE must be programmed into  
NVPROT to protect addresses $E000 through $FFFF.  
FPS7 FPS6 FPS5 FPS4 FPS3 FPS2 FPS1  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
A15 A14  
A13  
A12  
A11  
A10  
A9  
A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0  
Figure 4-5. Block Protection Mechanism  
One use for block protection is to block protect an area of FLASH memory for a bootloader program. This  
bootloader program then can be used to erase the rest of the FLASH memory and reprogram it. Because  
the bootloader is protected, it remains intact even if MCU power is lost in the middle of an erase and  
reprogram operation.  
4.4.7  
Vector Redirection  
Whenever any block protection is enabled, the reset and interrupt vectors will be protected. Vector  
redirection allows users to modify interrupt vector information without unprotecting bootloader and reset  
vector space. Vector redirection is enabled by programming the FNORED bit in the NVOPT register  
located at address $FFBF to zero. For redirection to occur, at least some portion but not all of the FLASH  
memory must be block protected by programming the NVPROT register located at address $FFBD. All of  
the interrupt vectors (memory locations $FFC0–$FFFD) are redirected, though the reset vector  
($FFFE:FFFF) is not.  
For example, if 512 bytes of FLASH are protected, the protected address region is from $FE00 through  
$FFFF. The interrupt vectors ($FFC0–$FFFD) are redirected to the locations $FDC0–$FDFD. Now, if an  
SPI interrupt is taken for instance, the values in the locations $FDE0:FDE1 are used for the vector instead  
of the values in the locations $FFE0:FFE1. This allows the user to reprogram the unprotected portion of  
the FLASH with new program code including new interrupt vector values while leaving the protected area,  
which includes the default vector locations, unchanged.  
4.5  
Security  
The MC9S08AW60 Series includes circuitry to prevent unauthorized access to the contents of FLASH and  
RAM memory. When security is engaged, FLASH and RAM are considered secure resources. Direct-page  
registers, high-page registers, and the background debug controller are considered unsecured resources.  
Programs executing within secure memory have normal access to any MCU memory locations and  
resources. Attempts to access a secure memory location with a program executing from an unsecured  
memory space or through the background debug interface are blocked (writes are ignored and reads return  
all 0s).  
Security is engaged or disengaged based on the state of two nonvolatile register bits (SEC01:SEC00) in  
the FOPT register. During reset, the contents of the nonvolatile location NVOPT are copied from FLASH  
into the working FOPT register in high-page register space. A user engages security by programming the  
NVOPT location which can be done at the same time the FLASH memory is programmed. The 1:0 state  
disengages security and the other three combinations engage security. Notice the erased state (1:1) makes  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
56  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
the MCU secure. During development, whenever the FLASH is erased, it is good practice to immediately  
program the SEC00 bit to 0 in NVOPT so SEC01:SEC00 = 1:0. This would allow the MCU to remain  
unsecured after a subsequent reset.  
The on-chip debug module cannot be enabled while the MCU is secure. The separate background debug  
controller can still be used for background memory access commands, but the MCU cannot enter active  
background mode except by holding BKGD/MS low at the rising edge of reset.  
A user can choose to allow or disallow a security unlocking mechanism through an 8-byte backdoor  
security key. If the nonvolatile KEYEN bit in NVOPT/FOPT is 0, the backdoor key is disabled and there  
is no way to disengage security without completely erasing all FLASH locations. If KEYEN is 1, a secure  
user program can temporarily disengage security by:  
1. Writing 1 to KEYACC in the FCNFG register. This makes the FLASH module interpret writes to  
the backdoor comparison key locations (NVBACKKEY through NVBACKKEY+7) as values to  
be compared against the key rather than as the first step in a FLASH program or erase command.  
2. Writing the user-entered key values to the NVBACKKEY through NVBACKKEY+7 locations.  
These writes must be done in order starting with the value for NVBACKKEY and ending with  
NVBACKKEY+7. STHX should not be used for these writes because these writes cannot be done  
on adjacent bus cycles. User software normally would get the key codes from outside the MCU  
system through a communication interface such as a serial I/O.  
3. Writing 0 to KEYACC in the FCNFG register. If the 8-byte key that was just written matches the  
key stored in the FLASH locations, SEC01:SEC00 are automatically changed to 1:0 and security  
will be disengaged until the next reset.  
The security key can be written only from secure memory (either RAM or FLASH), so it cannot be entered  
through background commands without the cooperation of a secure user program.  
The backdoor comparison key (NVBACKKEY through NVBACKKEY+7) is located in FLASH memory  
locations in the nonvolatile register space so users can program these locations exactly as they would  
program any other FLASH memory location. The nonvolatile registers are in the same 512-byte block of  
FLASH as the reset and interrupt vectors, so block protecting that space also block protects the backdoor  
comparison key. Block protects cannot be changed from user application programs, so if the vector space  
is block protected, the backdoor security key mechanism cannot permanently change the block protect,  
security settings, or the backdoor key.  
Security can always be disengaged through the background debug interface by taking these steps:  
1. Disable any block protections by writing FPROT. FPROT can be written only with background  
debug commands, not from application software.  
2. Mass erase FLASH if necessary.  
3. Blank check FLASH. Provided FLASH is completely erased, security is disengaged until the next  
reset.  
To avoid returning to secure mode after the next reset, program NVOPT so SEC01:SEC00 = 1:0.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
57  
Chapter 4 Memory  
4.6  
FLASH Registers and Control Bits  
The FLASH module has nine 8-bit registers in the high-page register space, three locations in the  
nonvolatile register space in FLASH memory which are copied into three corresponding high-page control  
registers at reset. There is also an 8-byte comparison key in FLASH memory. Refer to Table 4-3 and  
Table 4-4 for the absolute address assignments for all FLASH registers. This section refers to registers and  
control bits only by their names. A Freescale-provided equate or header file normally is used to translate  
these names into the appropriate absolute addresses.  
4.6.1  
FLASH Clock Divider Register (FCDIV)  
Bit 7 of this register is a read-only status flag. Bits 6 through 0 may be read at any time but can be written  
only one time. Before any erase or programming operations are possible, write to this register to set the  
frequency of the clock for the nonvolatile memory system within acceptable limits.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
DIVLD  
PRDIV8  
DIV5  
DIV4  
DIV3  
DIV2  
DIV1  
DIV0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 4-6. FLASH Clock Divider Register (FCDIV)  
Table 4-6. FCDIV Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Divisor Loaded Status Flag — When set, this read-only status flag indicates that the FCDIV register has been  
written since reset. Reset clears this bit and the first write to this register causes this bit to become set regardless  
of the data written.  
DIVLD  
0 FCDIV has not been written since reset; erase and program operations disabled for FLASH.  
1 FCDIV has been written since reset; erase and program operations enabled for FLASH.  
6
Prescale (Divide) FLASH Clock by 8  
PRDIV8  
0 Clock input to the FLASH clock divider is the bus rate clock.  
1 Clock input to the FLASH clock divider is the bus rate clock divided by 8.  
5:0  
DIV[5:0]  
Divisor for FLASH Clock Divider — The FLASH clock divider divides the bus rate clock (or the bus rate clock  
divided by 8 if PRDIV8 = 1) by the value in the 6-bit DIV5:DIV0 field plus one. The resulting frequency of the  
internal FLASH clock must fall within the range of 200 kHz to 150 kHz for proper FLASH operations.  
Program/Erase timing pulses are one cycle of this internal FLASH clock which corresponds to a range of 5 μs to  
6.7 μs. The automated programming logic uses an integer number of these pulses to complete an erase or  
program operation. See Equation 4-1, Equation 4-2, and Table 4-6.  
if PRDIV8 = 0 — f  
if PRDIV8 = 1 — f  
= f  
÷ ([DIV5:DIV0] + 1)  
Bus  
Eqn. 4-1  
Eqn. 4-2  
FCLK  
= f  
÷ (8 × ([DIV5:DIV0] + 1))  
FCLK  
Bus  
Table 4-7 shows the appropriate values for PRDIV8 and DIV5:DIV0 for selected bus frequencies.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
58  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
Table 4-7. FLASH Clock Divider Settings  
PRDIV8  
(Binary)  
DIV5:DIV0  
fFCLK  
Program/Erase Timing Pulse  
fBus  
(Decimal)  
(5 μs Min, 6.7 μs Max)  
20 MHz  
10 MHz  
8 MHz  
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
12  
49  
39  
19  
9
192.3 kHz  
200 kHz  
200 kHz  
200 kHz  
200 kHz  
200 kHz  
200 kHz  
150 kHz  
5.2 μs  
5 μs  
5 μs  
4 MHz  
5 μs  
2 MHz  
5 μs  
1 MHz  
4
5 μs  
200 kHz  
150 kHz  
0
5 μs  
0
6.7 μs  
4.6.2  
FLASH Options Register (FOPT and NVOPT)  
During reset, the contents of the nonvolatile location NVOPT are copied from FLASH into FOPT. Bits 5  
through 2 are not used and always read 0. This register may be read at any time, but writes have no meaning  
or effect. To change the value in this register, erase and reprogram the NVOPT location in FLASH memory  
as usual and then issue a new MCU reset.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
KEYEN  
FNORED  
0
0
0
0
SEC01  
SEC00  
Reset  
This register is loaded from nonvolatile location NVOPT during reset.  
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 4-7. FLASH Options Register (FOPT)  
Table 4-8. FOPT Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Backdoor Key Mechanism Enable — When this bit is 0, the backdoor key mechanism cannot be used to  
disengage security. The backdoor key mechanism is accessible only from user (secured) firmware. BDM  
commands cannot be used to write key comparison values that would unlock the backdoor key. For more detailed  
information about the backdoor key mechanism, refer to Section 4.5, “Security.”  
KEYEN  
0 No backdoor key access allowed.  
1 If user firmware writes an 8-byte value that matches the nonvolatile backdoor key (NVBACKKEY through  
NVBACKKEY+7 in that order), security is temporarily disengaged until the next MCU reset.  
6
Vector Redirection Disable — When this bit is 1, then vector redirection is disabled.  
FNORED 0 Vector redirection enabled.  
1 Vector redirection disabled.  
1:0  
Security State Code — This 2-bit field determines the security state of the MCU as shown in Table 4-9. When  
SEC0[1:0] the MCU is secure, the contents of RAM and FLASH memory cannot be accessed by instructions from any  
unsecured source including the background debug interface. For more detailed information about security, refer  
to Section 4.5, “Security.”  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
59  
Chapter 4 Memory  
Table 4-9. Security States  
SEC01:SEC00  
Description  
0:0  
0:1  
1:0  
1:1  
secure  
secure  
unsecured  
secure  
SEC01:SEC00 changes to 1:0 after successful backdoor key entry or a successful blank check of FLASH.  
4.6.3  
FLASH Configuration Register (FCNFG)  
Bits 7 through 5 may be read or written at any time. Bits 4 through 0 always read 0 and cannot be written.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
KEYACC  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 4-8. FLASH Configuration Register (FCNFG)  
Table 4-10. FCNFG Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
5
Enable Writing of Access Key — This bit enables writing of the backdoor comparison key. For more detailed  
information about the backdoor key mechanism, refer to Section 4.5, “Security.”  
KEYACC  
0 Writes to $FFB0–$FFB7 are interpreted as the start of a FLASH programming or erase command.  
1 Writes to NVBACKKEY ($FFB0–$FFB7) are interpreted as comparison key writes.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
60  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
4.6.4  
FLASH Protection Register (FPROT and NVPROT)  
During reset, the contents of the nonvolatile location NVPROT are copied from FLASH into FPROT. This  
register may be read at any time.  
If FPDIS = 0, then protection can be increased (in other words, a smaller value of FPS can be  
written).  
If FPDIS = 1, then writes do not change protection.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
FPS7  
FPS6  
FPS5  
FPS4  
FPS3  
FPS2  
FPS1  
FPDIS  
(1)  
(1)  
(1)  
(1)  
(1)  
(1)  
(1)  
(1)  
W
Reset  
This register is loaded from nonvolatile location NVPROT during reset.  
1
Background commands can be used to change the contents of these bits in FPROT.  
Figure 4-9. FLASH Protection Register (FPROT)  
Table 4-11. FPROT Register Field Descriptions  
Field  
Description  
7:1  
FPS[7:1]  
FLASH Protect Select Bits — When FPDIS = 0, this 7-bit field determines the ending address of unprotected  
FLASH locations at the high address end of the FLASH. Protected FLASH locations cannot be erased or  
programmed.  
0
FLASH Protection Disable  
FPDIS  
0 FLASH block specified by FPS[7:1] is block protected (program and erase not allowed).  
1 No FLASH block is protected.  
4.6.5  
FLASH Status Register (FSTAT)  
Bits 3, 1, and 0 always read 0 and writes have no meaning or effect. The remaining five bits are status bits  
that can be read at any time. Writes to these bits have special meanings that are discussed in the bit  
descriptions.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
FCCF  
0
FBLANK  
0
0
FCBEF  
FPVIOL  
FACCERR  
Reset  
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 4-10. FLASH Status Register (FSTAT)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
61  
Chapter 4 Memory  
Field  
Table 4-12. FSTAT Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
7
FLASH Command Buffer Empty Flag — The FCBEF bit is used to launch commands. It also indicates that the  
command buffer is empty so that a new command sequence can be executed when performing burst  
programming. The FCBEF bit is cleared by writing a one to it or when a burst program command is transferred  
to the array for programming. Only burst program commands can be buffered.  
FCBEF  
0 Command buffer is full (not ready for additional commands).  
1 A new burst program command may be written to the command buffer.  
6
FLASH Command Complete Flag — FCCF is set automatically when the command buffer is empty and no  
command is being processed. FCCF is cleared automatically when a new command is started (by writing 1 to  
FCBEF to register a command). Writing to FCCF has no meaning or effect.  
0 Command in progress  
FCCF  
1 All commands complete  
5
Protection Violation Flag — FPVIOL is set automatically when FCBEF is cleared to register a command that  
attempts to erase or program a location in a protected block (the erroneous command is ignored). FPVIOL is  
cleared by writing a 1 to FPVIOL.  
FPVIOL  
0 No protection violation.  
1 An attempt was made to erase or program a protected location.  
4
Access Error Flag — FACCERR is set automatically when the proper command sequence is not obeyed exactly  
FACCERR (the erroneous command is ignored), if a program or erase operation is attempted before the FCDIV register has  
been initialized, or if the MCU enters stop while a command was in progress. For a more detailed discussion of  
the exact actions that are considered access errors, see Section 4.4.5, “Access Errors.” FACCERR is cleared by  
writing a 1 to FACCERR. Writing a 0 to FACCERR has no meaning or effect.  
0 No access error.  
1 An access error has occurred.  
2
FLASH Verified as All Blank (erased) Flag — FBLANK is set automatically at the conclusion of a blank check  
command if the entire FLASH array was verified to be erased. FBLANK is cleared by clearing FCBEF to write a  
new valid command. Writing to FBLANK has no meaning or effect.  
FBLANK  
0 After a blank check command is completed and FCCF = 1, FBLANK = 0 indicates the FLASH array is not  
completely erased.  
1 After a blank check command is completed and FCCF = 1, FBLANK = 1 indicates the FLASH array is  
completely erased (all $FF).  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
62  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 4 Memory  
4.6.6  
FLASH Command Register (FCMD)  
Only five command codes are recognized in normal user modes as shown in Table 4-14. Refer to  
Section 4.4.3, “Program and Erase Command Execution” for a detailed discussion of FLASH  
programming and erase operations.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FCMD7  
FCMD6  
FCMD5  
FCMD4  
FCMD3  
FCMD2  
FCMD1  
FCMD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 4-11. FLASH Command Register (FCMD)  
Table 4-13. FCMD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
FCMD[7:0] FLASH Command Bits — See Table 4-14  
Table 4-14. FLASH Commands  
Command  
FCMD  
Equate File Label  
Blank check  
$05  
$20  
$25  
$40  
$41  
mBlank  
Byte program  
mByteProg  
mBurstProg  
mPageErase  
mMassErase  
Byte program — burst mode  
Page erase (512 bytes/page)  
Mass erase (all FLASH)  
All other command codes are illegal and generate an access error.  
It is not necessary to perform a blank check command after a mass erase operation. Only blank check is  
required as part of the security unlocking mechanism.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
63  
Chapter 4 Memory  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
64  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 5  
Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
5.1  
Introduction  
This chapter discusses basic reset and interrupt mechanisms and the various sources of reset and interrupts  
in the MC9S08AW60 Series. Some interrupt sources from peripheral modules are discussed in greater  
detail within other chapters of this data manual. This chapter gathers basic information about all reset and  
interrupt sources in one place for easy reference. A few reset and interrupt sources, including the computer  
operating properly (COP) watchdog and real-time interrupt (RTI), are not part of on-chip peripheral  
systems with their own sections but are part of the system control logic.  
5.2  
Features  
Reset and interrupt features include:  
Multiple sources of reset for flexible system configuration and reliable operation:  
— Power-on detection (POR)  
— Low voltage detection (LVD) with enable  
— External RESET pin  
— COP watchdog with enable and two timeout choices  
— Illegal opcode  
— Serial command from a background debug host  
Reset status register (SRS) to indicate source of most recent reset  
Separate interrupt vectors for each module (reduces polling overhead) (see Table 5-10)  
5.3  
MCU Reset  
Resetting the MCU provides a way to start processing from a known set of initial conditions. During reset,  
most control and status registers are forced to initial values and the program counter is loaded from the  
reset vector ($FFFE:$FFFF). On-chip peripheral modules are disabled and I/O pins are initially configured  
as general-purpose high-impedance inputs with pullup devices disabled. The I bit in the condition code  
register (CCR) is set to block maskable interrupts so the user program has a chance to initialize the stack  
pointer (SP) and system control settings. SP is forced to $00FF at reset.  
The MC9S08AW60 Series has seven sources for reset:  
Power-on reset (POR)  
Low-voltage detect (LVD)  
Computer operating properly (COP) timer  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
65  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
Illegal opcode detect  
Background debug forced reset  
The reset pin (RESET)  
Clock generator loss of lock and loss of clock reset  
Each of these sources, with the exception of the background debug forced reset, has an associated bit in  
the system reset status register. Whenever the MCU enters reset, the internal clock generator (ICG) module  
switches to self-clocked mode with the frequency of f  
selected. The reset pin is driven low for 34  
Self_reset  
bus cycles where the internal bus frequency is half the ICG frequency. After the 34 bus cycles are  
completed, the pin is released and will be pulled up by the internal pullup resistor, unless it is held low  
externally. After the pin is released, it is sampled after another 38 bus cycles to determine whether the reset  
pin is the cause of the MCU reset.  
5.4  
Computer Operating Properly (COP) Watchdog  
The COP watchdog is intended to force a system reset when the application software fails to execute as  
expected. To prevent a system reset from the COP timer (when it is enabled), application software must  
reset the COP timer periodically. If the application program gets lost and fails to reset the COP before it  
times out, a system reset is generated to force the system back to a known starting point. The COP  
watchdog is enabled by the COPE bit in SOPT (see Section 5.9.4, “System Options Register (SOPT)” for  
additional information). The COP timer is reset by writing any value to the address of SRS. This write does  
not affect the data in the read-only SRS. Instead, the act of writing to this address is decoded and sends a  
reset signal to the COP timer.  
After any reset, the COP timer is enabled. This provides a reliable way to detect code that is not executing  
as intended. If the COP watchdog is not used in an application, it can be disabled by clearing the COPE  
bit in the write-once SOPT register. Also, the COPT bit can be used to choose one of two timeout periods  
18  
13  
(2 or 2 cycles of the bus rate clock). Even if the application will use the reset default settings in COPE  
and COPT, the user should write to write-once SOPT during reset initialization to lock in the settings. That  
way, they cannot be changed accidentally if the application program gets lost.  
The write to SRS that services (clears) the COP timer should not be placed in an interrupt service routine  
(ISR) because the ISR could continue to be executed periodically even if the main application program  
fails.  
When the MCU is in active background mode, the COP timer is temporarily disabled.  
5.5  
Interrupts  
Interrupts provide a way to save the current CPU status and registers, execute an interrupt service routine  
(ISR), and then restore the CPU status so processing resumes where it left off before the interrupt. Other  
than the software interrupt (SWI), which is a program instruction, interrupts are caused by hardware events  
such as an edge on the IRQ pin or a timer-overflow event. The debug module can also generate an SWI  
under certain circumstances.  
If an event occurs in an enabled interrupt source, an associated read-only status flag will become set. The  
CPU will not respond until and unless the local interrupt enable is a logic 1 to enable the interrupt. The  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
66  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
I bit in the CCR is 0 to allow interrupts. The global interrupt mask (I bit) in the CCR is initially set after  
reset which masks (prevents) all maskable interrupt sources. The user program initializes the stack pointer  
and performs other system setup before clearing the I bit to allow the CPU to respond to interrupts.  
When the CPU receives a qualified interrupt request, it completes the current instruction before responding  
to the interrupt. The interrupt sequence obeys the same cycle-by-cycle sequence as the SWI instruction and  
consists of:  
Saving the CPU registers on the stack  
Setting the I bit in the CCR to mask further interrupts  
Fetching the interrupt vector for the highest-priority interrupt that is currently pending  
Filling the instruction queue with the first three bytes of program information starting from the  
address fetched from the interrupt vector locations  
While the CPU is responding to the interrupt, the I bit is automatically set to avoid the possibility of another  
interrupt interrupting the ISR itself (this is called nesting of interrupts). Normally, the I bit is restored to 0  
when the CCR is restored from the value stacked on entry to the ISR. In rare cases, the I bit may be cleared  
inside an ISR (after clearing the status flag that generated the interrupt) so that other interrupts can be  
serviced without waiting for the first service routine to finish. This practice is not recommended for anyone  
other than the most experienced programmers because it can lead to subtle program errors that are difficult  
to debug.  
The interrupt service routine ends with a return-from-interrupt (RTI) instruction which restores the CCR,  
A, X, and PC registers to their pre-interrupt values by reading the previously saved information off the  
stack.  
NOTE  
For compatibility with the M68HC08, the H register is not automatically  
saved and restored. It is good programming practice to push H onto the stack  
at the start of the interrupt service routine (ISR) and restore it immediately  
before the RTI that is used to return from the ISR.  
When two or more interrupts are pending when the I bit is cleared, the highest priority source is serviced  
first (see Table 5-1).  
5.5.1  
Interrupt Stack Frame  
Figure 5-1 shows the contents and organization of a stack frame. Before the interrupt, the stack pointer  
(SP) points at the next available byte location on the stack. The current values of CPU registers are stored  
on the stack starting with the low-order byte of the program counter (PCL) and ending with the CCR. After  
stacking, the SP points at the next available location on the stack which is the address that is one less than  
the address where the CCR was saved. The PC value that is stacked is the address of the instruction in the  
main program that would have executed next if the interrupt had not occurred.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
67  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
TOWARD LOWER ADDRESSES  
UNSTACKING  
ORDER  
7
0
SP AFTER  
INTERRUPT STACKING  
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4
5
CONDITION CODE REGISTER  
ACCUMULATOR  
*
INDEX REGISTER (LOW BYTE X)  
PROGRAM COUNTER HIGH  
PROGRAM COUNTER LOW  
SP BEFORE  
THE INTERRUPT  
STACKING  
ORDER  
TOWARD HIGHER ADDRESSES  
* High byte (H) of index register is not automatically stacked.  
Figure 5-1. Interrupt Stack Frame  
When an RTI instruction is executed, these values are recovered from the stack in reverse order. As part of  
the RTI sequence, the CPU fills the instruction pipeline by reading three bytes of program information,  
starting from the PC address recovered from the stack.  
The status flag causing the interrupt must be acknowledged (cleared) before returning from the ISR.  
Typically, the flag should be cleared at the beginning of the ISR so that if another interrupt is generated by  
this same source, it will be registered so it can be serviced after completion of the current ISR.  
5.5.2  
External Interrupt Request (IRQ) Pin  
External interrupts are managed by the IRQSC status and control register. When the IRQ function is  
enabled, synchronous logic monitors the pin for edge-only or edge-and-level events. When the MCU is in  
stop mode and system clocks are shut down, a separate asynchronous path is used so the IRQ (if enabled)  
can wake the MCU.  
5.5.2.1  
Pin Configuration Options  
The IRQ pin enable (IRQPE) control bit in the IRQSC register must be 1 in order for the IRQ pin to act as  
the interrupt request (IRQ) input. As an IRQ input, the user can choose the polarity of edges or levels  
detected (IRQEDG), whether the pin detects edges-only or edges and levels (IRQMOD), and whether an  
event causes an interrupt or only sets the IRQF flag which can be polled by software.  
When the IRQ pin is configured to detect rising edges, an optional pulldown resistor is available rather than  
a pullup resistor. BIH and BIL instructions may be used to detect the level on the IRQ pin when the pin is  
configured to act as the IRQ input.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
68  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
NOTE  
The voltage measured on the pulled up IRQ pin may be as low as  
– 0.7 V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled all the way  
V
DD  
to V . All other pins with enabled pullup resistors will have an unloaded  
DD  
measurement of V  
.
DD  
5.5.2.2  
Edge and Level Sensitivity  
The IRQMOD control bit reconfigures the detection logic so it detects edge events and pin levels. In this  
edge detection mode, the IRQF status flag becomes set when an edge is detected (when the IRQ pin  
changes from the deasserted to the asserted level), but the flag is continuously set (and cannot be cleared)  
as long as the IRQ pin remains at the asserted level.  
5.5.3  
Interrupt Vectors, Sources, and Local Masks  
Table 5-1 provides a summary of all interrupt sources. Higher-priority sources are located toward the  
bottom of the table. The high-order byte of the address for the interrupt service routine is located at the  
first address in the vector address column, and the low-order byte of the address for the interrupt service  
routine is located at the next higher address.  
When an interrupt condition occurs, an associated flag bit becomes set. If the associated local interrupt  
enable is 1, an interrupt request is sent to the CPU. Within the CPU, if the global interrupt mask (I bit in  
the CCR) is 0, the CPU will finish the current instruction, stack the PCL, PCH, X, A, and CCR CPU  
registers, set the I bit, and then fetch the interrupt vector for the highest priority pending interrupt.  
Processing then continues in the interrupt service routine.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
69  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
Table 5-1. Vector Summary  
Vector  
Priority  
Vector  
Number  
Address  
(High/Low)  
Vector Name Module  
Source  
Enable  
Description  
Lower  
26  
through  
31  
$FFC0/FFC1  
through  
$FFCA/FFCB  
Unused Vector Space  
(available for user program)  
25  
$FFCC/FFCD  
Vrti  
System  
control  
RTIF  
RTIE  
Real-time interrupt  
24  
23  
22  
21  
$FFCE/FFCF  
$FFD0/FFD1  
$FFD2/FFD3  
$FFD4/FFD5  
Viic1  
Vadc1  
Vkeyboard 1  
Vsci2tx  
IIC1  
ADC1  
KBI1  
SCI2  
IICIF  
COCO  
KBF  
TDRE  
TC  
IICIE  
AIEN  
KBIE  
TIE  
TCIE  
IIC1  
ADC1  
KBI1 pins  
SCI2 transmit  
20  
19  
$FFD6/FFD7  
$FFD8/FFD9  
Vsci2rx  
SCI2  
SCI2  
IDLE  
RDRF  
OR  
NF  
FE  
PF  
ILIE  
RIE  
ORIE  
NFIE  
FEIE  
PFIE  
SCI2 receive  
SCI2 error  
Vsci2err  
18  
17  
16  
$FFDA/FFDB  
$FFDC/FFDD  
$FFDE/FFDF  
Vsci1tx  
Vsci1rx  
Vsci1err  
SCI1  
SCI1  
SCI1  
TDRE  
TC  
IDLE  
TIE  
TCIE  
SCI1 transmit  
SCI1 receive  
SCI1 error  
ILIE  
RIE  
ORIE  
NFIE  
FEIE  
PFIE  
RDRF  
OR  
NF  
FE  
PF  
15  
$FFE0/FFE1  
Vspi1  
SPI1  
SPIF  
MODF  
SPTEF  
SPIE  
SPIE  
SPTIE  
SPI1  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
6
5
$FFE2/FFE3  
$FFE4/FFE5  
$FFE6/FFE7  
$FFE8/FFE9  
$FFEA/FFEB  
$FFEC/FFED  
$FFEE/FFEF  
$FFF0/FFF1  
$FFF2/FFF3  
$FFF4/FFF5  
$FFF6/FFF7  
Vtpm2ovf  
Vtpm2ch1  
Vtpm2ch0  
Vtpm1ovf  
Vtpm1ch5  
Vtpm1ch4  
Vtpm1ch3  
Vtpm1ch2  
Vtpm1ch1  
Vtpm1ch0  
Vicg  
TPM2  
TPM2  
TPM2  
TPM1  
TPM1  
TPM1  
TPM1  
TPM1  
TPM1  
TPM1  
ICG  
TOF  
CH1F  
CH0F  
TOF  
CH5F  
CH4F  
CH3F  
CH2F  
CH1F  
CH0F  
TOIE  
CH1IE  
CH0IE  
TOIE  
CH5IE  
CH4IE  
CH3IE  
CH2IE  
CH1IE  
TPM2 overflow  
TPM2 channel 1  
TPM2 channel 0  
TPM1 overflow  
TPM1 channel 5  
TPM1 channel 4  
TPM1 channel 3  
TPM1 channel 2  
TPM1 channel 1  
TPM1 channel 0  
ICG  
CH0IE  
4
ICGIF  
LOLRE/LOCRE  
(LOLS/LOCS)  
3
$FFF8/FFF9  
Vlvd  
System  
control  
IRQ  
LVDF  
IRQF  
LVDIE  
Low-voltage detect  
2
1
$FFFA/FFFB  
$FFFC/FFFD  
Virq  
Vswi  
IRQIE  
IRQ pin  
Software interrupt  
Core  
SWI  
Instruction  
0
$FFFE/FFFF  
Vreset  
System  
control  
COP  
LVD  
RESET pin  
Illegal opcode  
COPE  
LVDRE  
Watchdog timer  
Low-voltage detect  
External pin  
Higher  
Illegal opcode  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
70  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
5.6  
Low-Voltage Detect (LVD) System  
The MC9S08AW60 Series includes a system to protect against low voltage conditions in order to protect  
memory contents and control MCU system states during supply voltage variations. The system is  
comprised of a power-on reset (POR) circuit and an LVD circuit with a user selectable trip voltage, either  
high (V  
) or low (V  
). The LVD circuit is enabled when LVDE in SPMSC1 is high and the trip  
LVDH  
LVDL  
voltage is selected by LVDV in SPMSC2. The LVD is disabled upon entering any of the stop modes unless  
the LVDSE bit is set. If LVDSE and LVDE are both set, then the MCU cannot enter stop2, and the current  
consumption in stop3 with the LVD enabled will be greater.  
5.6.1  
Power-On Reset Operation  
When power is initially applied to the MCU, or when the supply voltage drops below the V  
level, the  
POR  
POR circuit will cause a reset condition. As the supply voltage rises, the LVD circuit will hold the chip in  
reset until the supply has risen above the V  
following a POR.  
level. Both the POR bit and the LVD bit in SRS are set  
LVDL  
5.6.2  
LVD Reset Operation  
The LVD can be configured to generate a reset upon detection of a low voltage condition by setting  
LVDRE to 1. After an LVD reset has occurred, the LVD system will hold the MCU in reset until the supply  
voltage has risen above the level determined by LVDV. The LVD bit in the SRS register is set following  
either an LVD reset or POR.  
5.6.3  
LVD Interrupt Operation  
When a low voltage condition is detected and the LVD circuit is configured for interrupt operation (LVDE  
set, LVDIE set, and LVDRE clear), then LVDF will be set and an LVD interrupt will occur.  
5.6.4  
Low-Voltage Warning (LVW)  
The LVD system has a low voltage warning flag to indicate to the user that the supply voltage is  
approaching, the LVD voltage. The LVW does not have an interrupt associated with it. There are two user  
selectable trip voltages for the LVW, one high (V  
) and one low (V  
). The trip voltage is selected  
LVWH  
LVWL  
by LVWV in SPMSC2. Setting the LVW trip voltage equal to the LVD trip voltage is not recommended.  
Typical use of the LVW would be to select V and V  
.
LVDL  
LVWH  
5.7  
Real-Time Interrupt (RTI)  
The real-time interrupt function can be used to generate periodic interrupts. The RTI can accept two  
sources of clocks, the 1-kHz internal clock or an external clock if available. The 1-kHz internal clock  
source is completely independent of any bus clock source and is used only by the RTI module and, on some  
MCUs, the COP watchdog. To use an external clock source, it must be available and active. The RTICLKS  
bit in SRTISC is used to select the RTI clock source.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
71  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
Either RTI clock source can be used when the MCU is in run, wait or stop3 mode. When using the external  
oscillator in stop3, it must be enabled in stop (OSCSTEN = 1) and configured for low bandwidth operation  
(RANGE = 0). Only the internal 1-kHz clock source can be selected to wake the MCU from stop2 mode.  
The SRTISC register includes a read-only status flag, a write-only acknowledge bit, and a 3-bit control  
value (RTIS2:RTIS1:RTIS0) used to disable the clock source to the real-time interrupt or select one of  
seven wakeup periods. The RTI has a local interrupt enable, RTIE, to allow masking of the real-time  
interrupt. The RTI can be disabled by writing each bit of RTIS to zeroes, and no interrupts will be  
generated. See Section 5.9.7, “System Real-Time Interrupt Status and Control Register (SRTISC),” for  
detailed information about this register.  
5.8  
MCLK Output  
The PTC2 pin is shared with the MCLK clock output. Setting the pin enable bit, MPE, causes the PTC2  
pin to output a divided version of the internal MCU bus clock. The divide ratio is determined by the  
MCSEL bits. When MPE is set, the PTC2 pin is forced to operate as an output pin regardless of the state  
of the port data direction control bit for the pin. If the MCSEL bits are all 0s, the pin is driven low. The  
slew rate and drive strength for the pin are controlled by PTCSE2 and PTCDS2, respectively. The  
maximum clock output frequency is limited if slew rate control is enabled, see Appendix A, “Electrical  
Characteristics and Timing Specifications,” for pin rise and fall times with slew rate enabled.  
5.9  
Reset, Interrupt, and System Control Registers and Control Bits  
One 8-bit register in the direct page register space and eight 8-bit registers in the high-page register space  
are related to reset and interrupt systems.  
Refer to the direct-page register summary in Chapter 4, “Memory,” of this data sheet for the absolute  
address assignments for all registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names.  
A Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute  
addresses.  
Some control bits in the SOPT and SPMSC2 registers are related to modes of operation. Although brief  
descriptions of these bits are provided here, the related functions are discussed in greater detail in  
Chapter 3, “Modes of Operation.”  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
72  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
5.9.1  
Interrupt Pin Request Status and Control Register (IRQSC)  
This direct page register includes two unimplemented bits which always read 0, four read/write bits, one  
read-only status bit, and one write-only bit. These bits are used to configure the IRQ function, report status,  
and acknowledge IRQ events.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
IRQF  
0
IRQEDG  
IRQPE  
IRQIE  
IRQMOD  
IRQACK  
0
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 5-2. Interrupt Request Status and Control Register (IRQSC)  
Table 5-2. IRQSC Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
5
Interrupt Request (IRQ) Edge Select — This read/write control bit is used to select the polarity of edges or  
levels on the IRQ pin that cause IRQF to be set. The IRQMOD control bit determines whether the IRQ pin is  
sensitive to both edges and levels or only edges. When the IRQ pin is enabled as the IRQ input and is configured  
to detect rising edges, the optional pullup resistor is re-configured as an optional pulldown resistor.  
0 IRQ is falling edge or falling edge/low-level sensitive.  
IRQEDG  
1 IRQ is rising edge or rising edge/high-level sensitive.  
4
IRQ Pin Enable — This read/write control bit enables the IRQ pin function. When this bit is set the IRQ pin can  
be used as an interrupt request. Also, when this bit is set, either an internal pull-up or an internal pull-down  
resistor is enabled depending on the state of the IRQEDG bit.  
IRQPE  
0 IRQ pin function is disabled.  
1 IRQ pin function is enabled.  
3
IRQ Flag — This read-only status bit indicates when an interrupt request event has occurred.  
IRQF  
0 No IRQ request.  
1 IRQ event detected.  
2
IRQ Acknowledge — This write-only bit is used to acknowledge interrupt request events (write 1 to clear IRQF).  
Writing 0 has no meaning or effect. Reads always return logic 0. If edge-and-level detection is selected  
(IRQMOD = 1), IRQF cannot be cleared while the IRQ pin remains at its asserted level.  
IRQACK  
1
IRQ Interrupt Enable — This read/write control bit determines whether IRQ events generate a hardware  
interrupt request.  
IRQIE  
0 Hardware interrupt requests from IRQF disabled (use polling).  
1 Hardware interrupt requested whenever IRQF = 1.  
0
IRQ Detection Mode — This read/write control bit selects either edge-only detection or edge-and-level  
IRQMOD detection. The IRQEDG control bit determines the polarity of edges and levels that are detected as interrupt  
request events. See Section 5.5.2.2, “Edge and Level Sensitivity” for more details.  
0 IRQ event on falling edges or rising edges only.  
1 IRQ event on falling edges and low levels or on rising edges and high levels.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
73  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
5.9.2  
System Reset Status Register (SRS)  
This register includes seven read-only status flags to indicate the source of the most recent reset. When a  
debug host forces reset by writing 1 to BDFR in the SBDFR register, none of the status bits in SRS will be  
set. Writing any value to this register address clears the COP watchdog timer without affecting the contents  
of this register. The reset state of these bits depends on what caused the MCU to reset.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
POR  
PIN  
COP  
ILOP  
0
ICG  
LVD  
0
Writing any value to SIMRS address clears COP watchdog timer.  
POR  
LVR:  
1
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
(1)  
(1)  
(1)  
(1)  
Any other  
reset:  
U = Unaffected by reset  
1
Any of these reset sources that are active at the time of reset will cause the corresponding bit(s) to be set; bits corresponding  
to sources that are not active at the time of reset will be cleared.  
Figure 5-3. System Reset Status (SRS)  
Table 5-3. SRS Register Field Descriptions  
Field  
Description  
7
POR  
Power-On Reset — Reset was caused by the power-on detection logic. Because the internal supply voltage was  
ramping up at the time, the low-voltage reset (LVR) status bit is also set to indicate that the reset occurred while  
the internal supply was below the LVR threshold.  
0 Reset not caused by POR.  
1 POR caused reset.  
6
PIN  
External Reset Pin — Reset was caused by an active-low level on the external reset pin.  
0 Reset not caused by external reset pin.  
1 Reset came from external reset pin.  
5
COP  
Computer Operating Properly (COP) Watchdog — Reset was caused by the COP watchdog timer timing out.  
This reset source may be blocked by COPE = 0.  
0 Reset not caused by COP timeout.  
1 Reset caused by COP timeout.  
4
Illegal Opcode — Reset was caused by an attempt to execute an unimplemented or illegal opcode. The STOP  
instruction is considered illegal if stop is disabled by STOPE = 0 in the SOPT register. The BGND instruction is  
considered illegal if active background mode is disabled by ENBDM = 0 in the BDCSC register.  
0 Reset not caused by an illegal opcode.  
ILOP  
1 Reset caused by an illegal opcode.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
74  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
Table 5-3. SRS Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
2
ICG  
Internal Clock Generation Module Reset — Reset was caused by an ICG module reset.  
0 Reset not caused by ICG module.  
1 Reset caused by ICG module.  
1
LVD  
Low Voltage Detect — If the LVDRE and LVDSE bits are set and the supply drops below the LVD trip voltage,  
an LVD reset will occur. This bit is also set by POR.  
0 Reset not caused by LVD trip or POR.  
1 Reset caused by LVD trip or POR.  
5.9.3  
System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR)  
This register contains a single write-only control bit. A serial background command such as  
WRITE_BYTE must be used to write to SBDFR. Attempts to write this register from a user program are  
ignored. Reads always return $00.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BDFR1  
0
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
1
BDFR is writable only through serial background debug commands, not from user programs.  
Figure 5-4. System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR)  
Table 5-4. SBDFR Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
0
Background Debug Force Reset — A serial background command such as WRITE_BYTE may be used to  
allow an external debug host to force a target system reset. Writing logic 1 to this bit forces an MCU reset. This  
bit cannot be written from a user program.  
BDFR  
5.9.4  
System Options Register (SOPT)  
This register may be read at any time. Bits 3 and 2 are unimplemented and always read 0. This is a  
write-once register so only the first write after reset is honored. Any subsequent attempt to write to SOPT  
(intentionally or unintentionally) is ignored to avoid accidental changes to these sensitive settings. SOPT  
should be written during the user’s reset initialization program to set the desired controls even if the desired  
settings are the same as the reset settings.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
75  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
COPE  
COPT  
STOPE  
Reset  
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 5-5. System Options Register (SOPT)  
Table 5-5. SOPT Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
COP Watchdog Enable — This write-once bit defaults to 1 after reset.  
0 COP watchdog timer disabled.  
COPE  
1 COP watchdog timer enabled (force reset on timeout).  
6
COP Watchdog Timeout — This write-once bit defaults to 1 after reset.  
0 Short timeout period selected (213 cycles of BUSCLK).  
1 Long timeout period selected (218 cycles of BUSCLK).  
COPT  
5
Stop Mode Enable — This write-once bit defaults to 0 after reset, which disables stop mode. If stop mode is  
disabled and a user program attempts to execute a STOP instruction, an illegal opcode reset is forced.  
0 Stop mode disabled.  
STOPE  
1 Stop mode enabled.  
5.9.5  
System MCLK Control Register (SMCLK)  
This register is used to control the MCLK clock output.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
MPE  
MCSEL  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 5-6. System MCLK Control Register (SMCLK)  
Table 5-6. SMCLK Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
4
MPE  
MCLK Pin Enable — This bit is used to enable the MCLK function.  
0 MCLK output disabled.  
1 MCLK output enabled on PTC2 pin.  
2:0  
MCSEL  
MCLK Divide Select — These bits are used to select the divide ratio for the MCLK output according to the  
formula below when the MCSEL bits are not equal to all zeroes. In the case that the MCSEL bits are all zero and  
MPE is set, the pin is driven low. See Equation 5-1.  
MCLK frequency = Bus Clock frequency ÷ (2 * MCSEL)  
Eqn. 5-1  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
76  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
5.9.6  
System Device Identification Register (SDIDH, SDIDL)  
This read-only register is included so host development systems can identify the HCS08 derivative. This  
allows the development software to recognize where specific memory blocks, registers, and control bits  
are located in a target MCU.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
ID11  
ID10  
ID9  
ID8  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 5-7. System Device Identification Register — High (SDIDH)  
Table 5-7. SDIDH Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:4  
Bits 7:4 are reserved. Reading these bits will result in an indeterminate value; writes have no effect.  
Reserved  
3:0  
Part Identification Number — Each derivative in the HCS08 family has a unique identification number. The  
ID[11:8]  
MC9S08AW60 Series is hard coded to the value $008. See also ID bits in Table 5-8.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
ID7  
ID6  
ID5  
ID4  
ID3  
ID2  
ID1  
ID0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 5-8. System Device Identification Register — Low (SDIDL)  
Table 5-8. SDIDL Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Part Identification Number — Each derivative in the HCS08 family has a unique identification number. The  
ID[7:0]  
MC9S08AW60 Series is hard coded to the value $008. See also ID bits in Table 5-7.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
77  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
5.9.7  
System Real-Time Interrupt Status and Control Register (SRTISC)  
This register contains one read-only status flag, one write-only acknowledge bit, three read/write delay  
selects, and three unimplemented bits, which always read 0.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
RTIF  
0
0
RTICLKS  
RTIE  
RTIS2  
RTIS1  
RTIS0  
RTIACK  
0
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 5-9. System RTI Status and Control Register (SRTISC)  
Table 5-9. SRTISC Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
RTIF  
Real-Time Interrupt Flag — This read-only status bit indicates the periodic wakeup timer has timed out.  
0 Periodic wakeup timer not timed out.  
1 Periodic wakeup timer timed out.  
6
Real-Time Interrupt Acknowledge — This write-only bit is used to acknowledge real-time interrupt request  
RTIACK  
(write 1 to clear RTIF). Writing 0 has no meaning or effect. Reads always return logic 0.  
5
Real-Time Interrupt Clock Select — This read/write bit selects the clock source for the real-time interrupt.  
RTICLKS 0 Real-time interrupt request clock source is internal 1-kHz oscillator.  
1 Real-time interrupt request clock source is external clock.  
4
Real-Time Interrupt Enable — This read-write bit enables real-time interrupts.  
0 Real-time interrupts disabled.  
RTIE  
1 Real-time interrupts enabled.  
2:0  
Real-Time Interrupt Delay Selects — These read/write bits select the wakeup delay for the RTI. The clock  
RTIS[2:0] source for the real-time interrupt is a self-clocked source which oscillates at about 1 kHz, is independent of other  
MCU clock sources. Using external clock source the delays will be crystal frequency divided by value in  
RTIS2:RTIS1:RTIS0. See Table 5-10.  
Table 5-10. Real-Time Interrupt Frequency  
Using External Clock Source Delay  
RTIS2:RTIS1:RTIS0  
1-kHz Clock Source Delay1  
(Crystal Frequency)  
0:0:0  
0:0:1  
0:1:0  
0:1:1  
1:0:0  
1:0:1  
1:1:0  
1:1:1  
Disable periodic wakeup timer  
Disable periodic wakeup timer  
divide by 256  
8 ms  
32 ms  
divide by 1024  
64 ms  
divide by 2048  
128 ms  
256 ms  
512 ms  
1.024 s  
divide by 4096  
divide by 8192  
divide by 16384  
divide by 32768  
1
Normal values are shown in this column based on fRTI = 1 kHz. See Appendix A, “Electrical Characteristics and Timing  
Specifications,fRTI for the tolerance on these values.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
78  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
5.9.8  
System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1)  
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
LVDF  
0
LVDIE  
LVDRE(2)  
LVDSE(2)  
LVDE(2)  
BGBE  
W
LVDACK  
0
Reset  
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
1
2
Bit 1 is a reserved bit that must always be written to 0.  
This bit can be written only one time after reset. Additional writes are ignored.  
Figure 5-10. System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1)  
Table 5-11. SPMSC1 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Low-Voltage Detect Flag — Provided LVDE = 1, this read-only status bit indicates a low-voltage detect event.  
LVDF  
6
Low-Voltage Detect Acknowledge — This write-only bit is used to acknowledge low voltage detection errors  
LVDACK  
(write 1 to clear LVDF). Reads always return 0.  
5
Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Enable — This read/write bit enables hardware interrupt requests for LVDF.  
0 Hardware interrupt disabled (use polling).  
LVDIE  
1 Request a hardware interrupt when LVDF = 1.  
4
Low-Voltage Detect Reset Enable — This read/write bit enables LVDF events to generate a hardware reset  
(provided LVDE = 1).  
LVDRE  
0 LVDF does not generate hardware resets.  
1 Force an MCU reset when LVDF = 1.  
3
Low-Voltage Detect Stop Enable — Provided LVDE = 1, this read/write bit determines whether the low-voltage  
detect function operates when the MCU is in stop mode.  
LVDSE  
0 Low-voltage detect disabled during stop mode.  
1 Low-voltage detect enabled during stop mode.  
2
Low-Voltage Detect Enable — This read/write bit enables low-voltage detect logic and qualifies the operation  
LVDE  
of other bits in this register.  
0 LVD logic disabled.  
1 LVD logic enabled.  
0
Bandgap Buffer Enable — The BGBE bit is used to enable an internal buffer for the bandgap voltage reference  
for use by the ADC module on one of its internal channels.  
0 Bandgap buffer disabled.  
BGBE  
1 Bandgap buffer enabled.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
79  
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
5.9.9  
System Power Management Status and Control 2 Register (SPMSC2)  
This register is used to report the status of the low voltage warning function, and to configure the stop mode  
behavior of the MCU.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
LVWF  
0
PPDF  
0
LVDV  
LVWV  
PPDC1  
W
LVWACK  
0
PPDACK  
0
0(2)  
0(2)  
0(2)  
0
U
U
0
U
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Power-on  
reset:  
0
0
0
0
LVD  
reset:  
Any other  
reset:  
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
U = Unaffected by reset  
1
2
This bit can be written only one time after reset. Additional writes are ignored.  
LVWF will be set in the case when VSupply transitions below the trip point or after reset and VSupply is already below VLVW  
.
Figure 5-11. System Power Management Status and Control 2 Register (SPMSC2)  
Table 5-12. SPMSC2 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Low-Voltage Warning Flag — The LVWF bit indicates the low voltage warning status.  
0 Low voltage warning not present.  
LVWF  
1 Low voltage warning is present or was present.  
6
Low-Voltage Warning Acknowledge — The LVWACK bit is the low-voltage warning acknowledge.  
LVWACK  
Writing a 1 to LVWACK clears LVWF to a 0 if a low voltage warning is not present.  
5
Low-Voltage Detect Voltage Select — The LVDV bit selects the LVD trip point voltage (VLVD).  
0 Low trip point selected (VLVD = VLVDL).  
LVDV  
1 High trip point selected (VLVD = VLVDH).  
4
Low-Voltage Warning Voltage Select — The LVWV bit selects the LVW trip point voltage (VLVW).  
0 Low trip point selected (VLVW = VLVWL).  
LVWV  
1 High trip point selected (VLVW = VLVWH).  
3
Partial Power Down Flag — The PPDF bit indicates that the MCU has exited the stop2 mode.  
PPDF  
0 Not stop2 mode recovery.  
1 Stop2 mode recovery.  
2
Partial Power Down Acknowledge — Writing a 1 to PPDACK clears the PPDF bit.  
PPDACK  
0
Partial Power Down Control — The write-once PPDC bit controls whether stop2 or stop3 mode is selected.  
0 Stop3 mode enabled.  
PPDC  
1 Stop2, partial power down, mode enabled.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
80  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6  
Parallel Input/Output  
6.1  
Introduction  
This chapter explains software controls related to parallel input/output (I/O). The MC9S08AW60 has  
seven I/O ports which include a total of 54 general-purpose I/O pins. See Chapter 2, “Pins and  
Connections” for more information about the logic and hardware aspects of these pins.  
Many of these pins are shared with on-chip peripherals such as timer systems, communication systems, or  
keyboard interrupts. When these other modules are not controlling the port pins, they revert to  
general-purpose I/O control.  
Pins that are not used in the application must be terminated. This prevents excess current caused by floating  
inputs and enhances immunity during noise or transient events. Termination methods include:  
Configuring unused pins as outputs driving high or low  
Configuring unused pins as inputs and using internal or external pullups  
Never connect unused pins to V or V .  
DD  
SS  
Table 6-1. KBI and Parallel I/O Interaction  
PTxPEn  
(Pull Enable)  
PTxDDn  
KBIPEn  
KBEDGn  
Pullup  
Pulldown  
(Data Direction) (KBI Pin Enable) (KBI Edge Select)  
0
0
0
1
x
x
x
0
0
0
1
1
1
x1  
x
disabled  
enabled  
disabled  
enabled  
disabled  
disabled  
disabled  
disabled  
disabled  
disabled  
enabled  
disabled  
1
x
x
1
0
1
x
1
0
1
x = Don’t care  
6.2  
Features  
Parallel I/O and Pin Control features, depending on package choice, include:  
A total of 54 general-purpose I/O pins in seven ports  
Hysteresis input buffers  
Software-controlled pullups on each input pin  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
81  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
Software-controlled slew rate output buffers  
Eight port A pins  
Eight port B pins shared with ADC1  
Seven port C pins shared with SCI2, IIC1, and MCLK  
Eight port D pins shared with ADC1, KBI1, and TPM1 and TPM2 external clock inputs  
Eight port E pins shared with SCI1, TPM1, and SPI1  
Eight port F pins shared with TPM1 and TPM2  
Seven port G pins shared with XTAL, EXTAL, and KBI1  
6.3  
Pin Descriptions  
The MC9S08AW60 Series has a total of 54 parallel I/O pins in seven ports (PTA–PTG). Not all pins are  
bonded out in all packages. Consult the pin assignment in Chapter 2, “Pins and Connections,” for available  
parallel I/O pins. All of these pins are available for general-purpose I/O when they are not used by other  
on-chip peripheral systems.  
After reset, the shared peripheral functions are disabled so that the pins are controlled by the parallel I/O.  
All of the parallel I/O are configured as inputs (PTxDDn = 0). The pin control functions for each pin are  
configured as follows: slew rate control enabled (PTxSEn = 1), low drive strength selected (PTxDSn = 0),  
and internal pullups disabled (PTxPEn = 0).  
The following paragraphs discuss each port and the software controls that determine each pin’s use.  
6.3.1  
Port A  
Port A  
Bit 7  
MCU Pin: PTA7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
PTA6  
PTA5  
PTA4  
PTA3  
PTA2  
PTA1  
PTA0  
Figure 6-1. Port A Pin Names  
Port A pins are general-purpose I/O pins. Parallel I/O function is controlled by the port A data (PTAD) and  
data direction (PTADD) registers which are located in page zero register space. The pin control registers,  
pullup enable (PTAPE), slew rate control (PTASE), and drive strength select (PTADS) are located in the  
high page registers. Refer to Section 6.4, “Parallel I/O Control” for more information about  
general-purpose I/O control and Section 6.5, “Pin Control” for more information about pin control.  
6.3.2  
Port B  
Port B  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
PTB7/  
AD1P7  
PTB6/  
AD1P6  
PTB5/  
AD1P5  
PTB4/  
AD1P4  
PTB3/  
AD1P3  
PTB2/  
AD1P2  
PTB1/  
AD1P1  
PTB0/  
AD1P0  
MCU Pin:  
Figure 6-2. Port B Pin Names  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
82  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
Port B pins are general-purpose I/O pins. Parallel I/O function is controlled by the port B data (PTBD) and  
data direction (PTBDD) registers which are located in page zero register space. The pin control registers,  
pullup enable (PTBPE), slew rate control (PTBSE), and drive strength select (PTBDS) are located in the  
high page registers. Refer to Section 6.4, “Parallel I/O Control” for more information about  
general-purpose I/O control and Section 6.5, “Pin Control” for more information about pin control.  
Port B general-purpose I/O are shared with the ADC. Any pin enabled as an ADC input will have the  
general-purpose I/O function disabled. Refer to Chapter 14, “Analog-to-Digital Converter  
(S08ADC10V1)” for more information about using port B as analog inputs.  
6.3.3  
Port C  
Port C  
Bit 7  
6
5
3
3
2
1
Bit 0  
PTC5/  
RxD2  
PTC3/  
TxD2  
PTC2/  
MCLK  
PTC1/  
SDA1  
PTC0/  
SCL1  
MCU Pin:  
PTC6  
PTC4  
Figure 6-3. Port C Pin Names  
Port C pins are general-purpose I/O pins. Parallel I/O function is controlled by the port C data (PTCD) and  
data direction (PTCDD) registers which are located in page zero register space. The pin control registers,  
pullup enable (PTCPE), slew rate control (PTCSE), and drive strength select (PTCDS) are located in the  
high page registers. Refer to Section 6.4, “Parallel I/O Control” for more information about  
general-purpose I/O control and Section 6.5, “Pin Control” for more information about pin control.  
Port C general-purpose I/O is shared with SCI2, IIC, and MCLK. When any of these shared functions is  
enabled, the direction, input or output, is controlled by the shared function and not by the data direction  
register of the parallel I/O port. Also, for pins which are configured as outputs by the shared function, the  
output data is controlled by the shared function and not by the port data register.  
Refer to Chapter 11, “Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)” for more information about using  
port C pins as SCI pins.  
Refer to Chapter 13, “Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)” for more information about using port C pins  
as IIC pins.  
Refer to Chapter 5, “Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration” for more information about using  
PTC2 as the MCLK pin.  
6.3.4  
Port D  
Port D  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
PTD7/  
AD1P15/  
KBI1P7  
PTD6/  
AD1P14/  
TPM1CLK  
PTD4/  
AD1P12/  
TPM2CLK  
PTD3/  
AD1P11/  
KBI1P6  
PTD2/  
AD1P10/  
KBI1P5  
PTD5/  
AD1P13/  
PTD1/  
AD1P9  
PTD0/  
AD1P8  
MCU Pin:  
Figure 6-4. Port D Pin Names  
Port D pins are general-purpose I/O pins. Parallel I/O function is controlled by the port D data (PTDD) and  
data direction (PTDDD) registers which are located in page zero register space. The pin control registers,  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
83  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
pullup enable (PTDPE), slew rate control (PTDSE), and drive strength select (PTDDS) are located in the  
high page registers. Refer to Section 6.4, “Parallel I/O Control” for more information about  
general-purpose I/O control and Section 6.5, “Pin Control” for more information about pin control.  
Port D general-purpose I/O are shared with the ADC, KBI, and TPM1 and TPM2 external clock inputs.  
When any of these shared functions is enabled, the direction, input or output, is controlled by the shared  
function and not by the data direction register of the parallel I/O port. When a pin is shared with both the  
ADC and a digital peripheral function, the ADC has higher priority. For example, in the case that both the  
ADC and the KBI are configured to use PTD7 then the pin is controlled by the ADC module.  
Refer to Chapter 10, “Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)” for more information about using port D pins as TPM  
external clock inputs.  
Refer to Chapter 14, “Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)” for more information about using  
port D pins as analog inputs.  
Refer to Chapter 9, “Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)” for more information about using port D pins as  
keyboard inputs.  
6.3.5  
Port E  
Port E  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
PTE7/  
SPSCK1  
PTE6/  
MOSI1  
PTE5/  
MISO1  
PTE4/  
SS1  
PTE3/ PTE2/  
TPM1CH1 TPM1CH0  
PTE1/  
RxD1  
PTE0/  
TxD1  
MCU Pin:  
Figure 6-5. Port E Pin Names  
Port E pins are general-purpose I/O pins. Parallel I/O function is controlled by the port E data (PTED) and  
data direction (PTEDD) registers which are located in page zero register space. The pin control registers,  
pullup enable (PTEPE), slew rate control (PTESE), and drive strength select (PTEDS) are located in the  
high page registers. Refer to Section 6.4, “Parallel I/O Control” for more information about  
general-purpose I/O control and Section 6.5, “Pin Control” for more information about pin control.  
Port E general-purpose I/O is shared with SCI1, SPI, and TPM1 timer channels. When any of these shared  
functions is enabled, the direction, input or output, is controlled by the shared function and not by the data  
direction register of the parallel I/O port. Also, for pins which are configured as outputs by the shared  
function, the output data is controlled by the shared function and not by the port data register.  
Refer to Chapter 11, “Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)for more information about using  
port E pins as SCI pins.  
Refer to Chapter 12, “Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)for more information about using port E  
pins as SPI pins.  
Refer to Chapter 10, “Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)for more information about using port E pins as TPM  
channel pins.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
84  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.3.6  
Port F  
Port F  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
PTF5/  
PTF4/  
PTF3/  
PTF2/  
TPM2CH1 TPM2CH0 TPM1CH5 TPM1CH4 TPM1CH3 TPM1CH2  
PTF1/  
PTF0/  
MCU Pin:  
PTF7  
PTF6  
Figure 6-6. Port F Pin Names  
Port F pins are general-purpose I/O pins. Parallel I/O function is controlled by the port F data (PTFD) and  
data direction (PTFDD) registers which are located in page zero register space. The pin control registers,  
pullup enable (PTFPE), slew rate control (PTFSE), and drive strength select (PTFDS) are located in the  
high page registers. Refer to Section 6.4, “Parallel I/O Control” for more information about  
general-purpose I/O control and Section 6.5, “Pin Control” for more information about pin control.  
Port F general-purpose I/O is shared with TPM1 and TPM2 timer channels. When any of these shared  
functions is enabled, the direction, input or output, is controlled by the shared function and not by the data  
direction register of the parallel I/O port. Also, for pins which are configured as outputs by the shared  
function, the output data is controlled by the shared function and not by the port data register.  
Refer to Chapter 10, “Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)” for more information about using port F pins as TPM  
channel pins.  
6.3.7  
Port G  
Port G  
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
PTG6/  
EXTAL  
PTG5/  
XTAL  
PTG4/  
KBI1P4  
PTG3/  
KBI1P3  
PTG2/  
KBI1P2  
PTG1/  
KBI1P1  
PTG0/  
KBI1P0  
MCU Pin:  
Figure 6-7. Port G Pin Names  
Port G pins are general-purpose I/O pins. Parallel I/O function is controlled by the port G data (PTGD) and  
data direction (PTGDD) registers which are located in page zero register space. The pin control registers,  
pullup enable (PTGPE), slew rate control (PTGSE), and drive strength select (PTGDS) are located in the  
high page registers. Refer to Section 6.4, “Parallel I/O Control” for more information about  
general-purpose I/O control and Section 6.5, “Pin Control” for more information about pin control.  
Port G general-purpose I/O is shared with KBI, XTAL, and EXTAL. When a pin is enabled as a KBI input,  
the pin functions as an input regardless of the state of the associated PTG data direction register bit. When  
the external oscillator is enabled, PTG5 and PTG6 function as oscillator pins. In this case the associated  
parallel I/O and pin control registers have no control of the pins.  
Refer to Chapter 8, “Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)” for more information about using port G pins  
as XTAL and EXTAL pins.  
Refer to Chapter 9, “Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)” for more information about using port G pins as  
keyboard inputs.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
85  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.4  
Parallel I/O Control  
Reading and writing of parallel I/O is done through the port data registers. The direction, input or output,  
is controlled through the port data direction registers. The parallel I/O port function for an individual pin  
is illustrated in the block diagram below.  
PTxDDn  
Output Enable  
D
Q
PTxDn  
Output Data  
D
Q
1
0
Port Read  
Data  
Input Data  
Synchronizer  
BUSCLK  
Figure 6-8. Parallel I/O Block Diagram  
The data direction control bits determine whether the pin output driver is enabled, and they control what  
is read for port data register reads. Each port pin has a data direction register bit. When PTxDDn = 0, the  
corresponding pin is an input and reads of PTxD return the pin value. When PTxDDn = 1, the  
corresponding pin is an output and reads of PTxD return the last value written to the port data register.  
When a peripheral module or system function is in control of a port pin, the data direction register bit still  
controls what is returned for reads of the port data register, even though the peripheral system has  
overriding control of the actual pin direction.  
When a shared analog function is enabled for a pin, all digital pin functions are disabled. A read of the port  
data register returns a value of 0 for any bits which have shared analog functions enabled. In general,  
whenever a pin is shared with both an alternate digital function and an analog function, the analog function  
has priority such that if both the digital and analog functions are enabled, the analog function controls the  
pin.  
It is a good programming practice to write to the port data register before changing the direction of a port  
pin to become an output. This ensures that the pin will not be driven momentarily with an old data value  
that happened to be in the port data register.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
86  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.5  
Pin Control  
The pin control registers are located in the high page register block of the memory. These registers are used  
to control pullups, slew rate, and drive strength for the I/O pins. The pin control registers operate  
independently of the parallel I/O registers.  
6.5.1  
Internal Pullup Enable  
An internal pullup device can be enabled for each port pin by setting the corresponding bit in one of the  
pullup enable registers (PTxPEn). The pullup device is disabled if the pin is configured as an output by the  
parallel I/O control logic or any shared peripheral function regardless of the state of the corresponding  
pullup enable register bit. The pullup device is also disabled if the pin is controlled by an analog function.  
6.5.2  
Output Slew Rate Control Enable  
Slew rate control can be enabled for each port pin by setting the corresponding bit in one of the slew rate  
control registers (PTxSEn). When enabled, slew control limits the rate at which an output can transition in  
order to reduce EMC emissions. Slew rate control has no effect on pins which are configured as inputs.  
6.5.3  
Output Drive Strength Select  
An output pin can be selected to have high output drive strength by setting the corresponding bit in one of  
the drive strength select registers (PTxDSn). When high drive is selected a pin is capable of sourcing and  
sinking greater current. Even though every I/O pin can be selected as high drive, the user must ensure that  
the total current source and sink limits for the chip are not exceeded. Drive strength selection is intended  
to affect the DC behavior of I/O pins. However, the AC behavior is also affected. High drive allows a pin  
to drive a greater load with the same switching speed as a low drive enabled pin into a smaller load.  
Because of this the EMC emissions may be affected by enabling pins as high drive.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
87  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.6  
Pin Behavior in Stop Modes  
Depending on the stop mode, I/O functions differently as the result of executing a STOP instruction. An  
explanation of I/O behavior for the various stop modes follows:  
Stop2 mode is a partial power-down mode, whereby I/O latches are maintained in their state as  
before the STOP instruction was executed. CPU register status and the state of I/O registers should  
be saved in RAM before the STOP instruction is executed to place the MCU in stop2 mode. Upon  
recovery from stop2 mode, before accessing any I/O, the user should examine the state of the PPDF  
bit in the SPMSC2 register. If the PPDF bit is 0, I/O must be initialized as if a power on reset had  
occurred. If the PPDF bit is 1, I/O data previously stored in RAM, before the STOP instruction was  
executed, peripherals may require being initialized and restored to their pre-stop condition. The  
user must then write a 1 to the PPDACK bit in the SPMSC2 register. Access to I/O is now permitted  
again in the user’s application program.  
In stop3 mode, all I/O is maintained because internal logic circuity stays powered up. Upon  
recovery, normal I/O function is available to the user.  
6.7  
Parallel I/O and Pin Control Registers  
This section provides information about the registers associated with the parallel I/O ports and pin control  
functions. These parallel I/O registers are located in page zero of the memory map and the pin control  
registers are located in the high page register section of memory.  
Refer to tables in Chapter 4, “Memory,” for the absolute address assignments for all parallel I/O and pin  
control registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A Freescale-provided  
equate or header file normally is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses.  
6.7.1  
Port A I/O Registers (PTAD and PTADD)  
Port A parallel I/O function is controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTAD7  
PTAD6  
PTAD5  
PTAD4  
PTAD3  
PTAD2  
PTAD1  
PTAD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-9. Port A Data Register (PTAD)  
Table 6-2. PTAD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Port A Data Register Bits — For port A pins that are inputs, reads return the logic level on the pin. For port A  
PTAD[7:0] pins that are configured as outputs, reads return the last value written to this register.  
Writes are latched into all bits of this register. For port A pins that are configured as outputs, the logic level is  
driven out the corresponding MCU pin.  
Reset forces PTAD to all 0s, but these 0s are not driven out the corresponding pins because reset also configures  
all port pins as high-impedance inputs with pullups disabled.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
88  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTADD7  
PTADD6  
PTADD5  
PTADD4  
PTADD3  
PTADD2  
PTADD1  
PTADD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-10. Data Direction for Port A Register (PTADD)  
Table 6-3. PTADD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Data Direction for Port A Bits — These read/write bits control the direction of port A pins and what is read for  
PTADD[7:0] PTAD reads.  
0 Input (output driver disabled) and reads return the pin value.  
1 Output driver enabled for port A bit n and PTAD reads return the contents of PTADn.  
6.7.2  
Port A Pin Control Registers (PTAPE, PTASE, PTADS)  
In addition to the I/O control, port A pins are controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTAPE7  
PTAPE6  
PTAPE5  
PTAPE4  
PTAPE3  
PTAPE2  
PTAPE1  
PTAPE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-11. Internal Pullup Enable for Port A (PTAPE)  
Table 6-4. PTADD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
[7:0]  
Internal Pullup Enable for Port A Bits — Each of these control bits determines if the internal pullup device is  
PTAPE[7:0] enabled for the associated PTA pin. For port A pins that are configured as outputs, these bits have no effect and  
the internal pullup devices are disabled.  
0 Internal pullup device disabled for port A bit n.  
1 Internal pullup device enabled for port A bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
89  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
PTASE7  
0
PTASE6  
0
PTASE5  
PTASE4  
PTASE3  
PTASE2  
PTASE1  
PTASE0  
W
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-12. Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port A (PTASE)  
Table 6-5. PTASE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port A Bits — Each of these control bits determine whether output slew  
PTASE[7:0] rate control is enabled for the associated PTA pin. For port A pins that are configured as inputs, these bits have  
no effect.  
0 Output slew rate control disabled for port A bit n.  
1 Output slew rate control enabled for port A bit n.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTADS7  
PTADS6  
PTADS5  
PTADS4  
PTADS3  
PTADS2  
PTADS1  
PTADS0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-13. Output Drive Strength Selection for Port A (PTASE)  
Table 6-6. PTASE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Drive Strength Selection for Port A Bits — Each of these control bits selects between low and high  
PTADS[7:0] output drive for the associated PTA pin.  
0 Low output drive enabled for port A bit n.  
1 High output drive enabled for port A bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
90  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.3  
Port B I/O Registers (PTBD and PTBDD)  
Port B parallel I/O function is controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTBD7  
PTBD6  
PTBD5  
PTBD4  
PTBD3  
PTBD2  
PTBD1  
PTBD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-14. Port B Data Register (PTBD)  
Table 6-7. PTBD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Port B Data Register Bits — For port B pins that are inputs, reads return the logic level on the pin. For port B  
PTBD[7:0] pins that are configured as outputs, reads return the last value written to this register.  
Writes are latched into all bits of this register. For port B pins that are configured as outputs, the logic level is  
driven out the corresponding MCU pin.  
Reset forces PTBD to all 0s, but these 0s are not driven out the corresponding pins because reset also configures  
all port pins as high-impedance inputs with pullups disabled.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTBDD7  
PTBDD6  
PTBDD5  
PTBDD4  
PTBDD3  
PTBDD2  
PTBDD1  
PTBDD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-15. Data Direction for Port B (PTBDD)  
Table 6-8. PTBDD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Data Direction for Port B Bits — These read/write bits control the direction of port B pins and what is read for  
PTBDD[7:0] PTBD reads.  
0 Input (output driver disabled) and reads return the pin value.  
1 Output driver enabled for port B bit n and PTBD reads return the contents of PTBDn.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
91  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.4  
Port B Pin Control Registers (PTBPE, PTBSE, PTBDS)  
In addition to the I/O control, port B pins are controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTBPE7  
PTBPE6  
PTBPE5  
PTBPE4  
PTBPE3  
PTBPE2  
PTBPE1  
PTBPE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-16. Internal Pullup Enable for Port B (PTBPE)  
Table 6-9. PTBPE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Internal Pullup Enable for Port B Bits — Each of these control bits determines if the internal pullup device is  
PTBPE[7:0] enabled for the associated PTB pin. For port B pins that are configured as outputs, these bits have no effect and  
the internal pullup devices are disabled.  
0 Internal pullup device disabled for port B bit n.  
1 Internal pullup device enabled for port B bit n.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTBSE7  
PTBSE6  
PTBSE5  
PTBSE4  
PTBSE3  
PTBSE2  
PTBSE1  
PTBSE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-17. Output Slew Rate Control Enable (PTBSE)  
Table 6-10. PTBSE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port B Bits— Each of these control bits determine whether output slew  
PTBSE[7:0] rate control is enabled for the associated PTB pin. For port B pins that are configured as inputs, these bits have  
no effect.  
0 Output slew rate control disabled for port B bit n.  
1 Output slew rate control enabled for port B bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
92  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTBDS7  
PTBDS6  
PTBDS5  
PTBDS4  
PTBDS3  
PTBDS2  
PTBDS1  
PTBDS0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-18. Output Drive Strength Selection for Port B (PTBDS)  
Table 6-11. PTBDS Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Drive Strength Selection for Port B Bits — Each of these control bits selects between low and high  
PTBDS[7:0] output drive for the associated PTB pin.  
0 Low output drive enabled for port B bit n.  
1 High output drive enabled for port B bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
93  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.5  
Port C I/O Registers (PTCD and PTCDD)  
Port C parallel I/O function is controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTCD6  
PTCD5  
PTCD4  
PTCD3  
PTCD2  
PTCD1  
PTCD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-19. Port C Data Register (PTCD)  
Table 6-12. PTCD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Port C Data Register Bits — For port C pins that are inputs, reads return the logic level on the pin. For port C  
PTCD[6:0] pins that are configured as outputs, reads return the last value written to this register.  
Writes are latched into all bits of this register. For port C pins that are configured as outputs, the logic level is  
driven out the corresponding MCU pin.  
Reset forces PTCD to all 0s, but these 0s are not driven out the corresponding pins because reset also  
configures all port pins as high-impedance inputs with pullups disabled.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTCDD6  
PTCDD5  
PTCDD4  
PTCDD3  
PTCDD2  
PTCDD1  
PTCDD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-20. Data Direction for Port C (PTCDD)  
Table 6-13. PTCDD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Data Direction for Port C Bits — These read/write bits control the direction of port C pins and what is read for  
PTCDD[6:0] PTCD reads.  
0 Input (output driver disabled) and reads return the pin value.  
1 Output driver enabled for port C bit n and PTCD reads return the contents of PTCDn.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
94  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.6  
Port C Pin Control Registers (PTCPE, PTCSE, PTCDS)  
In addition to the I/O control, port C pins are controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTCPE6  
PTCPE5  
PTCPE4  
PTCPE3  
PTCPE2  
PTCPE1  
PTCPE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-21. Internal Pullup Enable for Port C (PTCPE)  
Table 6-14. PTCPE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Internal Pullup Enable for Port C Bits — Each of these control bits determines if the internal pullup device is  
PTCPE[6:0] enabled for the associated PTC pin. For port C pins that are configured as outputs, these bits have no effect and  
the internal pullup devices are disabled.  
0 Internal pullup device disabled for port C bit n.  
1 Internal pullup device enabled for port C bit n.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTCSE6  
PTCSE5  
PTCSE4  
PTCSE3  
PTCSE2  
PTCSE1  
PTCSE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-22. Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port C (PTCSE)  
Table 6-15. PTCSE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port C Bits — Each of these control bits determine whether output slew  
PTCSE[6:0] rate control is enabled for the associated PTC pin. For port C pins that are configured as inputs, these bits have  
no effect.  
0 Output slew rate control disabled for port C bit n.  
1 Output slew rate control enabled for port C bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
95  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
PTCDS6  
0
PTCDS5  
PTCDS4  
PTCDS3  
PTCDS2  
PTCDS1  
PTCDS0  
W
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-23. Output Drive Strength Selection for Port C (PTCDS)  
Table 6-16. PTCDS Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Output Drive Strength Selection for Port C Bits — Each of these control bits selects between low and high  
PTCDS[6:0] output drive for the associated PTC pin.  
0 Low output drive enabled for port C bit n.  
1 High output drive enabled for port C bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
96  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.7  
Port D I/O Registers (PTDD and PTDDD)  
Port D parallel I/O function is controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTDD7  
PTDD6  
PTDD5  
PTDD4  
PTDD3  
PTDD2  
PTDD1  
PTDD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-24. Port D Data Register (PTDD)  
Table 6-17. PTDD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Port D Data Register Bits — For port D pins that are inputs, reads return the logic level on the pin. For port D  
PTDD[7:0] pins that are configured as outputs, reads return the last value written to this register.  
Writes are latched into all bits of this register. For port D pins that are configured as outputs, the logic level is  
driven out the corresponding MCU pin.  
Reset forces PTDD to all 0s, but these 0s are not driven out the corresponding pins because reset also  
configures all port pins as high-impedance inputs with pullups disabled.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTDDD7  
PTDDD6  
PTDDD5  
PTDDD4  
PTDDD3  
PTDDD2  
PTDDD1  
PTDDD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-25. Data Direction for Port D (PTDDD)  
Table 6-18. PTDDD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Data Direction for Port D Bits — These read/write bits control the direction of port D pins and what is read for  
PTDDD[7:0] PTDD reads.  
0 Input (output driver disabled) and reads return the pin value.  
1 Output driver enabled for port D bit n and PTDD reads return the contents of PTDDn.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
97  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.8  
Port D Pin Control Registers (PTDPE, PTDSE, PTDDS)  
In addition to the I/O control, port D pins are controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTDPE7  
PTDPE6  
PTDPE5  
PTDPE4  
PTDPE3  
PTDPE2  
PTDPE1  
PTDPE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-26. Internal Pullup Enable for Port D (PTDPE)  
Table 6-19. PTDPE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Internal Pullup Enable for Port D Bits — Each of these control bits determines if the internal pullup device is  
PTDPE[7:0] enabled for the associated PTD pin. For port D pins that are configured as outputs, these bits have no effect and  
the internal pullup devices are disabled.  
0 Internal pullup device disabled for port D bit n.  
1 Internal pullup device enabled for port D bit n.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTDSE7  
PTDSE6  
PTDSE5  
PTDSE4  
PTDSE3  
PTDSE2  
PTDSE1  
PTDSE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-27. Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port D (PTDSE)  
Table 6-20. PTDSE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port D Bits — Each of these control bits determine whether output slew  
PTDSE[7:0] rate control is enabled for the associated PTD pin. For port D pins that are configured as inputs, these bits have  
no effect.  
0 Output slew rate control disabled for port D bit n.  
1 Output slew rate control enabled for port D bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
98  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTDDS7  
PTDDS6  
PTDDS5  
PTDDS4  
PTDDS3  
PTDDS2  
PTDDS1  
PTDDS0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-28. Output Drive Strength Selection for Port D (PTDDS)  
Table 6-21. PTDDS Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Drive Strength Selection for Port D Bits — Each of these control bits selects between low and high  
PTDDS[7:0] output drive for the associated PTD pin.  
0 Low output drive enabled for port D bit n.  
1 High output drive enabled for port D bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
99  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.9  
Port E I/O Registers (PTED and PTEDD)  
Port E parallel I/O function is controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTED7  
PTED6  
PTED5  
PTED4  
PTED3  
PTED2  
PTED1  
PTED0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-29. Port E Data Register (PTED)  
Table 6-22. PTED Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Port E Data Register Bits — For port E pins that are inputs, reads return the logic level on the pin. For port E  
PTED[7:0] pins that are configured as outputs, reads return the last value written to this register.  
Writes are latched into all bits of this register. For port E pins that are configured as outputs, the logic level is  
driven out the corresponding MCU pin.  
Reset forces PTED to all 0s, but these 0s are not driven out the corresponding pins because reset also configures  
all port pins as high-impedance inputs with pullups disabled.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTEDD7  
PTEDD6  
PTEDD5  
PTEDD4  
PTEDD3  
PTEDD2  
PTEDD1  
PTEDD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-30. Data Direction for Port E (PTEDD)  
Table 6-23. PTEDD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Data Direction for Port E Bits — These read/write bits control the direction of port E pins and what is read for  
PTEDD[7:0] PTED reads.  
0 Input (output driver disabled) and reads return the pin value.  
1 Output driver enabled for port E bit n and PTED reads return the contents of PTEDn.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
100  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.10 Port E Pin Control Registers (PTEPE, PTESE, PTEDS)  
In addition to the I/O control, port E pins are controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTEPE7  
PTEPE6  
PTEPE5  
PTEPE4  
PTEPE3  
PTEPE2  
PTEPE1  
PTEPE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-31. Internal Pullup Enable for Port E (PTEPE)  
Table 6-24. PTEPE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Internal Pullup Enable for Port E Bits— Each of these control bits determines if the internal pullup device is  
PTEPE[7:0] enabled for the associated PTE pin. For port E pins that are configured as outputs, these bits have no effect and  
the internal pullup devices are disabled.  
0 Internal pullup device disabled for port E bit n.  
1 Internal pullup device enabled for port E bit n.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTESE7  
PTESE6  
PTESE5  
PTESE4  
PTESE3  
PTESE2  
PTESE1  
PTESE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-32. Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port E (PTESE)  
Table 6-25. PTESE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port E Bits — Each of these control bits determine whether output slew  
PTESE[7:0] rate control is enabled for the associated PTE pin. For port E pins that are configured as inputs, these bits have  
no effect.  
0 Output slew rate control disabled for port E bit n.  
1 Output slew rate control enabled for port E bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
101  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
PTEDS7  
0
PTEDS6  
0
PTEDS5  
PTEDS4  
PTEDS3  
PTEDS2  
PTEDS1  
PTEDS0  
W
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-33. Output Drive Strength Selection for Port E (PTEDS)  
Table 6-26. PTEDS Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Drive Strength Selection for Port E Bits — Each of these control bits selects between low and high  
PTEDS[7:0] output drive for the associated PTE pin.  
0 Low output drive enabled for port E bit n.  
1 High output drive enabled for port E bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
102  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.11 Port F I/O Registers (PTFD and PTFDD)  
Port F parallel I/O function is controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTFD7  
PTFD6  
PTFD5  
PTFD4  
PTFD3  
PTFD2  
PTFD1  
PTFD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-34. Port F Data Register (PTFD)  
Table 6-27. PTFD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Port F Data Register Bits— For port F pins that are inputs, reads return the logic level on the pin. For port F  
PTFD[7:0] pins that are configured as outputs, reads return the last value written to this register.  
Writes are latched into all bits of this register. For port F pins that are configured as outputs, the logic level is  
driven out the corresponding MCU pin.  
Reset forces PTFD to all 0s, but these 0s are not driven out the corresponding pins because reset also configures  
all port pins as high-impedance inputs with pullups disabled.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTFDD7  
PTFDD6  
PTFDD5  
PTFDD4  
PTFDD3  
PTFDD2  
PTFDD1  
PTFDD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-35. Data Direction for Port F (PTFDD)  
Table 6-28. PTFDD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Data Direction for Port F Bits — These read/write bits control the direction of port F pins and what is read for  
PTFDD[7:0] PTFD reads.  
0 Input (output driver disabled) and reads return the pin value.  
1 Output driver enabled for port F bit n and PTFD reads return the contents of PTFDn.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
103  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.12 Port F Pin Control Registers (PTFPE, PTFSE, PTFDS)  
In addition to the I/O control, port F pins are controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTFPE7  
PTFPE6  
PTFPE5  
PTFPE4  
PTFPE3  
PTFPE2  
PTFPE1  
PTFPE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-36. Internal Pullup Enable for Port F (PTFPE)  
Table 6-29. PTFPE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Internal Pullup Enable for Port F Bits — Each of these control bits determines if the internal pullup device is  
PTFPE[7:0] enabled for the associated PTF pin. For port F pins that are configured as outputs, these bits have no effect and  
the internal pullup devices are disabled.  
0 Internal pullup device disabled for port F bit n.  
1 Internal pullup device enabled for port F bit n.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTFSE7  
PTFSE6  
PTFSE5  
PTFSE4  
PTFSE3  
PTFSE2  
PTFSE1  
PTFSE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-37. Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port F (PTFSE)  
Table 6-30. PTFSE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port F Bits — Each of these control bits determine whether output slew  
PTFSE[7:0] rate control is enabled for the associated PTF pin. For port F pins that are configured as inputs, these bits have  
no effect.  
0 Output slew rate control disabled for port F bit n.  
1 Output slew rate control enabled for port F bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
104  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTFDS7  
PTFDS6  
PTFDS5  
PTFDS4  
PTFDS3  
PTFDS2  
PTFDS1  
PTFDS0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-38. Output Drive Strength Selection for Port F (PTFDS)  
Table 6-31. PTFDS Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Output Drive Strength Selection for Port F Bits — Each of these control bits selects between low and high  
PTFDS[7:0] output drive for the associated PTF pin.  
0 Low output drive enabled for port F bit n.  
1 High output drive enabled for port F bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
105  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.13 Port G I/O Registers (PTGD and PTGDD)  
Port G parallel I/O function is controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTGD6  
PTGD5  
PTGD4  
PTGD3  
PTGD2  
PTGD1  
PTGD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-39. Port G Data Register (PTGD)  
Table 6-32. PTGD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Port G Data Register Bits — For port G pins that are inputs, reads return the logic level on the pin. For port G  
PTGD[6:0] pins that are configured as outputs, reads return the last value written to this register.  
Writes are latched into all bits of this register. For port G pins that are configured as outputs, the logic level is  
driven out the corresponding MCU pin.  
Reset forces PTGD to all 0s, but these 0s are not driven out the corresponding pins because reset also  
configures all port pins as high-impedance inputs with pullups disabled.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTGDD6  
PTGDD5  
PTGDD4  
PTGDD3  
PTGDD2  
PTGDD1  
PTGDD0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-40. Data Direction for Port G (PTGDD)  
Table 6-33. PTGDD Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Data Direction for Port G Bits — These read/write bits control the direction of port G pins and what is read for  
PTGDD[6:0] PTGD reads.  
0 Input (output driver disabled) and reads return the pin value.  
1 Output driver enabled for port G bit n and PTGD reads return the contents of PTGDn.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
106  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
6.7.14 Port G Pin Control Registers (PTGPE, PTGSE, PTGDS)  
In addition to the I/O control, port G pins are controlled by the registers listed below.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTGPE6  
PTGPE5  
PTGPE4  
PTGPE3  
PTGPE2  
PTGPE1  
PTGPE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-41. Internal Pullup Enable for Port G Bits (PTGPE)  
Table 6-34. PTGPE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Internal Pullup Enable for Port G Bits — Each of these control bits determines if the internal pullup device is  
PTGPE[6:0] enabled for the associated PTG pin. For port G pins that are configured as outputs, these bits have no effect and  
the internal pullup devices are disabled.  
0 Internal pullup device disabled for port G bit n.  
1 Internal pullup device enabled for port G bit n.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
PTGSE6  
PTGSE5  
PTGSE4  
PTGSE3  
PTGSE2  
PTGSE1  
PTGSE0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-42. Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port G Bits (PTGSE)  
Table 6-35. PTGSE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Output Slew Rate Control Enable for Port G Bits— Each of these control bits determine whether output slew  
PTGSE[6:0] rate control is enabled for the associated PTG pin. For port G pins that are configured as inputs, these bits have  
no effect.  
0 Output slew rate control disabled for port G bit n.  
1 Output slew rate control enabled for port G bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
107  
Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
PTGDS6  
0
PTGDS5  
PTGDS4  
PTGDS3  
PTGDS2  
PTGDS1  
PTGDS0  
W
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-43. Output Drive Strength Selection for Port G (PTGDS)  
Table 6-36. PTGDS Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:0  
Output Drive Strength Selection for Port G Bits — Each of these control bits selects between low and high  
PTGDS[6:0] output drive for the associated PTG pin.  
0 Low output drive enabled for port G bit n.  
1 High output drive enabled for port G bit n.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
108  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7  
Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7.1  
Introduction  
This section provides summary information about the registers, addressing modes, and instruction set of  
the CPU of the HCS08 family. For a more detailed discussion, refer to the HCS08 Family Reference  
Manual, volume 1, Freescale Semiconductor document order number HCS08RMV1/D.  
The HCS08 CPU is fully source- and object-code-compatible with the M68HC08 CPU. Several  
instructions and enhanced addressing modes were added to improve C compiler efficiency and to support  
a new background debug system which replaces the monitor mode of earlier M68HC08 microcontrollers  
(MCU).  
7.1.1  
Features  
Features of the HCS08 CPU include:  
Object code fully upward-compatible with M68HC05 and M68HC08 Families  
All registers and memory are mapped to a single 64-Kbyte address space  
16-bit stack pointer (any size stack anywhere in 64-Kbyte address space)  
16-bit index register (H:X) with powerful indexed addressing modes  
8-bit accumulator (A)  
Many instructions treat X as a second general-purpose 8-bit register  
Seven addressing modes:  
— Inherent — Operands in internal registers  
— Relative — 8-bit signed offset to branch destination  
— Immediate — Operand in next object code byte(s)  
— Direct — Operand in memory at 0x0000–0x00FF  
— Extended — Operand anywhere in 64-Kbyte address space  
— Indexed relative to H:X — Five submodes including auto increment  
— Indexed relative to SP — Improves C efficiency dramatically  
Memory-to-memory data move instructions with four address mode combinations  
Overflow, half-carry, negative, zero, and carry condition codes support conditional branching on  
the results of signed, unsigned, and binary-coded decimal (BCD) operations  
Efficient bit manipulation instructions  
Fast 8-bit by 8-bit multiply and 16-bit by 8-bit divide instructions  
STOP and WAIT instructions to invoke low-power operating modes  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
109  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7.2  
Programmer’s Model and CPU Registers  
Figure 7-1 shows the five CPU registers. CPU registers are not part of the memory map.  
7
0
ACCUMULATOR  
A
16-BIT INDEX REGISTER H:X  
INDEX REGISTER (HIGH) INDEX REGISTER (LOW)  
H
X
15  
8
7
0
SP  
PC  
STACK POINTER  
15  
0
PROGRAM COUNTER  
7
0
CONDITION CODE REGISTER  
V
1
1
H
I
N
Z
C
CCR  
CARRY  
ZERO  
NEGATIVE  
INTERRUPT MASK  
HALF-CARRY (FROM BIT 3)  
TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW  
Figure 7-1. CPU Registers  
7.2.1  
Accumulator (A)  
The A accumulator is a general-purpose 8-bit register. One operand input to the arithmetic logic unit  
(ALU) is connected to the accumulator and the ALU results are often stored into the A accumulator after  
arithmetic and logical operations. The accumulator can be loaded from memory using various addressing  
modes to specify the address where the loaded data comes from, or the contents of A can be stored to  
memory using various addressing modes to specify the address where data from A will be stored.  
Reset has no effect on the contents of the A accumulator.  
7.2.2  
Index Register (H:X)  
This 16-bit register is actually two separate 8-bit registers (H and X), which often work together as a 16-bit  
address pointer where H holds the upper byte of an address and X holds the lower byte of the address. All  
indexed addressing mode instructions use the full 16-bit value in H:X as an index reference pointer;  
however, for compatibility with the earlier M68HC05 family, some instructions operate only on the  
low-order 8-bit half (X).  
Many instructions treat X as a second general-purpose 8-bit register that can be used to hold 8-bit data  
values. X can be cleared, incremented, decremented, complemented, negated, shifted, or rotated. Transfer  
instructions allow data to be transferred from A or transferred to A where arithmetic and logical operations  
can then be performed.  
For compatibility with the earlier M68HC05 family, H is forced to 0x00 during reset. Reset has no effect  
on the contents of X.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
110  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7.2.3  
Stack Pointer (SP)  
This 16-bit address pointer register points at the next available location on the automatic last-in-first-out  
(LIFO) stack. The stack may be located anywhere in the 64-Kbyte address space that has RAM and can  
be any size up to the amount of available RAM. The stack is used to automatically save the return address  
for subroutine calls, the return address and CPU registers during interrupts, and for local variables. The  
AIS (add immediate to stack pointer) instruction adds an 8-bit signed immediate value to SP. This is most  
often used to allocate or deallocate space for local variables on the stack.  
SP is forced to 0x00FF at reset for compatibility with the earlier M68HC05 family. HCS08 programs  
normally change the value in SP to the address of the last location (highest address) in on-chip RAM  
during reset initialization to free up direct page RAM (from the end of the on-chip registers to 0x00FF).  
The RSP (reset stack pointer) instruction was included for compatibility with the M68HC05 family and is  
seldom used in new HCS08 programs because it only affects the low-order half of the stack pointer.  
7.2.4  
Program Counter (PC)  
The program counter is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next instruction or operand to be  
fetched.  
During normal program execution, the program counter automatically increments to the next sequential  
memory location every time an instruction or operand is fetched. Jump, branch, interrupt, and return  
operations load the program counter with an address other than that of the next sequential location. This  
is called a change-of-flow.  
During reset, the program counter is loaded with the reset vector that is located at 0xFFFE and 0xFFFF.  
The vector stored there is the address of the first instruction that will be executed after exiting the reset  
state.  
7.2.5  
Condition Code Register (CCR)  
The 8-bit condition code register contains the interrupt mask (I) and five flags that indicate the results of  
the instruction just executed. Bits 6 and 5 are set permanently to 1. The following paragraphs describe the  
functions of the condition code bits in general terms. For a more detailed explanation of how each  
instruction sets the CCR bits, refer to the HCS08 Family Reference Manual, volume 1, Freescale  
Semiconductor document order number HCS08RMv1.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
111  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7
0
CONDITION CODE REGISTER  
V
1
1
H
I
N
Z
C
CCR  
CARRY  
ZERO  
NEGATIVE  
INTERRUPT MASK  
HALF-CARRY (FROM BIT 3)  
TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW  
Figure 7-2. Condition Code Register  
Table 7-1. CCR Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Two’s Complement Overflow Flag — The CPU sets the overflow flag when a two’s complement overflow occurs.  
V
The signed branch instructions BGT, BGE, BLE, and BLT use the overflow flag.  
0 No overflow  
1 Overflow  
4
H
Half-Carry Flag — The CPU sets the half-carry flag when a carry occurs between accumulator bits 3 and 4 during  
an add-without-carry (ADD) or add-with-carry (ADC) operation. The half-carry flag is required for binary-coded  
decimal (BCD) arithmetic operations. The DAA instruction uses the states of the H and C condition code bits to  
automatically add a correction value to the result from a previous ADD or ADC on BCD operands to correct the  
result to a valid BCD value.  
0 No carry between bits 3 and 4  
1 Carry between bits 3 and 4  
3
I
Interrupt Mask Bit — When the interrupt mask is set, all maskable CPU interrupts are disabled. CPU interrupts  
are enabled when the interrupt mask is cleared. When a CPU interrupt occurs, the interrupt mask is set  
automatically after the CPU registers are saved on the stack, but before the first instruction of the interrupt service  
routine is executed.  
Interrupts are not recognized at the instruction boundary after any instruction that clears I (CLI or TAP). This  
ensures that the next instruction after a CLI or TAP will always be executed without the possibility of an intervening  
interrupt, provided I was set.  
0 Interrupts enabled  
1 Interrupts disabled  
2
N
Negative Flag — The CPU sets the negative flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data  
manipulation produces a negative result, setting bit 7 of the result. Simply loading or storing an 8-bit or 16-bit value  
causes N to be set if the most significant bit of the loaded or stored value was 1.  
0 Non-negative result  
1 Negative result  
1
Z
Zero Flag — The CPU sets the zero flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data manipulation  
produces a result of 0x00 or 0x0000. Simply loading or storing an 8-bit or 16-bit value causes Z to be set if the  
loaded or stored value was all 0s.  
0 Non-zero result  
1 Zero result  
0
C
Carry/Borrow Flag — The CPU sets the carry/borrow flag when an addition operation produces a carry out of bit  
7 of the accumulator or when a subtraction operation requires a borrow. Some instructions — such as bit test and  
branch, shift, and rotate — also clear or set the carry/borrow flag.  
0 No carry out of bit 7  
1 Carry out of bit 7  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
112  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7.3  
Addressing Modes  
Addressing modes define the way the CPU accesses operands and data. In the HCS08, all memory, status  
and control registers, and input/output (I/O) ports share a single 64-Kbyte linear address space so a 16-bit  
binary address can uniquely identify any memory location. This arrangement means that the same  
instructions that access variables in RAM can also be used to access I/O and control registers or nonvolatile  
program space.  
Some instructions use more than one addressing mode. For instance, move instructions use one addressing  
mode to specify the source operand and a second addressing mode to specify the destination address.  
Instructions such as BRCLR, BRSET, CBEQ, and DBNZ use one addressing mode to specify the location  
of an operand for a test and then use relative addressing mode to specify the branch destination address  
when the tested condition is true. For BRCLR, BRSET, CBEQ, and DBNZ, the addressing mode listed in  
the instruction set tables is the addressing mode needed to access the operand to be tested, and relative  
addressing mode is implied for the branch destination.  
7.3.1  
Inherent Addressing Mode (INH)  
In this addressing mode, operands needed to complete the instruction (if any) are located within CPU  
registers so the CPU does not need to access memory to get any operands.  
7.3.2  
Relative Addressing Mode (REL)  
Relative addressing mode is used to specify the destination location for branch instructions. A signed 8-bit  
offset value is located in the memory location immediately following the opcode. During execution, if the  
branch condition is true, the signed offset is sign-extended to a 16-bit value and is added to the current  
contents of the program counter, which causes program execution to continue at the branch destination  
address.  
7.3.3  
Immediate Addressing Mode (IMM)  
In immediate addressing mode, the operand needed to complete the instruction is included in the object  
code immediately following the instruction opcode in memory. In the case of a 16-bit immediate operand,  
the high-order byte is located in the next memory location after the opcode, and the low-order byte is  
located in the next memory location after that.  
7.3.4  
Direct Addressing Mode (DIR)  
In direct addressing mode, the instruction includes the low-order eight bits of an address in the direct page  
(0x0000–0x00FF). During execution a 16-bit address is formed by concatenating an implied 0x00 for the  
high-order half of the address and the direct address from the instruction to get the 16-bit address where  
the desired operand is located. This is faster and more memory efficient than specifying a complete 16-bit  
address for the operand.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
113  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7.3.5  
Extended Addressing Mode (EXT)  
In extended addressing mode, the full 16-bit address of the operand is located in the next two bytes of  
program memory after the opcode (high byte first).  
7.3.6  
Indexed Addressing Mode  
Indexed addressing mode has seven variations including five that use the 16-bit H:X index register pair and  
two that use the stack pointer as the base reference.  
7.3.6.1  
Indexed, No Offset (IX)  
This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair as the address of  
the operand needed to complete the instruction.  
7.3.6.2  
Indexed, No Offset with Post Increment (IX+)  
This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair as the address of  
the operand needed to complete the instruction. The index register pair is then incremented  
(H:X = H:X + 0x0001) after the operand has been fetched. This addressing mode is only used for MOV  
and CBEQ instructions.  
7.3.6.3  
Indexed, 8-Bit Offset (IX1)  
This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair plus an unsigned  
8-bit offset included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction.  
7.3.6.4  
Indexed, 8-Bit Offset with Post Increment (IX1+)  
This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair plus an unsigned  
8-bit offset included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction.  
The index register pair is then incremented (H:X = H:X + 0x0001) after the operand has been fetched. This  
addressing mode is used only for the CBEQ instruction.  
7.3.6.5  
Indexed, 16-Bit Offset (IX2)  
This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair plus a 16-bit offset  
included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction.  
7.3.6.6  
SP-Relative, 8-Bit Offset (SP1)  
This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the stack pointer (SP) plus an unsigned 8-bit  
offset included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
114  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7.3.6.7  
SP-Relative, 16-Bit Offset (SP2)  
This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the stack pointer (SP) plus a 16-bit offset  
included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction.  
7.4  
Special Operations  
The CPU performs a few special operations that are similar to instructions but do not have opcodes like  
other CPU instructions. In addition, a few instructions such as STOP and WAIT directly affect other MCU  
circuitry. This section provides additional information about these operations.  
7.4.1  
Reset Sequence  
Reset can be caused by a power-on-reset (POR) event, internal conditions such as the COP (computer  
operating properly) watchdog, or by assertion of an external active-low reset pin. When a reset event  
occurs, the CPU immediately stops whatever it is doing (the MCU does not wait for an instruction  
boundary before responding to a reset event). For a more detailed discussion about how the MCU  
recognizes resets and determines the source, refer to the Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration  
chapter.  
The reset event is considered concluded when the sequence to determine whether the reset came from an  
internal source is done and when the reset pin is no longer asserted. At the conclusion of a reset event, the  
CPU performs a 6-cycle sequence to fetch the reset vector from 0xFFFE and 0xFFFF and to fill the  
instruction queue in preparation for execution of the first program instruction.  
7.4.2  
Interrupt Sequence  
When an interrupt is requested, the CPU completes the current instruction before responding to the  
interrupt. At this point, the program counter is pointing at the start of the next instruction, which is where  
the CPU should return after servicing the interrupt. The CPU responds to an interrupt by performing the  
same sequence of operations as for a software interrupt (SWI) instruction, except the address used for the  
vector fetch is determined by the highest priority interrupt that is pending when the interrupt sequence  
started.  
The CPU sequence for an interrupt is:  
1. Store the contents of PCL, PCH, X, A, and CCR on the stack, in that order.  
2. Set the I bit in the CCR.  
3. Fetch the high-order half of the interrupt vector.  
4. Fetch the low-order half of the interrupt vector.  
5. Delay for one free bus cycle.  
6. Fetch three bytes of program information starting at the address indicated by the interrupt vector  
to fill the instruction queue in preparation for execution of the first instruction in the interrupt  
service routine.  
After the CCR contents are pushed onto the stack, the I bit in the CCR is set to prevent other interrupts  
while in the interrupt service routine. Although it is possible to clear the I bit with an instruction in the  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
115  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
interrupt service routine, this would allow nesting of interrupts (which is not recommended because it  
leads to programs that are difficult to debug and maintain).  
For compatibility with the earlier M68HC05 MCUs, the high-order half of the H:X index register pair (H)  
is not saved on the stack as part of the interrupt sequence. The user must use a PSHH instruction at the  
beginning of the service routine to save H and then use a PULH instruction just before the RTI that ends  
the interrupt service routine. It is not necessary to save H if you are certain that the interrupt service routine  
does not use any instructions or auto-increment addressing modes that might change the value of H.  
The software interrupt (SWI) instruction is like a hardware interrupt except that it is not masked by the  
global I bit in the CCR and it is associated with an instruction opcode within the program so it is not  
asynchronous to program execution.  
7.4.3  
Wait Mode Operation  
The WAIT instruction enables interrupts by clearing the I bit in the CCR. It then halts the clocks to the  
CPU to reduce overall power consumption while the CPU is waiting for the interrupt or reset event that  
will wake the CPU from wait mode. When an interrupt or reset event occurs, the CPU clocks will resume  
and the interrupt or reset event will be processed normally.  
If a serial BACKGROUND command is issued to the MCU through the background debug interface while  
the CPU is in wait mode, CPU clocks will resume and the CPU will enter active background mode where  
other serial background commands can be processed. This ensures that a host development system can still  
gain access to a target MCU even if it is in wait mode.  
7.4.4  
Stop Mode Operation  
Usually, all system clocks, including the crystal oscillator (when used), are halted during stop mode to  
minimize power consumption. In such systems, external circuitry is needed to control the time spent in  
stop mode and to issue a signal to wake up the target MCU when it is time to resume processing. Unlike  
the earlier M68HC05 and M68HC08 MCUs, the HCS08 can be configured to keep a minimum set of  
clocks running in stop mode. This optionally allows an internal periodic signal to wake the target MCU  
from stop mode.  
When a host debug system is connected to the background debug pin (BKGD) and the ENBDM control  
bit has been set by a serial command through the background interface (or because the MCU was reset into  
active background mode), the oscillator is forced to remain active when the MCU enters stop mode. In this  
case, if a serial BACKGROUND command is issued to the MCU through the background debug interface  
while the CPU is in stop mode, CPU clocks will resume and the CPU will enter active background mode  
where other serial background commands can be processed. This ensures that a host development system  
can still gain access to a target MCU even if it is in stop mode.  
Recovery from stop mode depends on the particular HCS08 and whether the oscillator was stopped in stop  
mode. Refer to the Modes of Operation chapter for more details.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
116  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7.4.5  
BGND Instruction  
The BGND instruction is new to the HCS08 compared to the M68HC08. BGND would not be used in  
normal user programs because it forces the CPU to stop processing user instructions and enter the active  
background mode. The only way to resume execution of the user program is through reset or by a host  
debug system issuing a GO, TRACE1, or TAGGO serial command through the background debug  
interface.  
Software-based breakpoints can be set by replacing an opcode at the desired breakpoint address with the  
BGND opcode. When the program reaches this breakpoint address, the CPU is forced to active background  
mode rather than continuing the user program.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
117  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
7.5  
HCS08 Instruction Set Summary  
Instruction Set Summary Nomenclature  
The nomenclature listed here is used in the instruction descriptions in Table 7-2.  
Operators  
( ) = Contents of register or memory location shown inside parentheses  
&
|
×
÷
:
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
Is loaded with (read: “gets”)  
Boolean AND  
Boolean OR  
Boolean exclusive-OR  
Multiply  
Divide  
Concatenate  
Add  
+
Negate (two’s complement)  
CPU registers  
A
CCR  
H
X
PC  
PCH  
PCL  
SP  
=
Accumulator  
Condition code register  
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
Index register, higher order (most significant) 8 bits  
Index register, lower order (least significant) 8 bits  
Program counter  
Program counter, higher order (most significant) 8 bits  
Program counter, lower order (least significant) 8 bits  
Stack pointer  
Memory and addressing  
M = A memory location or absolute data, depending on addressing mode  
M:M + 0x0001= A 16-bit value in two consecutive memory locations. The higher-order (most  
significant) 8 bits are located at the address of M, and the lower-order (least  
significant) 8 bits are located at the next higher sequential address.  
Condition code register (CCR) bits  
V
H
I
N
Z
C
=
=
=
=
=
=
Two’s complement overflow indicator, bit 7  
Half carry, bit 4  
Interrupt mask, bit 3  
Negative indicator, bit 2  
Zero indicator, bit 1  
Carry/borrow, bit 0 (carry out of bit 7)  
CCR activity notation  
Bit not affected  
=
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
118  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
0
1
=
=
=
=
Bit forced to 0  
Bit forced to 1  
Bit set or cleared according to results of operation  
Undefined after the operation  
U
Machine coding notation  
dd  
ee  
ff  
ii  
jj  
kk  
hh  
ll  
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
Low-order 8 bits of a direct address 0x0000–0x00FF (high byte assumed to be 0x00)  
Upper 8 bits of 16-bit offset  
Lower 8 bits of 16-bit offset or 8-bit offset  
One byte of immediate data  
High-order byte of a 16-bit immediate data value  
Low-order byte of a 16-bit immediate data value  
High-order byte of 16-bit extended address  
Low-order byte of 16-bit extended address  
Relative offset  
rr  
Source form  
Everything in the source forms columns, except expressions in italic characters, is literal information that  
must appear in the assembly source file exactly as shown. The initial 3- to 5-letter mnemonic is always a  
literal expression. All commas, pound signs (#), parentheses, and plus signs (+) are literal characters.  
n Any label or expression that evaluates to a single integer in the range 0–7  
opr8i Any label or expression that evaluates to an 8-bit immediate value  
opr16i Any label or expression that evaluates to a 16-bit immediate value  
opr8a Any label or expression that evaluates to an 8-bit value. The instruction treats this 8-bit  
value as the low order 8 bits of an address in the direct page of the 64-Kbyte address  
space (0x00xx).  
opr16a Any label or expression that evaluates to a 16-bit value. The instruction treats this  
value as an address in the 64-Kbyte address space.  
oprx8 Any label or expression that evaluates to an unsigned 8-bit value, used for indexed  
addressing  
oprx16 Any label or expression that evaluates to a 16-bit value. Because the HCS08 has a  
16-bit address bus, this can be either a signed or an unsigned value.  
rel Any label or expression that refers to an address that is within –128 to +127 locations  
from the next address after the last byte of object code for the current instruction. The  
assembler will calculate the 8-bit signed offset and include it in the object code for this  
instruction.  
Address modes  
INH  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
=
=
=
=
Inherent (no operands)  
8-bit or 16-bit immediate  
8-bit direct  
16-bit extended  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
119  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
IX  
IX+  
IX1  
=
=
=
=
16-bit indexed no offset  
16-bit indexed no offset, post increment (CBEQ and MOV only)  
16-bit indexed with 8-bit offset from H:X  
16-bit indexed with 8-bit offset, post increment  
(CBEQ only)  
IX1+  
IX2  
REL  
SP1  
SP2  
=
=
=
=
16-bit indexed with 16-bit offset from H:X  
8-bit relative offset  
Stack pointer with 8-bit offset  
Stack pointer with 16-bit offset  
Table 7-2. HCS08 Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 1 of 7)  
Effect  
on CCR  
Source  
Form  
Operation  
Description  
V H I N Z C  
ADC #opr8i  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
A9 ii  
B9 dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
ADC opr8a  
ADC opr16a  
ADC oprx16,X  
ADC oprx8,X  
ADC ,X  
ADC oprx16,SP  
ADC oprx8,SP  
C9 hh ll  
D9 ee ff  
E9 ff  
Add with Carry  
A (A) + (M) + (C)  
IX1  
IX  
SP2  
SP1  
F9  
9ED9 ee ff  
9EE9 ff  
ADD #opr8i  
ADD opr8a  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
AB ii  
BB dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
ADD opr16a  
ADD oprx16,X  
ADD oprx8,X  
ADD ,X  
CB hh ll  
DB ee ff  
EB ff  
Add without Carry  
A (A) + (M)  
IX1  
IX  
FB  
ADD oprx16,SP  
ADD oprx8,SP  
SP2  
SP1  
9EDB ee ff  
9EEB ff  
Add Immediate Value  
SP (SP) + (M)  
AIS #opr8i  
– IMM  
A7 ii  
2
(Signed) to Stack Pointer M is sign extended to a 16-bit value  
Add Immediate Value  
H:X (H:X) + (M)  
AIX #opr8i  
(Signed) to Index  
– IMM  
AF ii  
2
M is sign extended to a 16-bit value  
Register (H:X)  
AND #opr8i  
AND opr8a  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
A4 ii  
B4 dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
AND opr16a  
AND oprx16,X  
AND oprx8,X  
AND ,X  
C4 hh ll  
D4 ee ff  
E4 ff  
IX2  
Logical AND  
A (A) & (M)  
0
IX1  
IX  
F4  
AND oprx16,SP  
AND oprx8,SP  
SP2  
SP1  
9ED4 ee ff  
9EE4 ff  
ASL opr8a  
ASLA  
DIR  
INH  
38 dd  
48  
5
1
1
5
4
6
ASLX  
Arithmetic Shift Left  
(Same as LSL)  
INH  
58  
C
0
ASL oprx8,X  
ASL ,X  
IX1  
68 ff  
78  
b7  
b0  
b0  
IX  
ASL oprx8,SP  
SP1  
9E68 ff  
ASR opr8a  
ASRA  
DIR  
INH  
37 dd  
47  
5
1
1
5
4
6
ASRX  
INH  
57  
C
Arithmetic Shift Right  
ASR oprx8,X  
ASR ,X  
IX1  
67 ff  
77  
b7  
IX  
ASR oprx8,SP  
SP1  
9E67 ff  
BCC rel  
Branch if Carry Bit Clear  
Branch if (C) = 0  
– REL  
24 rr  
3
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
120  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
Table 7-2. HCS08 Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 2 of 7)  
Effect  
on CCR  
Source  
Form  
Operation  
Description  
V H I N Z C  
DIR (b0)  
DIR (b1)  
DIR (b2)  
DIR (b3)  
DIR (b4)  
DIR (b5)  
DIR (b6)  
DIR (b7)  
11 dd  
13 dd  
15 dd  
17 dd  
19 dd  
1B dd  
1D dd  
1F dd  
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
BCLR n,opr8a  
Clear Bit n in Memory  
Mn 0  
– – – – – –  
Branch if Carry Bit Set  
(Same as BLO)  
BCS rel  
BEQ rel  
Branch if (C) = 1  
Branch if (Z) = 1  
REL  
REL  
25 rr  
27 rr  
3
3
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
Branch if Equal  
Branch if Greater Than or  
Equal To  
BGE rel  
Branch if (N V) = 0  
REL  
INH  
90 rr  
82  
3
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
(Signed Operands)  
Waits For and Processes BDM  
Commands Until GO, TRACE1, or  
TAGGO  
Enter Active Background  
if ENBDM = 1  
BGND  
5+  
Branch if Greater Than  
(Signed Operands)  
BGT rel  
Branch if (Z) | (N V) = 0  
REL  
REL  
92 rr  
28 rr  
3
3
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
Branch if Half Carry Bit  
Clear  
BHCC rel  
Branch if (H) = 0  
Branch if Half Carry Bit  
Set  
BHCS rel  
BHI rel  
Branch if (H) = 1  
Branch if (C) | (Z) = 0  
Branch if (C) = 0  
REL  
REL  
REL  
29 rr  
22 rr  
24 rr  
3
3
3
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
Branch if Higher  
Branch if Higher or Same  
(Same as BCC)  
BHS rel  
BIH rel  
BIL rel  
Branch if IRQ Pin High  
Branch if IRQ Pin Low  
Branch if IRQ pin = 1  
Branch if IRQ pin = 0  
REL  
REL  
2F rr  
2E rr  
3
3
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
BIT #opr8i  
BIT opr8a  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
A5 ii  
B5 dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
BIT opr16a  
BIT oprx16,X  
BIT oprx8,X  
BIT ,X  
C5 hh ll  
D5 ee ff  
E5 ff  
(A) & (M)  
(CCR Updated but Operands  
Not Changed)  
Bit Test  
0 – –  
IX1  
IX  
SP2  
SP1  
F5  
BIT oprx16,SP  
BIT oprx8,SP  
9ED5 ee ff  
9EE5 ff  
Branch if Less Than  
or Equal To  
(Signed Operands)  
BLE rel  
Branch if (Z) | (N V) = 1  
REL  
93 rr  
3
– – – – – –  
Branch if Lower  
(Same as BCS)  
BLO rel  
BLS rel  
BLT rel  
Branch if (C) = 1  
Branch if (C) | (Z) = 1  
Branch if (N V ) = 1  
REL  
REL  
REL  
25 rr  
23 rr  
91 rr  
3
3
3
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
Branch if Lower or Same  
Branch if Less Than  
(Signed Operands)  
Branch if Interrupt Mask  
Clear  
BMC rel  
BMI rel  
BMS rel  
Branch if (I) = 0  
Branch if (N) = 1  
Branch if (I) = 1  
REL  
REL  
REL  
2C rr  
2B rr  
2D rr  
3
3
3
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
Branch if Minus  
Branch if Interrupt Mask  
Set  
BNE rel  
BPL rel  
BRA rel  
Branch if Not Equal  
Branch if Plus  
Branch if (Z) = 0  
Branch if (N) = 0  
No Test  
REL  
REL  
REL  
26 rr  
2A rr  
20 rr  
3
3
3
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
Branch Always  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
121  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
Table 7-2. HCS08 Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 3 of 7)  
Effect  
on CCR  
Source  
Form  
Operation  
Description  
V H I N Z C  
DIR (b0)  
DIR (b1)  
DIR (b2)  
DIR (b3)  
DIR (b4)  
DIR (b5)  
DIR (b6)  
DIR (b7)  
01 dd rr  
03 dd rr  
05 dd rr  
07 dd rr  
09 dd rr  
0B dd rr  
0D dd rr  
0F dd rr  
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
Branch if Bit n in Memory  
BRCLR n,opr8a,rel  
BRN rel  
Branch if (Mn) = 0  
Uses 3 Bus Cycles  
Branch if (Mn) = 1  
– – – – –  
Clear  
Branch Never  
REL  
21 rr  
3
– – – – – –  
DIR (b0)  
DIR (b1)  
DIR (b2)  
DIR (b3)  
DIR (b4)  
DIR (b5)  
DIR (b6)  
DIR (b7)  
00 dd rr  
02 dd rr  
04 dd rr  
06 dd rr  
08 dd rr  
0A dd rr  
0C dd rr  
0E dd rr  
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
Branch if Bit n in Memory  
Set  
BRSET n,opr8a,rel  
– – – – –  
DIR (b0)  
DIR (b1)  
DIR (b2)  
DIR (b3)  
DIR (b4)  
DIR (b5)  
DIR (b6)  
DIR (b7)  
10 dd  
12 dd  
14 dd  
16 dd  
18 dd  
1A dd  
1C dd  
1E dd  
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
BSET n,opr8a  
BSR rel  
Set Bit n in Memory  
Mn 1  
– – – – – –  
PC (PC) + 0x0002  
push (PCL); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
push (PCH); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
PC (PC) + rel  
Branch to Subroutine  
Compare and Branch if  
REL  
AD rr  
5
– – – – – –  
CBEQ opr8a,rel  
CBEQA #opr8i,rel  
CBEQX #opr8i,rel  
CBEQ oprx8,X+,rel Equal  
CBEQ ,X+,rel  
CBEQ oprx8,SP,rel  
Branch if (A) = (M)  
Branch if (A) = (M)  
Branch if (X) = (M)  
Branch if (A) = (M)  
Branch if (A) = (M)  
Branch if (A) = (M)  
DIR  
IMM  
IMM  
IX1+  
IX+  
31 dd rr  
41 ii rr  
51 ii rr  
61 ff rr  
71 rr  
5
4
4
5
5
6
– – – – – –  
SP1  
9E61 ff rr  
CLC  
CLI  
Clear Carry Bit  
C 0  
I 0  
INH  
INH  
98  
9A  
1
1
– – – – – 0  
– – 0 – – –  
Clear Interrupt Mask Bit  
Clear  
CLR opr8a  
CLRA  
M 0x00  
A 0x00  
X 0x00  
H 0x00  
M 0x00  
M 0x00  
M 0x00  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
INH  
IX1  
IX  
3F dd  
4F  
5
1
1
1
5
4
6
CLRX  
CLRH  
5F  
8C  
0 – – 0 1 –  
CLR oprx8,X  
CLR ,X  
6F ff  
7F  
CLR oprx8,SP  
SP1  
9E6F ff  
CMP #opr8i  
CMP opr8a  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
A1 ii  
B1 dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
CMP opr16a  
CMP oprx16,X  
CMP oprx8,X  
CMP ,X  
C1 hh ll  
D1 ee ff  
E1 ff  
(A) – (M)  
(CCR Updated But Operands Not  
Changed)  
Compare Accumulator  
with Memory  
– –  
IX1  
IX  
SP2  
SP1  
F1  
CMP oprx16,SP  
CMP oprx8,SP  
9ED1 ee ff  
9EE1 ff  
COM opr8a  
COMA  
M (M)= 0xFF – (M)  
A (A) = 0xFF – (A)  
X (X) = 0xFF – (X)  
M (M) = 0xFF – (M)  
M (M) = 0xFF – (M)  
M (M) = 0xFF – (M)  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
IX1  
IX  
33 dd  
43  
5
1
1
5
4
6
COMX  
Complement  
53  
0 – –  
1
COM oprx8,X  
COM ,X  
COM oprx8,SP  
(One’s Complement)  
63 ff  
73  
9E63 ff  
SP1  
CPHX opr16a  
CPHX #opr16i  
CPHX opr8a  
EXT  
IMM  
DIR  
SP1  
3E hh ll  
65 jj kk  
75 dd  
6
3
5
6
(H:X) – (M:M + 0x0001)  
(CCR Updated But Operands Not  
Changed)  
Compare Index Register  
(H:X) with Memory  
– –  
CPHX oprx8,SP  
9EF3 ff  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
122  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
Table 7-2. HCS08 Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 4 of 7)  
Effect  
on CCR  
Source  
Form  
Operation  
Description  
V H I N Z C  
CPX #opr8i  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
A3 ii  
B3 dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
CPX opr8a  
CPX opr16a  
CPX oprx16,X  
CPX oprx8,X  
CPX ,X  
CPX oprx16,SP  
CPX oprx8,SP  
C3 hh ll  
D3 ee ff  
E3 ff  
Compare X (Index  
Register Low) with  
Memory  
(X) – (M)  
(CCR Updated But Operands Not  
Changed)  
– –  
IX1  
IX  
SP2  
SP1  
F3  
9ED3 ee ff  
9EE3 ff  
Decimal Adjust  
Accumulator After ADD or  
ADC of BCD Values  
DAA  
(A)  
INH  
72  
1
U – –  
10  
DBNZ opr8a,rel  
DBNZA rel  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
3B dd rr  
4B rr  
7
4
4
7
6
8
Decrement A, X, or M  
Branch if (result) 0  
DBNZX Affects X Not H  
DBNZX rel  
Decrement and Branch if  
Not Zero  
5B rr  
– – – – – –  
DBNZ oprx8,X,rel  
DBNZ ,X,rel  
DBNZ oprx8,SP,rel  
IX1  
IX  
6B ff rr  
7B rr  
9E6B ff rr  
SP1  
DEC opr8a  
DECA  
M (M) – 0x01  
A (A) – 0x01  
X (X) – 0x01  
M (M) – 0x01  
M (M) – 0x01  
M (M) – 0x01  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
IX1  
IX  
3A dd  
4A  
5
1
1
5
4
6
DECX  
5A  
Decrement  
Divide  
– –  
DEC oprx8,X  
DEC ,X  
DEC oprx8,SP  
6A ff  
7A  
9E6A ff  
SP1  
A (H:A)÷(X)  
DIV  
INH  
52  
6
– – – –  
H Remainder  
EOR #opr8i  
EOR opr8a  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
A8 ii  
B8 dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
EOR opr16a  
EOR oprx16,X  
EOR oprx8,X  
EOR ,X  
C8 hh ll  
D8 ee ff  
E8 ff  
Exclusive OR  
Memory with  
Accumulator  
IX2  
A (A M)  
0 – –  
IX1  
IX  
F8  
EOR oprx16,SP  
EOR oprx8,SP  
SP2  
SP1  
9ED8 ee ff  
9EE8 ff  
INC opr8a  
INCA  
M (M) + 0x01  
A (A) + 0x01  
X (X) + 0x01  
M (M) + 0x01  
M (M) + 0x01  
M (M) + 0x01  
DIR  
INH  
3C dd  
4C  
5
1
1
5
4
6
INCX  
INH  
5C  
Increment  
– –  
INC oprx8,X  
INC ,X  
IX1  
6C ff  
7C  
IX  
INC oprx8,SP  
SP1  
9E6C ff  
JMP opr8a  
JMP opr16a  
JMP oprx16,X  
JMP oprx8,X  
JMP ,X  
DIR  
BC dd  
CC hh ll  
DC ee ff  
EC ff  
3
4
4
3
3
EXT  
Jump  
PC Jump Address  
IX2  
IX1  
IX  
– – – – – –  
FC  
JSR opr8a  
JSR opr16a  
JSR oprx16,X  
JSR oprx8,X  
JSR ,X  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
IX1  
IX  
BD dd  
CD hh ll  
DD ee ff  
ED ff  
5
6
6
5
5
PC (PC) + n (n = 1, 2, or 3)  
Push (PCL); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
Push (PCH); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
PC Unconditional Address  
Jump to Subroutine  
– – – – – –  
FD  
LDA #opr8i  
LDA opr8a  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
A6 ii  
B6 dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
LDA opr16a  
LDA oprx16,X  
LDA oprx8,X  
LDA ,X  
C6 hh ll  
D6 ee ff  
E6 ff  
Load Accumulator from  
Memory  
A (M)  
0 – –  
IX1  
IX  
SP2  
SP1  
F6  
LDA oprx16,SP  
LDA oprx8,SP  
9ED6 ee ff  
9EE6 ff  
LDHX #opr16i  
LDHX opr8a  
LDHX opr16a  
LDHX ,X  
LDHX oprx16,X  
LDHX oprx8,X  
LDHX oprx8,SP  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX  
IX2  
IX1  
SP1  
45 jj kk  
55 dd  
32 hh ll  
9EAE  
9EBE ee ff  
9ECE ff  
9EFE ff  
3
4
5
5
6
5
5
Load Index Register (H:X)  
from Memory  
H:X ← (M:M + 0x0001)  
0 – –  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
123  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
Table 7-2. HCS08 Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 5 of 7)  
Effect  
on CCR  
Source  
Form  
Operation  
Description  
V H I N Z C  
LDX #opr8i  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
AE ii  
BE dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
LDX opr8a  
LDX opr16a  
LDX oprx16,X  
LDX oprx8,X  
LDX ,X  
LDX oprx16,SP  
LDX oprx8,SP  
CE hh ll  
DE ee ff  
EE ff  
Load X (Index Register  
Low) from Memory  
X (M)  
0 – –  
IX1  
IX  
SP2  
SP1  
FE  
9EDE ee ff  
9EEE ff  
LSL opr8a  
LSLA  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
IX1  
IX  
38 dd  
48  
5
1
1
5
4
6
LSLX  
Logical Shift Left  
(Same as ASL)  
58  
C
0
– –  
LSL oprx8,X  
LSL ,X  
68 ff  
78  
b7  
b0  
b0  
LSL oprx8,SP  
SP1  
9E68 ff  
LSR opr8a  
LSRA  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
IX1  
IX  
34 dd  
44  
5
1
1
5
4
6
LSRX  
54  
0
C
Logical Shift Right  
– – 0  
LSR oprx8,X  
LSR ,X  
64 ff  
74  
b7  
LSR oprx8,SP  
SP1  
9E64 ff  
MOV opr8a,opr8a  
MOV opr8a,X+  
MOV #opr8i,opr8a  
MOV ,X+,opr8a  
(M)  
(M)  
DIR/DIR  
DIR/IX+  
IMM/DIR  
IX+/DIR  
4E dd dd  
5E dd  
6E ii dd  
7E dd  
5
5
4
5
destination  
source  
Move  
0 – –  
H:X (H:X) + 0x0001 in  
IX+/DIR and DIR/IX+ Modes  
MUL  
Unsigned multiply  
X:A (X) × (A)  
INH  
42  
5
– 0 – – – 0  
NEG opr8a  
NEGA  
M – (M) = 0x00 – (M)  
A – (A) = 0x00 – (A)  
X – (X) = 0x00 – (X)  
M – (M) = 0x00 – (M)  
M – (M) = 0x00 – (M)  
M – (M) = 0x00 – (M)  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
IX1  
IX  
30 dd  
40  
5
1
1
5
4
6
NEGX  
Negate  
(Two’s Complement)  
50  
– –  
NEG oprx8,X  
NEG ,X  
NEG oprx8,SP  
60 ff  
70  
9E60 ff  
SP1  
NOP  
No Operation  
Uses 1 Bus Cycle  
INH  
9D  
1
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
Nibble Swap  
Accumulator  
NSA  
A (A[3:0]:A[7:4])  
INH  
62  
1
ORA #opr8i  
ORA opr8a  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
AA ii  
BA dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
ORA opr16a  
ORA oprx16,X  
ORA oprx8,X  
ORA ,X  
CA hh ll  
DA ee ff  
EA ff  
InclusiveORAccumulator  
and Memory  
A (A) | (M)  
0 – –  
IX1  
IX  
SP2  
SP1  
FA  
ORA oprx16,SP  
ORA oprx8,SP  
9EDA ee ff  
9EEA ff  
Push Accumulator onto  
Stack  
PSHA  
PSHH  
PSHX  
PULA  
PULH  
PULX  
Push (A); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
Push (H); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
Push (X); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
SP (SP + 0x0001); Pull (A)  
SP (SP + 0x0001); Pull (H)  
SP (SP + 0x0001); Pull (X)  
INH  
INH  
INH  
INH  
INH  
INH  
87  
8B  
89  
86  
8A  
88  
2
2
2
3
3
3
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
Push H (Index Register  
High) onto Stack  
Push X (Index Register  
Low) onto Stack  
Pull Accumulator from  
Stack  
Pull H (Index Register  
High) from Stack  
Pull X (Index Register  
Low) from Stack  
ROL opr8a  
ROLA  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
IX1  
IX  
39 dd  
49  
5
1
1
5
4
6
ROLX  
59  
C
Rotate Left through Carry  
– –  
ROL oprx8,X  
ROL ,X  
ROL oprx8,SP  
69 ff  
79  
9E69 ff  
b7  
b0  
SP1  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
124  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
Table 7-2. HCS08 Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 6 of 7)  
Effect  
on CCR  
Source  
Form  
Operation  
Description  
V H I N Z C  
ROR opr8a  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
IX1  
IX  
36 dd  
46  
5
1
1
5
4
6
RORA  
RORX  
Rotate Right through  
Carry  
56  
C
– –  
ROR oprx8,X  
ROR ,X  
66 ff  
76  
9E66 ff  
b7  
b0  
ROR oprx8,SP  
SP1  
SP 0xFF  
RSP  
Reset Stack Pointer  
Return from Interrupt  
Return from Subroutine  
INH  
9C  
80  
81  
1
9
6
– – – – – –  
(High Byte Not Affected)  
SP (SP) + 0x0001; Pull (CCR)  
SP (SP) + 0x0001; Pull (A)  
SP (SP) + 0x0001; Pull (X)  
SP (SP) + 0x0001; Pull (PCH)  
SP (SP) + 0x0001; Pull (PCL)  
SP SP + 0x0001; Pull (PCH)  
SP SP + 0x0001; Pull (PCL)  
RTI  
INH  
RTS  
INH  
– – – – – –  
SBC #opr8i  
SBC opr8a  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
A2 ii  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
B2 dd  
SBC opr16a  
SBC oprx16,X  
SBC oprx8,X  
SBC ,X  
C2 hh ll  
D2 ee ff  
E2 ff  
Subtract with Carry  
A (A) – (M) – (C)  
– –  
IX1  
IX  
SP2  
SP1  
F2  
SBC oprx16,SP  
SBC oprx8,SP  
9ED2 ee ff  
9EE2 ff  
SEC  
SEI  
Set Carry Bit  
C 1  
I 1  
INH  
INH  
99  
9B  
1
1
– – – – – 1  
– – 1 – – –  
Set Interrupt Mask Bit  
STA opr8a  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
IX1  
IX  
B7 dd  
C7 hh ll  
D7 ee ff  
E7 ff  
3
4
4
3
2
5
4
STA opr16a  
STA oprx16,X  
STA oprx8,X  
STA ,X  
Store Accumulator in  
Memory  
M (A)  
0 – –  
F7  
STA oprx16,SP  
STA oprx8,SP  
SP2  
SP1  
9ED7 ee ff  
9EE7 ff  
STHX opr8a  
STHX opr16a  
STHX oprx8,SP  
DIR  
EXT  
SP1  
35 dd  
96 hh ll  
9EFF ff  
4
5
5
Store H:X (Index Reg.)  
(M:M + 0x0001) (H:X)  
I bit 0; Stop Processing  
0 – –  
Enable Interrupts:  
Stop Processing  
Refer to MCU  
STOP  
INH  
8E  
2+  
– – 0 – – –  
Documentation  
STX opr8a  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
IX1  
IX  
BF dd  
CF hh ll  
DF ee ff  
EF ff  
3
4
4
3
2
5
4
STX opr16a  
STX oprx16,X  
STX oprx8,X  
STX ,X  
Store X (Low 8 Bits of  
Index Register)  
in Memory  
M (X)  
0 – –  
FF  
STX oprx16,SP  
STX oprx8,SP  
SP2  
SP1  
9EDF ee ff  
9EEF ff  
SUB #opr8i  
SUB opr8a  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
IX2  
A0 ii  
B0 dd  
2
3
4
4
3
3
5
4
SUB opr16a  
SUB oprx16,X  
SUB oprx8,X  
SUB ,X  
C0 hh ll  
D0 ee ff  
E0 ff  
Subtract  
A (A) (M)  
– –  
IX1  
IX  
F0  
SUB oprx16,SP  
SUB oprx8,SP  
SP2  
SP1  
9ED0 ee ff  
9EE0 ff  
PC (PC) + 0x0001  
Push (PCL); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
Push (PCH); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
Push (X); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
Push (A); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
Push (CCR); SP (SP) – 0x0001  
I 1;  
SWI  
Software Interrupt  
INH  
83  
11  
– – 1 – – –  
PCH Interrupt Vector High Byte  
PCL Interrupt Vector Low Byte  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
125  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
Table 7-2. HCS08 Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 7 of 7)  
Effect  
on CCR  
Source  
Form  
Operation  
Description  
V H I N Z C  
Transfer Accumulator to  
CCR  
TAP  
TAX  
TPA  
CCR (A)  
X (A)  
INH  
84  
97  
85  
1
1
1
Transfer Accumulator to  
X (Index Register Low)  
INH  
INH  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
Transfer CCR to  
Accumulator  
A (CCR)  
TST opr8a  
TSTA  
(M) – 0x00  
(A) – 0x00  
(X) – 0x00  
(M) – 0x00  
(M) – 0x00  
(M) – 0x00  
DIR  
INH  
INH  
IX1  
IX  
3D dd  
4D  
4
1
1
4
3
5
TSTX  
5D  
Test for Negative or Zero  
0 – –  
TST oprx8,X  
TST ,X  
TST oprx8,SP  
6D ff  
7D  
9E6D ff  
SP1  
TSX  
TXA  
TXS  
WAIT  
Transfer SP to Index Reg.  
H:X (SP) + 0x0001  
A (X)  
INH  
INH  
INH  
INH  
95  
9F  
94  
8F  
2
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – – – – –  
– – 0 – – –  
Transfer X (Index Reg.  
Low) to Accumulator  
1
Transfer Index Reg. to SP  
SP (H:X) – 0x0001  
I bit 0; Halt CPU  
2
Enable Interrupts; Wait  
for Interrupt  
2+  
1
Bus clock frequency is one-half of the CPU clock frequency.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
126  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
Table 7-3. Opcode Map (Sheet 1 of 2)  
Bit-Manipulation  
10  
Branch  
20  
Read-Modify-Write  
Control  
Register/Memory  
00  
5
5
3
30  
5
40  
1
50  
1
60  
5
70  
4
80  
9
90  
3
A0  
2
B0  
3
C0  
4
D0  
4
E0  
3
3
BRSET0 BSET0  
BRA  
NEG  
NEGA  
NEGX  
NEG  
NEG  
RTI  
BGE  
SUB  
SUB  
SUB  
SUB  
SUB  
3
01  
DIR  
5
2
11  
DIR  
5
2
21  
REL  
3
2
DIR  
5
1
INH  
4
1
INH  
4
2
IX1  
5
1
IX  
5
1
81  
INH  
6
2
91  
REL  
3
2
IMM  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
IX  
3
31  
41  
51  
61  
71  
A1  
B1  
C1  
D1  
E1  
BRCLR0 BCLR0  
BRN  
CBEQ CBEQA CBEQX CBEQ  
CBEQ  
RTS  
BLT  
CMP  
CMP  
CMP  
CMP  
CMP  
CMP  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
22  
REL  
3
3
DIR  
5
3
IMM  
5
3
IMM  
6
3
IX1+  
1
2
IX+  
1
1
82  
INH  
2
REL  
3
2
IMM  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
IX  
3
02  
12  
32  
42  
52  
62  
72  
5+ 92  
A2  
B2  
C2  
D2  
E2  
F2  
BRSET1 BSET1  
BHI  
LDHX  
MUL  
DIV  
NSA  
DAA  
BGND  
BGT  
SBC  
SBC  
SBC  
SBC  
SBC  
SBC  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
23  
REL  
3
3
EXT  
5
1
43  
INH  
1
1
53  
INH  
1
1
63  
INH  
5
1
73  
INH  
4
1
INH  
2
REL  
3
2
IMM  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
IX  
3
03  
13  
33  
83  
11 93  
A3  
B3  
C3  
D3  
E3  
F3  
BRCLR1 BCLR1  
BLS  
COM  
COMA  
COMX  
COM  
COM  
SWI  
BLE  
CPX  
CPX  
CPX  
CPX  
CPX  
CPX  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
24  
REL  
3
2
DIR  
5
1
INH  
1
INH  
2
IX1  
5
1
IX  
4
1
84  
INH  
1
2
94  
REL  
2
2
IMM  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
IX  
3
04  
14  
34  
44  
1
54  
1
64  
74  
A4  
B4  
C4  
D4  
E4  
F4  
BRSET2 BSET2  
BCC  
LSR  
LSRA  
LSRX  
LSR  
LSR  
TAP  
TXS  
AND  
AND  
AND  
AND  
AND  
AND  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
25  
REL  
3
2
35  
DIR  
4
1
INH  
3
1
INH  
4
2
65  
IX1  
3
1
75  
IX  
5
1
85  
INH  
1
1
95  
INH  
2
2
IMM  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
IX  
3
05  
15  
45  
55  
A5  
B5  
C5  
D5  
E5  
F5  
BRCLR2 BCLR2  
BCS  
STHX  
LDHX  
LDHX  
CPHX  
CPHX  
TPA  
TSX  
BIT  
BIT  
BIT  
BIT  
BIT  
BIT  
LDA  
STA  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
26  
REL  
3
2
DIR  
5
3
IMM  
1
2
DIR  
1
3
IMM  
5
2
DIR  
4
1
86  
INH  
3
1
96  
INH  
5
2
A6  
IMM  
2
2
B6  
DIR  
3
3
C6  
EXT  
4
3
D6  
IX2  
4
2
E6  
IX1  
3
1
F6  
IX  
3
06  
16  
36  
ROR  
46  
56  
66  
ROR  
76  
ROR  
BRSET3 BSET3  
BNE  
RORA  
RORX  
PULA  
STHX  
LDA  
LDA  
LDA  
LDA  
LDA  
3
07  
DIR  
5
2
17  
DIR  
5
2
27  
REL  
3
2
DIR  
5
1
INH  
1
INH  
2
IX1  
5
1
IX  
4
1
87  
INH  
2
3
97  
EXT  
1
2
A7  
IMM  
2
2
B7  
DIR  
3
3
C7  
EXT  
4
3
D7  
IX2  
4
2
E7  
IX1  
3
1
F7  
IX  
2
37  
47  
1
57  
1
67  
77  
BRCLR3 BCLR3  
BEQ  
ASR  
ASRA  
ASRX  
ASR  
ASR  
PSHA  
TAX  
AIS  
STA  
STA  
STA  
STA  
3
08  
DIR  
5
2
18  
DIR  
5
2
28  
REL  
3
2
DIR  
5
1
INH  
1
1
INH  
1
2
IX1  
5
1
IX  
4
1
88  
INH  
3
1
98  
INH  
1
2
A8  
IMM  
2
2
B8  
DIR  
3
3
C8  
EXT  
4
3
D8  
IX2  
4
2
E8  
IX1  
3
1
F8  
IX  
3
38  
48  
58  
68  
78  
BRSET4 BSET4  
BHCC  
LSL  
LSLA  
LSLX  
LSL  
LSL  
PULX  
CLC  
EOR  
EOR  
EOR  
EOR  
EOR  
EOR  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
REL  
2
39  
DIR  
5
1
INH  
1
1
INH  
1
2
69  
IX1  
5
1
79  
IX  
4
1
INH  
2
1
99  
INH  
1
2
IMM  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
IX  
3
09  
19  
29  
3
49  
59  
89  
A9  
B9  
C9  
D9  
E9  
F9  
BRCLR4 BCLR4  
BHCS  
ROL  
ROLA  
ROLX  
ROL  
ROL  
PSHX  
SEC  
ADC  
ADC  
ADC  
ADC  
ADC  
ADC  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
REL  
3
2
DIR  
5
1
INH  
1
1
INH  
1
2
IX1  
5
1
IX  
4
1
INH  
3
1
INH  
1
2
IMM  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
IX  
3
0A  
1A  
2A  
3A  
4A  
5A  
6A  
7A  
8A  
9A  
AA  
BA  
CA  
DA  
EA  
FA  
BRSET5 BSET5  
BPL  
DEC  
DECA  
DECX  
DEC  
DEC  
PULH  
CLI  
ORA  
ORA  
ORA  
ORA  
ORA  
ORA  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
2B  
REL  
3
2
DIR  
7
1
INH  
1
INH  
2
IX1  
7
1
IX  
6
1
INH  
2
1
9B  
INH  
1
2
IMM  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
IX  
3
0B  
1B  
3B  
4B  
4
5B  
4
6B  
7B  
8B  
AB  
BB  
CB  
DB  
EB  
FB  
BRCLR5 BCLR5  
BMI  
DBNZ  
DBNZA DBNZX  
DBNZ  
DBNZ  
PSHH  
SEI  
ADD  
ADD  
ADD  
ADD  
ADD  
ADD  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
2C  
REL  
3
3
DIR  
5
2
INH  
1
2
INH  
1
3
IX1  
5
2
IX  
4
1
INH  
1
9C  
INH  
1
2
IMM  
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
IX  
3
0C  
1C  
3C  
4C  
5C  
6C  
7C  
8C  
1
BC  
CC  
DC  
EC  
FC  
BRSET6 BSET6  
BMC  
INC  
INCA  
INCX  
INC  
INC  
CLRH  
RSP  
JMP  
JMP  
JMP  
JMP  
JMP  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
REL  
3
2
3D  
DIR  
4
1
INH  
1
1
INH  
1
2
6D  
IX1  
4
1
7D  
IX  
3
1
INH  
1
INH  
1
2
DIR  
5
3
EXT  
6
3
IX2  
6
2
IX1  
5
1
IX  
5
0D  
1D  
2D  
4D  
5D  
9D  
AD  
5
BD  
CD  
DD  
ED  
FD  
BRCLR6 BCLR6  
BMS  
TST  
TSTA  
TSTX  
TST  
TST  
NOP  
BSR  
JSR  
JSR  
JSR  
JSR  
JSR  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
REL  
3
2
3E  
DIR  
6
1
INH  
5
1
INH  
5
2
6E  
IX1  
4
1
7E  
IX  
5
1
INH  
2
REL  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
IX  
3
0E  
1E  
2E  
4E  
5E  
8E  
2+ 9E  
AE  
BE  
CE  
DE  
EE  
FE  
BRSET7 BSET7  
BIL  
CPHX  
MOV  
MOV  
MOV  
MOV  
STOP  
Page 2  
LDX  
LDX  
LDX  
LDX  
LDX  
LDX  
3
DIR  
5
2
DIR  
5
2
2F  
REL  
3
3
EXT  
3
DD  
1
2
DIX+  
1
3
IMD  
5
2
IX+D  
4
1
INH  
2
IMM  
2
2
DIR  
3
3
EXT  
4
3
IX2  
4
2
IX1  
3
1
FF  
IX  
2
0F  
1F  
3F  
5
4F  
5F  
6F  
7F  
1
8F  
2+ 9F  
1
AF  
BF  
STX  
CF  
STX  
DF  
STX  
EF  
STX  
BRCLR7 BCLR7  
BIH  
CLR  
CLRA  
CLRX  
CLR  
CLR  
WAIT  
TXA  
AIX  
STX  
3
DIR  
2
DIR  
2
REL  
2
DIR  
1
INH  
1
INH  
2
IX1  
IX  
1
INH  
1
INH  
2
IMM  
2
DIR  
3
EXT  
3
IX2  
2
IX1  
1
IX  
INH  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
DD  
Inherent  
REL  
IX  
Relative  
SP1  
SP2  
IX+  
Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset  
Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset  
Indexed, No Offset with  
Post Increment  
Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with  
Post Increment  
Immediate  
Direct  
Indexed, No Offset  
IX1  
IX2  
IMD  
Indexed, 8-Bit Offset  
Indexed, 16-Bit Offset  
IMM to DIR  
Extended  
DIR to DIR  
IX+D IX+ to DIR  
IX1+  
DIX+ DIR to IX+  
Opcode in  
F0  
3
HCS08 Cycles  
Instruction Mnemonic  
Addressing Mode  
Hexadecimal  
SUB  
Number of Bytes  
1
IX  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
127  
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2)  
Table 7-3. Opcode Map (Sheet 2 of 2)  
Bit-Manipulation  
Branch  
Read-Modify-Write  
9E60  
Control  
Register/Memory  
6
9ED0  
SUB  
5
9EE0  
4
NEG  
SUB  
3
SP1  
6
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9E61  
9ED1  
9EE1  
CBEQ  
CMP  
CMP  
4
SP1  
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9ED2  
9EE2  
SBC  
SBC  
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9E63  
6
9ED3  
9EE3  
9EF3  
6
COM  
CPX  
CPX  
CPHX  
3
SP1  
6
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
3
SP1  
9E64  
9ED4  
9EE4  
LSR  
AND  
AND  
3
SP1  
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9ED5  
9EE5  
BIT  
BIT  
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9E66  
6
9ED6  
9EE6  
ROR  
LDA  
LDA  
3
SP1  
6
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9E67  
9ED7  
9EE7  
ASR  
STA  
STA  
3
SP1  
6
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9E68  
9ED8  
9EE8  
LSL  
EOR  
EOR  
3
SP1  
6
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9E69  
9ED9  
9EE9  
ROL  
ADC  
ADC  
3
SP1  
6
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9E6A  
9EDA  
9EEA  
DEC  
ORA  
ORA  
3
SP1  
8
4
SP2  
5
3
SP1  
4
9E6B  
9EDB  
9EEB  
DBNZ  
ADD  
ADD  
4
SP1  
4
SP2  
3
SP1  
9E6C  
6
INC  
3
SP1  
5
9E6D  
TST  
3
SP1  
5
9EBE  
6
5
5
4
5
LDHX  
IX  
4
IX2  
IX1  
SP1  
5
9E6F  
6
CLR  
STX  
STX  
STHX  
3
SP1  
4
SP2  
3
SP1  
3
SP1  
INH  
Inherent  
Immediate  
Direct  
REL  
IX  
Relative  
SP1  
SP2  
IX+  
Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset  
Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset  
Indexed, No Offset with  
Post Increment  
Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with  
Post Increment  
IMM  
DIR  
EXT  
DD  
Indexed, No Offset  
Indexed, 8-Bit Offset  
Indexed, 16-Bit Offset  
IMM to DIR  
IX1  
IX2  
IMD  
Extended  
DIR to DIR  
IX1+  
IX+D IX+ to DIR  
DIX+ DIR to IX+  
Note: All Sheet 2 Opcodes are Preceded by the Page 2 Prebyte (9E)  
Prebyte (9E) and Opcode in  
Hexadecimal  
9E60  
3
6
HCS08 Cycles  
Instruction Mnemonic  
Addressing Mode  
NEG  
Number of Bytes  
SP1  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
128  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8  
Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
The internal clock generation (ICG) module is used to generate the system clocks for the MC9S08AW60  
Series MCU. The analog supply lines V  
and V  
are internally derived from the MCU’s V and  
DDA  
SSA DD  
V
pins. Electrical parametric data for the ICG may be found in Appendix A, “Electrical Characteristics  
SS  
and Timing Specifications.”  
SYSTEM  
CONTROL  
LOGIC  
TPM1  
TPM2  
IIC1  
SCI1  
SCI2  
SPI1  
ICGERCLK  
RTI  
FFE  
÷2  
ICG  
FIXED FREQ CLOCK (XCLK)  
BUSCLK  
ICGOUT  
÷2  
ICGLCLK*  
CPU  
BDC  
RAM  
FLASH  
ADC  
ADC has min and max  
frequency requirements.  
See Chapter 14,  
FLASH has frequency  
requirements for program  
and erase operation.  
* ICGLCLK is the alternate BDC clock source for the MC9S08AW60 Series.  
“Analog-to-Digital Converter  
(S08ADC10V1) and  
See Appendix A, “Electrical  
Characteristics and Timing  
Specifications.  
Appendix A, “Electrical  
Characteristics and Timing  
Specifications  
Figure 8-1. System Clock Distribution Diagram  
NOTE  
Freescale Semiconductor recommends that FLASH location $FFBE be  
reserved to store a nonvolatile version of ICGTRM. This will allow  
debugger and programmer vendors to perform a manual trim operation and  
store the resultant ICGTRM value for users to access at a later time.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
129  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
HCS08 CORE  
DEBUG  
MODULE (DBG)  
8
PTA7– PTA0  
BKGD/MS  
BDC  
CPU  
8
PTB7/AD1P7–  
PTB0/AD1P0  
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL  
RESET  
IRQ  
PTC6  
RESETS AND INTERRUPTS  
MODES OF OPERATION  
POWER MANAGEMENT  
RxD2  
TxD2  
PTC5/RxD2  
PTC4  
PTC3/TxD2  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI2)  
PTC2/MCLK  
PTC1/SDA1  
SDA1  
SCL1  
RTI  
COP  
LVD  
IIC MODULE (IIC1)  
PTC0/SCL1  
IRQ  
AD1P7–AD1P0  
8
V
DDAD  
8
10-BIT  
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL  
CONVERTER (ADC1)  
AD1P15–AD1P8  
V
SSAD  
V
REFL  
PTD7/AD1P15/KBI1P7  
PTD6/AD1P14/TPM1CLK  
PTD5/AD1P13  
PTD4/AD1P12/TPM2CLK  
PTD3/AD1P11/KBI1P6  
PTD2/AD1P10/KBI1P5  
PTD1/AD1P9  
V
REFH  
USER FLASH  
(AW60 = 63,280 BYTES)  
(AW48 = 49,152 BYTES)  
(AW32 = 32,768 BYTES)  
(AW16 = 16,384 BYTES)  
PTD0/AD1P8  
SPSCK1  
PTE7/SPSCK1  
PTE6/MOSI1  
MOSI1  
SERIAL PERIPHERAL  
USER RAM  
MISO1  
SS1  
INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1)  
PTE5/MISO1  
PTE4/SS1  
AW60/48/32 = 2048 BYTES  
AW16 = 1024 BYTES  
TPM1CLK  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM1)  
TPM1CH5–  
TPM1CH0  
INTERNAL CLOCK  
GENERATOR (ICG)  
6
RxD1  
TxD1  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTF7  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI1)  
LOW-POWER OSCILLATOR  
PTF6  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
TPM2CLK  
V
DD  
VOLTAGE  
REGULATOR  
2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM2)  
TPM2CH1–TPM2CH0  
V
SS  
2
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
KBI1P7–KBI1P5  
3
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
8-BIT KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI1)  
KBI1P4–KBI1P0  
5
EXTAL  
XTAL  
PTG6/EXTAL  
PTG5/XTAL  
NOTES:  
PTG4/KBI1P4  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
PTG2/KBI1P2  
PTG1/KBI1P1  
PTG0/KBI1P0  
1. Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port.  
2. Pin contains software configurable pullup/pulldown device if IRQ is enabled  
(IRQPE = 1). Pulldown is enabled if rising edge detect is selected (IRQEDG = 1)  
3. IRQ does not have a clamp diode to VDD. IRQ should not be driven above VDD  
4. Pin contains integrated pullup device.  
.
5. Pins PTD7, PTD3, PTD2, and PTG4 contain both pullup and pulldown devices.  
Pulldown enabled when KBI is enabled (KBIPEn = 1) and rising edge is selected  
(KBEDGn = 1).  
Figure 8-2. Block Diagram Highlighting ICG Module  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
130  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.1  
Introduction  
The ICG provides multiple options for clock sources. This offers a user great flexibility when making  
choices between cost, precision, current draw, and performance. As seen in Figure 8-3, the ICG consists  
of four functional blocks. Each of these is briefly described here and then in more detail in a later section.  
Oscillator block — The oscillator block provides means for connecting an external crystal or  
resonator. Two frequency ranges are software selectable to allow optimal startup and stability.  
Alternatively, the oscillator block can be used to route an external square wave to the system clock.  
External sources can provide a very precise clock source. The oscillator is capable of being  
configured for low power mode or high amplitude mode as selected by HGO.  
Internal reference generator — The internal reference generator consists of two controlled clock  
sources. One is designed to be approximately 8 MHz and can be selected as a local clock for the  
background debug controller. The other internal reference clock source is typically 243 kHz and  
can be trimmed for finer accuracy via software when a precise timed event is input to the MCU.  
This provides a highly reliable, low-cost clock source.  
Frequency-locked loop — A frequency-locked loop (FLL) stage takes either the internal or  
external clock source and multiplies it to a higher frequency. Status bits provide information when  
the circuit has achieved lock and when it falls out of lock. Additionally, this block can monitor the  
external reference clock and signals whether the clock is valid or not.  
Clock select block — The clock select block provides several switch options for connecting  
different clock sources to the system clock tree. ICGDCLK is the multiplied clock frequency out  
of the FLL, ICGERCLK is the reference clock frequency from the crystal or external clock source,  
and FFE (fixed frequency enable) is a control signal used to control the system fixed frequency  
clock (XCLK). ICGLCLK is the clock source for the background debug controller (BDC).  
8.1.1  
Features  
The module is intended to be very user friendly with many of the features occurring automatically without  
user intervention. To quickly configure the module, go to Section 8.5, “Initialization/Application  
Information” and pick an example that best suits the application needs.  
Features of the ICG and clock distribution system:  
Several options for the primary clock source allow a wide range of cost, frequency, and precision  
choices:  
— 32 kHz–100 kHz crystal or resonator  
— 1 MHz–16 MHz crystal or resonator  
— External clock  
— Internal reference generator  
Defaults to self-clocked mode to minimize startup delays  
Frequency-locked loop (FLL) generates 8 MHz to 40 MHz (for bus rates up to 20 MHz)  
— Uses external or internal clock as reference frequency  
Automatic lockout of non-running clock sources  
Reset or interrupt on loss of clock or loss of FLL lock  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
131  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
Digitally-controlled oscillator (DCO) preserves previous frequency settings, allowing fast  
frequency lock when recovering from stop3 mode  
DCO will maintain operating frequency during a loss or removal of reference clock  
Post-FLL divider selects 1 of 8 bus rate divisors (/1 through /128)  
Separate self-clocked source for real-time interrupt  
Trimmable internal clock source supports SCI communications without additional external  
components  
Automatic FLL engagement after lock is acquired  
External oscillator selectable for low power or high gain  
8.1.2  
Modes of Operation  
This is a high-level description only. Detailed descriptions of operating modes are contained in  
Section 8.4, “Functional Description.”  
Mode 1 — Off  
The output clock, ICGOUT, is static. This mode may be entered when the STOP instruction is  
executed.  
Mode 2 — Self-clocked (SCM)  
Default mode of operation that is entered immediately after reset. The ICG’s FLL is open loop and  
the digitally controlled oscillator (DCO) is free running at a frequency set by the filter bits.  
Mode 3 — FLL engaged internal (FEI)  
In this mode, the ICG’s FLL is used to create frequencies that are programmable multiples of the  
internal reference clock.  
— FLL engaged internal unlocked is a transition state that occurs while the FLL is attempting to  
lock. The FLL DCO frequency is off target and the FLL is adjusting the DCO to match the  
target frequency.  
— FLL engaged internal locked is a state that occurs when the FLL detects that the DCO is locked  
to a multiple of the internal reference.  
Mode 4 — FLL bypassed external (FBE)  
In this mode, the ICG is configured to bypass the FLL and use an external clock as the clock source.  
Mode 5 — FLL engaged external (FEE)  
The ICG’s FLL is used to generate frequencies that are programmable multiples of the external  
clock reference.  
— FLL engaged external unlocked is a transition state that occurs while the FLL is attempting to  
lock. The FLL DCO frequency is off target and the FLL is adjusting the DCO to match the  
target frequency.  
— FLL engaged external locked is a state which occurs when the FLL detects that the DCO is  
locked to a multiple of the internal reference.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
132  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.1.3  
Block Diagram  
Figure 8-3 is a top-level diagram that shows the functional organization of the internal clock generation  
(ICG) module. This section includes a general description and a feature list.  
EXTAL  
ICG  
OSCILLATOR (OSC)  
CLOCK  
WITH EXTERNAL REF  
SELECT  
SELECT  
ICGERCLK  
OUTPUT  
XTAL  
CLOCK  
ICGDCLK  
/R  
FREQUENCY  
LOCKED  
SELECT  
DCO  
ICGOUT  
REF  
LOOP (FLL)  
SELECT  
V
DDA  
(SEE NOTE 2)  
LOSS OF LOCK  
AND CLOCK DETECTOR  
V
SSA  
(SEE NOTE 2)  
FIXED  
CLOCK  
SELECT  
FFE  
IRG  
TYP 243 kHz  
ICGIRCLK  
INTERNAL  
REFERENCE  
8 MHz  
RG  
LOCAL CLOCK FOR OPTIONAL USE WITH BDC  
GENERATORS  
ICGLCLK  
NOTES:  
1. See Table 8-9 for specific use of ICGOUT, FFE, ICGLCLK, ICGERCLK  
2. Not all HCS08 microcontrollers have unique supply pins for the ICG. See the device pin assignments.  
Figure 8-3. ICG Block Diagram  
8.2  
External Signal Description  
The oscillator pins are used to provide an external clock source for the MCU. The oscillator pins are gain  
controlled in low-power mode (default). Oscillator amplitudes in low-power mode are limited to  
approximately 1 V, peak-to-peak.  
8.2.1  
EXTAL — External Reference Clock / Oscillator Input  
If upon the first write to ICGC1, either the FEE mode or FBE mode is selected, this pin functions as either  
the external clock input or the input of the oscillator circuit as determined by REFS. If upon the first write  
to ICGC1, either the FEI mode or SCM mode is selected, this pin is not used by the ICG.  
8.2.2  
XTAL — Oscillator Output  
If upon the first write to ICGC1, either the FEE mode or FBE mode is selected, this pin functions as the  
output of the oscillator circuit. If upon the first write to ICGC1, either the FEI mode or SCM mode is  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
133  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
selected, this pin is not used by the ICG. The oscillator is capable of being configured to provide a higher  
amplitude output for improved noise immunity. This mode of operation is selected by HGO = 1.  
8.2.3  
External Clock Connections  
If an external clock is used, then the pins are connected as shown Figure 8-4.  
ICG  
EXTAL  
XTAL  
V
SS  
NOT CONNECTED  
CLOCK INPUT  
Figure 8-4. External Clock Connections  
8.2.4  
External Crystal/Resonator Connections  
If an external crystal/resonator frequency reference is used, then the pins are connected as shown in  
Figure 8-5. Recommended component values are listed in the Electrical Characteristics chapter.  
ICG  
EXTAL  
V
XTAL  
SS  
R
S
C
C
2
1
R
F
CRYSTAL OR RESONATOR  
Figure 8-5. External Frequency Reference Connection  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
134  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.3  
Register Definition  
Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter of this data sheet for the absolute address  
assignments for all ICG registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A  
Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute  
addresses.  
8.3.1  
ICG Control Register 1 (ICGC1)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
0
HGO1  
RANGE  
REFS  
CLKS  
OSCSTEN  
LOCD  
W
Reset  
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 8-6. ICG Control Register 1 (ICGC1)  
1
This bit can be written only once after reset. Additional writes are ignored.  
Table 8-1. ICGC1 Register Field Descriptions  
Field  
Description  
7
High Gain Oscillator Select — The HGO bit is used to select between low power operation and high gain  
HGO  
operation for improved noise immunity. This bit is write-once after reset.  
0
1
Oscillator configured for low power operation.  
Oscillator configured for high gain operation.  
6
Frequency Range Select — The RANGE bit controls the oscillator, reference divider, and FLL loop prescaler  
multiplication factor (P). It selects one of two reference frequency ranges for the ICG. The RANGE bit is  
write-once after a reset. The RANGE bit only has an effect in FLL engaged external and FLL bypassed external  
modes.  
RANGE  
0
1
Oscillator configured for low frequency range. FLL loop prescale factor P is 64.  
Oscillator configured for high frequency range. FLL loop prescale factor P is 1.  
5
External Reference Select — The REFS bit controls the external reference clock source for ICGERCLK. The  
REFS  
REFS bit is write-once after a reset.  
0
1
External clock requested.  
Oscillator using crystal or resonator requested.  
4:3  
CLKS  
Clock Mode Select — The CLKS bits control the clock mode as described below. If FLL bypassed external is  
requested, it will not be selected until ERCS = 1. If the ICG enters off mode, the CLKS bits will remain  
unchanged. Writes to the CLKS bits will not take effect if a previous write is not complete.  
00 Self-clocked  
01 FLL engaged, internal reference  
10 FLL bypassed, external reference  
11 FLL engaged, external reference  
The CLKS bits are writable at any time, unless the first write after a reset was CLKS = 0X, the CLKS bits cannot  
be written to 1X until after the next reset (because the EXTAL pin was not reserved).  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
135  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
Table 8-1. ICGC1 Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
2
Enable Oscillator in Off Mode — The OSCSTEN bit controls whether or not the oscillator circuit remains  
OSCSTEN enabled when the ICG enters off mode. This bit has no effect if HGO = 1 and RANGE = 1.  
0
1
Oscillator disabled when ICG is in off mode unless ENABLE is high, CLKS = 10, and REFST = 1.  
Oscillator enabled when ICG is in off mode, CLKS = 1X and REFST = 1.  
1
Loss of Clock Disable  
LOCD  
0
Loss of clock detection enabled.  
1
Loss of clock detection disabled.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
136  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.3.2  
ICG Control Register 2 (ICGC2)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
LOLRE  
MFD  
LOCRE  
RFD  
W
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 8-7. ICG Control Register 2 (ICGC2)  
Table 8-2. ICGC2 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Loss of Lock Reset Enable — The LOLRE bit determines what type of request is made by the ICG following a  
LOLRE  
loss of lock indication. The LOLRE bit only has an effect when LOLS is set.  
0
1
Generate an interrupt request on loss of lock.  
Generate a reset request on loss of lock.  
6:4  
MFD  
Multiplication Factor — The MFD bits control the programmable multiplication factor in the FLL loop. The value  
specified by the MFD bits establishes the multiplication factor (N) applied to the reference frequency. Writes to  
the MFD bits will not take effect if a previous write is not complete. Select a low enough value for N such that  
fICGDCLK does not exceed its maximum specified value.  
000 Multiplication factor = 4  
001 Multiplication factor = 6  
010 Multiplication factor = 8  
011 Multiplication factor = 10  
100 Multiplication factor = 12  
101 Multiplication factor = 14  
110 Multiplication factor = 16  
111 Multiplication factor = 18  
3
Loss of Clock Reset Enable — The LOCRE bit determines how the system manages a loss of clock condition.  
LOCRE  
0
Generate an interrupt request on loss of clock.  
1
Generate a reset request on loss of clock.  
2:0  
Reduced Frequency Divider — The RFD bits control the value of the divider following the clock select circuitry.  
RFD  
The value specified by the RFD bits establishes the division factor (R) applied to the selected output clock source.  
Writes to the RFD bits will not take effect if a previous write is not complete.  
000 Division factor = 1  
001 Division factor = 2  
010 Division factor = 4  
011 Division factor = 8  
100 Division factor = 16  
101 Division factor = 32  
110 Division factor = 64  
111 Division factor = 128  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
137  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.3.3  
ICG Status Register 1 (ICGS1)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
CLKST  
REFST  
LOLS  
LOCK  
LOCS  
ERCS  
ICGIF  
W
1
0
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 8-8. ICG Status Register 1 (ICGS1)  
Table 8-3. ICGS1 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:6  
CLKST  
Clock Mode Status — The CLKST bits indicate the current clock mode. The CLKST bits don’t update  
immediately after a write to the CLKS bits due to internal synchronization between clock domains.  
00 Self-clocked  
01 FLL engaged, internal reference  
10 FLL bypassed, external reference  
11 FLL engaged, external reference  
5
Reference Clock Status — The REFST bit indicates which clock reference is currently selected by the  
REFST  
Reference Select circuit.  
0
1
External Clock selected.  
Crystal/Resonator selected.  
4
FLL Loss of Lock Status — The LOLS bit is an indication of FLL lock status.  
LOLS  
0
FLL has not unexpectedly lost lock since LOLS was last cleared.  
1
FLL has unexpectedly lost lock since LOLS was last cleared, LOLRE determines action taken.  
3
FLL Lock Status — The LOCK bit indicates whether the FLL has acquired lock. The LOCK bit is cleared in off,  
LOCK  
self-clocked, and FLL bypassed modes.  
0
1
FLL is currently unlocked.  
FLL is currently locked.  
2
Loss Of Clock Status — The LOCS bit is an indication of ICG loss of clock status.  
LOCS  
0
ICG has not lost clock since LOCS was last cleared.  
1
ICG has lost clock since LOCS was last cleared, LOCRE determines action taken.  
1
External Reference Clock Status — The ERCS bit is an indication of whether or not the external reference  
ERCS  
clock (ICGERCLK) meets the minimum frequency requirement.  
0
1
External reference clock is not stable, frequency requirement is not met.  
External reference clock is stable, frequency requirement is met.  
0
ICG Interrupt Flag — The ICGIF read/write flag is set when an ICG interrupt request is pending. It is cleared by  
a reset or by reading the ICG status register when ICGIF is set and then writing a logic 1 to ICGIF. If another ICG  
interrupt occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, the sequence is reset so ICGIF would remain set after  
the clear sequence was completed for the earlier interrupt. Writing a logic 0 to ICGIF has no effect.  
ICGIF  
0
1
No ICG interrupt request is pending.  
An ICG interrupt request is pending.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
138  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.3.4  
ICG Status Register 2 (ICGS2)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DCOS  
W
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 8-9. ICG Status Register 2 (ICGS2)  
Table 8-4. ICGS2 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
0
DCO Clock Stable — The DCOS bit is set when the DCO clock (ICG2DCLK) is stable, meaning the count error  
has not changed by more than nunlock for two consecutive samples and the DCO clock is not static. This bit is  
used when exiting off state if CLKS = X1 to determine when to switch to the requested clock mode. It is also used  
in self-clocked mode to determine when to start monitoring the DCO clock. This bit is cleared upon entering the  
off state.  
DCOS  
0 DCO clock is unstable.  
1 DCO clock is stable.  
8.3.5  
ICG Filter Registers (ICGFLTU, ICGFLTL)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
FLT  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 8-10. ICG Upper Filter Register (ICGFLTU)  
Table 8-5. ICGFLTU Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
3:0  
FLT  
Filter Value — The FLT bits indicate the current filter value, which controls the DCO frequency. The FLT bits are  
read only except when the CLKS bits are programmed to self-clocked mode (CLKS = 00). In self-clocked mode,  
any write to ICGFLTU updates the current 12-bit filter value. Writes to the ICGFLTU register will not affect FLT if  
a previous latch sequence is not complete.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
139  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
FLT  
Reset  
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 8-11. ICG Lower Filter Register (ICGFLTL)  
Table 8-6. ICGFLTL Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
FLT  
Filter Value — The FLT bits indicate the current filter value, which controls the DCO frequency. The FLT bits are  
read only except when the CLKS bits are programmed to self-clocked mode (CLKS = 00). In self-clocked mode,  
any write to ICGFLTU updates the current 12-bit filter value. Writes to the ICGFLTU register will not affect FLT if  
a previous latch sequence is not complete. The filter registers show the filter value (FLT).  
8.3.6  
ICG Trim Register (ICGTRM)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
TRIM  
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
POR  
Reset:  
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U = Unaffected by MCU reset  
Figure 8-12. ICG Trim Register (ICGTRM)  
Table 8-7. ICGTRM Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
ICG Trim Setting — The TRIM bits control the internal reference generator frequency. They allow a 25%  
adjustment of the nominal (POR) period. The bit’s effect on period is binary weighted (i.e., bit 1 will adjust twice  
as much as changing bit 0). Increasing the binary value in TRIM will increase the period and decreasing the value  
will decrease the period.  
TRIM  
8.4  
Functional Description  
This section provides a functional description of each of the five operating modes of the ICG. Also  
discussed are the loss of clock and loss of lock errors and requirements for entry into each mode. The ICG  
is very flexible, and in some configurations, it is possible to exceed certain clock specifications. When  
using the FLL, configure the ICG so that the frequency of ICGDCLK does not exceed its maximum value  
to ensure proper MCU operation.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
140  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.4.1  
Off Mode (Off)  
Normally when the CPU enters stop mode, the ICG will cease all clock activity and is in the off state.  
However there are two cases to consider when clock activity continues while the CPU is in stop mode,  
8.4.1.1  
BDM Active  
When the BDM is enabled, the ICG continues activity as originally programmed. This allows access to  
memory and control registers via the BDC controller.  
8.4.1.2  
OSCSTEN Bit Set  
When the oscillator is enabled in stop mode (OSCSTEN = 1), the individual clock generators are enabled  
but the clock feed to the rest of the MCU is turned off. This option is provided to avoid long oscillator  
startup times if necessary, or to run the RTI from the oscillator during stop3.  
8.4.1.3  
Stop/Off Mode Recovery  
Upon the CPU exiting stop mode due to an interrupt, the previously set control bits are valid and the system  
clock feed resumes. If FEE is selected, the ICG will source the internal reference until the external clock  
is stable. If FBE is selected, the ICG will wait for the external clock to stabilize before enabling ICGOUT.  
Upon the CPU exiting stop mode due to a reset, the previously set ICG control bits are ignored and the  
default reset values applied. Therefore the ICG will exit stop in SCM mode configured for an  
approximately 8 MHz DCO output (4 MHz bus clock) with trim value maintained. If using a crystal, 4096  
clocks are detected prior to engaging ICGERCLK. This is incorporated in crystal start-up time.  
8.4.2  
Self-Clocked Mode (SCM)  
Self-clocked mode (SCM) is the default mode of operation and is entered when any of the following  
conditions occur:  
After any reset.  
Exiting from off mode when CLKS does not equal 10. If CLKS = X1, the ICG enters this state  
temporarily until the DCO is stable (DCOS = 1).  
CLKS bits are written from X1 to 00.  
CLKS = 1X and ICGERCLK is not detected (both ERCS = 0 and LOCS = 1).  
In this state, the FLL loop is open. The DCO is on, and the output clock signal ICGOUT frequency is given  
by f / R. The ICGDCLK frequency can be varied from 8 MHz to 40 MHz by writing a new value  
ICGDCLK  
into the filter registers (ICGFLTH and ICGFLTL). This is the only mode in which the filter registers can  
be written.  
If this mode is entered due to a reset, f  
will default to f  
which is nominally 8 MHz. If this  
Self_reset  
ICGDCLK  
mode is entered from FLL engaged internal, f  
will maintain the previous frequency.If this mode  
ICGDCLK  
is entered from FLL engaged external (either by programming CLKS or due to a loss of external reference  
clock), f will maintain the previous frequency, but ICGOUT will double if the FLL was unlocked.  
ICGDCLK  
If this mode is entered from off mode, f  
will be equal to the frequency of ICGDCLK before  
ICGDCLK  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
141  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
entering off mode. If CLKS bits are set to 01 or 11 coming out of the Off state, the ICG enters this mode  
until ICGDCLK is stable as determined by the DCOS bit. After ICGDCLK is considered stable, the ICG  
automatically closes the loop by switching to FLL engaged (internal or external) as selected by the CLKS  
bits.  
CLKST  
CLKS  
RFD  
REFERENCE  
DIVIDER (/7)  
ICGIRCLK  
CLOCK  
SELECT  
CIRCUIT  
REDUCED  
FREQUENCY  
DIVIDER (R)  
ICGOUT  
RANGE  
MFD  
ICGDCLK  
FLT  
1x  
2x  
DIGITAL  
LOOP  
FILTER  
DIGITALLY  
CONTROLLED  
OSCILLATOR  
SUBTRACTOR  
FLL ANALOG  
CLKST  
FREQUENCY-  
LOCKED  
LOOP (FLL)  
OVERFLOW  
ICG2DCLK  
PULSE  
COUNTER  
COUNTER ENABLE  
RANGE  
IRQ  
LOCK AND  
LOSS OF CLOCK  
DETECTOR  
RESET AND  
INTERRUPT  
CONTROL  
RESET  
DCOS LOCK LOLS LOCS ERCS LOCD  
ICGIF LOLRE LOCRE  
Figure 8-13. Detailed Frequency-Locked Loop Block Diagram  
8.4.3  
FLL Engaged, Internal Clock (FEI) Mode  
FLL engaged internal (FEI) is entered when any of the following conditions occur:  
CLKS bits are written to 01  
The DCO clock stabilizes (DCOS = 1) while in SCM upon exiting the off state with CLKS = 01  
In FLL engaged internal mode, the reference clock is derived from the internal reference clock  
ICGIRCLK, and the FLL loop will attempt to lock the ICGDCLK frequency to the desired value, as  
selected by the MFD bits.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
142  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.4.4  
FLL Engaged Internal Unlocked  
FEI unlocked is a temporary state that is entered when FEI is entered and the count error (Δn) output from  
the subtractor is greater than the maximum n  
lock detector to detect the unlock condition.  
or less than the minimum n  
, as required by the  
unlock  
unlock  
The ICG will remain in this state while the count error (Δn) is greater than the maximum n  
or less than  
lock  
the minimum n , as required by the lock detector to detect the lock condition.  
lock  
In this state the output clock signal ICGOUT frequency is given by f  
/ R.  
ICGDCLK  
8.4.5  
FLL Engaged Internal Locked  
FLL engaged internal locked is entered from FEI unlocked when the count error (Δn), which comes from  
the subtractor, is less than n (max) and greater than n (min) for a given number of samples, as  
lock  
lock  
required by the lock detector to detect the lock condition. The output clock signal ICGOUT frequency is  
given by f / R. In FEI locked, the filter value is updated only once every four comparison cycles.  
ICGDCLK  
The update made is an average of the error measurements taken in the four previous comparisons.  
8.4.6  
FLL Bypassed, External Clock (FBE) Mode  
FLL bypassed external (FBE) is entered when any of the following conditions occur:  
From SCM when CLKS = 10 and ERCS is high  
When CLKS = 10, ERCS = 1 upon entering off mode, and off is then exited  
From FLL engaged external mode if a loss of DCO clock occurs and the external reference remains  
valid (both LOCS = 1 and ERCS = 1)  
In this state, the DCO and IRG are off and the reference clock is derived from the external reference clock,  
ICGERCLK. The output clock signal ICGOUT frequency is given by f / R. If an external clock  
ICGERCLK  
source is used (REFS = 0), then the input frequency on the EXTAL pin can be anywhere in the range  
0 MHz to 40 MHz. If a crystal or resonator is used (REFS = 1), then frequency range is either low for  
RANGE = 0 or high for RANGE = 1.  
8.4.7  
FLL Engaged, External Clock (FEE) Mode  
The FLL engaged external (FEE) mode is entered when any of the following conditions occur:  
CLKS = 11 and ERCS and DCOS are both high.  
The DCO stabilizes (DCOS = 1) while in SCM upon exiting the off state with CLKS = 11.  
In FEE mode, the reference clock is derived from the external reference clock ICGERCLK, and the FLL  
loop will attempt to lock the ICGDCLK frequency to the desired value, as selected by the MFD bits. To  
run in FEE mode, there must be a working 32 kHz–100 kHz or 2 MHz–10 MHz external clock source. The  
maximum external clock frequency is limited to 10 MHz in FEE mode to prevent over-clocking the DCO.  
The minimum multiplier for the FLL, from Table 8-12 is 4. Because 4 X 10 MHz is 40MHz, which is the  
operational limit of the DCO, the reference clock cannot be any faster than 10 MHz.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
143  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.4.7.1  
FLL Engaged External Unlocked  
FEE unlocked is entered when FEE is entered and the count error (Δn) output from the subtractor is greater  
than the maximum n  
unlock condition.  
or less than the minimum n  
, as required by the lock detector to detect the  
unlock  
unlock  
The ICG will remain in this state while the count error (Δn) is greater than the maximum n  
or less than  
lock  
the minimum n , as required by the lock detector to detect the lock condition.  
lock  
In this state, the pulse counter, subtractor, digital loop filter, and DCO form a closed loop and attempt to  
lock it according to their operational descriptions later in this section. Upon entering this state and until  
the FLL becomes locked, the output clock signal ICGOUT frequency is given by f  
/ (2×R) This  
ICGDCLK  
extra divide by two prevents frequency overshoots during the initial locking process from exceeding  
chip-level maximum frequency specifications. After the FLL has locked, if an unexpected loss of lock  
causes it to re-enter the unlocked state while the ICG remains in FEE mode, the output clock signal  
ICGOUT frequency is given by f  
/ R.  
ICGDCLK  
8.4.7.2  
FLL Engaged External Locked  
FEE locked is entered from FEE unlocked when the count error (Δn) is less than n  
(max) and greater  
lock  
than n  
(min) for a given number of samples, as required by the lock detector to detect the lock  
lock  
condition. The output clock signal ICGOUT frequency is given by f  
/R. In FLL engaged external  
ICGDCLK  
locked, the filter value is updated only once every four comparison cycles. The update made is an average  
of the error measurements taken in the four previous comparisons.  
8.4.8  
FLL Lock and Loss-of-Lock Detection  
To determine the FLL locked and loss-of-lock conditions, the pulse counter counts the pulses of the DCO  
for one comparison cycle (see Table 8-9 for explanation of a comparison cycle) and passes this number to  
the subtractor. The subtractor compares this value to the value in MFD and produces a count error, Δn. To  
achieve locked status, Δn must be between n  
(min) and n  
(max). After the FLL has locked, Δn must  
lock  
lock  
stay between n  
(min) and n  
(max) to remain locked. If Δn goes outside this range unexpectedly,  
unlock  
unlock  
the LOLS status bit is set and remains set until cleared by software or until the MCU is reset. LOLS is  
cleared by reading ICGS1 then writing 1 to ICGIF (LOLRE = 0), or by a loss-of-lock induced reset  
(LOLRE = 1), or by any MCU reset.  
If the ICG enters the off state due to stop mode when ENBDM = OSCSTEN = 0, the FLL loses locked  
status (LOCK is cleared), but LOLS remains unchanged because this is not an unexpected loss-of-lock  
condition. Though it would be unusual, if ENBDM is cleared to 0 while the MCU is in stop, the ICG enters  
the off state. Because this is an unexpected stopping of clocks, LOLS will be set when the MCU wakes up  
from stop.  
Expected loss of lock occurs when the MFD or CLKS bits are changed or in FEI mode only, when the  
TRIM bits are changed. In these cases, the LOCK bit will be cleared until the FLL regains lock, but the  
LOLS will not be set.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
144  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.4.9  
FLL Loss-of-Clock Detection  
The reference clock and the DCO clock are monitored under different conditions (see Table 8-8). Provided  
the reference frequency is being monitored, ERCS = 1 indicates that the reference clock meets minimum  
frequency requirements. When the reference and/or DCO clock(s) are being monitored, if either one falls  
below a certain frequency, f  
and f  
, respectively, the LOCS status bit will be set to indicate the error.  
LOR  
LOD  
LOCS will remain set until it is acknowledged or until the MCU is reset. LOCS is cleared by reading  
ICGS1 then writing 1 to ICGIF (LOCRE = 0), or by a loss-of-clock induced reset (LOCRE = 1), or by any  
MCU reset.  
If the ICG is in FEE, a loss of reference clock causes the ICG to enter SCM, and a loss of DCO clock causes  
the ICG to enter FBE mode. If the ICG is in FBE mode, a loss of reference clock will cause the ICG to  
enter SCM. In each case, the CLKST and CLKS bits will be automatically changed to reflect the new state.  
If the ICG is in FEE mode when a loss of clock occurs and the ERCS is still set to 1, then the CLKST bits  
are set to 10 and the ICG reverts to FBE mode.  
A loss of clock will also cause a loss of lock when in FEE or FEI modes. Because the method of clearing  
the LOCS and LOLS bits is the same, this would only be an issue in the unlikely case that LOLRE = 1 and  
LOCRE = 0. In this case, the interrupt would be overridden by the reset for the loss of lock.  
Table 8-8. Clock Monitoring (When LOCD = 0)  
External Reference  
DCO Clock  
Mode  
CLKS  
REFST  
ERCS  
Clock  
Monitored?  
Monitored?  
Off  
0X or 11  
10  
X
0
1
X
0
1
X
X
X
0
1
X
Forced Low  
Forced Low  
Real-Time1  
Forced Low  
Forced High  
Real-Time  
Real-Time  
Forced Low  
Real-Time  
Forced High  
Real-Time  
Real-Time  
No  
No  
Yes(1)  
No  
No  
10  
No  
SCM  
(CLKST = 00)  
0X  
No  
Yes2  
Yes(2)  
Yes(2)  
Yes(2)  
Yes  
10  
No  
10  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
11  
FEI  
(CLKST = 01)  
0X  
11  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
FBE  
(CLKST = 10)  
10  
No  
10  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
FEE  
11  
Yes  
(CLKST = 11)  
1
2
If ENABLE is high (waiting for external crystal start-up after exiting stop).  
DCO clock will not be monitored until DCOS = 1 upon entering SCM from off or FLL bypassed external mode.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
145  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.4.10 Clock Mode Requirements  
A clock mode is requested by writing to CLKS1:CLKS0 and the actual clock mode is indicated by  
CLKST1:CLKST0. Provided minimum conditions are met, the status shown in CLKST1:CLKST0 should  
be the same as the requested mode in CLKS1:CLKS0. Table 8-9 shows the relationship between CLKS,  
CLKST, and ICGOUT. It also shows the conditions for CLKS = CLKST or the reason CLKS CLKST.  
NOTE  
If a crystal will be used before the next reset, then be sure to set REFS = 1  
and CLKS = 1x on the first write to the ICGC1 register. Failure to do so will  
result in “locking” REFS = 0 which will prevent the oscillator amplifier  
from being enabled until the next reset occurs.  
Table 8-9. ICG State Table  
Actual  
Mode  
(CLKST)  
Desired  
Mode  
(CLKS)  
Reference  
Frequency  
(fREFERENCE)  
Reason  
CLKS1 ≠  
CLKST  
Comparison  
Cycle Time  
Conditions1 for  
CLKS = CLKST  
Range  
ICGOUT  
Off  
(XX)  
X
X
0
0
0
0
Off  
(XX)  
FBE  
(10)  
ERCS = 0  
Not switching  
from FBE to  
SCM  
SCM  
(00)  
ICGIRCLK/72  
8/fICGIRCLK  
X
ICGDCLK/R  
f
FEI  
(01)  
8/fICGIRCLK  
8/fICGIRCLK  
8/fICGIRCLK  
8/fICGIRCLK  
8/fICGIRCLK  
0
X
X
0
ICGDCLK/R  
ICGDCLK/R  
ICGDCLK/R  
ICGDCLK/R  
ICGDCLK/R  
ICGERCLK/R  
ICGERCLK/R  
ICGDCLK/R3  
ICGDCLK/R(2)  
DCOS = 0  
ERCS = 0  
f
f
f
ICGIRCLK/7(1)  
ICGIRCLK/7(1)  
ICGIRCLK/7(1)  
SCM  
(00)  
FBE  
(10)  
FEE  
(11)  
DCOS = 0 or  
ERCS = 0  
FEI  
(01)  
fICGIRCLK/7  
DCOS = 1  
ERCS = 0  
FEI  
(01)  
FEE  
(11)  
fICGIRCLK/7  
X
X
X
0
FBE  
(10)  
0
ERCS = 1  
FBE  
(10)  
FEE  
(11)  
LOCS = 1 &  
ERCS = 1  
0
ERCS = 1 and  
DCOS = 1  
fICGERCLK  
fICGERCLK  
2/fICGERCLK  
128/fICGERCLK  
FEE  
(11)  
FEE  
(11)  
ERCS = 1 and  
DCOS = 1  
1
1
2
3
CLKST will not update immediately after a write to CLKS. Several bus cycles are required before CLKST updates to the new  
value.  
The reference frequency has no effect on ICGOUT in SCM, but the reference frequency is still used in making the comparisons  
that determine the DCOS bit  
After initial LOCK; will be ICGDCLK/2R during initial locking process and while FLL is re-locking after the MFD bits are changed.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
146  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.4.11 Fixed Frequency Clock  
The ICG provides a fixed frequency clock output, XCLK, for use by on-chip peripherals. This output is  
equal to the internal bus clock, BUSCLK, in all modes except FEE. In FEE mode, XCLK is equal to  
ICGERCLK ÷ 2 when the following conditions are met:  
(P × N) ÷ R 4 where P is determined by RANGE (see Table 8-11), N and R are determined by  
MFD and RFD respectively (see Table 8-12).  
LOCK = 1.  
If the above conditions are not true, then XCLK is equal to BUSCLK.  
When the ICG is in either FEI or SCM mode, XCLK is turned off. Any peripherals which can use XCLK  
as a clock source must not do so when the ICG is in FEI or SCM mode.  
8.4.12 High Gain Oscillator  
The oscillator has the option of running in a high gain oscillator (HGO) mode, which improves the  
oscillator's resistance to EMC noise when running in FBE or FEE modes. This option is selected by writing  
a 1 to the HGO bit in the ICGC1 register. HGO is used with both the high and low range oscillators but is  
only valid when REFS = 1 in the ICGC1 register. When HGO = 0, the standard low-power oscillator is  
selected. This bit is writable only once after any reset.  
8.5  
Initialization/Application Information  
Introduction  
8.5.1  
The section is intended to give some basic direction on which configuration a user would want to select  
when initializing the ICG. For some applications, the serial communication link may dictate the accuracy  
of the clock reference. For other applications, lowest power consumption may be the chief clock  
consideration. Still others may have lowest cost as the primary goal. The ICG allows great flexibility in  
choosing which is best for any application.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
147  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
Table 8-10. ICG Configuration Consideration  
Clock Reference Source = Internal  
Clock Reference Source = External  
FEI  
FEE  
4 MHz < fBus < 20 MHz.  
4 MHz < fBus < 20 MHz  
Medium power (will be less than FEE if oscillator  
range = high)  
Medium power (will be less than FEI if oscillator  
range = low)  
FLL  
Good clock accuracy (After IRG is trimmed)  
Lowest system cost (no external components  
required)  
IRG is on. DCO is on. 1  
Engaged  
High clock accuracy  
Medium/High system cost (crystal, resonator or  
external clock source required)  
IRG is off. DCO is on.  
SCM  
FBE  
This mode is mainly provided for quick and reliable  
system startup.  
3 MHz < fBus < 5 MHz (default).  
3 MHz < fBus < 20 MHz (via filter bits).  
Medium power  
Poor accuracy.  
IRG is off. DCO is on and open loop.  
fBus range 8 MHz when crystal or resonator is  
used.  
Lowest power  
Highest clock accuracy  
Medium/High system cost (Crystal, resonator or  
external clock source required)  
IRG is off. DCO is off.  
FLL  
Bypassed  
1
The IRG typically consumes 100 μA. The FLL and DCO typically consumes 0.5 to 2.5 mA, depending upon output frequency.  
For minimum power consumption and minimum jitter, choose N and R to be as small as possible.  
The following sections contain initialization examples for various configurations.  
NOTE  
Hexadecimal values designated by a preceding $, binary values designated  
by a preceding %, and decimal values have no preceding character.  
Important configuration information is repeated here for reference.  
Table 8-11. ICGOUT Frequency Calculation Options  
1
Clock Scheme  
fICGOUT  
P
Note  
SCM — self-clocked mode (FLL bypassed  
internal)  
fICGDCLK / R  
NA  
Typical fICGOUT = 8 MHz  
immediately after reset  
FBE — FLL bypassed external  
FEI — FLL engaged internal  
FEE — FLL engaged external  
fext / R  
NA  
64  
(fIRG / 7)* 64 * N / R  
fext * P * N / R  
Typical fIRG = 243 kHz  
Range = 0 ; P = 64  
Range = 1; P = 1  
1
Ensure that f  
, which is equal to f  
* R, does not exceed f  
.
ICGDCLK  
ICGOUT  
ICGDCLKmax  
Table 8-12. MFD and RFD Decode Table  
MFD Value  
Multiplication Factor (N)  
RFD  
Division Factor (R)  
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
4
6
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
÷1  
÷2  
÷4  
÷8  
÷16  
8
10  
12  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
148  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
Table 8-12. MFD and RFD Decode Table  
101  
110  
111  
14  
16  
18  
101  
110  
111  
÷32  
÷64  
÷128  
8.5.2  
Example #1: External Crystal = 32 kHz, Bus Frequency = 4.19 MHz  
In this example, the FLL will be used (in FEE mode) to multiply the external 32 kHz oscillator up to  
8.38 MHz to achieve 4.19 MHz bus frequency.  
After the MCU is released from reset, the ICG is in self-clocked mode (SCM) and supplies approximately  
8 MHz on ICGOUT, which corresponds to a 4 MHz bus frequency (f ).  
Bus  
The clock scheme will be FLL engaged, external (FEE). So  
f
= f * P * N / R ; P = 64, f = 32 kHz  
ext  
Eqn. 8-1  
Eqn. 8-2  
ICGOUT  
ext  
Solving for N / R gives:  
N / R = 8.38 MHz /(32 kHz * 64) = 4 ; we can choose N = 4 and R =1  
The values needed in each register to set up the desired operation are:  
ICGC1 = $38 (%00111000)  
Bit 7  
Bit 6  
Bit 5  
HGO  
RANGE  
REFS  
0
0
1
11  
Configures oscillator for low power  
Configures oscillator for low-frequency range; FLL prescale factor is 64  
Oscillator using crystal or resonator is requested  
FLL engaged, external reference clock mode  
Oscillator disabled  
Loss-of-clock detection enabled  
Unimplemented or reserved, always reads zero  
Bits 4:3 CLKS  
Bit 2  
Bit 1  
Bit 0  
OSCSTEN 0  
LOCD  
0
0
ICGC2 = $00 (%00000000)  
Bit 7 LOLRE  
0
Generates an interrupt request on loss of lock  
Bits 6:4 MFD  
000 Sets the MFD multiplication factor to 4  
Generates an interrupt request on loss of clock  
000 Sets the RFD division factor to ÷1  
Bit 3  
LOCRE  
0
Bits 2:0 RFD  
ICGS1 = $xx  
This is read only except for clearing interrupt flag  
ICGS2 = $xx  
This is read only; should read DCOS = 1 before performing any time critical tasks  
ICGFLTLU/L = $xx  
Only needed in self-clocked mode; FLT will be adjusted by loop to give 8.38 MHz DCO clock  
Bits 15:12 unused  
0000  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
149  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
Bits 11:0 FLT  
ICGTRM = $xx  
Bits 7:0 TRIM  
No need for user initialization  
Only need to write when trimming internal oscillator; not used when external  
crystal is clock source  
Figure 8-14 shows flow charts for three conditions requiring ICG initialization.  
QUICK RECOVERY FROM STOP  
MINIMUM CURRENT DRAW IN STOP  
RESET  
RECOVERY FROM STOP  
OSCSTEN = 0  
RECOVERY FROM STOP  
OSCSTEN = 1  
INITIALIZE ICG  
ICGC1 = $38  
ICGC2 = $00  
CHECK  
NO  
CHECK  
NO  
FLL LOCK STATUS.  
FLL LOCK STATUS.  
LOCK = 1?  
LOCK = 1?  
YES  
YES  
CHECK  
FLL LOCK STATUS.  
LOCK = 1?  
NO  
CONTINUE  
CONTINUE  
YES  
CONTINUE  
NOTE: THIS WILL REQUIRE THE OSCILLATOR TO START AND  
STABILIZE. ACTUAL TIME IS DEPENDENT ON CRYSTAL /RESONATOR  
AND EXTERNAL CIRCUITRY.  
Figure 8-14. ICG Initialization for FEE in Example #1  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
150  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.5.3  
Example #2: External Crystal = 4 MHz, Bus Frequency = 20 MHz  
In this example, the FLL will be used (in FEE mode) to multiply the external 4 MHz oscillator up to  
40-MHz to achieve 20 MHz bus frequency.  
After the MCU is released from reset, the ICG is in self-clocked mode (SCM) and supplies approximately  
8 MHz on ICGOUT which corresponds to a 4 MHz bus frequency (f ).  
Bus  
During reset initialization software, the clock scheme will be set to FLL engaged, external (FEE). So  
f
= f * P * N / R ; P = 1, f = 4.00 MHz  
Eqn. 8-3  
ICGOUT  
ext  
ext  
Solving for N / R gives:  
N / R = 40 MHz /(4 MHz * 1) = 10 ; We can choose N = 10 and R = 1  
The values needed in each register to set up the desired operation are:  
ICGC1 = $78 (%01111000)  
Eqn. 8-4  
Bit 7  
Bit 6  
Bit 5  
HGO  
RANGE  
REFS  
0
1
1
Configures oscillator for low power  
Configures oscillator for high-frequency range; FLL prescale factor is 1  
Requests an oscillator  
Bits 4:3 CLKS  
11  
FLL engaged, external reference clock mode  
Disables the oscillator  
Loss-of-clock detection enabled  
Bit 2  
Bit 1  
Bit 0  
OSCSTEN 0  
LOCD  
0
0
Unimplemented or reserved, always reads zero  
ICGC2 = $30 (%00110000)  
Bit 7 LOLRE  
0
Generates an interrupt request on loss of lock  
Bit 6:4 MFD  
011 Sets the MFD multiplication factor to 10  
Generates an interrupt request on loss of clock  
000 Sets the RFD division factor to ÷1  
Bit 3  
LOCRE  
0
Bit 2:0 RFD  
ICGS1 = $xx  
This is read only except for clearing interrupt flag  
ICGS2 = $xx  
This is read only. Should read DCOS before performing any time critical tasks  
ICGFLTLU/L = $xx  
Not used in this example  
ICGTRM  
Not used in this example  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
151  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
RECOVERY  
FROM STOP  
RESET  
INITIALIZE ICG  
ICGC1 = $7A  
ICGC2 = $30  
SERVICE INTERRUPT  
SOURCE (f  
= 4 MHz)  
Bus  
CHECK  
FLL LOCK STATUS  
LOCK = 1?  
NO  
CHECK  
FLL LOCK STATUS  
LOCK = 1?  
NO  
YES  
YES  
CONTINUE  
CONTINUE  
Figure 8-15. ICG Initialization and Stop Recovery for Example #2  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
152  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.5.4  
Example #3: No External Crystal Connection, 5.4 MHz Bus  
Frequency  
In this example, the FLL will be used (in FEI mode) to multiply the internal 243 kHz (approximate)  
reference clock up to 10.8 MHz to achieve 5.4 MHz bus frequency. This system will also use the trim  
function to fine tune the frequency based on an external reference signal.  
After the MCU is released from reset, the ICG is in self-clocked mode (SCM) and supplies approximately  
8 MHz on ICGOUT which corresponds to a 4 MHz bus frequency (f ).  
Bus  
The clock scheme will be FLL engaged, internal (FEI). So  
f
= (f  
/ 7) * P * N / R ; P = 64, f = 243 kHz  
IRG  
Eqn. 8-5  
Eqn. 8-6  
ICGOUT  
IRG  
Solving for N / R gives:  
N / R = 10.8 MHz /(243/7 kHz * 64) = 4.86 ; We can choose N = 10 and R = 2.  
A trim procedure will be required to hone the frequency to exactly 5.4 MHz. An example of the trim  
procedure is shown in example #4.  
The values needed in each register to set up the desired operation are:  
ICGC1 = $28 (%00101000)  
Bit 7  
Bit 6  
Bit 5  
HGO  
RANGE  
REFS  
0
0
1
01  
Configures oscillator for low power  
Configures oscillator for low-frequency range; FLL prescale factor is 64  
Oscillator using crystal or resonator requested (bit is really a don’t care)  
FLL engaged, internal reference clock mode  
Disables the oscillator  
Loss-of-clock enabled  
Unimplemented or reserved, always reads zero  
Bits 4:3 CLKS  
Bit 2  
Bit 1  
Bit 0  
OSCSTEN 0  
LOCD  
0
0
ICGC2 = $31 (%00110001)  
Bit 7 LOLRE  
Bit 6:4 MFD  
0
Generates an interrupt request on loss of lock  
011 Sets the MFD multiplication factor to 10  
Generates an interrupt request on loss of clock  
001 Sets the RFD division factor to ÷2  
Bit 3  
LOCRE  
0
Bit 2:0 RFD  
ICGS1 = $xx  
This is read only except for clearing interrupt flag  
ICGS2 = $xx  
This is read only; good idea to read this before performing time critical operations  
ICGFLTLU/L = $xx  
Not used in this example  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
153  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
ICGTRM = $xx  
Bit 7:0 TRIM  
Only need to write when trimming internal oscillator; done in separate  
operation (see example #4)  
RECOVERY  
FROM STOP  
RESET  
INITIALIZE ICG  
ICGC1 = $28  
ICGC2 = $31  
CHECK  
FLL LOCK STATUS.  
LOCK = 1?  
NO  
YES  
CHECK  
FLL LOCK STATUS.  
LOCK = 1?  
NO  
CONTINUE  
YES  
CONTINUE  
NOTE: THIS WILL REQUIRE THE INTERAL REFERENCE CLOCK TO START AND  
STABILIZE.  
Figure 8-16. ICG Initialization and Stop Recovery for Example #3  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
154  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
8.5.5  
Example #4: Internal Clock Generator Trim  
The internally generated clock source is guaranteed to have a period 25% of the nominal value. In some  
cases, this may be sufficient accuracy. For other applications that require a tight frequency tolerance, a  
trimming procedure is provided that will allow a very accurate source. This section outlines one example  
of trimming the internal oscillator. Many other possible trimming procedures are valid and can be used.  
Initial conditions:  
1) Clock supplied from ATE has 500 μsec duty period  
2) ICG configured for internal reference with 4 MHz bus  
START TRIM PROCEDURE  
ICGTRM = $80, n = 1  
MEASURE  
INCOMING CLOCK WIDTH  
(COUNT = # OF BUS CLOCKS / 4)  
COUNT < EXPECTED = 500  
(RUNNING TOO SLOW)  
COUNT = EXPECTED = 500  
.
CASE STATEMENT  
COUNT > EXPECTED = 500  
(RUNNING TOO FAST)  
ICGTRM =  
ICGTRM - 128 / (2**n)  
(DECREASING ICGTRM  
INCREASES THE FREQUENCY)  
ICGTRM =  
STORE ICGTRM VALUE  
IN NON-VOLATILE  
MEMORY  
ICGTRM + 128 / (2**n)  
(INCREASING ICGTRM  
DECREASES THE FREQUENCY)  
CONTINUE  
n = n + 1  
YES  
IS n > 8?  
NO  
Figure 8-17. Trim Procedure  
In this particular case, the MCU has been attached to a PCB and the entire assembly is undergoing final  
test with automated test equipment. A separate signal or message is provided to the MCU operating under  
user provided software control. The MCU initiates a trim procedure as outlined in Figure 8-17 while the  
tester supplies a precision reference signal.  
If the intended bus frequency is near the maximum allowed for the device, it is recommended to trim using  
a reduction divisor (R) twice the final value. After the trim procedure is complete, the reduction divisor  
can be restored. This will prevent accidental overshoot of the maximum clock frequency.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
155  
Chapter 8 Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
156  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 9  
Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)  
9.1  
Introduction  
The MC9S08AW60 Series has one KBI module with eight keyboard interrupt inputs that are shared with  
port D and port G pins. See Chapter 2, “Pins and Connections,” for more information about the logic and  
hardware aspects of these pins.  
9.2  
Keyboard Pin Sharing  
The KBI input KBIP7 shares a common pin with PTD7 and AD15. When KBIP7 is enabled the pin is  
forced to its input state regardless of the value of the associated port D data direction bit. The port D pullup  
enable is still used to control the pullup resistor and the pin state can be sensed through a read of the port  
D data register (this requires that bit 7 of the port D DDR is 0). In the case that the pin is enabled as an  
ADC input, both the PTD7 and KBIP7 functions are disabled, including the pullup resistor.  
The KBI input KBIP6 shares a common pin with PTD3 and AD11, and KBI input KBIP5 shares a common  
pin with PTD2 and AD10. The sharing of each of these inputs with port and ADC functions operates in  
the same way as described above for KBIP7.  
The KBI inputs KBIP4 – KBIP0 are shared on common pins with PTG4 – PTG0. These pins all operate  
in the same way as described above for KBIP7 except that none are shared with an ADC input.  
KBIP3 – KBIP0 are always falling-edge/low-level sensitive. KBIP7 – KBIP4 can be configured for  
rising-edge/high-level or for falling-edge/low-level sensitivity. When any of the inputs KBIP7 – KBIP0 are  
enabled and configured to detect rising edges/high levels, and the pin pullup is enabled through the  
corresponding port pullup enable bit for that pin, a pulldown resistor rather than a pullup resistor is enabled  
on the pin.  
Table 9-1. KBI and Parallel I/O Interaction  
PTxPEn  
(Pull Enable)  
PTxDDn  
KBIPEn  
KBEDGn  
Pullup  
Pulldown  
(Data Direction) (KBI Pin Enable) (KBI Edge Select)  
0
1
x
1
1
0
0
0
1
x
x
x
0
0
0
1
1
1
x1  
x
disabled  
enabled  
disabled  
enabled  
disabled  
disabled  
disabled  
disabled  
disabled  
disabled  
enabled  
disabled  
x
0
1
x
1
x = Don’t care  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
157  
Chapter 9 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)  
9.3  
Features  
The keyboard interrupt (KBI) module features include:  
Four falling edge/low level sensitive  
Four falling edge/low level or rising edge/high level sensitive  
Choice of edge-only or edge-and-level sensitivity  
Common interrupt flag and interrupt enable control  
Capable of waking up the MCU from stop3 or wait mode  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
158  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 9 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)  
HCS08 CORE  
DEBUG  
MODULE (DBG)  
8
PTA7– PTA0  
BKGD/MS  
BDC  
CPU  
8
PTB7/AD1P7–  
PTB0/AD1P0  
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL  
RESET  
IRQ  
PTC6  
RESETS AND INTERRUPTS  
MODES OF OPERATION  
POWER MANAGEMENT  
RxD2  
TxD2  
PTC5/RxD2  
PTC4  
PTC3/TxD2  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI2)  
PTC2/MCLK  
PTC1/SDA1  
SDA1  
SCL1  
RTI  
COP  
LVD  
IIC MODULE (IIC1)  
PTC0/SCL1  
IRQ  
AD1P7–AD1P0  
8
V
DDAD  
8
10-BIT  
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL  
CONVERTER (ADC1)  
AD1P15–AD1P8  
V
SSAD  
V
REFL  
PTD7/AD1P15/KBI1P7  
PTD6/AD1P14/TPM1CLK  
PTD5/AD1P13  
PTD4/AD1P12/TPM2CLK  
PTD3/AD1P11/KBI1P6  
PTD2/AD1P10/KBI1P5  
PTD1/AD1P9  
V
REFH  
USER FLASH  
(AW60 = 63,280 BYTES)  
(AW48 = 49,152 BYTES)  
(AW32 = 32,768 BYTES)  
(AW16 = 16,384 BYTES)  
PTD0/AD1P8  
SPSCK1  
PTE7/SPSCK1  
PTE6/MOSI1  
MOSI1  
SERIAL PERIPHERAL  
USER RAM  
MISO1  
SS1  
INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1)  
PTE5/MISO1  
PTE4/SS1  
AW60/48/32 = 2048 BYTES  
AW16 = 1024 BYTES  
TPM1CLK  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM1)  
TPM1CH5–  
TPM1CH0  
INTERNAL CLOCK  
GENERATOR (ICG)  
6
RxD1  
TxD1  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTF7  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI1)  
LOW-POWER OSCILLATOR  
PTF6  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
TPM2CLK  
V
DD  
VOLTAGE  
REGULATOR  
2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM2)  
TPM2CH1–TPM2CH0  
V
SS  
2
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
KBI1P7–KBI1P5  
3
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
8-BIT KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI1)  
KBI1P4–KBI1P0  
5
EXTAL  
XTAL  
PTG6/EXTAL  
PTG5/XTAL  
NOTES:  
PTG4/KBI1P4  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
PTG2/KBI1P2  
PTG1/KBI1P1  
PTG0/KBI1P0  
1. Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port.  
2. Pin contains software configurable pullup/pulldown device if IRQ is enabled  
(IRQPE = 1). Pulldown is enabled if rising edge detect is selected (IRQEDG = 1)  
3. IRQ does not have a clamp diode to VDD. IRQ should not be driven above VDD  
4. Pin contains integrated pullup device.  
.
5. Pins PTD7, PTD3, PTD2, and PTG4 contain both pullup and pulldown devices.  
Pulldown enabled when KBI is enabled (KBIPEn = 1) and rising edge is selected  
(KBEDGn = 1).  
Figure 9-1. Block Diagram Highlighting KBI Module  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
159  
Chapter 9 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)  
9.3.1  
KBI Block Diagram  
Figure 9-2 shows the block diagram for a KBI module.  
KBI1P0  
KBIPE0  
BUSCLK  
KBACK  
RESET  
KBI1P3  
V
KBIPE3  
KBIPE4  
DD  
KBF  
CLR  
D
Q
1
0
SYNCHRONIZER  
STOP BYPASS  
CK  
KBI1P4  
S
KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT FF  
STOP  
KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT  
REQUEST  
KBEDG4  
KBIMOD  
1
0
KBIE  
KBI1Pn  
S
KBIPEn  
KBEDGn  
Figure 9-2. KBI Block Diagram  
9.4  
Register Definition  
This section provides information about all registers and control bits associated with the KBI module.  
Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter of this data sheet for the absolute address  
assignments for all KBI registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A  
Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute  
addresses.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
160  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 9 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)  
9.4.1  
KBI Status and Control Register (KBI1SC)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
KBF  
0
KBEDG7  
KBEDG6  
KBEDG5  
KBEDG4  
KBIE  
KBIMOD  
W
KBACK  
0
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 9-3. KBI Status and Control Register (KBI1SC)  
Table 9-2. KBI1SC Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:4  
Keyboard Edge Select for KBI Port Bits — Each of these read/write bits selects the polarity of the edges and/or  
KBEDG[7:4] levels that are recognized as trigger events on the corresponding KBI port pin when it is configured as a keyboard  
interrupt input (KBIPEn = 1). Also see the KBIMOD control bit, which determines whether the pin is sensitive to  
edges-only or edges and levels.  
0 Falling edges/low levels  
1 Rising edges/high levels  
3
Keyboard Interrupt Flag — This read-only status flag is set whenever the selected edge event has been  
KBF  
detected on any of the enabled KBI port pins. This flag is cleared by writing a 1 to the KBACK control bit. The  
flag will remain set if KBIMOD = 1 to select edge-and-level operation and any enabled KBI port pin remains at  
the asserted level.  
KBF can be used as a software pollable flag (KBIE = 0) or it can generate a hardware interrupt request to the  
CPU (KBIE = 1).  
0 No KBI interrupt pending  
1 KBI interrupt pending  
2
Keyboard Interrupt Acknowledge — This write-only bit (reads always return 0) is used to clear the KBF status  
flag by writing a 1 to KBACK. When KBIMOD = 1 to select edge-and-level operation and any enabled KBI port  
pin remains at the asserted level, KBF is being continuously set so writing 1 to KBACK does not clear the KBF  
flag.  
KBACK  
1
Keyboard Interrupt Enable — This read/write control bit determines whether hardware interrupts are generated  
when the KBF status flag equals 1. When KBIE = 0, no hardware interrupts are generated, but KBF can still be  
used for software polling.  
KBIE  
0 KBF does not generate hardware interrupts (use polling)  
1 KBI hardware interrupt requested when KBF = 1  
KBIMOD  
Keyboard Detection Mode — This read/write control bit selects either edge-only detection or edge-and-level  
detection. KBI port bits 3 through 0 can detect falling edges-only or falling edges and low levels. KBI port bits 7  
through 4 can be configured to detect either:  
• Rising edges-only or rising edges and high levels (KBEDGn = 1)  
• Falling edges-only or falling edges and low levels (KBEDGn = 0)  
0 Edge-only detection  
1 Edge-and-level detection  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
161  
Chapter 9 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)  
9.4.2  
KBI Pin Enable Register (KBI1PE)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
KBIPE7  
KBIPE6  
KBIPE5  
KBIPE4  
KBIPE3  
KBIPE2  
KBIPE1  
KBIPE0  
W
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 9-4. KBI Pin Enable Register (KBI1PE)  
Table 9-3. KBI1PE Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Keyboard Pin Enable for KBI Port Bits — Each of these read/write bits selects whether the associated KBI  
KBIPE[7:0] port pin is enabled as a keyboard interrupt input or functions as a general-purpose I/O pin.  
0 Bit n of KBI port is a general-purpose I/O pin not associated with the KBI  
1 Bit n of KBI port enabled as a keyboard interrupt input  
9.5  
Functional Description  
Pin Enables  
9.5.1  
The KBIPEn control bits in the KBI1PE register allow a user to enable (KBIPEn = 1) any combination of  
KBI-related port pins to be connected to the KBI module. Pins corresponding to 0s in KBI1PE are  
general-purpose I/O pins that are not associated with the KBI module.  
9.5.2  
Edge and Level Sensitivity  
Synchronous logic is used to detect edges. Prior to detecting an edge, enabled keyboard inputs in a KBI  
module must be at the deasserted logic level.  
A falling edge is detected when an enabled keyboard input signal is seen as a logic 1 (the deasserted level)  
during one bus cycle and then a logic 0 (the asserted level) during the next cycle.  
A rising edge is detected when the input signal is seen as a logic 0 during one bus cycle and then a logic 1  
during the next cycle.  
The KBIMOD control bit can be set to reconfigure the detection logic so that it detects edges and levels.  
In KBIMOD = 1 mode, the KBF status flag becomes set when an edge is detected (when one or more  
enabled pins change from the deasserted to the asserted level while all other enabled pins remain at their  
deasserted levels), but the flag is continuously set (and cannot be cleared) as long as any enabled keyboard  
input pin remains at the asserted level. When the MCU enters stop3 mode, the synchronous edge-detection  
logic is bypassed (because clocks are stopped). In stop3 mode, KBI inputs act as asynchronous  
level-sensitive inputs so they can wake the MCU from stop3 mode.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
162  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 9 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)  
9.5.3  
KBI Interrupt Controls  
The KBF status flag becomes set (1) when an edge event has been detected on any KBI input pin. If  
KBIE = 1 in the KBI1SC register, a hardware interrupt will be requested whenever KBF = 1. The KBF flag  
is cleared by writing a 1 to the keyboard acknowledge (KBACK) bit.  
When KBIMOD = 0 (selecting edge-only operation), KBF is always cleared by writing 1 to KBACK.  
When KBIMOD = 1 (selecting edge-and-level operation), KBF cannot be cleared as long as any keyboard  
input is at its asserted level.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
163  
Chapter 9 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV1)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
164  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 10  
Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)  
10.1 Introduction  
The MC9S08AW60 Series includes two independent timer/PWM (TPM) modules which support  
traditional input capture, output compare, or buffered edge-aligned pulse-width modulation (PWM) on  
each channel. A control bit in each TPM configures all channels in that timer to operate as center-aligned  
PWM functions. In each of these two TPMs, timing functions are based on a separate 16-bit counter with  
prescaler and modulo features to control frequency and range (period between overflows) of the time  
reference. This timing system is ideally suited for a wide range of control applications, and the  
center-aligned PWM capability on the 3-channel TPM extends the field of applications to motor control in  
small appliances.  
The use of the fixed system clock, XCLK, as the clock source for either of the TPM modules allows the  
TPM prescaler to run using the oscillator rate divided by two (ICGERCLK/2). This option is only available  
if the ICG is configured in FEE mode and the proper conditions are met (see Section 8.4.11, “Fixed  
Frequency Clock”). In all other ICG modes this selection is redundant because XCLK is the same as  
BUSCLK.  
10.2 Features  
The timer system in the MC9S08AW60 Series includes a 6-channel TPM1 and a separate 2-channel  
TPM2. Timer system features include:  
A total of eight channels:  
— Each channel may be input capture, output compare, or buffered edge-aligned PWM  
— Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger  
— Set, clear, or toggle output compare action  
— Selectable polarity on PWM outputs  
Each TPM may be configured for buffered, center-aligned pulse-width modulation (CPWM) on all  
channels  
Clock source to prescaler for each TPM is independently selectable as bus clock, fixed system  
clock, or an external pin:  
— Prescale taps for divide by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, or 128  
— External clock inputs TPM1CLK for TPM1 and TPM2CLK for TPM2 (only available in  
64-pin package)  
16-bit free-running or up/down (CPWM) count operation  
16-bit modulus register to control counter range  
Timer system enable  
One interrupt per channel plus a terminal count interrupt for each TPM module  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
165  
Chapter 10 Timer/PWM (S08TPMV2)  
HCS08 CORE  
DEBUG  
MODULE (DBG)  
8
PTA7– PTA0  
BKGD/MS  
BDC  
CPU  
8
PTB7/AD1P7–  
PTB0/AD1P0  
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL  
RESET  
IRQ  
PTC6  
RESETS AND INTERRUPTS  
MODES OF OPERATION  
POWER MANAGEMENT  
RxD2  
TxD2  
PTC5/RxD2  
PTC4  
PTC3/TxD2  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI2)  
PTC2/MCLK  
PTC1/SDA1  
SDA1  
SCL1  
RTI  
COP  
LVD  
IIC MODULE (IIC1)  
PTC0/SCL1  
IRQ  
AD1P7–AD1P0  
8
V
DDAD  
8
10-BIT  
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL  
CONVERTER (ADC1)  
AD1P15–AD1P8  
V
SSAD  
V
REFL  
PTD7/AD1P15/KBI1P7  
PTD6/AD1P14/TPM1CLK  
PTD5/AD1P13  
PTD4/AD1P12/TPM2CLK  
PTD3/AD1P11/KBI1P6  
PTD2/AD1P10/KBI1P5  
PTD1/AD1P9  
V
REFH  
USER FLASH  
(AW60 = 63,280 BYTES)  
(AW48 = 49,152 BYTES)  
(AW32 = 32,768 BYTES)  
(AW16 = 16,384 BYTES)  
PTD0/AD1P8  
SPSCK1  
PTE7/SPSCK1  
PTE6/MOSI1  
MOSI1  
SERIAL PERIPHERAL  
USER RAM  
MISO1  
SS1  
INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1)  
PTE5/MISO1  
PTE4/SS1  
AW60/48/32 = 2048 BYTES  
AW16 = 1024 BYTES  
TPM1CLK  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM1)  
TPM1CH5–  
TPM1CH0  
INTERNAL CLOCK  
GENERATOR (ICG)  
6
RxD1  
TxD1  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTF7  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI1)  
LOW-POWER OSCILLATOR  
PTF6  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
TPM2CLK  
V
DD  
VOLTAGE  
REGULATOR  
2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM2)  
TPM2CH1–TPM2CH0  
V
SS  
2
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
KBI1P7–KBI1P5  
3
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
8-BIT KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI1)  
KBI1P4–KBI1P0  
5
EXTAL  
XTAL  
PTG6/EXTAL  
PTG5/XTAL  
NOTES:  
PTG4/KBI1P4  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
PTG2/KBI1P2  
PTG1/KBI1P1  
PTG0/KBI1P0  
1. Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port.  
2. Pin contains software configurable pullup/pulldown device if IRQ is enabled  
(IRQPE = 1). Pulldown is enabled if rising edge detect is selected (IRQEDG = 1)  
3. IRQ does not have a clamp diode to VDD. IRQ should not be driven above VDD  
4. Pin contains integrated pullup device.  
.
5. Pins PTD7, PTD3, PTD2, and PTG4 contain both pullup and pulldown devices.  
Pulldown enabled when KBI is enabled (KBIPEn = 1) and rising edge is selected  
(KBEDGn = 1).  
Figure 10-1. Block Diagram Highlighting the TPM Module  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
166  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
10.2.1 Features  
The TPM has the following features:  
Each TPM may be configured for buffered, center-aligned pulse-width modulation (CPWM) on all  
channels  
Clock sources independently selectable per TPM (multiple TPMs device)  
Selectable clock sources (device dependent): bus clock, fixed system clock, external pin  
Clock prescaler taps for divide by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, or 128  
16-bit free-running or up/down (CPWM) count operation  
16-bit modulus register to control counter range  
Timer system enable  
One interrupt per channel plus a terminal count interrupt for each TPM module (multiple TPMs  
device)  
Channel features:  
— Each channel may be input capture, output compare, or buffered edge-aligned PWM  
— Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger  
— Set, clear, or toggle output compare action  
— Selectable polarity on PWM outputs  
10.2.2 Block Diagram  
Figure 10-2 shows the structure of a TPM. Some MCUs include more than one TPM, with various  
numbers of channels.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
167  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
BUSCLK  
CLOCK SOURCE  
SELECT  
PRESCALE AND SELECT  
DIVIDE BY  
XCLK  
OFF, BUS, XCLK, EXT  
1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, or 128  
SYNC  
TPMxCLK  
PS2  
PS1  
PS0  
CLKSB  
CLKSA  
CPWMS  
MAIN 16-BIT COUNTER  
TOF  
TOIE  
INTERRUPT  
LOGIC  
COUNTER RESET  
16-BIT COMPARATOR  
TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL  
ELS0B ELS0A  
CHANNEL 0  
PORT  
LOGIC  
TPMxCH0  
16-BIT COMPARATOR  
TPMxC0VH:TPMxC0VL  
CH0F  
INTERRUPT  
LOGIC  
16-BIT LATCH  
CH0IE  
MS0B  
MS0A  
ELS1B ELS1A  
CHANNEL 1  
16-BIT COMPARATOR  
TPMxC1VH:TPMxC1VL  
16-BIT LATCH  
TPMxCH1  
PORT  
LOGIC  
CH1F  
INTERRUPT  
LOGIC  
CH1IE  
MS1B  
MS1A  
ELSnB ELSnA  
CHANNEL n  
TPMxCHn  
PORT  
LOGIC  
16-BIT COMPARATOR  
TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL  
CHnF  
INTERRUPT  
LOGIC  
16-BIT LATCH  
CHnIE  
MSnA  
MSnB  
Figure 10-2. TPM Block Diagram  
The central component of the TPM is the 16-bit counter that can operate as a free-running counter, a  
modulo counter, or an up-/down-counter when the TPM is configured for center-aligned PWM. The TPM  
counter (when operating in normal up-counting mode) provides the timing reference for the input capture,  
output compare, and edge-aligned PWM functions. The timer counter modulo registers,  
TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL, control the modulo value of the counter. (The values 0x0000 or 0xFFFF  
effectively make the counter free running.) Software can read the counter value at any time without  
affecting the counting sequence. Any write to either byte of the TPMxCNT counter resets the counter  
regardless of the data value written.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
168  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
All TPM channels are programmable independently as input capture, output compare, or buffered  
edge-aligned PWM channels.  
10.3 External Signal Description  
When any pin associated with the timer is configured as a timer input, a passive pullup can be enabled.  
After reset, the TPM modules are disabled and all pins default to general-purpose inputs with the passive  
pullups disabled.  
10.3.1 External TPM Clock Sources  
When control bits CLKSB:CLKSA in the timer status and control register are set to 1:1, the prescaler and  
consequently the 16-bit counter for TPMx are driven by an external clock source, TPMxCLK, connected  
to an I/O pin. A synchronizer is needed between the external clock and the rest of the TPM. This  
synchronizer is clocked by the bus clock so the frequency of the external source must be less than one-half  
the frequency of the bus rate clock. The upper frequency limit for this external clock source is specified to  
be one-fourth the bus frequency to conservatively accommodate duty cycle and phase-locked loop (PLL)  
or frequency-locked loop (FLL) frequency jitter effects.  
On some devices the external clock input is shared with one of the TPM channels. When a TPM channel  
is shared as the external clock input, the associated TPM channel cannot use the pin. (The channel can still  
be used in output compare mode as a software timer.) Also, if one of the TPM channels is used as the  
external clock input, the corresponding ELSnB:ELSnA control bits must be set to 0:0 so the channel is not  
trying to use the same pin.  
10.3.2 TPMxCHn — TPMx Channel n I/O Pins  
Each TPM channel is associated with an I/O pin on the MCU. The function of this pin depends on the  
configuration of the channel. In some cases, no pin function is needed so the pin reverts to being controlled  
by general-purpose I/O controls. When a timer has control of a port pin, the port data and data direction  
registers do not affect the related pin(s). See the Pins and Connections chapter for additional information  
about shared pin functions.  
10.4 Register Definition  
The TPM includes:  
An 8-bit status and control register (TPMxSC)  
A 16-bit counter (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL)  
A 16-bit modulo register (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL)  
Each timer channel has:  
An 8-bit status and control register (TPMxCnSC)  
A 16-bit channel value register (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL)  
Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter of this data sheet for the absolute address  
assignments for all TPM registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
169  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute  
addresses.  
Some MCU systems have more than one TPM, so register names include placeholder characters to identify  
which TPM and which channel is being referenced. For example, TPMxCnSC refers to timer (TPM) x,  
channel n and TPM1C2SC is the status and control register for timer 1, channel 2.  
10.4.1 Timer x Status and Control Register (TPMxSC)  
TPMxSC contains the overflow status flag and control bits that are used to configure the interrupt enable,  
TPM configuration, clock source, and prescale divisor. These controls relate to all channels within this  
timer module.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
TOF  
TOIE  
CPWMS  
CLKSB  
CLKSA  
PS2  
PS1  
PS0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 10-3. Timer x Status and Control Register (TPMxSC)  
Table 10-1. TPMxSC Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
TOF  
Timer Overflow Flag — This flag is set when the TPM counter changes to 0x0000 after reaching the modulo  
value programmed in the TPM counter modulo registers. When the TPM is configured for CPWM, TOF is set  
after the counter has reached the value in the modulo register, at the transition to the next lower count value.  
Clear TOF by reading the TPM status and control register when TOF is set and then writing a 0 to TOF. If another  
TPM overflow occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, the sequence is reset so TOF would remain set  
after the clear sequence was completed for the earlier TOF. Reset clears TOF. Writing a 1 to TOF has no effect.  
0 TPM counter has not reached modulo value or overflow  
1 TPM counter has overflowed  
6
Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable — This read/write bit enables TPM overflow interrupts. If TOIE is set, an  
interrupt is generated when TOF equals 1. Reset clears TOIE.  
0 TOF interrupts inhibited (use software polling)  
TOIE  
1 TOF interrupts enabled  
5
Center-Aligned PWM Select — This read/write bit selects CPWM operating mode. Reset clears this bit so the  
TPM operates in up-counting mode for input capture, output compare, and edge-aligned PWM functions. Setting  
CPWMS reconfigures the TPM to operate in up-/down-counting mode for CPWM functions. Reset clears  
CPWMS.  
CPWMS  
0 All TPMx channels operate as input capture, output compare, or edge-aligned PWM mode as selected by the  
MSnB:MSnA control bits in each channel’s status and control register  
1 All TPMx channels operate in center-aligned PWM mode  
4:3  
Clock Source Select — As shown in Table 10-2, this 2-bit field is used to disable the TPM system or select one  
CLKS[B:A] of three clock sources to drive the counter prescaler. The external source and the XCLK are synchronized to the  
bus clock by an on-chip synchronization circuit.  
2:0  
PS[2:0]  
Prescale Divisor Select — This 3-bit field selects one of eight divisors for the TPM clock input as shown in  
Table 10-3. This prescaler is located after any clock source synchronization or clock source selection, so it affects  
whatever clock source is selected to drive the TPM system.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
170  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
Table 10-2. TPM Clock Source Selection  
CLKSB:CLKSA  
TPM Clock Source to Prescaler Input  
0:0  
0:1  
1:0  
1:1  
No clock selected (TPMx disabled)  
Bus rate clock (BUSCLK)  
Fixed system clock (XCLK)  
External source (TPMxCLK)1,2  
1
2
The maximum frequency that is allowed as an external clock is one-fourth of the bus  
frequency.  
If the external clock input is shared with channel n and is selected as the TPM clock source,  
the corresponding ELSnB:ELSnA control bits should be set to 0:0 so channel n does not try  
to use the same pin for a conflicting function.  
Table 10-3. Prescale Divisor Selection  
PS2:PS1:PS0  
TPM Clock Source Divided-By  
0:0:0  
0:0:1  
0:1:0  
0:1:1  
1:0:0  
1:0:1  
1:1:0  
1:1:1  
1
2
4
8
16  
32  
64  
128  
10.4.2 Timer x Counter Registers (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL)  
The two read-only TPM counter registers contain the high and low bytes of the value in the TPM counter.  
Reading either byte (TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL) latches the contents of both bytes into a buffer where  
they remain latched until the other byte is read. This allows coherent 16-bit reads in either order. The  
coherency mechanism is automatically restarted by an MCU reset, a write of any value to TPMxCNTH or  
TPMxCNTL, or any write to the timer status/control register (TPMxSC).  
Reset clears the TPM counter registers.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
Bit 15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
Bit 8  
Any write to TPMxCNTH clears the 16-bit counter.  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 10-4. Timer x Counter Register High (TPMxCNTH)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
171  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
Any write to TPMxCNTL clears the 16-bit counter.  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 10-5. Timer x Counter Register Low (TPMxCNTL)  
When background mode is active, the timer counter and the coherency mechanism are frozen such that the  
buffer latches remain in the state they were in when the background mode became active even if one or  
both bytes of the counter are read while background mode is active.  
10.4.3 Timer x Counter Modulo Registers (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL)  
The read/write TPM modulo registers contain the modulo value for the TPM counter. After the TPM  
counter reaches the modulo value, the TPM counter resumes counting from 0x0000 at the next clock  
(CPWMS = 0) or starts counting down (CPWMS = 1), and the overflow flag (TOF) becomes set. Writing  
to TPMxMODH or TPMxMODL inhibits TOF and overflow interrupts until the other byte is written. Reset  
sets the TPM counter modulo registers to 0x0000, which results in a free-running timer counter (modulo  
disabled).  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
Bit 15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
Bit 8  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 10-6. Timer x Counter Modulo Register High (TPMxMODH)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 10-7. Timer x Counter Modulo Register Low (TPMxMODL)  
It is good practice to wait for an overflow interrupt so both bytes of the modulo register can be written well  
before a new overflow. An alternative approach is to reset the TPM counter before writing to the TPM  
modulo registers to avoid confusion about when the first counter overflow will occur.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
172  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
10.4.4 Timer x Channel n Status and Control Register (TPMxCnSC)  
TPMxCnSC contains the channel interrupt status flag and control bits that are used to configure the  
interrupt enable, channel configuration, and pin function.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
CHnF  
CHnIE  
MSnB  
MSnA  
ELSnB  
ELSnA  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 10-8. Timer x Channel n Status and Control Register (TPMxCnSC)  
Table 10-4. TPMxCnSC Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Channel n Flag — When channel n is configured for input capture, this flag bit is set when an active edge occurs  
on the channel n pin. When channel n is an output compare or edge-aligned PWM channel, CHnF is set when  
the value in the TPM counter registers matches the value in the TPM channel n value registers. This flag is  
seldom used with center-aligned PWMs because it is set every time the counter matches the channel value  
register, which correspond to both edges of the active duty cycle period.  
CHnF  
A corresponding interrupt is requested when CHnF is set and interrupts are enabled (CHnIE = 1). Clear CHnF  
by reading TPMxCnSC while CHnF is set and then writing a 0 to CHnF. If another interrupt request occurs before  
the clearing sequence is complete, the sequence is reset so CHnF would remain set after the clear sequence  
was completed for the earlier CHnF. This is done so a CHnF interrupt request cannot be lost by clearing a  
previous CHnF. Reset clears CHnF. Writing a 1 to CHnF has no effect.  
0 No input capture or output compare event occurred on channel n  
1 Input capture or output compare event occurred on channel n  
6
Channel n Interrupt Enable — This read/write bit enables interrupts from channel n. Reset clears CHnIE.  
0 Channel n interrupt requests disabled (use software polling)  
CHnIE  
1 Channel n interrupt requests enabled  
5
Mode Select B for TPM Channel n — When CPWMS = 0, MSnB = 1 configures TPM channel n for  
MSnB  
edge-aligned PWM mode. For a summary of channel mode and setup controls, refer to Table 10-5.  
4
Mode Select A for TPM Channel n — When CPWMS = 0 and MSnB = 0, MSnA configures TPM channel n for  
input capture mode or output compare mode. Refer to Table 10-5 for a summary of channel mode and setup  
controls.  
MSnA  
3:2  
Edge/Level Select Bits — Depending on the operating mode for the timer channel as set by  
ELSn[B:A] CPWMS:MSnB:MSnA and shown in Table 10-5, these bits select the polarity of the input edge that triggers an  
input capture event, select the level that will be driven in response to an output compare match, or select the  
polarity of the PWM output.  
Setting ELSnB:ELSnA to 0:0 configures the related timer pin as a general-purpose I/O pin unrelated to any timer  
channel functions. This function is typically used to temporarily disable an input capture channel or to make the  
timer pin available as a general-purpose I/O pin when the associated timer channel is set up as a software timer  
that does not require the use of a pin.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
173  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
Table 10-5. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection  
CPWMS  
MSnB:MSnA  
ELSnB:ELSnA  
Mode  
Configuration  
X
XX  
00  
Pin not used for TPM channel; use as an external clock for the TPM or  
revert to general-purpose I/O  
0
00  
01  
01  
10  
11  
00  
01  
10  
11  
10  
X1  
10  
X1  
Input capture  
Capture on rising edge only  
Capture on falling edge only  
Capture on rising or falling edge  
Software compare only  
Output  
compare  
Toggle output on compare  
Clear output on compare  
Set output on compare  
1X  
XX  
Edge-aligned  
PWM  
High-true pulses (clear output on compare)  
Low-true pulses (set output on compare)  
1
Center-aligned High-true pulses (clear output on compare-up)  
PWM  
Low-true pulses (set output on compare-up)  
If the associated port pin is not stable for at least two bus clock cycles before changing to input capture  
mode, it is possible to get an unexpected indication of an edge trigger. Typically, a program would clear  
status flags after changing channel configuration bits and before enabling channel interrupts or using the  
status flags to avoid any unexpected behavior.  
10.4.5 Timer x Channel Value Registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL)  
These read/write registers contain the captured TPM counter value of the input capture function or the  
output compare value for the output compare or PWM functions. The channel value registers are cleared  
by reset.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
Bit 15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
Bit 8  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 10-9. Timer x Channel Value Register High (TPMxCnVH)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 10-10. Timer Channel Value Register Low (TPMxCnVL)  
In input capture mode, reading either byte (TPMxCnVH or TPMxCnVL) latches the contents of both bytes  
into a buffer where they remain latched until the other byte is read. This latching mechanism also resets  
(becomes unlatched) when the TPMxCnSC register is written.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
174  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
In output compare or PWM modes, writing to either byte (TPMxCnVH or TPMxCnVL) latches the value  
into a buffer. When both bytes have been written, they are transferred as a coherent 16-bit value into the  
timer channel value registers. This latching mechanism may be manually reset by writing to the  
TPMxCnSC register.  
This latching mechanism allows coherent 16-bit writes in either order, which is friendly to various  
compiler implementations.  
10.5 Functional Description  
All TPM functions are associated with a main 16-bit counter that allows flexible selection of the clock  
source and prescale divisor. A 16-bit modulo register also is associated with the main 16-bit counter in the  
TPM. Each TPM channel is optionally associated with an MCU pin and a maskable interrupt function.  
The TPM has center-aligned PWM capabilities controlled by the CPWMS control bit in TPMxSC. When  
CPWMS is set to 1, timer counter TPMxCNT changes to an up-/down-counter and all channels in the  
associated TPM act as center-aligned PWM channels. When CPWMS = 0, each channel can  
independently be configured to operate in input capture, output compare, or buffered edge-aligned PWM  
mode.  
The following sections describe the main 16-bit counter and each of the timer operating modes (input  
capture, output compare, edge-aligned PWM, and center-aligned PWM). Because details of pin operation  
and interrupt activity depend on the operating mode, these topics are covered in the associated mode  
sections.  
10.5.1 Counter  
All timer functions are based on the main 16-bit counter (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL). This section  
discusses selection of the clock source, up-counting vs. up-/down-counting, end-of-count overflow, and  
manual counter reset.  
After any MCU reset, CLKSB:CLKSA = 0:0 so no clock source is selected and the TPM is inactive.  
Normally, CLKSB:CLKSA would be set to 0:1 so the bus clock drives the timer counter. The clock source  
for each of the TPM can be independently selected to be off, the bus clock (BUSCLK), the fixed system  
clock (XCLK), or an external input. The maximum frequency allowed for the external clock option is  
one-fourth the bus rate. Refer to Section 10.4.1, “Timer x Status and Control Register (TPMxSC)and  
Table 10-2 for more information about clock source selection.  
When the microcontroller is in active background mode, the TPM temporarily suspends all counting until  
the microcontroller returns to normal user operating mode. During stop mode, all TPM clocks are stopped;  
therefore, the TPM is effectively disabled until clocks resume. During wait mode, the TPM continues to  
operate normally.  
The main 16-bit counter has two counting modes. When center-aligned PWM is selected (CPWMS = 1),  
the counter operates in up-/down-counting mode. Otherwise, the counter operates as a simple up-counter.  
As an up-counter, the main 16-bit counter counts from 0x0000 through its terminal count and then  
continues with 0x0000. The terminal count is 0xFFFF or a modulus value in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
175  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
When center-aligned PWM operation is specified, the counter counts upward from 0x0000 through its  
terminal count and then counts downward to 0x0000 where it returns to up-counting. Both 0x0000 and the  
terminal count value (value in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL) are normal length counts (one timer clock  
period long).  
An interrupt flag and enable are associated with the main 16-bit counter. The timer overflow flag (TOF) is  
a software-accessible indication that the timer counter has overflowed. The enable signal selects between  
software polling (TOIE = 0) where no hardware interrupt is generated, or interrupt-driven operation  
(TOIE = 1) where a static hardware interrupt is automatically generated whenever the TOF flag is 1.  
The conditions that cause TOF to become set depend on the counting mode (up or up/down). In  
up-counting mode, the main 16-bit counter counts from 0x0000 through 0xFFFF and overflows to 0x0000  
on the next counting clock. TOF becomes set at the transition from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. When a modulus  
limit is set, TOF becomes set at the transition from the value set in the modulus register to 0x0000. When  
the main 16-bit counter is operating in up-/down-counting mode, the TOF flag gets set as the counter  
changes direction at the transition from the value set in the modulus register and the next lower count value.  
This corresponds to the end of a PWM period. (The 0x0000 count value corresponds to the center of a  
period.)  
Because the HCS08 MCU is an 8-bit architecture, a coherency mechanism is built into the timer counter  
for read operations. Whenever either byte of the counter is read (TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL), both bytes  
are captured into a buffer so when the other byte is read, the value will represent the other byte of the count  
at the time the first byte was read. The counter continues to count normally, but no new value can be read  
from either byte until both bytes of the old count have been read.  
The main timer counter can be reset manually at any time by writing any value to either byte of the timer  
count TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL. Resetting the counter in this manner also resets the coherency  
mechanism in case only one byte of the counter was read before resetting the count.  
10.5.2 Channel Mode Selection  
Provided CPWMS = 0 (center-aligned PWM operation is not specified), the MSnB and MSnA control bits  
in the channel n status and control registers determine the basic mode of operation for the corresponding  
channel. Choices include input capture, output compare, and buffered edge-aligned PWM.  
10.5.2.1 Input Capture Mode  
With the input capture function, the TPM can capture the time at which an external event occurs. When an  
active edge occurs on the pin of an input capture channel, the TPM latches the contents of the TPM counter  
into the channel value registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL). Rising edges, falling edges, or any edge may  
be chosen as the active edge that triggers an input capture.  
When either byte of the 16-bit capture register is read, both bytes are latched into a buffer to support  
coherent 16-bit accesses regardless of order. The coherency sequence can be manually reset by writing to  
the channel status/control register (TPMxCnSC).  
An input capture event sets a flag bit (CHnF) that can optionally generate a CPU interrupt request.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
176  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
10.5.2.2 Output Compare Mode  
With the output compare function, the TPM can generate timed pulses with programmable position,  
polarity, duration, and frequency. When the counter reaches the value in the channel value registers of an  
output compare channel, the TPM can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin.  
In output compare mode, values are transferred to the corresponding timer channel value registers only  
after both 8-bit bytes of a 16-bit register have been written. This coherency sequence can be manually reset  
by writing to the channel status/control register (TPMxCnSC).  
An output compare event sets a flag bit (CHnF) that can optionally generate a CPU interrupt request.  
10.5.2.3 Edge-Aligned PWM Mode  
This type of PWM output uses the normal up-counting mode of the timer counter (CPWMS = 0) and can  
be used when other channels in the same TPM are configured for input capture or output compare  
functions. The period of this PWM signal is determined by the setting in the modulus register  
(TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL). The duty cycle is determined by the setting in the timer channel value  
register (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL). The polarity of this PWM signal is determined by the setting in the  
ELSnA control bit. Duty cycle cases of 0 percent and 100 percent are possible.  
As Figure 10-11 shows, the output compare value in the TPM channel registers determines the pulse width  
(duty cycle) of the PWM signal. The time between the modulus overflow and the output compare is the  
pulse width. If ELSnA = 0, the counter overflow forces the PWM signal high and the output compare  
forces the PWM signal low. If ELSnA = 1, the counter overflow forces the PWM signal low and the output  
compare forces the PWM signal high.  
OVERFLOW  
OVERFLOW  
OVERFLOW  
PERIOD  
PULSE  
WIDTH  
TPMxC  
OUTPUT  
COMPARE  
OUTPUT  
COMPARE  
OUTPUT  
COMPARE  
Figure 10-11. PWM Period and Pulse Width (ELSnA = 0)  
When the channel value register is set to 0x0000, the duty cycle is 0 percent. By setting the timer channel  
value register (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) to a value greater than the modulus setting, 100% duty cycle  
can be achieved. This implies that the modulus setting must be less than 0xFFFF to get 100% duty cycle.  
Because the HCS08 is a family of 8-bit MCUs, the settings in the timer channel registers are buffered to  
ensure coherent 16-bit updates and to avoid unexpected PWM pulse widths. Writes to either register,  
TPMxCnVH or TPMxCnVL, write to buffer registers. In edge-PWM mode, values are transferred to the  
corresponding timer channel registers only after both 8-bit bytes of a 16-bit register have been written and  
the value in the TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL counter is 0x0000. (The new duty cycle does not take effect  
until the next full period.)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
177  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
10.5.3 Center-Aligned PWM Mode  
This type of PWM output uses the up-/down-counting mode of the timer counter (CPWMS = 1). The  
output compare value in TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL determines the pulse width (duty cycle) of the PWM  
signal and the period is determined by the value in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL.  
TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL should be kept in the range of 0x0001 to 0x7FFF because values outside this  
range can produce ambiguous results. ELSnA will determine the polarity of the CPWM output.  
pulse width = 2 x (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL)  
Eqn. 10-1  
period = 2 x (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL);  
for TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0001–0x7FFF  
Eqn. 10-2  
If the channel value register TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL is zero or negative (bit 15 set), the duty cycle will  
be 0%. If TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL is a positive value (bit 15 clear) and is greater than the (nonzero)  
modulus setting, the duty cycle will be 100% because the duty cycle compare will never occur. This  
implies the usable range of periods set by the modulus register is 0x0001 through 0x7FFE (0x7FFF if  
generation of 100% duty cycle is not necessary). This is not a significant limitation because the resulting  
period is much longer than required for normal applications.  
TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0000 is a special case that should not be used with center-aligned PWM  
mode. When CPWMS = 0, this case corresponds to the counter running free from 0x0000 through  
0xFFFF, but when CPWMS = 1 the counter needs a valid match to the modulus register somewhere other  
than at 0x0000 in order to change directions from up-counting to down-counting.  
Figure 10-12 shows the output compare value in the TPM channel registers (multiplied by 2), which  
determines the pulse width (duty cycle) of the CPWM signal. If ELSnA = 0, the compare match while  
counting up forces the CPWM output signal low and a compare match while counting down forces the  
output high. The counter counts up until it reaches the modulo setting in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL, then  
counts down until it reaches zero. This sets the period equal to two times TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL.  
COUNT = 0  
OUTPUT  
COMPARE  
(COUNT UP)  
OUTPUT  
COMPARE  
(COUNT DOWN)  
COUNT =  
TPMxMODH:TPMx  
COUNT =  
TPMxMODH:TPMx  
TPM1C  
PULSE WIDTH  
PERIOD  
2 x  
2 x  
Figure 10-12. CPWM Period and Pulse Width (ELSnA = 0)  
Center-aligned PWM outputs typically produce less noise than edge-aligned PWMs because fewer I/O pin  
transitions are lined up at the same system clock edge. This type of PWM is also required for some types  
of motor drives.  
Because the HCS08 is a family of 8-bit MCUs, the settings in the timer channel registers are buffered to  
ensure coherent 16-bit updates and to avoid unexpected PWM pulse widths. Writes to any of the registers,  
TPMxMODH, TPMxMODL, TPMxCnVH, and TPMxCnVL, actually write to buffer registers. Values are  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
178  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
transferred to the corresponding timer channel registers only after both 8-bit bytes of a 16-bit register have  
been written and the timer counter overflows (reverses direction from up-counting to down-counting at the  
end of the terminal count in the modulus register). This TPMxCNT overflow requirement only applies to  
PWM channels, not output compares.  
Optionally, when TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL = TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL, the TPM can generate a TOF  
interrupt at the end of this count. The user can choose to reload any number of the PWM buffers, and they  
will all update simultaneously at the start of a new period.  
Writing to TPMxSC cancels any values written to TPMxMODH and/or TPMxMODL and resets the  
coherency mechanism for the modulo registers. Writing to TPMxCnSC cancels any values written to the  
channel value registers and resets the coherency mechanism for TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL.  
10.6 TPM Interrupts  
The TPM generates an optional interrupt for the main counter overflow and an interrupt for each channel.  
The meaning of channel interrupts depends on the mode of operation for each channel. If the channel is  
configured for input capture, the interrupt flag is set each time the selected input capture edge is  
recognized. If the channel is configured for output compare or PWM modes, the interrupt flag is set each  
time the main timer counter matches the value in the 16-bit channel value register. See the Resets,  
Interrupts, and System Configuration chapter for absolute interrupt vector addresses, priority, and local  
interrupt mask control bits.  
For each interrupt source in the TPM, a flag bit is set on recognition of the interrupt condition such as timer  
overflow, channel input capture, or output compare events. This flag may be read (polled) by software to  
verify that the action has occurred, or an associated enable bit (TOIE or CHnIE) can be set to enable  
hardware interrupt generation. While the interrupt enable bit is set, a static interrupt will be generated  
whenever the associated interrupt flag equals 1. It is the responsibility of user software to perform a  
sequence of steps to clear the interrupt flag before returning from the interrupt service routine.  
10.6.1 Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags  
TPM interrupt flags are cleared by a 2-step process that includes a read of the flag bit while it is set (1)  
followed by a write of 0 to the bit. If a new event is detected between these two steps, the sequence is reset  
and the interrupt flag remains set after the second step to avoid the possibility of missing the new event.  
10.6.2 Timer Overflow Interrupt Description  
The conditions that cause TOF to become set depend on the counting mode (up or up/down). In  
up-counting mode, the 16-bit timer counter counts from 0x0000 through 0xFFFF and overflows to 0x0000  
on the next counting clock. TOF becomes set at the transition from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. When a modulus  
limit is set, TOF becomes set at the transition from the value set in the modulus register to 0x0000. When  
the counter is operating in up-/down-counting mode, the TOF flag gets set as the counter changes direction  
at the transition from the value set in the modulus register and the next lower count value. This corresponds  
to the end of a PWM period. (The 0x0000 count value corresponds to the center of a period.)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
179  
Chapter 10 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2)  
10.6.3 Channel Event Interrupt Description  
The meaning of channel interrupts depends on the current mode of the channel (input capture, output  
compare, edge-aligned PWM, or center-aligned PWM).  
When a channel is configured as an input capture channel, the ELSnB:ELSnA control bits select rising  
edges, falling edges, any edge, or no edge (off) as the edge that triggers an input capture event. When the  
selected edge is detected, the interrupt flag is set. The flag is cleared by the 2-step sequence described in  
Section 10.6.1, “Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags.”  
When a channel is configured as an output compare channel, the interrupt flag is set each time the main  
timer counter matches the 16-bit value in the channel value register. The flag is cleared by the 2-step  
sequence described in Section 10.6.1, “Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags.”  
10.6.4 PWM End-of-Duty-Cycle Events  
For channels that are configured for PWM operation, there are two possibilities:  
When the channel is configured for edge-aligned PWM, the channel flag is set when the timer  
counter matches the channel value register that marks the end of the active duty cycle period.  
When the channel is configured for center-aligned PWM, the timer count matches the channel  
value register twice during each PWM cycle. In this CPWM case, the channel flag is set at the start  
and at the end of the active duty cycle, which are the times when the timer counter matches the  
channel value register.  
The flag is cleared by the 2-step sequence described in Section 10.6.1, “Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags.”  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
180  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 11  
Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
11.1 Introduction  
The MC9S08AW60 Series includes two independent serial communications interface (SCI) modules  
which are sometimes called universal asynchronous receiver/transmitters (UARTs). Typically, these  
systems are used to connect to the RS232 serial input/output (I/O) port of a personal computer or  
workstation, but they can also be used to communicate with other embedded controllers.  
A flexible, 13-bit, modulo-based baud rate generator supports a broad range of standard baud rates beyond  
115.2 kbaud. Transmit and receive within the same SCI use a common baud rate, and each SCI module  
has a separate baud rate generator.  
This SCI system offers many advanced features not commonly found on other asynchronous serial I/O  
peripherals on other embedded controllers. The receiver employs an advanced data sampling technique  
that ensures reliable communication and noise detection. Hardware parity, receiver wakeup, and double  
buffering on transmit and receive are also included.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
181  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
HCS08 CORE  
DEBUG  
MODULE (DBG)  
8
PTA7– PTA0  
BKGD/MS  
BDC  
CPU  
8
PTB7/AD1P7–  
PTB0/AD1P0  
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL  
RESET  
IRQ  
PTC6  
RESETS AND INTERRUPTS  
MODES OF OPERATION  
POWER MANAGEMENT  
RxD2  
TxD2  
PTC5/RxD2  
PTC4  
PTC3/TxD2  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI2)  
PTC2/MCLK  
PTC1/SDA1  
SDA1  
SCL1  
RTI  
COP  
LVD  
IIC MODULE (IIC1)  
PTC0/SCL1  
IRQ  
AD1P7–AD1P0  
8
V
DDAD  
8
10-BIT  
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL  
CONVERTER (ADC1)  
AD1P15–AD1P8  
V
SSAD  
V
REFL  
PTD7/AD1P15/KBI1P7  
PTD6/AD1P14/TPM1CLK  
PTD5/AD1P13  
PTD4/AD1P12/TPM2CLK  
PTD3/AD1P11/KBI1P6  
PTD2/AD1P10/KBI1P5  
PTD1/AD1P9  
V
REFH  
USER FLASH  
(AW60 = 63,280 BYTES)  
(AW48 = 49,152 BYTES)  
(AW32 = 32,768 BYTES)  
(AW16 = 16,384 BYTES)  
PTD0/AD1P8  
SPSCK1  
PTE7/SPSCK1  
PTE6/MOSI1  
MOSI1  
SERIAL PERIPHERAL  
USER RAM  
MISO1  
SS1  
INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1)  
PTE5/MISO1  
PTE4/SS1  
AW60/48/32 = 2048 BYTES  
AW16 = 1024 BYTES  
TPM1CLK  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM1)  
TPM1CH5–  
TPM1CH0  
INTERNAL CLOCK  
GENERATOR (ICG)  
6
RxD1  
TxD1  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTF7  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI1)  
LOW-POWER OSCILLATOR  
PTF6  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
TPM2CLK  
V
DD  
VOLTAGE  
REGULATOR  
2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM2)  
TPM2CH1–TPM2CH0  
V
SS  
2
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
KBI1P7–KBI1P5  
3
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
8-BIT KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI1)  
KBI1P4–KBI1P0  
5
EXTAL  
XTAL  
PTG6/EXTAL  
PTG5/XTAL  
NOTES:  
PTG4/KBI1P4  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
PTG2/KBI1P2  
PTG1/KBI1P1  
PTG0/KBI1P0  
1. Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port.  
2. Pin contains software configurable pullup/pulldown device if IRQ is enabled  
(IRQPE = 1). Pulldown is enabled if rising edge detect is selected (IRQEDG = 1)  
3. IRQ does not have a clamp diode to VDD. IRQ should not be driven above VDD  
4. Pin contains integrated pullup device.  
.
5. Pins PTD7, PTD3, PTD2, and PTG4 contain both pullup and pulldown devices.  
Pulldown enabled when KBI is enabled (KBIPEn = 1) and rising edge is selected  
(KBEDGn = 1).  
Figure 11-1. Block Diagram Highlighting the SCI Modules  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
182  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
11.1.1 Features  
Features of SCI module include:  
Full-duplex, standard non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format  
Double-buffered transmitter and receiver with separate enables  
Programmable baud rates (13-bit modulo divider)  
Interrupt-driven or polled operation:  
— Transmit data register empty and transmission complete  
— Receive data register full  
— Receive overrun, parity error, framing error, and noise error  
— Idle receiver detect  
Hardware parity generation and checking  
Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit character length  
Receiver wakeup by idle-line or address-mark  
Optional 13-bit break character  
Selectable transmitter output polarity  
11.1.2 Modes of Operation  
See Section 11.3, “Functional Description,” for a detailed description of SCI operation in the different  
modes.  
8- and 9-bit data modes  
Stop modes — SCI is halted during all stop modes  
Loop mode  
Single-wire mode  
11.1.3 Block Diagram  
Figure 11-2 shows the transmitter portion of the SCI.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
183  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
INTERNAL BUS  
(WRITE-ONLY)  
LOOPS  
RSRC  
SCID – Tx BUFFER  
LOOP  
CONTROL  
TO RECEIVE  
DATA IN  
M
11-BIT TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER  
H
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L
TO TxD PIN  
1 × BAUD  
RATE CLOCK  
SHIFT DIRECTION  
TXINV  
T8  
PE  
PT  
PARITY  
GENERATION  
SCI CONTROLS TxD  
TxD DIRECTION  
TE  
SBK  
TO TxD  
TRANSMIT CONTROL  
PIN LOGIC  
TXDIR  
BRK13  
TDRE  
TIE  
Tx INTERRUPT  
REQUEST  
TC  
TCIE  
Figure 11-2. SCI Transmitter Block Diagram  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
184  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
Figure 11-3 shows the receiver portion of the SCI.  
INTERNAL BUS  
(READ-ONLY)  
SCID – Rx BUFFER  
DIVIDE  
BY 16  
16 × BAUD  
RATE CLOCK  
M
11-BIT RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER  
H
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L
DATA RECOVERY  
FROM RxD PIN  
SHIFT DIRECTION  
LOOPS  
RSRC  
WAKE  
SINGLE-WIRE  
LOOP CONTROL  
WAKEUP  
LOGIC  
RWU  
ILT  
FROM  
TRANSMITTER  
RDRF  
RIE  
Rx INTERRUPT  
REQUEST  
IDLE  
ILIE  
OR  
ORIE  
FE  
FEIE  
ERROR INTERRUPT  
REQUEST  
NF  
NEIE  
PE  
PT  
PARITY  
CHECKING  
PF  
PEIE  
Figure 11-3. SCI Receiver Block Diagram  
11.2 Register Definition  
The SCI has eight 8-bit registers to control baud rate, select SCI options, report SCI status, and for  
transmit/receive data.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
185  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter of this data sheet for the absolute address  
assignments for all SCI registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A  
Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute  
addresses.  
11.2.1 SCI Baud Rate Registers (SCIxBDH, SCIxBHL)  
This pair of registers controls the prescale divisor for SCI baud rate generation. To update the 13-bit baud  
rate setting [SBR12:SBR0], first write to SCIxBDH to buffer the high half of the new value and then write  
to SCIxBDL. The working value in SCIxBDH does not change until SCIxBDL is written.  
SCIxBDL is reset to a non-zero value, so after reset the baud rate generator remains disabled until the first  
time the receiver or transmitter is enabled (RE or TE bits in SCIxC2 are written to 1).  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
SBR12  
SBR11  
SBR10  
SBR9  
SBR8  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 11-4. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCIxBDH)  
Table 11-1. SCIxBDH Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
4:0  
Baud Rate Modulo Divisor — These 13 bits are referred to collectively as BR, and they set the modulo divide  
SBR[12:8] rate for the SCI baud rate generator. When BR = 0, the SCI baud rate generator is disabled to reduce supply  
current. When BR = 1 to 8191, the SCI baud rate = BUSCLK/(16×BR). See also BR bits in Table 11-2.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
SBR7  
SBR6  
SBR5  
SBR4  
SBR3  
SBR2  
SBR1  
SBR0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Figure 11-5. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCIxBDL)  
Table 11-2. SCIxBDL Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
4:0  
Baud Rate Modulo Divisor — These 13 bits are referred to collectively as BR, and they set the modulo divide  
SBR[12:8] rate for the SCI baud rate generator. When BR = 0, the SCI baud rate generator is disabled to reduce supply  
current. When BR = 1 to 8191, the SCI baud rate = BUSCLK/(16×BR). See also BR bits in Table 11-1.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
186  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
11.2.2 SCI Control Register 1 (SCIxC1)  
This read/write register is used to control various optional features of the SCI system.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
LOOPS  
SCISWAI  
RSRC  
M
WAKE  
ILT  
PE  
PT  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 11-6. SCI Control Register 1 (SCIxC1)  
Table 11-3. SCIxC1 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Loop Mode Select — Selects between loop back modes and normal 2-pin full-duplex modes. When  
LOOPS = 1, the transmitter output is internally connected to the receiver input.  
0 Normal operation — RxD and TxD use separate pins.  
LOOPS  
1 Loop mode or single-wire mode where transmitter outputs are internally connected to receiver input. (See  
RSRC bit.) RxD pin is not used by SCI.  
6
SCI Stops in Wait Mode  
SCISWAI 0 SCI clocks continue to run in wait mode so the SCI can be the source of an interrupt that wakes up the CPU.  
1 SCI clocks freeze while CPU is in wait mode.  
5
Receiver Source Select — This bit has no meaning or effect unless the LOOPS bit is set to 1. When  
LOOPS = 1, the receiver input is internally connected to the TxD pin and RSRC determines whether this  
connection is also connected to the transmitter output.  
RSRC  
0 Provided LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 0 selects internal loop back mode and the SCI does not use the RxD or TxD  
pins.  
1 Single-wire SCI mode where the TxD pin is connected to the transmitter output and receiver input.  
4
9-Bit or 8-Bit Mode Select  
M
0 Normal — start + 8 data bits (LSB first) + stop.  
1 Receiver and transmitter use 9-bit data characters  
start + 8 data bits (LSB first) + 9th data bit + stop.  
3
Receiver Wakeup Method Select — Refer to Section 11.3.3.2, “Receiver Wakeup Operation” for more  
WAKE  
information.  
0 Idle-line wakeup.  
1 Address-mark wakeup.  
2
ILT  
Idle Line Type Select — Setting this bit to 1 ensures that the stop bit and logic 1 bits at the end of a character  
do not count toward the 10 or 11 bit times of the logic high level by the idle line detection logic. Refer to  
Section 11.3.3.2.1, “Idle-Line Wakeup” for more information.  
0 Idle character bit count starts after start bit.  
1 Idle character bit count starts after stop bit.  
1
PE  
Parity Enable — Enables hardware parity generation and checking. When parity is enabled, the most significant  
bit (MSB) of the data character (eighth or ninth data bit) is treated as the parity bit.  
0 No hardware parity generation or checking.  
1 Parity enabled.  
0
Parity Type — Provided parity is enabled (PE = 1), this bit selects even or odd parity. Odd parity means the total  
PT  
number of 1s in the data character, including the parity bit, is odd. Even parity means the total number of 1s in  
the data character, including the parity bit, is even.  
0 Even parity.  
1 Odd parity.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
187  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
11.2.3 SCI Control Register 2 (SCIxC2)  
This register can be read or written at any time.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
TIE  
TCIE  
RIE  
ILIE  
TE  
RE  
RWU  
SBK  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 11-7. SCI Control Register 2 (SCIxC2)  
Table 11-4. SCIxC2 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Transmit Interrupt Enable (for TDRE)  
TIE  
0 Hardware interrupts from TDRE disabled (use polling).  
1 Hardware interrupt requested when TDRE flag is 1.  
6
Transmission Complete Interrupt Enable (for TC)  
0 Hardware interrupts from TC disabled (use polling).  
1 Hardware interrupt requested when TC flag is 1.  
TCIE  
5
Receiver Interrupt Enable (for RDRF)  
RIE  
0 Hardware interrupts from RDRF disabled (use polling).  
1 Hardware interrupt requested when RDRF flag is 1.  
4
Idle Line Interrupt Enable (for IDLE)  
ILIE  
0 Hardware interrupts from IDLE disabled (use polling).  
1 Hardware interrupt requested when IDLE flag is 1.  
3
TE  
Transmitter Enable  
0 Transmitter off.  
1 Transmitter on.  
TE must be 1 in order to use the SCI transmitter. Normally, when TE = 1, the SCI forces the TxD pin to act as an  
output for the SCI system. If LOOPS = 1 and RSRC = 0, the TxD pin reverts to being a port B general-purpose  
I/O pin even if TE = 1.  
When the SCI is configured for single-wire operation (LOOPS = RSRC = 1), TXDIR controls the direction of  
traffic on the single SCI communication line (TxD pin).  
TE also can be used to queue an idle character by writing TE = 0 then TE = 1 while a transmission is in progress.  
Refer to Section 11.3.2.1, “Send Break and Queued Idle” for more details.  
When TE is written to 0, the transmitter keeps control of the port TxD pin until any data, queued idle, or queued  
break character finishes transmitting before allowing the pin to revert to a general-purpose I/O pin.  
2
Receiver Enable — When the SCI receiver is off, the RxD pin reverts to being a general-purpose port I/O pin.  
RE  
0 Receiver off.  
1 Receiver on.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
188  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
Table 11-4. SCIxC2 Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
1
Receiver Wakeup Control — This bit can be written to 1 to place the SCI receiver in a standby state where it  
waits for automatic hardware detection of a selected wakeup condition. The wakeup condition is either an idle  
line between messages (WAKE = 0, idle-line wakeup), or a logic 1 in the most significant data bit in a character  
(WAKE = 1, address-mark wakeup). Application software sets RWU and (normally) a selected hardware  
condition automatically clears RWU. Refer to Section 11.3.3.2, “Receiver Wakeup Operation” for more details.  
0 Normal SCI receiver operation.  
RWU  
1 SCI receiver in standby waiting for wakeup condition.  
0
SBK  
Send Break — Writing a 1 and then a 0 to SBK queues a break character in the transmit data stream. Additional  
break characters of 10 or 11 bit times of logic 0 are queued as long as SBK = 1. Depending on the timing of the  
set and clear of SBK relative to the information currently being transmitted, a second break character may be  
queued before software clears SBK. Refer to Section 11.3.2.1, “Send Break and Queued Idle” for more details.  
0 Normal transmitter operation.  
1 Queue break character(s) to be sent.  
11.2.4 SCI Status Register 1 (SCIxS1)  
This register has eight read-only status flags. Writes have no effect. Special software sequences (which do  
not involve writing to this register) are used to clear these status flags.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
TDRE  
TC  
RDRF  
IDLE  
OR  
NF  
FE  
PF  
Reset  
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 11-8. SCI Status Register 1 (SCIxS1)  
Table 11-5. SCIxS1 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Transmit Data Register Empty Flag — TDRE is set out of reset and when a transmit data value transfers from  
the transmit data buffer to the transmit shifter, leaving room for a new character in the buffer. To clear TDRE, read  
SCIxS1 with TDRE = 1 and then write to the SCI data register (SCIxD).  
0 Transmit data register (buffer) full.  
TDRE  
1 Transmit data register (buffer) empty.  
6
TC  
Transmission Complete Flag — TC is set out of reset and when TDRE = 1 and no data, preamble, or break  
character is being transmitted.  
0 Transmitter active (sending data, a preamble, or a break).  
1 Transmitter idle (transmission activity complete).  
TC is cleared automatically by reading SCIxS1 with TC = 1 and then doing one of the following three things:  
• Write to the SCI data register (SCIxD) to transmit new data  
• Queue a preamble by changing TE from 0 to 1  
• Queue a break character by writing 1 to SBK in SCIxC2  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
189  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
Table 11-5. SCIxS1 Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
5
Receive Data Register Full Flag — RDRF becomes set when a character transfers from the receive shifter into  
the receive data register (SCIxD). In 8-bit mode, to clear RDRF, read SCIxS1 with RDRF = 1 and then read the  
SCI data register (SCIxD). In 9-bit mode, to clear RDRF, read SCIxS1 with RDRF = 1 and then read SCIxD and  
the SCI control 3 register (SCIxC3). SCIxD and SCIxC3 can be read in any order, but the flag is cleared only after  
both data registers are read.  
RDRF  
0 Receive data register empty.  
1 Receive data register full.  
4
IDLE  
Idle Line Flag — IDLE is set when the SCI receive line becomes idle for a full character time after a period of  
activity. When ILT = 0, the receiver starts counting idle bit times after the start bit. So if the receive character is  
all 1s, these bit times and the stop bit time count toward the full character time of logic high (10 or 11 bit times  
depending on the M control bit) needed for the receiver to detect an idle line. When ILT = 1, the receiver doesn’t  
start counting idle bit times until after the stop bit. So the stop bit and any logic high bit times at the end of the  
previous character do not count toward the full character time of logic high needed for the receiver to detect an  
idle line.  
To clear IDLE, read SCIxS1 with IDLE = 1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD). After IDLE has been  
cleared, it cannot become set again until after a new character has been received and RDRF has been set. IDLE  
will get set only once even if the receive line remains idle for an extended period.  
0 No idle line detected.  
1 Idle line was detected.  
3
OR  
Receiver Overrun Flag — OR is set when a new serial character is ready to be transferred to the receive data  
register (buffer), but the previously received character has not been read from SCIxD yet. In this case, the new  
character (and all associated error information) is lost because there is no room to move it into SCIxD. To clear  
OR, read SCIxS1 with OR = 1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD).  
0 No overrun.  
1 Receive overrun (new SCI data lost).  
2
NF  
Noise Flag — The advanced sampling technique used in the receiver takes seven samples during the start bit  
and three samples in each data bit and the stop bit. If any of these samples disagrees with the rest of the samples  
within any bit time in the frame, the flag NF will be set at the same time as the flag RDRF gets set for the  
character. To clear NF, read SCIxS1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD).  
0 No noise detected.  
1 Noise detected in the received character in SCIxD.  
1
FE  
Framing Error Flag — FE is set at the same time as RDRF when the receiver detects a logic 0 where the stop  
bit was expected. This suggests the receiver was not properly aligned to a character frame. To clear FE, read  
SCIxS1 with FE = 1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD).  
0 No framing error detected. This does not guarantee the framing is correct.  
1 Framing error.  
0
Parity Error Flag — PF is set at the same time as RDRF when parity is enabled (PE = 1) and the parity bit in  
PF  
the received character does not agree with the expected parity value. To clear PF, read SCIxS1 and then read  
the SCI data register (SCIxD).  
0 No parity error.  
1 Parity error.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
190  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
11.2.5 SCI Status Register 2 (SCIxS2)  
This register has one read-only status flag. Writes have no effect.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
RAF  
BRK13  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 11-9. SCI Status Register 2 (SCIxS2)  
Table 11-6. SCIxS2 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
2
Break Character Length — BRK13 is used to select a longer break character length. Detection of a framing  
error is not affected by the state of this bit.  
BRK13  
0 Break character is 10 bit times (11 if M = 1)  
1 Break character is 13 bit times (14 if M = 1)  
0
RAF  
Receiver Active Flag — RAF is set when the SCI receiver detects the beginning of a valid start bit, and RAF is  
cleared automatically when the receiver detects an idle line. This status flag can be used to check whether an  
SCI character is being received before instructing the MCU to go to stop mode.  
0 SCI receiver idle waiting for a start bit.  
1 SCI receiver active (RxD input not idle).  
11.2.6 SCI Control Register 3 (SCIxC3)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
R8  
T8  
TXDIR  
TXINV  
ORIE  
NEIE  
FEIE  
PEIE  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 11-10. SCI Control Register 3 (SCIxC3)  
Table 11-7. SCIxC3 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
R8  
Ninth Data Bit for Receiver — When the SCI is configured for 9-bit data (M = 1), R8 can be thought of as a  
ninth receive data bit to the left of the MSB of the buffered data in the SCIxD register. When reading 9-bit data,  
both R8 and SCIxD must be read to complete the automatic RDRF clearing sequence.  
6
T8  
Ninth Data Bit for Transmitter — When the SCI is configured for 9-bit data (M = 1), T8 may be thought of as a  
ninth transmit data bit to the left of the MSB of the data in the SCIxD register. When writing 9-bit data, the entire  
9-bit value is transferred to the SCI shift register after SCIxD is written so T8 should be written (if it needs to  
change from its previous value) before SCIxD is written. If T8 does not need to change in the new value (such  
as when it is used to generate mark or space parity), it need not be written each time SCIxD is written.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
191  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
Table 11-7. SCIxC3 Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
5
TxD Pin Direction in Single-Wire Mode — When the SCI is configured for single-wire half-duplex operation  
(LOOPS = RSRC = 1), this bit determines the direction of data at the TxD pin.  
0 TxD pin is an input in single-wire mode.  
TXDIR  
1 TxD pin is an output in single-wire mode.  
4
Transmit Data Inversion — Setting this bit reverses the polarity of the transmitted data output.  
0 Transmit data not inverted  
TXINV1  
1 Transmit data inverted  
3
Overrun Interrupt Enable — This bit enables the overrun flag (OR) to generate hardware interrupt requests.  
0 OR interrupts disabled (use polling).  
ORIE  
1 Hardware interrupt requested when OR = 1.  
2
Noise Error Interrupt Enable — This bit enables the noise flag (NF) to generate hardware interrupt requests.  
0 NF interrupts disabled (use polling).  
NEIE  
1 Hardware interrupt requested when NF = 1.  
1
Framing Error Interrupt Enable — This bit enables the framing error flag (FE) to generate hardware interrupt  
FEIE  
requests.  
0 FE interrupts disabled (use polling).  
1 Hardware interrupt requested when FE = 1.  
0
Parity Error Interrupt Enable — This bit enables the parity error flag (PF) to generate hardware interrupt  
PEIE  
requests.  
0 PF interrupts disabled (use polling).  
1 Hardware interrupt requested when PF = 1.  
1
Setting TXINV inverts the TxD output for all cases: data bits, start and stop bits, break, and idle.  
11.2.7 SCI Data Register (SCIxD)  
This register is actually two separate registers. Reads return the contents of the read-only receive data  
buffer and writes go to the write-only transmit data buffer. Reads and writes of this register are also  
involved in the automatic flag clearing mechanisms for the SCI status flags.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
R7  
R6  
R5  
R4  
R3  
R2  
R1  
R0  
T7  
0
T6  
0
T5  
0
T4  
0
T3  
0
T2  
0
T1  
0
T0  
0
Reset  
Figure 11-11. SCI Data Register (SCIxD)  
11.3 Functional Description  
The SCI allows full-duplex, asynchronous, NRZ serial communication among the MCU and remote  
devices, including other MCUs. The SCI comprises a baud rate generator, transmitter, and receiver block.  
The transmitter and receiver operate independently, although they use the same baud rate generator. During  
normal operation, the MCU monitors the status of the SCI, writes the data to be transmitted, and processes  
received data. The following describes each of the blocks of the SCI.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
192  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
11.3.1 Baud Rate Generation  
As shown in Figure 11-12, the clock source for the SCI baud rate generator is the bus-rate clock.  
MODULO DIVIDE BY  
(1 THROUGH 8191)  
DIVIDE BY  
16  
Tx BAUD RATE  
BUSCLK  
SBR12:SBR0  
Rx SAMPLING CLOCK  
BAUD RATE GENERATOR  
OFF IF [SBR12:SBR0] = 0  
(16 × BAUD RATE)  
BUSCLK  
BAUD RATE =  
[SBR12:SBR0] × 16  
Figure 11-12. SCI Baud Rate Generation  
SCI communications require the transmitter and receiver (which typically derive baud rates from  
independent clock sources) to use the same baud rate. Allowed tolerance on this baud frequency depends  
on the details of how the receiver synchronizes to the leading edge of the start bit and how bit sampling is  
performed.  
The MCU resynchronizes to bit boundaries on every high-to-low transition, but in the worst case, there are  
no such transitions in the full 10- or 11-bit time character frame so any mismatch in baud rate is  
accumulated for the whole character time. For a Freescale Semiconductor SCI system whose bus  
frequency is driven by a crystal, the allowed baud rate mismatch is about 4.5 percent for 8-bit data format  
and about 4 percent for 9-bit data format. Although baud rate modulo divider settings do not always  
produce baud rates that exactly match standard rates, it is normally possible to get within a few percent,  
which is acceptable for reliable communications.  
11.3.2 Transmitter Functional Description  
This section describes the overall block diagram for the SCI transmitter, as well as specialized functions  
for sending break and idle characters. The transmitter block diagram is shown in Figure 11-2.  
The transmitter output (TxD) idle state defaults to logic high (TXINV = 0 following reset). The transmitter  
output is inverted by setting TXINV = 1. The transmitter is enabled by setting the TE bit in SCIxC2. This  
queues a preamble character that is one full character frame of the idle state. The transmitter then remains  
idle until data is available in the transmit data buffer. Programs store data into the transmit data buffer by  
writing to the SCI data register (SCIxD).  
The central element of the SCI transmitter is the transmit shift register that is either 10 or 11 bits long  
depending on the setting in the M control bit. For the remainder of this section, we will assume M = 0,  
selecting the normal 8-bit data mode. In 8-bit data mode, the shift register holds a start bit, eight data bits,  
and a stop bit. When the transmit shift register is available for a new SCI character, the value waiting in  
the transmit data register is transferred to the shift register (synchronized with the baud rate clock) and the  
transmit data register empty (TDRE) status flag is set to indicate another character may be written to the  
transmit data buffer at SCIxD.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
193  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
If no new character is waiting in the transmit data buffer after a stop bit is shifted out the TxD pin, the  
transmitter sets the transmit complete flag and enters an idle mode, with TxD high, waiting for more  
characters to transmit.  
Writing 0 to TE does not immediately release the pin to be a general-purpose I/O pin. Any transmit activity  
that is in progress must first be completed. This includes data characters in progress, queued idle  
characters, and queued break characters.  
11.3.2.1 Send Break and Queued Idle  
The SBK control bit in SCIxC2 is used to send break characters which were originally used to gain the  
attention of old teletype receivers. Break characters are a full character time of logic 0 (10 bit times  
including the start and stop bits). A longer break of 13 bit times can be enabled by setting BRK13 = 1.  
Normally, a program would wait for TDRE to become set to indicate the last character of a message has  
moved to the transmit shifter, then write 1 and then write 0 to the SBK bit. This action queues a break  
character to be sent as soon as the shifter is available. If SBK is still 1 when the queued break moves into  
the shifter (synchronized to the baud rate clock), an additional break character is queued. If the receiving  
device is another Freescale Semiconductor SCI, the break characters will be received as 0s in all eight data  
bits and a framing error (FE = 1) occurs.  
When idle-line wakeup is used, a full character time of idle (logic 1) is needed between messages to wake  
up any sleeping receivers. Normally, a program would wait for TDRE to become set to indicate the last  
character of a message has moved to the transmit shifter, then write 0 and then write 1 to the TE bit. This  
action queues an idle character to be sent as soon as the shifter is available. As long as the character in the  
shifter does not finish while TE = 0, the SCI transmitter never actually releases control of the TxD pin. If  
there is a possibility of the shifter finishing while TE = 0, set the general-purpose I/O controls so the pin  
that is shared with TxD is an output driving a logic 1. This ensures that the TxD line will look like a normal  
idle line even if the SCI loses control of the port pin between writing 0 and then 1 to TE.  
The length of the break character is affected by the BRK13 and M bits as shown below.  
Table 11-8. Break Character Length  
BRK13  
M
Break Character Length  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
10 bit times  
11 bit times  
13 bit times  
14 bit times  
11.3.3 Receiver Functional Description  
In this section, the receiver block diagram (Figure 11-3) is used as a guide for the overall receiver  
functional description. Next, the data sampling technique used to reconstruct receiver data is described in  
more detail. Finally, two variations of the receiver wakeup function are explained.  
The receiver is enabled by setting the RE bit in SCIxC2. Character frames consist of a start bit of logic 0,  
eight (or nine) data bits (LSB first), and a stop bit of logic 1. For information about 9-bit data mode, refer  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
194  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
to Section 11.3.5.1, “8- and 9-Bit Data Modes.” For the remainder of this discussion, we assume the SCI  
is configured for normal 8-bit data mode.  
After receiving the stop bit into the receive shifter, and provided the receive data register is not already full,  
the data character is transferred to the receive data register and the receive data register full (RDRF) status  
flag is set. If RDRF was already set indicating the receive data register (buffer) was already full, the overrun  
(OR) status flag is set and the new data is lost. Because the SCI receiver is double-buffered, the program  
has one full character time after RDRF is set before the data in the receive data buffer must be read to avoid  
a receiver overrun.  
When a program detects that the receive data register is full (RDRF = 1), it gets the data from the receive  
data register by reading SCIxD. The RDRF flag is cleared automatically by a 2-step sequence which is  
normally satisfied in the course of the user’s program that handles receive data. Refer to Section 11.3.4,  
“Interrupts and Status Flags” for more details about flag clearing.  
11.3.3.1 Data Sampling Technique  
The SCI receiver uses a 16× baud rate clock for sampling. The receiver starts by taking logic level samples  
at 16 times the baud rate to search for a falling edge on the RxD serial data input pin. A falling edge is  
defined as a logic 0 sample after three consecutive logic 1 samples. The 16× baud rate clock is used to  
divide the bit time into 16 segments labeled RT1 through RT16. When a falling edge is located, three more  
samples are taken at RT3, RT5, and RT7 to make sure this was a real start bit and not merely noise. If at  
least two of these three samples are 0, the receiver assumes it is synchronized to a receive character.  
The receiver then samples each bit time, including the start and stop bits, at RT8, RT9, and RT10 to  
determine the logic level for that bit. The logic level is interpreted to be that of the majority of the samples  
taken during the bit time. In the case of the start bit, the bit is assumed to be 0 if at least two of the samples  
at RT3, RT5, and RT7 are 0 even if one or all of the samples taken at RT8, RT9, and RT10 are 1s. If any  
sample in any bit time (including the start and stop bits) in a character frame fails to agree with the logic  
level for that bit, the noise flag (NF) will be set when the received character is transferred to the receive  
data buffer.  
The falling edge detection logic continuously looks for falling edges, and if an edge is detected, the sample  
clock is resynchronized to bit times. This improves the reliability of the receiver in the presence of noise  
or mismatched baud rates. It does not improve worst case analysis because some characters do not have  
any extra falling edges anywhere in the character frame.  
In the case of a framing error, provided the received character was not a break character, the sampling logic  
that searches for a falling edge is filled with three logic 1 samples so that a new start bit can be detected  
almost immediately.  
In the case of a framing error, the receiver is inhibited from receiving any new characters until the framing  
error flag is cleared. The receive shift register continues to function, but a complete character cannot  
transfer to the receive data buffer if FE is still set.  
11.3.3.2 Receiver Wakeup Operation  
Receiver wakeup is a hardware mechanism that allows an SCI receiver to ignore the characters in a  
message that is intended for a different SCI receiver. In such a system, all receivers evaluate the first  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
195  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
character(s) of each message, and as soon as they determine the message is intended for a different  
receiver, they write logic 1 to the receiver wake up (RWU) control bit in SCIxC2. When RWU = 1, it  
inhibits setting of the status flags associated with the receiver, thus eliminating the software overhead for  
handling the unimportant message characters. At the end of a message, or at the beginning of the next  
message, all receivers automatically force RWU to 0 so all receivers wake up in time to look at the first  
character(s) of the next message.  
11.3.3.2.1  
Idle-Line Wakeup  
When WAKE = 0, the receiver is configured for idle-line wakeup. In this mode, RWU is cleared  
automatically when the receiver detects a full character time of the idle-line level. The M control bit selects  
8-bit or 9-bit data mode that determines how many bit times of idle are needed to constitute a full character  
time (10 or 11 bit times because of the start and stop bits).  
When the RWU bit is set, the idle character that wakes a receiver does not set the receiver idle bit, IDLE,  
or the receive data register full flag, RDRF. It therefore will not generate an interrupt when this idle  
character occurs. The receiver will wake up and wait for the next data transmission which will set RDRF  
and generate an interrupt if enabled.  
The idle-line type (ILT) control bit selects one of two ways to detect an idle line. When ILT = 0, the idle  
bit counter starts after the start bit so the stop bit and any logic 1s at the end of a character count toward  
the full character time of idle. When ILT = 1, the idle bit counter does not start until after a stop bit time,  
so the idle detection is not affected by the data in the last character of the previous message.  
11.3.3.2.2  
Address-Mark Wakeup  
When WAKE = 1, the receiver is configured for address-mark wakeup. In this mode, RWU is cleared  
automatically when the receiver detects a logic 1 in the most significant bit of a received character (eighth  
bit in M = 0 mode and ninth bit in M = 1 mode).  
Address-mark wakeup allows messages to contain idle characters but requires that the MSB be reserved  
for use in address frames. The logic 1 MSB of an address frame clears the receivers RWU bit before the  
stop bit is received and sets the RDRF flag.  
11.3.4 Interrupts and Status Flags  
The SCI system has three separate interrupt vectors to reduce the amount of software needed to isolate the  
cause of the interrupt. One interrupt vector is associated with the transmitter for TDRE and TC events.  
Another interrupt vector is associated with the receiver for RDRF and IDLE events, and a third vector is  
used for OR, NF, FE, and PF error conditions. Each of these eight interrupt sources can be separately  
masked by local interrupt enable masks. The flags can still be polled by software when the local masks are  
cleared to disable generation of hardware interrupt requests.  
The SCI transmitter has two status flags that optionally can generate hardware interrupt requests. Transmit  
data register empty (TDRE) indicates when there is room in the transmit data buffer to write another  
transmit character to SCIxD. If the transmit interrupt enable (TIE) bit is set, a hardware interrupt will be  
requested whenever TDRE = 1. Transmit complete (TC) indicates that the transmitter is finished  
transmitting all data, preamble, and break characters and is idle with TxD high. This flag is often used in  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
196  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
systems with modems to determine when it is safe to turn off the modem. If the transmit complete interrupt  
enable (TCIE) bit is set, a hardware interrupt will be requested whenever TC = 1. Instead of hardware  
interrupts, software polling may be used to monitor the TDRE and TC status flags if the corresponding TIE  
or TCIE local interrupt masks are 0s.  
When a program detects that the receive data register is full (RDRF = 1), it gets the data from the receive  
data register by reading SCIxD. The RDRF flag is cleared by reading SCIxS1 while RDRF = 1 and then  
reading SCIxD. If the SCI is configured to operate in 9-bit mode, an additional read to the SCIxC3 register  
is required to clear RDRF  
When polling is used, this sequence is naturally satisfied in the normal course of the user program. If  
hardware interrupts are used, SCIxS1 must be read in the interrupt service routine (ISR). Normally, this is  
done in the ISR anyway to check for receive errors, so the sequence is automatically satisfied.  
The IDLE status flag includes logic that prevents it from getting set repeatedly when the RxD line remains  
idle for an extended period of time. IDLE is cleared by reading SCIxS1 while IDLE = 1 and then reading  
SCIxD. After IDLE has been cleared, it cannot become set again until the receiver has received at least one  
new character and has set RDRF.  
If the associated error was detected in the received character that caused RDRF to be set, the error flags —  
noise flag (NF), framing error (FE), and parity error flag (PF) — get set at the same time as RDRF. These  
flags are not set in overrun cases.  
If RDRF was already set when a new character is ready to be transferred from the receive shifter to the  
receive data buffer, the overrun (OR) flag gets set instead and the data and any associated NF, FE, or PF  
condition is lost.  
11.3.5 Additional SCI Functions  
The following sections describe additional SCI functions.  
11.3.5.1 8- and 9-Bit Data Modes  
The SCI system (transmitter and receiver) can be configured to operate in 9-bit data mode by setting the  
M control bit in SCIxC1. In 9-bit mode, there is a ninth data bit to the left of the MSB of the SCI data  
register. For the transmit data buffer, this bit is stored in T8 in SCIxC3. For the receiver, the ninth bit is  
held in R8 in SCIxC3.  
When transmitting 9-bit data, write to the T8 bit before writing to SCIxD for coherent writes to the transmit  
data buffer. If the bit value to be transmitted as the ninth bit of a new character is the same as for the  
previous character, it is not necessary to write to T8 again. When data is transferred from the transmit data  
buffer to the transmit shifter, the value in T8 is copied at the same time data is transferred from SCIxD to  
the shifter.  
When receiving 9-bit data, clear the RDRF bit by reading both R8 and SCIxD. R8 and SCIxD can be read  
in either order.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
197  
Chapter 11 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV2)  
9-bit data mode typically is used in conjunction with parity to allow eight bits of data plus the parity in the  
ninth bit. Or it is used with address-mark wakeup so the ninth data bit can serve as the wakeup bit. In  
custom protocols, the ninth bit can also serve as a software-controlled marker.  
11.3.5.2 Stop Mode Operation  
During all stop modes, clocks to the SCI module are halted.  
In stop1 and stop2 modes, all SCI register data is lost and must be re-initialized upon recovery from these  
two stop modes.  
No SCI module registers are affected in stop3 mode.  
Note, because the clocks are halted, the SCI module will resume operation upon exit from stop (only in  
stop3 mode). Software should ensure stop mode is not entered while there is a character being transmitted  
out of or received into the SCI module.  
11.3.5.3 Loop Mode  
When LOOPS = 1, the RSRC bit in the same register chooses between loop mode (RSRC = 0) or  
single-wire mode (RSRC = 1). Loop mode is sometimes used to check software, independent of  
connections in the external system, to help isolate system problems. In this mode, the transmitter output is  
internally connected to the receiver input and the RxD pin is not used by the SCI, so it reverts to a  
general-purpose port I/O pin.  
11.3.5.4 Single-Wire Mode  
When LOOPS = 1, the RSRC bit in the same register chooses between loop mode (RSRC = 0) or  
single-wire mode (RSRC = 1). Single-wire mode is used to implement a half-duplex serial connection.  
The receiver is internally connected to the transmitter output and to the TxD pin. The RxD pin is not used  
and reverts to a general-purpose port I/O pin.  
In single-wire mode, the TXDIR bit in SCIxC3 controls the direction of serial data on the TxD pin. When  
TXDIR = 0, the TxD pin is an input to the SCI receiver and the transmitter is temporarily disconnected  
from the TxD pin so an external device can send serial data to the receiver. When TXDIR = 1, the TxD pin  
is an output driven by the transmitter.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
198  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 12  
Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
The MC9S08AW60 Series has one serial peripheral interface (SPI) module. The four pins associated with  
SPI functionality are shared with port E pins 4–7. See Appendix A, “Electrical Characteristics and Timing  
Specifications,” for SPI electrical parametric information.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
199  
SPIChapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
HCS08 CORE  
DEBUG  
MODULE (DBG)  
8
PTA7– PTA0  
BKGD/MS  
BDC  
CPU  
8
PTB7/AD1P7–  
PTB0/AD1P0  
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL  
RESET  
IRQ  
PTC6  
RESETS AND INTERRUPTS  
MODES OF OPERATION  
POWER MANAGEMENT  
RxD2  
TxD2  
PTC5/RxD2  
PTC4  
PTC3/TxD2  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI2)  
PTC2/MCLK  
PTC1/SDA1  
SDA1  
SCL1  
RTI  
COP  
LVD  
IIC MODULE (IIC1)  
PTC0/SCL1  
IRQ  
AD1P7–AD1P0  
8
V
DDAD  
8
10-BIT  
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL  
CONVERTER (ADC1)  
AD1P15–AD1P8  
V
SSAD  
V
REFL  
PTD7/AD1P15/KBI1P7  
PTD6/AD1P14/TPM1CLK  
PTD5/AD1P13  
PTD4/AD1P12/TPM2CLK  
PTD3/AD1P11/KBI1P6  
PTD2/AD1P10/KBI1P5  
PTD1/AD1P9  
V
REFH  
USER FLASH  
(AW60 = 63,280 BYTES)  
(AW48 = 49,152 BYTES)  
(AW32 = 32,768 BYTES)  
(AW16 = 16,384 BYTES)  
PTD0/AD1P8  
SPSCK1  
PTE7/SPSCK1  
PTE6/MOSI1  
MOSI1  
SERIAL PERIPHERAL  
INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1)  
USER RAM  
MISO1  
SS1  
PTE5/MISO1  
PTE4/SS1  
AW60/48/32 = 2048 BYTES  
AW16 = 1024 BYTES  
TPM1CLK  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM1)  
TPM1CH5–  
TPM1CH0  
INTERNAL CLOCK  
GENERATOR (ICG)  
6
RxD1  
TxD1  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTF7  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI1)  
LOW-POWER OSCILLATOR  
PTF6  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
TPM2CLK  
V
DD  
VOLTAGE  
REGULATOR  
2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM2)  
TPM2CH1–TPM2CH0  
V
SS  
2
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
KBI1P7–KBI1P5  
3
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
8-BIT KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI1)  
KBI1P4–KBI1P0  
5
EXTAL  
XTAL  
PTG6/EXTAL  
PTG5/XTAL  
NOTES:  
PTG4/KBI1P4  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
PTG2/KBI1P2  
PTG1/KBI1P1  
PTG0/KBI1P0  
1. Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port.  
2. Pin contains software configurable pullup/pulldown device if IRQ is enabled  
(IRQPE = 1). Pulldown is enabled if rising edge detect is selected (IRQEDG = 1)  
3. IRQ does not have a clamp diode to VDD. IRQ should not be driven above VDD  
4. Pin contains integrated pullup device.  
.
5. Pins PTD7, PTD3, PTD2, and PTG4 contain both pullup and pulldown devices.  
Pulldown enabled when KBI is enabled (KBIPEn = 1) and rising edge is selected  
(KBEDGn = 1).  
Figure 12-1. Block Diagram Highlighting the SPI Module  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
200  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
12.0.1 Features  
Features of the SPI module include:  
Master or slave mode operation  
Full-duplex or single-wire bidirectional option  
Programmable transmit bit rate  
Double-buffered transmit and receive  
Serial clock phase and polarity options  
Slave select output  
Selectable MSB-first or LSB-first shifting  
12.0.2 Block Diagrams  
This section includes block diagrams showing SPI system connections, the internal organization of the SPI  
module, and the SPI clock dividers that control the master mode bit rate.  
12.0.2.1 SPI System Block Diagram  
Figure 12-2 shows the SPI modules of two MCUs connected in a master-slave arrangement. The master  
device initiates all SPI data transfers. During a transfer, the master shifts data out (on the MOSI pin) to the  
slave while simultaneously shifting data in (on the MISO pin) from the slave. The transfer effectively  
exchanges the data that was in the SPI shift registers of the two SPI systems. The SPSCK signal is a clock  
output from the master and an input to the slave. The slave device must be selected by a low level on the  
slave select input (SS pin). In this system, the master device has configured its SS pin as an optional slave  
select output.  
SLAVE  
MASTER  
MOSI  
MISO  
MOSI  
MISO  
SPI SHIFTER  
SPI SHIFTER  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SPSCK  
SS  
SPSCK  
SS  
CLOCK  
GENERATOR  
Figure 12-2. SPI System Connections  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
201  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
The most common uses of the SPI system include connecting simple shift registers for adding input or  
output ports or connecting small peripheral devices such as serial A/D or D/A converters. Although  
Figure 12-2 shows a system where data is exchanged between two MCUs, many practical systems involve  
simpler connections where data is unidirectionally transferred from the master MCU to a slave or from a  
slave to the master MCU.  
12.0.2.2 SPI Module Block Diagram  
Figure 12-3 is a block diagram of the SPI module. The central element of the SPI is the SPI shift register.  
Data is written to the double-buffered transmitter (write to SPI1D) and gets transferred to the SPI shift  
register at the start of a data transfer. After shifting in a byte of data, the data is transferred into the  
double-buffered receiver where it can be read (read from SPI1D). Pin multiplexing logic controls  
connections between MCU pins and the SPI module.  
When the SPI is configured as a master, the clock output is routed to the SPSCK pin, the shifter output is  
routed to MOSI, and the shifter input is routed from the MISO pin.  
When the SPI is configured as a slave, the SPSCK pin is routed to the clock input of the SPI, the shifter  
output is routed to MISO, and the shifter input is routed from the MOSI pin.  
In the external SPI system, simply connect all SPSCK pins to each other, all MISO pins together, and all  
MOSI pins together. Peripheral devices often use slightly different names for these pins.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
202  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
PIN CONTROL  
M
MOSI  
SPE  
S
(MOMI)  
Tx BUFFER (WRITE SPI1D)  
ENABLE  
M
S
MISO  
SPI SYSTEM  
(SISO)  
SHIFT  
OUT  
SHIFT  
IN  
SPI SHIFT REGISTER  
SPC0  
Rx BUFFER (READ SPI1D)  
BIDIROE  
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
Rx BUFFER  
FULL  
Tx BUFFER  
EMPTY  
LSBFE  
DIRECTION  
CLOCK  
MASTER CLOCK  
SLAVE CLOCK  
M
S
BUS RATE  
CLOCK  
CLOCK  
LOGIC  
SPIBR  
SPSCK  
CLOCK GENERATOR  
MASTER/SLAVE  
MODE SELECT  
MASTER/  
SLAVE  
MSTR  
MODFEN  
SSOE  
MODE FAULT  
DETECTION  
SS  
SPTEF  
SPTIE  
SPRF  
SPI  
INTERRUPT  
REQUEST  
MODF  
SPIE  
Figure 12-3. SPI Module Block Diagram  
12.0.3 SPI Baud Rate Generation  
As shown in Figure 12-4, the clock source for the SPI baud rate generator is the bus clock. The three  
prescale bits (SPPR2:SPPR1:SPPR0) choose a prescale divisor of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8. The three rate  
select bits (SPR2:SPR1:SPR0) divide the output of the prescaler stage by 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, or 256  
to get the internal SPI master mode bit-rate clock.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
203  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
PRESCALER  
CLOCK RATE DIVIDER  
MASTER  
SPI  
BIT RATE  
DIVIDE BY  
DIVIDE BY  
BUS CLOCK  
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8  
2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, or 256  
SPPR2:SPPR1:SPPR0  
SPR2:SPR1:SPR0  
Figure 12-4. SPI Baud Rate Generation  
12.1 External Signal Description  
The SPI optionally shares four port pins. The function of these pins depends on the settings of SPI control  
bits. When the SPI is disabled (SPE = 0), these four pins revert to being general-purpose port I/O pins that  
are not controlled by the SPI.  
12.1.1 SPSCK — SPI Serial Clock  
When the SPI is enabled as a slave, this pin is the serial clock input. When the SPI is enabled as a master,  
this pin is the serial clock output.  
12.1.2 MOSI — Master Data Out, Slave Data In  
When the SPI is enabled as a master and SPI pin control zero (SPC0) is 0 (not bidirectional mode), this  
pin is the serial data output. When the SPI is enabled as a slave and SPC0 = 0, this pin is the serial data  
input. If SPC0 = 1 to select single-wire bidirectional mode, and master mode is selected, this pin becomes  
the bidirectional data I/O pin (MOMI). Also, the bidirectional mode output enable bit determines whether  
the pin acts as an input (BIDIROE = 0) or an output (BIDIROE = 1). If SPC0 = 1 and slave mode is  
selected, this pin is not used by the SPI and reverts to being a general-purpose port I/O pin.  
12.1.3 MISO — Master Data In, Slave Data Out  
When the SPI is enabled as a master and SPI pin control zero (SPC0) is 0 (not bidirectional mode), this  
pin is the serial data input. When the SPI is enabled as a slave and SPC0 = 0, this pin is the serial data  
output. If SPC0 = 1 to select single-wire bidirectional mode, and slave mode is selected, this pin becomes  
the bidirectional data I/O pin (SISO) and the bidirectional mode output enable bit determines whether the  
pin acts as an input (BIDIROE = 0) or an output (BIDIROE = 1). If SPC0 = 1 and master mode is selected,  
this pin is not used by the SPI and reverts to being a general-purpose port I/O pin.  
12.1.4 SS — Slave Select  
When the SPI is enabled as a slave, this pin is the low-true slave select input. When the SPI is enabled as  
a master and mode fault enable is off (MODFEN = 0), this pin is not used by the SPI and reverts to being  
a general-purpose port I/O pin. When the SPI is enabled as a master and MODFEN = 1, the slave select  
output enable bit determines whether this pin acts as the mode fault input (SSOE = 0) or as the slave select  
output (SSOE = 1).  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
204  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
12.2 Modes of Operation  
12.2.1 SPI in Stop Modes  
The SPI is disabled in all stop modes, regardless of the settings before executing the STOP instruction.  
During either stop1 or stop2 mode, the SPI module will be fully powered down. Upon wake-up from stop1  
or stop2 mode, the SPI module will be in the reset state. During stop3 mode, clocks to the SPI module are  
halted. No registers are affected. If stop3 is exited with a reset, the SPI will be put into its reset state. If  
stop3 is exited with an interrupt, the SPI continues from the state it was in when stop3 was entered.  
12.3 Register Definition  
The SPI has five 8-bit registers to select SPI options, control baud rate, report SPI status, and for  
transmit/receive data.  
Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter of this data sheet for the absolute address  
assignments for all SPI registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names, and  
a Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute  
addresses.  
12.3.1 SPI Control Register 1 (SPI1C1)  
This read/write register includes the SPI enable control, interrupt enables, and configuration options.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
SPIE  
SPE  
SPTIE  
MSTR  
CPOL  
CPHA  
SSOE  
LSBFE  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Figure 12-5. SPI Control Register 1 (SPI1C1)  
Table 12-1. SPI1C1 Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
SPI Interrupt Enable (for SPRF and MODF) — This is the interrupt enable for SPI receive buffer full (SPRF)  
and mode fault (MODF) events.  
SPIE  
0 Interrupts from SPRF and MODF inhibited (use polling)  
1 When SPRF or MODF is 1, request a hardware interrupt  
6
SPI System Enable — Disabling the SPI halts any transfer that is in progress, clears data buffers, and initializes  
SPE  
internal state machines. SPRF is cleared and SPTEF is set to indicate the SPI transmit data buffer is empty.  
0 SPI system inactive  
1 SPI system enabled  
5
SPI Transmit Interrupt Enable — This is the interrupt enable bit for SPI transmit buffer empty (SPTEF).  
0 Interrupts from SPTEF inhibited (use polling)  
SPTIE  
1 When SPTEF is 1, hardware interrupt requested  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
205  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
Table 12-1. SPI1C1 Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
4
Master/Slave Mode Select  
MSTR  
0 SPI module configured as a slave SPI device  
1 SPI module configured as a master SPI device  
3
Clock Polarity — This bit effectively places an inverter in series with the clock signal from a master SPI or to a  
slave SPI device. Refer to Section 12.4.1, “SPI Clock Formatsfor more details.  
0 Active-high SPI clock (idles low)  
CPOL  
1 Active-low SPI clock (idles high)  
2
Clock Phase — This bit selects one of two clock formats for different kinds of synchronous serial peripheral  
devices. Refer to Section 12.4.1, “SPI Clock Formatsfor more details.  
CPHA  
0 First edge on SPSCK occurs at the middle of the first cycle of an 8-cycle data transfer  
1 First edge on SPSCK occurs at the start of the first cycle of an 8-cycle data transfer  
1
Slave Select Output Enable — This bit is used in combination with the mode fault enable (MODFEN) bit in  
SSOE  
SPCR2 and the master/slave (MSTR) control bit to determine the function of the SS pin as shown in Table 12-2.  
0
LSB First (Shifter Direction)  
LSBFE  
0 SPI serial data transfers start with most significant bit  
1 SPI serial data transfers start with least significant bit  
Table 12-2. SS Pin Function  
MODFEN  
SSOE  
Master Mode  
Slave Mode  
Slave select input  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
General-purpose I/O (not SPI)  
General-purpose I/O (not SPI)  
SS input for mode fault  
Slave select input  
Slave select input  
Slave select input  
Automatic SS output  
NOTE  
Ensure that the SPI should not be disabled (SPE=0) at the same time as a bit change to the CPHA bit. These  
changes should be performed as separate operations or unexpected behavior may occur.  
12.3.2 SPI Control Register 2 (SPI1C2)  
This read/write register is used to control optional features of the SPI system. Bits 7, 6, 5, and 2 are not  
implemented and always read 0.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
MODFEN  
BIDIROE  
SPISWAI  
SPC0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 12-6. SPI Control Register 2 (SPI1C2)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
206  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
Table 12-3. SPI1C2 Register Field Descriptions  
Field  
Description  
4
Master Mode-Fault Function Enable — When the SPI is configured for slave mode, this bit has no meaning or  
MODFEN effect. (The SS pin is the slave select input.) In master mode, this bit determines how the SS pin is used (refer  
to Table 12-2 for more details).  
0 Mode fault function disabled, master SS pin reverts to general-purpose I/O not controlled by SPI  
1 Mode fault function enabled, master SS pin acts as the mode fault input or the slave select output  
3
Bidirectional Mode Output Enable — When bidirectional mode is enabled by SPI pin control 0 (SPC0) = 1,  
BIDIROE BIDIROE determines whether the SPI data output driver is enabled to the single bidirectional SPI I/O pin.  
Depending on whether the SPI is configured as a master or a slave, it uses either the MOSI (MOMI) or MISO  
(SISO) pin, respectively, as the single SPI data I/O pin. When SPC0 = 0, BIDIROE has no meaning or effect.  
0 Output driver disabled so SPI data I/O pin acts as an input  
1 SPI I/O pin enabled as an output  
1
SPI Stop in Wait Mode  
SPISWAI 0 SPI clocks continue to operate in wait mode  
1 SPI clocks stop when the MCU enters wait mode  
0
SPI Pin Control 0 — The SPC0 bit chooses single-wire bidirectional mode. If MSTR = 0 (slave mode), the SPI  
uses the MISO (SISO) pin for bidirectional SPI data transfers. If MSTR = 1 (master mode), the SPI uses the  
MOSI (MOMI) pin for bidirectional SPI data transfers. When SPC0 = 1, BIDIROE is used to enable or disable the  
output driver for the single bidirectional SPI I/O pin.  
SPC0  
0 SPI uses separate pins for data input and data output  
1 SPI configured for single-wire bidirectional operation  
12.3.3 SPI Baud Rate Register (SPI1BR)  
This register is used to set the prescaler and bit rate divisor for an SPI master. This register may be read or  
written at any time.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
SPPR2  
SPPR1  
SPPR0  
SPR2  
SPR1  
SPR0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 12-7. SPI Baud Rate Register (SPI1BR)  
Table 12-4. SPI1BR Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
6:4  
SPI Baud Rate Prescale Divisor — This 3-bit field selects one of eight divisors for the SPI baud rate prescaler  
SPPR[2:0] as shown in Table 12-5. The input to this prescaler is the bus rate clock (BUSCLK). The output of this prescaler  
drives the input of the SPI baud rate divider (see Figure 12-4).  
2:0  
SPR[2:0]  
SPI Baud Rate Divisor — This 3-bit field selects one of eight divisors for the SPI baud rate divider as shown in  
Table 12-6. The input to this divider comes from the SPI baud rate prescaler (see Figure 12-4). The output of this  
divider is the SPI bit rate clock for master mode.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
207  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
Table 12-5. SPI Baud Rate Prescaler Divisor  
SPPR2:SPPR1:SPPR0  
Prescaler Divisor  
0:0:0  
0:0:1  
0:1:0  
0:1:1  
1:0:0  
1:0:1  
1:1:0  
1:1:1  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Table 12-6. SPI Baud Rate Divisor  
SPR2:SPR1:SPR0  
0:0:0  
Rate Divisor  
2
0:0:1  
0:1:0  
0:1:1  
1:0:0  
1:0:1  
1:1:0  
1:1:1  
4
8
16  
32  
64  
128  
256  
12.3.4 SPI Status Register (SPI1S)  
This register has three read-only status bits. Bits 6, 3, 2, 1, and 0 are not implemented and always read 0.  
Writes have no meaning or effect.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
SPRF  
0
SPTEF  
MODF  
0
0
0
0
Reset  
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 12-8. SPI Status Register (SPI1S)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
208  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
Table 12-7. SPI1S Register Field Descriptions  
Field  
Description  
7
SPI Read Buffer Full Flag — SPRF is set at the completion of an SPI transfer to indicate that received data may  
be read from the SPI data register (SPI1D). SPRF is cleared by reading SPRF while it is set, then reading the  
SPI data register.  
SPRF  
0 No data available in the receive data buffer  
1 Data available in the receive data buffer  
5
SPI Transmit Buffer Empty Flag — This bit is set when there is room in the transmit data buffer. It is cleared by  
reading SPI1S with SPTEF set, followed by writing a data value to the transmit buffer at SPI1D. SPI1S must be  
read with SPTEF = 1 before writing data to SPI1D or the SPI1D write will be ignored. SPTEF generates an  
SPTEF CPU interrupt request if the SPTIE bit in the SPI1C1 is also set. SPTEF is automatically set when a data  
byte transfers from the transmit buffer into the transmit shift register. For an idle SPI (no data in the transmit buffer  
or the shift register and no transfer in progress), data written to SPI1D is transferred to the shifter almost  
immediately so SPTEF is set within two bus cycles allowing a second 8-bit data value to be queued into the  
transmit buffer. After completion of the transfer of the value in the shift register, the queued value from the  
transmit buffer will automatically move to the shifter and SPTEF will be set to indicate there is room for new data  
in the transmit buffer. If no new data is waiting in the transmit buffer, SPTEF simply remains set and no data  
moves from the buffer to the shifter.  
SPTEF  
0 SPI transmit buffer not empty  
1 SPI transmit buffer empty  
4
Master Mode Fault Flag — MODF is set if the SPI is configured as a master and the slave select input goes  
low, indicating some other SPI device is also configured as a master. The SS pin acts as a mode fault error input  
only when MSTR = 1, MODFEN = 1, and SSOE = 0; otherwise, MODF will never be set. MODF is cleared by  
reading MODF while it is 1, then writing to SPI control register 1 (SPI1C1).  
0 No mode fault error  
MODF  
1 Mode fault error detected  
12.3.5 SPI Data Register (SPI1D)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
Bit 7  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 12-9. SPI Data Register (SPI1D)  
Reads of this register return the data read from the receive data buffer. Writes to this register write data to  
the transmit data buffer. When the SPI is configured as a master, writing data to the transmit data buffer  
initiates an SPI transfer.  
Data should not be written to the transmit data buffer unless the SPI transmit buffer empty flag (SPTEF)  
is set, indicating there is room in the transmit buffer to queue a new transmit byte.  
Data may be read from SPI1D any time after SPRF is set and before another transfer is finished. Failure  
to read the data out of the receive data buffer before a new transfer ends causes a receive overrun condition  
and the data from the new transfer is lost.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
209  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
12.4 Functional Description  
An SPI transfer is initiated by checking for the SPI transmit buffer empty flag (SPTEF = 1) and then  
writing a byte of data to the SPI data register (SPI1D) in the master SPI device. When the SPI shift register  
is available, this byte of data is moved from the transmit data buffer to the shifter, SPTEF is set to indicate  
there is room in the buffer to queue another transmit character if desired, and the SPI serial transfer starts.  
During the SPI transfer, data is sampled (read) on the MISO pin at one SPSCK edge and shifted, changing  
the bit value on the MOSI pin, one-half SPSCK cycle later. After eight SPSCK cycles, the data that was in  
the shift register of the master has been shifted out the MOSI pin to the slave while eight bits of data were  
shifted in the MISO pin into the master’s shift register. At the end of this transfer, the received data byte is  
moved from the shifter into the receive data buffer and SPRF is set to indicate the data can be read by  
reading SPI1D. If another byte of data is waiting in the transmit buffer at the end of a transfer, it is moved  
into the shifter, SPTEF is set, and a new transfer is started.  
Normally, SPI data is transferred most significant bit (MSB) first. If the least significant bit first enable  
(LSBFE) bit is set, SPI data is shifted LSB first.  
When the SPI is configured as a slave, its SS pin must be driven low before a transfer starts and SS must  
stay low throughout the transfer. If a clock format where CPHA = 0 is selected, SS must be driven to a  
logic 1 between successive transfers. If CPHA = 1, SS may remain low between successive transfers. See  
Section 12.4.1, “SPI Clock Formats” for more details.  
Because the transmitter and receiver are double buffered, a second byte, in addition to the byte currently  
being shifted out, can be queued into the transmit data buffer, and a previously received character can be  
in the receive data buffer while a new character is being shifted in. The SPTEF flag indicates when the  
transmit buffer has room for a new character. The SPRF flag indicates when a received character is  
available in the receive data buffer. The received character must be read out of the receive buffer (read  
SPI1D) before the next transfer is finished or a receive overrun error results.  
In the case of a receive overrun, the new data is lost because the receive buffer still held the previous  
character and was not ready to accept the new data. There is no indication for such an overrun condition  
so the application system designer must ensure that previous data has been read from the receive buffer  
before a new transfer is initiated.  
12.4.1 SPI Clock Formats  
To accommodate a wide variety of synchronous serial peripherals from different manufacturers, the SPI  
system has a clock polarity (CPOL) bit and a clock phase (CPHA) control bit to select one of four clock  
formats for data transfers. CPOL selectively inserts an inverter in series with the clock. CPHA chooses  
between two different clock phase relationships between the clock and data.  
Figure 12-10 shows the clock formats when CPHA = 1. At the top of the figure, the eight bit times are  
shown for reference with bit 1 starting at the first SPSCK edge and bit 8 ending one-half SPSCK cycle after  
the sixteenth SPSCK edge. The MSB first and LSB first lines show the order of SPI data bits depending  
on the setting in LSBFE. Both variations of SPSCK polarity are shown, but only one of these waveforms  
applies for a specific transfer, depending on the value in CPOL. The SAMPLE IN waveform applies to the  
MOSI input of a slave or the MISO input of a master. The MOSI waveform applies to the MOSI output  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
210  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
pin from a master and the MISO waveform applies to the MISO output from a slave. The SS OUT  
waveform applies to the slave select output from a master (provided MODFEN and SSOE = 1). The master  
SS output goes to active low one-half SPSCK cycle before the start of the transfer and goes back high at  
the end of the eighth bit time of the transfer. The SS IN waveform applies to the slave select input of a  
slave.  
BIT TIME #  
(REFERENCE)  
1
2
...  
6
7
8
SPSCK  
(CPOL = 0)  
SPSCK  
(CPOL = 1)  
SAMPLE IN  
(MISO OR MOSI)  
MOSI  
(MASTER OUT)  
MSB FIRST  
LSB FIRST  
BIT 7  
BIT 0  
BIT 6  
BIT 1  
...  
...  
BIT 2  
BIT 5  
BIT 1  
BIT 6  
BIT 0  
BIT 7  
MISO  
(SLAVE OUT)  
SS OUT  
(MASTER)  
SS IN  
(SLAVE)  
Figure 12-10. SPI Clock Formats (CPHA = 1)  
When CPHA = 1, the slave begins to drive its MISO output when SS goes to active low, but the data is not  
defined until the first SPSCK edge. The first SPSCK edge shifts the first bit of data from the shifter onto  
the MOSI output of the master and the MISO output of the slave. The next SPSCK edge causes both the  
master and the slave to sample the data bit values on their MISO and MOSI inputs, respectively. At the  
third SPSCK edge, the SPI shifter shifts one bit position which shifts in the bit value that was just sampled,  
and shifts the second data bit value out the other end of the shifter to the MOSI and MISO outputs of the  
master and slave, respectively. When CHPA = 1, the slave’s SS input is not required to go to its inactive  
high level between transfers.  
Figure 12-11 shows the clock formats when CPHA = 0. At the top of the figure, the eight bit times are  
shown for reference with bit 1 starting as the slave is selected (SS IN goes low), and bit 8 ends at the last  
SPSCK edge. The MSB first and LSB first lines show the order of SPI data bits depending on the setting  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
211  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
in LSBFE. Both variations of SPSCK polarity are shown, but only one of these waveforms applies for a  
specific transfer, depending on the value in CPOL. The SAMPLE IN waveform applies to the MOSI input  
of a slave or the MISO input of a master. The MOSI waveform applies to the MOSI output pin from a  
master and the MISO waveform applies to the MISO output from a slave. The SS OUT waveform applies  
to the slave select output from a master (provided MODFEN and SSOE = 1). The master SS output goes  
to active low at the start of the first bit time of the transfer and goes back high one-half SPSCK cycle after  
the end of the eighth bit time of the transfer. The SS IN waveform applies to the slave select input of a  
slave.  
BIT TIME #  
(REFERENCE)  
1
2
...  
6
7
8
SPSCK  
(CPOL = 0)  
SPSCK  
(CPOL = 1)  
SAMPLE IN  
(MISO OR MOSI)  
MOSI  
(MASTER OUT)  
MSB FIRST  
LSB FIRST  
BIT 7  
BIT 0  
BIT 6  
BIT 1  
...  
...  
BIT 2  
BIT 5  
BIT 1  
BIT 6  
BIT 0  
BIT 7  
MISO  
(SLAVE OUT)  
SS OUT  
(MASTER)  
SS IN  
(SLAVE)  
Figure 12-11. SPI Clock Formats (CPHA = 0)  
When CPHA = 0, the slave begins to drive its MISO output with the first data bit value (MSB or LSB  
depending on LSBFE) when SS goes to active low. The first SPSCK edge causes both the master and the  
slave to sample the data bit values on their MISO and MOSI inputs, respectively. At the second SPSCK  
edge, the SPI shifter shifts one bit position which shifts in the bit value that was just sampled and shifts the  
second data bit value out the other end of the shifter to the MOSI and MISO outputs of the master and  
slave, respectively. When CPHA = 0, the slave’s SS input must go to its inactive high level between  
transfers.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
212  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
12.4.2 SPI Interrupts  
There are three flag bits, two interrupt mask bits, and one interrupt vector associated with the SPI system.  
The SPI interrupt enable mask (SPIE) enables interrupts from the SPI receiver full flag (SPRF) and mode  
fault flag (MODF). The SPI transmit interrupt enable mask (SPTIE) enables interrupts from the SPI  
transmit buffer empty flag (SPTEF). When one of the flag bits is set, and the associated interrupt mask bit  
is set, a hardware interrupt request is sent to the CPU. If the interrupt mask bits are cleared, software can  
poll the associated flag bits instead of using interrupts. The SPI interrupt service routine (ISR) should  
check the flag bits to determine what event caused the interrupt. The service routine should also clear the  
flag bit(s) before returning from the ISR (usually near the beginning of the ISR).  
12.4.3 Mode Fault Detection  
A mode fault occurs and the mode fault flag (MODF) becomes set when a master SPI device detects an  
error on the SS pin (provided the SS pin is configured as the mode fault input signal). The SS pin is  
configured to be the mode fault input signal when MSTR = 1, mode fault enable is set (MODFEN = 1),  
and slave select output enable is clear (SSOE = 0).  
The mode fault detection feature can be used in a system where more than one SPI device might become  
a master at the same time. The error is detected when a master’s SS pin is low, indicating that some other  
SPI device is trying to address this master as if it were a slave. This could indicate a harmful output driver  
conflict, so the mode fault logic is designed to disable all SPI output drivers when such an error is detected.  
When a mode fault is detected, MODF is set and MSTR is cleared to change the SPI configuration back  
to slave mode. The output drivers on the SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO (if not bidirectional mode) are  
disabled.  
MODF is cleared by reading it while it is set, then writing to the SPI control register 1 (SPI1C1). User  
software should verify the error condition has been corrected before changing the SPI back to master  
mode.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
213  
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
214  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 13  
Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.1 Introduction  
The MC9S08AW60 Series of microcontrollers has an inter-integrated circuit (IIC) module for  
communication with other integrated circuits. The two pins associated with this module, SCL and SDA,  
are open-drain outputs and are shared with port C pins 0 and 1, respectively.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
215  
IICChapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
HCS08 CORE  
DEBUG  
MODULE (DBG)  
8
PTA7– PTA0  
BKGD/MS  
BDC  
CPU  
8
PTB7/AD1P7–  
PTB0/AD1P0  
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL  
RESET  
IRQ  
PTC6  
RESETS AND INTERRUPTS  
MODES OF OPERATION  
POWER MANAGEMENT  
RxD2  
TxD2  
PTC5/RxD2  
PTC4  
PTC3/TxD2  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI2)  
PTC2/MCLK  
PTC1/SDA1  
SDA1  
SCL1  
RTI  
COP  
LVD  
IIC MODULE (IIC1)  
PTC0/SCL1  
IRQ  
AD1P7–AD1P0  
8
V
DDAD  
8
10-BIT  
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL  
CONVERTER (ADC1)  
AD1P15–AD1P8  
V
SSAD  
V
REFL  
PTD7/AD1P15/KBI1P7  
PTD6/AD1P14/TPM1CLK  
PTD5/AD1P13  
PTD4/AD1P12/TPM2CLK  
PTD3/AD1P11/KBI1P6  
PTD2/AD1P10/KBI1P5  
PTD1/AD1P9  
V
REFH  
USER FLASH  
(AW60 = 63,280 BYTES)  
(AW48 = 49,152 BYTES)  
(AW32 = 32,768 BYTES)  
(AW16 = 16,384 BYTES)  
PTD0/AD1P8  
SPSCK1  
PTE7/SPSCK1  
PTE6/MOSI1  
MOSI1  
SERIAL PERIPHERAL  
USER RAM  
MISO1  
SS1  
INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1)  
PTE5/MISO1  
PTE4/SS1  
AW60/48/32 = 2048 BYTES  
AW16 = 1024 BYTES  
TPM1CLK  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM1)  
TPM1CH5–  
TPM1CH0  
INTERNAL CLOCK  
GENERATOR (ICG)  
6
RxD1  
TxD1  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTF7  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI1)  
LOW-POWER OSCILLATOR  
PTF6  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
TPM2CLK  
V
DD  
VOLTAGE  
REGULATOR  
2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM2)  
TPM2CH1–TPM2CH0  
V
SS  
2
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
KBI1P7–KBI1P5  
3
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
8-BIT KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI1)  
KBI1P4–KBI1P0  
5
EXTAL  
XTAL  
PTG6/EXTAL  
PTG5/XTAL  
NOTES:  
PTG4/KBI1P4  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
PTG2/KBI1P2  
PTG1/KBI1P1  
PTG0/KBI1P0  
1. Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port.  
2. Pin contains software configurable pullup/pulldown device if IRQ is enabled  
(IRQPE = 1). Pulldown is enabled if rising edge detect is selected (IRQEDG = 1)  
3. IRQ does not have a clamp diode to VDD. IRQ should not be driven above VDD  
4. Pin contains integrated pullup device.  
.
5. Pins PTD7, PTD3, PTD2, and PTG4 contain both pullup and pulldown devices.  
Pulldown enabled when KBI is enabled (KBIPEn = 1) and rising edge is selected  
(KBEDGn = 1).  
Figure 13-1. Block Diagram Highlighting the IIC Module  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
216  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.1.1 Features  
The IIC includes these distinctive features:  
Compatible with IIC bus standard  
Multi-master operation  
Software programmable for one of 64 different serial clock frequencies  
Software selectable acknowledge bit  
Interrupt driven byte-by-byte data transfer  
Arbitration lost interrupt with automatic mode switching from master to slave  
Calling address identification interrupt  
START and STOP signal generation/detection  
Repeated START signal generation  
Acknowledge bit generation/detection  
Bus busy detection  
13.1.2 Modes of Operation  
The IIC functions the same in normal and monitor modes. A brief description of the IIC in the various  
MCU modes is given here.  
Run mode — This is the basic mode of operation. To conserve power in this mode, disable the  
module.  
Wait mode — The module will continue to operate while the MCU is in wait mode and can provide  
a wake-up interrupt.  
Stop mode — The IIC is inactive in stop3 mode for reduced power consumption. The STOP  
instruction does not affect IIC register states. Stop2 will reset the register contents.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
217  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.1.3 Block Diagram  
Figure 13-2 is a block diagram of the IIC.  
ADDRESS  
DATA BUS  
DATA_MUX  
INTERRUPT  
ADDR_DECODE  
CTRL_REG  
FREQ_REG  
ADDR_REG  
STATUS_REG  
DATA_REG  
INPUT  
SYNC  
IN/OUT  
DATA  
START  
STOP  
SHIFT  
ARBITRATION  
CONTROL  
REGISTER  
CLOCK  
ADDRESS  
COMPARE  
CONTROL  
SDA  
SCL  
Figure 13-2. IIC Functional Block Diagram  
13.2 External Signal Description  
This section describes each user-accessible pin signal.  
13.2.1 SCL — Serial Clock Line  
The bidirectional SCL is the serial clock line of the IIC system.  
13.2.2 SDA — Serial Data Line  
The bidirectional SDA is the serial data line of the IIC system.  
13.3 Register Definition  
This section consists of the IIC register descriptions in address order.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
218  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter of this data sheet for the absolute address  
assignments for all IIC registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A  
Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute  
addresses.  
13.3.1 IIC Address Register (IIC1A)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
ADDR  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 13-3. IIC Address Register (IIC1A)  
Table 13-1. IIC1A Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:1  
IIC Address Register — The ADDR contains the specific slave address to be used by the IIC module. This is  
ADDR[7:1] the address the module will respond to when addressed as a slave.  
13.3.2 IIC Frequency Divider Register (IIC1F)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
MULT  
ICR  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 13-4. IIC Frequency Divider Register (IIC1F)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
219  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
Table 13-2. IIC1A Register Field Descriptions  
Field  
Description  
7:6  
IIC Multiplier Factor — The MULT bits define the multiplier factor mul. This factor is used along with the SCL  
MULT  
divider to generate the IIC baud rate. The multiplier factor mul as defined by the MULT bits is provided below.  
00 mul = 01  
01 mul = 02  
10 mul = 04  
11 Reserved  
5:0  
ICR  
IIC Clock Rate — The ICR bits are used to prescale the bus clock for bit rate selection. These bits are used to  
define the SCL divider and the SDA hold value. The SCL divider multiplied by the value provided by the MULT  
register (multiplier factor mul) is used to generate IIC baud rate.  
IIC baud rate = bus speed (Hz)/(mul * SCL divider)  
SDA hold time is the delay from the falling edge of the SCL (IIC clock) to the changing of SDA (IIC data). The  
ICR is used to determine the SDA hold value.  
SDA hold time = bus period (s) * SDA hold value  
Table 13-3 provides the SCL divider and SDA hold values for corresponding values of the ICR. These values can  
be used to set IIC baud rate and SDA hold time. For example:  
Bus speed = 8 MHz  
MULT is set to 01 (mul = 2)  
Desired IIC baud rate = 100 kbps  
IIC baud rate = bus speed (Hz)/(mul * SCL divider)  
100000 = 8000000/(2*SCL divider)  
SCL divider = 40  
Table 13-3 shows that ICR must be set to 0B to provide an SCL divider of 40 and that this will result in an SDA  
hold value of 9.  
SDA hold time = bus period (s) * SDA hold value  
SDA hold time = 1/8000000 * 9 = 1.125 μs  
If the generated SDA hold value is not acceptable, the MULT bits can be used to change the ICR. This will result  
in a different SDA hold value.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
220  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
Table 13-3. IIC Divider and Hold Values  
ICR  
(hex)  
SDA Hold  
Value  
ICR  
(hex)  
SDA Hold  
Value  
SCL Divider  
SCL Divider  
00  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
0A  
0B  
0C  
0D  
0E  
0F  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
1A  
1B  
1C  
1D  
1E  
1F  
20  
22  
7
7
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
2A  
2B  
2C  
2D  
2E  
2F  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
3A  
3B  
3C  
3D  
3E  
3F  
160  
192  
17  
17  
24  
8
224  
33  
26  
8
256  
33  
28  
9
288  
49  
30  
9
320  
49  
34  
10  
10  
7
384  
65  
40  
480  
65  
28  
320  
33  
32  
7
384  
33  
36  
9
448  
65  
40  
9
512  
65  
44  
11  
11  
13  
13  
9
576  
97  
48  
640  
97  
56  
768  
129  
129  
65  
68  
960  
48  
640  
56  
9
768  
65  
64  
13  
13  
17  
17  
21  
21  
9
896  
129  
129  
193  
193  
257  
257  
129  
129  
257  
257  
385  
385  
513  
513  
72  
1024  
1152  
1280  
1536  
1920  
1280  
1536  
1792  
2048  
2304  
2560  
3072  
3840  
80  
88  
104  
128  
80  
96  
9
112  
128  
144  
160  
192  
240  
17  
17  
25  
25  
33  
33  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
221  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.3.3 IIC Control Register (IIC1C)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
IICEN  
IICIE  
MST  
TX  
TXAK  
RSTA  
0
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 13-5. IIC Control Register (IIC1C)  
Table 13-4. IIC1C Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
IIC Enable — The IICEN bit determines whether the IIC module is enabled.  
IICEN  
0 IIC is not enabled.  
1 IIC is enabled.  
6
IICIE  
IIC Interrupt Enable — The IICIE bit determines whether an IIC interrupt is requested.  
0 IIC interrupt request not enabled.  
1 IIC interrupt request enabled.  
5
Master Mode Select — The MST bit is changed from a 0 to a 1 when a START signal is generated on the bus  
MST  
and master mode is selected. When this bit changes from a 1 to a 0 a STOP signal is generated and the mode  
of operation changes from master to slave.  
0 Slave Mode.  
1 Master Mode.  
4
Transmit Mode Select — The TX bit selects the direction of master and slave transfers. In master mode this bit  
TX  
should be set according to the type of transfer required. Therefore, for address cycles, this bit will always be high.  
When addressed as a slave this bit should be set by software according to the SRW bit in the status register.  
0 Receive.  
1 Transmit.  
3
Transmit Acknowledge Enable — This bit specifies the value driven onto the SDA during data acknowledge  
cycles for both master and slave receivers.  
TXAK  
0 An acknowledge signal will be sent out to the bus after receiving one data byte.  
1 No acknowledge signal response is sent.  
2
Repeat START — Writing a one to this bit will generate a repeated START condition provided it is the current  
RSTA  
master. This bit will always be read as a low. Attempting a repeat at the wrong time will result in loss of arbitration.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
222  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.3.4 IIC Status Register (IIC1S)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
TCF  
BUSY  
0
SRW  
RXAK  
IAAS  
ARBL  
IICIF  
Reset  
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 13-6. IIC Status Register (IIC1S)  
Table 13-5. IIC1S Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
TCF  
Transfer Complete Flag — This bit is set on the completion of a byte transfer. Note that this bit is only valid  
during or immediately following a transfer to the IIC module or from the IIC module.The TCF bit is cleared by  
reading the IIC1D register in receive mode or writing to the IIC1D in transmit mode.  
0 Transfer in progress.  
1 Transfer complete.  
6
Addressed as a Slave — The IAAS bit is set when the calling address matches the programmed slave address.  
IAAS  
Writing the IIC1C register clears this bit.  
0 Not addressed.  
1 Addressed as a slave.  
5
Bus Busy — The BUSY bit indicates the status of the bus regardless of slave or master mode. The BUSY bit is  
BUSY  
set when a START signal is detected and cleared when a STOP signal is detected.  
0 Bus is idle.  
1 Bus is busy.  
4
Arbitration Lost — This bit is set by hardware when the arbitration procedure is lost. The ARBL bit must be  
ARBL  
cleared by software, by writing a one to it.  
0 Standard bus operation.  
1 Loss of arbitration.  
2
Slave Read/Write — When addressed as a slave the SRW bit indicates the value of the R/W command bit of  
the calling address sent to the master.  
SRW  
0 Slave receive, master writing to slave.  
1 Slave transmit, master reading from slave.  
1
IIC Interrupt Flag — The IICIF bit is set when an interrupt is pending. This bit must be cleared by software, by  
IICIF  
writing a one to it in the interrupt routine. One of the following events can set the IICIF bit:  
One byte transfer completes  
Match of slave address to calling address  
Arbitration lost  
0 No interrupt pending.  
1 Interrupt pending.  
0
Receive Acknowledge — When the RXAK bit is low, it indicates an acknowledge signal has been received after  
RXAK  
the completion of one byte of data transmission on the bus. If the RXAK bit is high it means that no acknowledge  
signal is detected.  
0 Acknowledge received.  
1 No acknowledge received.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
223  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.3.5 IIC Data I/O Register (IIC1D)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
DATA  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 13-7. IIC Data I/O Register (IIC1D)  
Table 13-6. IIC1D Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7:0  
Data — In master transmit mode, when data is written to the IIC1D, a data transfer is initiated. The most  
DATA  
significant bit is sent first. In master receive mode, reading this register initiates receiving of the next byte of data.  
NOTE  
When transmitting out of master receive mode, the IIC mode should be  
switched before reading the IIC1D register to prevent an inadvertent  
initiation of a master receive data transfer.  
In slave mode, the same functions are available after an address match has occurred.  
Note that the TX bit in IIC1C must correctly reflect the desired direction of transfer in master and slave  
modes for the transmission to begin. For instance, if the IIC is configured for master transmit but a master  
receive is desired, then reading the IIC1D will not initiate the receive.  
Reading the IIC1D will return the last byte received while the IIC is configured in either master receive or  
slave receive modes. The IIC1D does not reflect every byte that is transmitted on the IIC bus, nor can  
software verify that a byte has been written to the IIC1D correctly by reading it back.  
In master transmit mode, the first byte of data written to IIC1D following assertion of MST is used for the  
address transfer and should comprise of the calling address (in bit 7–bit 1) concatenated with the required  
R/W bit (in position bit 0).  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
224  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.4 Functional Description  
This section provides a complete functional description of the IIC module.  
13.4.1 IIC Protocol  
The IIC bus system uses a serial data line (SDA) and a serial clock line (SCL) for data transfer. All devices  
connected to it must have open drain or open collector outputs. A logic AND function is exercised on both  
lines with external pull-up resistors. The value of these resistors is system dependent.  
Normally, a standard communication is composed of four parts:  
START signal  
Slave address transmission  
Data transfer  
STOP signal  
The STOP signal should not be confused with the CPU STOP instruction. The IIC bus system  
communication is described briefly in the following sections and illustrated in Figure 13-8.  
MSB  
1
LSB  
8
MSB  
1
LSB  
8
SCL  
SDA  
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 R/W  
XXX  
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0  
START  
SIGNAL  
CALLING ADDRESS  
READ/ ACK  
BIT  
WRITE  
DATA BYTE  
NO STOP  
ACK SIGNAL  
BIT  
MSB  
1
LSB  
MSB  
LSB  
8
SCL  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
SDA  
AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 R/W  
XX  
AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 R/W  
START  
SIGNAL  
CALLING ADDRESS  
READ/ ACK REPEATED  
BIT START  
SIGNAL  
NEW CALLING ADDRESS  
NO STOP  
ACK SIGNAL  
BIT  
READ/  
WRITE  
WRITE  
Figure 13-8. IIC Bus Transmission Signals  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
225  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.4.1.1 START Signal  
When the bus is free; i.e., no master device is engaging the bus (both SCL and SDA lines are at logical  
high), a master may initiate communication by sending a START signal. As shown in Figure 13-8, a  
START signal is defined as a high-to-low transition of SDA while SCL is high. This signal denotes the  
beginning of a new data transfer (each data transfer may contain several bytes of data) and brings all slaves  
out of their idle states.  
13.4.1.2 Slave Address Transmission  
The first byte of data transferred immediately after the START signal is the slave address transmitted by  
the master. This is a seven-bit calling address followed by a R/W bit. The R/W bit tells the slave the desired  
direction of data transfer.  
1 = Read transfer, the slave transmits data to the master.  
0 = Write transfer, the master transmits data to the slave.  
Only the slave with a calling address that matches the one transmitted by the master will respond by  
sending back an acknowledge bit. This is done by pulling the SDA low at the 9th clock (see Figure 13-8).  
No two slaves in the system may have the same address. If the IIC module is the master, it must not transmit  
an address that is equal to its own slave address. The IIC cannot be master and slave at the same time.  
However, if arbitration is lost during an address cycle, the IIC will revert to slave mode and operate  
correctly even if it is being addressed by another master.  
13.4.1.3 Data Transfer  
Before successful slave addressing is achieved, the data transfer can proceed byte-by-byte in a direction  
specified by the R/W bit sent by the calling master.  
All transfers that come after an address cycle are referred to as data transfers, even if they carry sub-address  
information for the slave device  
Each data byte is 8 bits long. Data may be changed only while SCL is low and must be held stable while  
SCL is high as shown in Figure 13-8. There is one clock pulse on SCL for each data bit, the MSB being  
transferred first. Each data byte is followed by a 9th (acknowledge) bit, which is signalled from the  
receiving device. An acknowledge is signalled by pulling the SDA low at the ninth clock. In summary, one  
complete data transfer needs nine clock pulses.  
If the slave receiver does not acknowledge the master in the 9th bit time, the SDA line must be left high  
by the slave. The master interprets the failed acknowledge as an unsuccessful data transfer.  
If the master receiver does not acknowledge the slave transmitter after a data byte transmission, the slave  
interprets this as an end of data transfer and releases the SDA line.  
In either case, the data transfer is aborted and the master does one of two things:  
Relinquishes the bus by generating a STOP signal.  
Commences a new calling by generating a repeated START signal.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
226  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.4.1.4 STOP Signal  
The master can terminate the communication by generating a STOP signal to free the bus. However, the  
master may generate a START signal followed by a calling command without generating a STOP signal  
first. This is called repeated START. A STOP signal is defined as a low-to-high transition of SDA while  
SCL at logical 1 (see Figure 13-8).  
The master can generate a STOP even if the slave has generated an acknowledge at which point the slave  
must release the bus.  
13.4.1.5 Repeated START Signal  
As shown in Figure 13-8, a repeated START signal is a START signal generated without first generating a  
STOP signal to terminate the communication. This is used by the master to communicate with another  
slave or with the same slave in different mode (transmit/receive mode) without releasing the bus.  
13.4.1.6 Arbitration Procedure  
The IIC bus is a true multi-master bus that allows more than one master to be connected on it. If two or  
more masters try to control the bus at the same time, a clock synchronization procedure determines the bus  
clock, for which the low period is equal to the longest clock low period and the high is equal to the shortest  
one among the masters. The relative priority of the contending masters is determined by a data arbitration  
procedure, a bus master loses arbitration if it transmits logic 1 while another master transmits logic 0. The  
losing masters immediately switch over to slave receive mode and stop driving SDA output. In this case,  
the transition from master to slave mode does not generate a STOP condition. Meanwhile, a status bit is  
set by hardware to indicate loss of arbitration.  
13.4.1.7 Clock Synchronization  
Because wire-AND logic is performed on the SCL line, a high-to-low transition on the SCL line affects all  
the devices connected on the bus. The devices start counting their low period and after a device’s clock has  
gone low, it holds the SCL line low until the clock high state is reached. However, the change of low to  
high in this device clock may not change the state of the SCL line if another device clock is still within its  
low period. Therefore, synchronized clock SCL is held low by the device with the longest low period.  
Devices with shorter low periods enter a high wait state during this time (see Figure 13-9). When all  
devices concerned have counted off their low period, the synchronized clock SCL line is released and  
pulled high. There is then no difference between the device clocks and the state of the SCL line and all the  
devices start counting their high periods. The first device to complete its high period pulls the SCL line  
low again.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
227  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
START COUNTING HIGH PERIOD  
DELAY  
SCL1  
SCL2  
SCL  
INTERNAL COUNTER RESET  
Figure 13-9. IIC Clock Synchronization  
13.4.1.8 Handshaking  
The clock synchronization mechanism can be used as a handshake in data transfer. Slave devices may hold  
the SCL low after completion of one byte transfer (9 bits). In such case, it halts the bus clock and forces  
the master clock into wait states until the slave releases the SCL line.  
13.4.1.9 Clock Stretching  
The clock synchronization mechanism can be used by slaves to slow down the bit rate of a transfer. After  
the master has driven SCL low the slave can drive SCL low for the required period and then release it. If  
the slave SCL low period is greater than the master SCL low period then the resulting SCL bus signal low  
period is stretched.  
13.5 Resets  
The IIC is disabled after reset. The IIC cannot cause an MCU reset.  
13.6 Interrupts  
The IIC generates a single interrupt.  
An interrupt from the IIC is generated when any of the events in Table 13-7 occur provided the IICIE bit  
is set. The interrupt is driven by bit IICIF (of the IIC status register) and masked with bit IICIE (of the IIC  
control register). The IICIF bit must be cleared by software by writing a one to it in the interrupt routine.  
The user can determine the interrupt type by reading the status register.  
Table 13-7. Interrupt Summary  
Interrupt Source  
Status  
Flag  
Local Enable  
Complete 1-byte transfer  
Match of received calling address  
Arbitration Lost  
TCF  
IAAS  
ARBL  
IICIF  
IICIF  
IICIF  
IICIE  
IICIE  
IICIE  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
228  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.6.1 Byte Transfer Interrupt  
The TCF (transfer complete flag) bit is set at the falling edge of the 9th clock to indicate the completion of  
byte transfer.  
13.6.2 Address Detect Interrupt  
When the calling address matches the programmed slave address (IIC address register), the IAAS bit in  
the status register is set. The CPU is interrupted provided the IICIE is set. The CPU must check the SRW  
bit and set its Tx mode accordingly.  
13.6.3 Arbitration Lost Interrupt  
The IIC is a true multi-master bus that allows more than one master to be connected on it. If two or more  
masters try to control the bus at the same time, the relative priority of the contending masters is determined  
by a data arbitration procedure. The IIC module asserts this interrupt when it loses the data arbitration  
process and the ARBL bit in the status register is set.  
Arbitration is lost in the following circumstances:  
SDA sampled as a low when the master drives a high during an address or data transmit cycle.  
SDA sampled as a low when the master drives a high during the acknowledge bit of a data receive  
cycle.  
A START cycle is attempted when the bus is busy.  
A repeated START cycle is requested in slave mode.  
A STOP condition is detected when the master did not request it.  
This bit must be cleared by software by writing a one to it.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
229  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
13.7 Initialization/Application Information  
Module Initialization (Slave)  
1. Write: IICA  
to set the slave address  
2. Write: IICC  
to enable IIC and interrupts  
3. Initialize RAM variables (IICEN = 1 and IICIE = 1) for transmit data  
4. Initialize RAM variables used to achieve the routine shown in Figure 13-11  
Module Initialization (Master)  
1. Write: IICF  
to set the IIC baud rate (example provided in this chapter)  
2. Write: IICC  
to enable IIC and interrupts  
3. Initialize RAM variables (IICEN = 1 and IICIE = 1) for transmit data  
4. Initialize RAM variables used to achieve the routine shown in Figure 13-11  
5. Write: IICC  
to enable TX  
6. Write: IICC  
to enable MST (master mode)  
7. Write: IICD  
with the address of the target slave. (The LSB of this byte will determine whether the communication is  
master receive or transmit.)  
Module Use  
The routine shown in Figure 13-11 can handle both master and slave IIC operations. For slave operation, an  
incoming IIC message that contains the proper address will begin IIC communication. For master operation,  
communication must be initiated by writing to the IICD register.  
Register Model  
ADDR  
Address to which the module will respond when addressed as a slave (in slave mode)  
MULT  
Baud rate = BUSCLK / (2 x MULT x (SCL DIVIDER))  
0
IICA  
IICF  
ICR  
IICEN  
Module configuration  
TCF IAAS  
Module status flags  
IICIE  
MST  
TX  
TXAK  
RSTA  
0
0
IICC  
IICS  
IICD  
BUSY  
ARBL  
0
SRW  
IICIF  
RXAK  
DATA  
Data register; Write to transmit IIC data read to read IIC data  
Figure 13-10. IIC Module Quick Start  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
230  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
Clear  
IICIF  
Master  
Mode  
?
Y
N
Y
Arbitration  
Lost  
TX  
RX  
Tx/Rx  
?
?
N
Last Byte  
Transmitted  
Clear ARBL  
Y
N
?
N
Last  
Byte to Be Read  
?
Y
N
RXAK=0  
?
IAAS=1  
?
IAAS=1  
?
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Data Transfer  
Address Transfer  
Y
End of  
Addr Cycle  
(Master Rx)  
?
2nd Last  
Byte to Be Read  
?
(Read)  
Y
Y
SRW=1  
?
TX/RX  
?
RX  
TX  
(Write)  
N
N
N
ACK from  
Receiver  
?
Y
Generate  
Stop Signal  
(MST = 0)  
Write Next  
Byte to IICD  
Set TX  
Mode  
Set TXACK =1  
N
Read Data  
from IICD  
and Store  
Tx Next  
Byte  
Write Data  
to IICD  
Switch to  
Rx Mode  
Set RX  
Mode  
Switch to  
Rx Mode  
Generate  
Stop Signal  
(MST = 0)  
Read Data  
from IICD  
and Store  
Dummy Read  
from IICD  
Dummy Read  
from IICD  
Dummy Read  
from IICD  
RTI  
Figure 13-11. Typical IIC Interrupt Routine  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
231  
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV1)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
232  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14  
Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
14.1 Overview  
The 10-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC) is a successive approximation ADC designed for operation  
within an integrated microcontroller system-on-chip. The ADC module design supports up to 28 separate  
analog inputs (AD0-AD27). Only 18 (AD0-AD15, AD26, and AD27) of the possible inputs are  
implemented on the MC9S08AW60 Series of MCUs. These inputs are selected by the ADCH bits. Some  
inputs are shared with I/O pins as shown in Figure 14-1. All of the channel assignments of the ADC for  
the MC9S08AW60 Series devices are summarized in Table 14-1.  
14.2 Channel Assignments  
The ADC channel assignments for the MC9S08AW60 Series devices are shown in the table below.  
Channels that are unimplemented are internally connected to V  
. Reserved channels convert to an  
REFL  
unknown value. Channels which are connected to an I/O pin have an associated pin control bit as shown.  
Table 14-1. ADC Channel Assignment  
ADCH  
Channel  
Input  
Pin Control  
ADCH  
Channel  
Input  
Pin Control  
00000  
00001  
00010  
00011  
00100  
00101  
00110  
00111  
01000  
01001  
01010  
AD0  
AD1  
AD2  
AD3  
AD4  
AD5  
AD6  
AD7  
AD8  
AD9  
AD10  
PTB0/ADC1P0  
PTB1/ADC1P1  
PTB2/ADC1P2  
PTB3/ADC1P3  
PTB4/ADC1P4  
PTB5/ADC1P5  
PTB6/ADC1P6  
PTB7/ADC1P7  
PTD0/ADC1P8  
PTD1/ADC1P9  
ADPC0  
ADPC1  
ADPC2  
ADPC3  
ADPC4  
ADPC5  
ADPC6  
ADPC7  
ADPC8  
ADPC9  
ADPC10  
10000  
10001  
10010  
10011  
10100  
10101  
10110  
10111  
11000  
11001  
11010  
AD16  
AD17  
AD18  
AD19  
AD20  
AD21  
AD22  
AD23  
AD24  
AD25  
AD26  
VREFL  
VREFL  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
VREFL  
VREFL  
VREFL  
VREFL  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
PTD2/ADC1P10/  
KBI1P5  
Temperature  
Sensor1  
01011  
01100  
01101  
AD11  
AD12  
AD13  
PTD3/ADC1P11/  
KBI1P6  
ADPC11  
ADPC12  
ADPC13  
11011  
11100  
11101  
AD27  
Internal Bandgap  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
PTD4/ADC1P12/  
TPM2CLK  
Reserved  
PTD5/ADC1P13  
VREFH  
VREFH  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
233  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
Table 14-1. ADC Channel Assignment (continued)  
ADCH  
Channel  
Input  
Pin Control  
ADCH  
Channel  
Input  
Pin Control  
01110  
AD14  
PTD6/ADC1P14/  
TPM1CLK  
ADPC14  
11110  
VREFL  
VREFL  
N/A  
01111  
AD15  
PTD7ADC1P15/  
KBI1P7  
ADPC15  
11111  
Module  
disabled  
None  
N/A  
1
For more information, see Section 14.2.3, “Temperature Sensor.”  
NOTE  
Selecting the internal bandgap channel requires BGBE =1 in SPMSC1 see  
Section 5.9.8, “System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register  
(SPMSC1).” For value of bandgap voltage reference see Section Table A-7.,  
“DC Characteristics.”  
14.2.1 Alternate Clock  
The ADC module is capable of performing conversions using the MCU bus clock, the bus clock divided  
by two, the local asynchronous clock (ADACK) within the module, or the alternate clock, ALTCLK. The  
alternate clock for the MC9S08AW60 Series MCU devices is the external reference clock (ICGERCLK)  
from the internal clock generator (ICG) module.  
Because ICGERCLK is active only while an external clock source is enabled, the ICG must be configured  
for either FBE or FEE mode (CLKS1 = 1). ICGERCLK must run at a frequency such that the ADC  
conversion clock (ADCK) runs at a frequency within its specified range (f  
) after being divided down  
ADCK  
from the ALTCLK input as determined by the ADIV bits. For example, if the ADIV bits are set up to divide  
by four, then the minimum frequency for ALTCLK (ICGERCLK) is four times the minimum value for  
f
and the maximum frequency is four times the maximum value for f  
. Because of the minimum  
ADCK  
ADCK  
frequency requirement, when an oscillator circuit is used it must be configured for high range operation  
(RANGE = 1).  
ALTCLK is active while the MCU is in wait mode provided the conditions described above are met. This  
allows ALTCLK to be used as the conversion clock source for the ADC while the MCU is in wait mode.  
ALTCLK cannot be used as the ADC conversion clock source while the MCU is in stop3.  
14.2.2 Hardware Trigger  
The ADC hardware trigger, ADHWT, is output from the real time interrupt (RTI) counter. The RTI counter  
can be clocked by either ICGERCLK or a nominal 1 kHz clock source within the RTI block. The 1-kHz  
clock source can be used with the MCU in run, wait, or stop3. With the ICG configured for either FBE or  
FEE mode, ICGERCLK can be used with the MCU in run or wait.  
The period of the RTI is determined by the input clock frequency and the RTIS bits. When the ADC  
hardware trigger is enabled, a conversion is initiated upon an RTI counter overflow. The RTI counter is a  
free running counter that generates an overflow at the RTI rate determined by the RTIS bits.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
234  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
14.2.2.1 Analog Pin Enables  
The ADC on MC9S08AW60 Series contains only two analog pin enable registers, APCTL1 and APCTL2.  
14.2.2.2 Low-Power Mode Operation  
The ADC is capable of running in stop3 mode but requires LVDSE and LVDE in SPMSC1 to be set.  
14.2.3 Temperature Sensor  
The ADC1 module includes a temperature sensor whose output is connected to one of the ADC analog  
channel inputs. Equation 14-1 provides an approximate transfer function of the temperature sensor.  
Temp = 25 - ((V  
-V  
) ÷ m)  
TEMP25  
Eqn. 14-1  
TEMP  
where:  
— V  
— V  
is the voltage of the temperature sensor channel at the ambient temperature.  
TEMP  
is the voltage of the temperature sensor channel at 25°C.  
TEMP25  
— m is the hot or cold voltage versus temperature slope in V/°C.  
For temperature calculations, use the V and m values from the ADC Electricals table.  
TEMP25  
In application code, the user reads the temperature sensor channel, calculates V  
, and compares to  
TEMP  
V
. If V  
is greater than V  
the cold slope value is applied in Equation 14-1. If V  
is  
TEMP25  
TEMP  
TEMP25  
TEMP  
less than V  
the hot slope value is applied in Equation 14-1.  
TEMP25  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
235  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
HCS08 CORE  
DEBUG  
MODULE (DBG)  
8
PTA7– PTA0  
BKGD/MS  
BDC  
CPU  
8
PTB7/AD1P7–  
PTB0/AD1P0  
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL  
RESET  
IRQ  
PTC6  
RESETS AND INTERRUPTS  
MODES OF OPERATION  
POWER MANAGEMENT  
RxD2  
TxD2  
PTC5/RxD2  
PTC4  
PTC3/TxD2  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI2)  
PTC2/MCLK  
PTC1/SDA1  
SDA1  
SCL1  
RTI  
COP  
LVD  
IIC MODULE (IIC1)  
PTC0/SCL1  
IRQ  
AD1P7–AD1P0  
8
V
DDAD  
8
10-BIT  
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL  
CONVERTER (ADC1)  
AD1P15–AD1P8  
V
V
SSAD  
REFL  
PTD7/AD1P15/KBI1P7  
PTD6/AD1P14/TPM1CLK  
PTD5/AD1P13  
PTD4/AD1P12/TPM2CLK  
PTD3/AD1P11/KBI1P6  
PTD2/AD1P10/KBI1P5  
PTD1/AD1P9  
V
REFH  
USER FLASH  
(AW60 = 63,280 BYTES)  
(AW48 = 49,152 BYTES)  
(AW32 = 32,768 BYTES)  
(AW16 = 16,384 BYTES)  
PTD0/AD1P8  
SPSCK1  
PTE7/SPSCK1  
PTE6/MOSI1  
MOSI1  
SERIAL PERIPHERAL  
USER RAM  
MISO1  
SS1  
INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1)  
PTE5/MISO1  
PTE4/SS1  
AW60/48/32 = 2048 BYTES  
AW16 = 1024 BYTES  
TPM1CLK  
PTE3/TPM1CH1  
PTE2/TPM1CH0  
6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM1)  
TPM1CH5–  
TPM1CH0  
INTERNAL CLOCK  
GENERATOR (ICG)  
6
RxD1  
TxD1  
PTE1/RxD1  
PTE0/TxD1  
PTF7  
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS  
INTERFACE MODULE (SCI1)  
LOW-POWER OSCILLATOR  
PTF6  
PTF5/TPM2CH1  
PTF4/TPM2CH0  
TPM2CLK  
V
DD  
VOLTAGE  
REGULATOR  
2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM  
MODULE (TPM2)  
TPM2CH1–TPM2CH0  
V
SS  
2
PTF3/TPM1CH5  
KBI1P7–KBI1P5  
3
PTF2/TPM1CH4  
PTF1/TPM1CH3  
PTF0/TPM1CH2  
8-BIT KEYBOARD  
INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI1)  
KBI1P4–KBI1P0  
5
EXTAL  
XTAL  
PTG6/EXTAL  
PTG5/XTAL  
NOTES:  
PTG4/KBI1P4  
PTG3/KBI1P3  
PTG2/KBI1P2  
PTG1/KBI1P1  
PTG0/KBI1P0  
1. Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port.  
2. Pin contains software configurable pullup/pulldown device if IRQ is enabled  
(IRQPE = 1). Pulldown is enabled if rising edge detect is selected (IRQEDG = 1)  
3. IRQ does not have a clamp diode to VDD. IRQ should not be driven above VDD  
4. Pin contains integrated pullup device.  
.
5. Pins PTD7, PTD3, PTD2, and PTG4 contain both pullup and pulldown devices.  
Pulldown enabled when KBI is enabled (KBIPEn = 1) and rising edge is selected  
(KBEDGn = 1).  
Figure 14-1. MC9S08AW60 Block Diagram Highlighting ADC Block and Pins  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
236  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
14.2.4 Features  
Features of the ADC module include:  
Linear successive approximation algorithm with 10 bits resolution.  
Up to 28 analog inputs.  
Output formatted in 10- or 8-bit right-justified format.  
Single or continuous conversion (automatic return to idle after single conversion).  
Configurable sample time and conversion speed/power.  
Conversion complete flag and interrupt.  
Input clock selectable from up to four sources.  
Operation in wait or stop3 modes for lower noise operation.  
Asynchronous clock source for lower noise operation.  
Selectable asynchronous hardware conversion trigger.  
Automatic compare with interrupt for less-than, or greater-than or equal-to, programmable value.  
14.2.5 Block Diagram  
Figure 14-2 provides a block diagram of the ADC module  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
237  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
Compare true  
ADC1SC1  
3
ADC1CFG  
Async  
Clock Gen  
1
2
ADACK  
Bus Clock  
ALTCLK  
MCU STOP  
ADHWT  
ADCK  
Clock  
Divide  
Control Sequencer  
÷2  
AD0  
1
2
AIEN  
Interrupt  
COCO  
ADVIN  
SAR Converter  
AD27  
V
V
REFH  
Data Registers  
REFL  
Compare true  
ADC1SC2  
3
Compare  
Logic  
Compare Value Registers  
Figure 14-2. ADC Block Diagram  
14.3 External Signal Description  
The ADC module supports up to 28 separate analog inputs. It also requires four supply/reference/ground  
connections.  
Table 14-2. Signal Properties  
Name  
Function  
AD27–AD0  
VREFH  
Analog Channel inputs  
High reference voltage  
Low reference voltage  
Analog power supply  
Analog ground  
VREFL  
VDDAD  
VSSAD  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
238  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
14.3.1 Analog Power (VDDAD  
)
The ADC analog portion uses V  
as its power connection. In some packages, V  
is connected  
DDAD  
DDAD  
internally to V . If externally available, connect the V  
pin to the same voltage potential as V  
.
DD  
DDAD  
DD  
External filtering may be necessary to ensure clean V  
for good results.  
DDAD  
14.3.2 Analog Ground (VSSAD  
)
The ADC analog portion uses V  
as its ground connection. In some packages, V  
is connected  
SSAD  
SSAD  
internally to V . If externally available, connect the V  
pin to the same voltage potential as V .  
SS  
SSAD  
SS  
14.3.3 Voltage Reference High (VREFH  
)
V
V
is the high reference voltage for the converter. In some packages, V  
is connected internally to  
REFH  
REFH  
. If externally available, V  
may be connected to the same potential as V  
, or may be  
DDAD  
REFH  
DDAD  
driven by an external source that is between the minimum V  
spec and the V  
potential (V  
DDAD  
DDAD REFH  
must never exceed V  
).  
DDAD  
14.3.4 Voltage Reference Low (VREFL  
)
V
V
is the low reference voltage for the converter. In some packages, V  
is connected internally to  
REFL  
REFL  
SSAD  
. If externally available, connect the V  
pin to the same voltage potential as V  
.
REFL  
SSAD  
14.3.5 Analog Channel Inputs (ADx)  
The ADC module supports up to 28 separate analog inputs. An input is selected for conversion through the  
ADCH channel select bits.  
14.4 Register Definition  
These memory mapped registers control and monitor operation of the ADC:  
Status and control register, ADC1SC1  
Status and control register, ADC1SC2  
Data result registers, ADC1RH and ADC1RL  
Compare value registers, ADC1CVH and ADC1CVL  
Configuration register, ADC1CFG  
Pin enable registers, APCTL1, APCTL2, APCTL3  
14.4.1 Status and Control Register 1 (ADC1SC1)  
This section describes the function of the ADC status and control register (ADC1SC1). Writing ADC1SC1  
aborts the current conversion and initiates a new conversion (if the ADCH bits are equal to a value other  
than all 1s).  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
239  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
COCO  
AIEN  
ADCO  
ADCH  
Reset:  
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 14-3. Status and Control Register (ADC1SC1)  
Table 14-3. ADC1SC1 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Conversion Complete Flag — The COCO flag is a read-only bit which is set each time a conversion is  
completed when the compare function is disabled (ACFE = 0). When the compare function is enabled (ACFE =  
1) the COCO flag is set upon completion of a conversion only if the compare result is true. This bit is cleared  
whenever ADC1SC1 is written or whenever ADC1RL is read.  
COCO  
0 Conversion not completed  
1 Conversion completed  
6
Interrupt Enable — AIEN is used to enable conversion complete interrupts. When COCO becomes set while  
AIEN is high, an interrupt is asserted.  
AIEN  
0 Conversion complete interrupt disabled  
1 Conversion complete interrupt enabled  
5
Continuous Conversion Enable — ADCO is used to enable continuous conversions.  
ADCO  
0 One conversion following a write to the ADC1SC1 when software triggered operation is selected, or one  
conversion following assertion of ADHWT when hardware triggered operation is selected.  
1 Continuous conversions initiated following a write to ADC1SC1 when software triggered operation is selected.  
Continuous conversions are initiated by an ADHWT event when hardware triggered operation is selected.  
4:0  
ADCH  
Input Channel Select — The ADCH bits form a 5-bit field which is used to select one of the input channels. The  
input channels are detailed in Figure 14-4.  
The successive approximation converter subsystem is turned off when the channel select bits are all set to 1.  
This feature allows for explicit disabling of the ADC and isolation of the input channel from all sources.  
Terminating continuous conversions this way will prevent an additional, single conversion from being performed.  
It is not necessary to set the channel select bits to all 1s to place the ADC in a low-power state when continuous  
conversions are not enabled because the module automatically enters a low-power state when a conversion  
completes.  
Figure 14-4. Input Channel Select  
ADCH  
Input Select  
ADCH  
Input Select  
00000  
00001  
00010  
00011  
00100  
00101  
00110  
00111  
AD0  
AD1  
AD2  
AD3  
AD4  
AD5  
AD6  
AD7  
10000  
10001  
10010  
10011  
10100  
10101  
10110  
10111  
AD16  
AD17  
AD18  
AD19  
AD20  
AD21  
AD22  
AD23  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
240  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
Figure 14-4. Input Channel Select (continued)  
ADCH  
Input Select  
ADCH  
Input Select  
01000  
01001  
01010  
01011  
01100  
01101  
01110  
01111  
AD8  
AD9  
11000  
11001  
11010  
11011  
11100  
11101  
11110  
11111  
AD24  
AD25  
AD10  
AD11  
AD12  
AD13  
AD14  
AD15  
AD26  
AD27  
Reserved  
VREFH  
VREFL  
Module disabled  
14.4.2 Status and Control Register 2 (ADC1SC2)  
The ADC1SC2 register is used to control the compare function, conversion trigger and conversion active  
of the ADC module.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
ADACT  
0
0
ADTRG  
ACFE  
ACFGT  
R1  
R1  
Reset:  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
1
Bits 1 and 0 are reserved bits that must always be written to 0.  
Figure 14-5. Status and Control Register 2 (ADC1SC2)  
Table 14-4. ADC1SC2 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Conversion Active — ADACT indicates that a conversion is in progress. ADACT is set when a conversion is  
initiated and cleared when a conversion is completed or aborted.  
0 Conversion not in progress  
ADACT  
1 Conversion in progress  
6
Conversion Trigger Select — ADTRG is used to select the type of trigger to be used for initiating a conversion.  
Two types of trigger are selectable: software trigger and hardware trigger. When software trigger is selected, a  
conversion is initiated following a write to ADC1SC1. When hardware trigger is selected, a conversion is initiated  
following the assertion of the ADHWT input.  
ADTRG  
0 Software trigger selected  
1 Hardware trigger selected  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
241  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
Table 14-4. ADC1SC2 Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
5
Compare Function Enable — ACFE is used to enable the compare function.  
0 Compare function disabled  
ACFE  
1 Compare function enabled  
4
Compare Function Greater Than Enable — ACFGT is used to configure the compare function to trigger when  
the result of the conversion of the input being monitored is greater than or equal to the compare value. The  
compare function defaults to triggering when the result of the compare of the input being monitored is less than  
the compare value.  
ACFGT  
0 Compare triggers when input is less than compare level  
1 Compare triggers when input is greater than or equal to compare level  
14.4.3 Data Result High Register (ADC1RH)  
ADC1RH contains the upper two bits of the result of a 10-bit conversion. When configured for 8-bit  
conversions both ADR8 and ADR9 are equal to zero. ADC1RH is updated each time a conversion  
completes except when automatic compare is enabled and the compare condition is not met. In 10-bit  
MODE, reading ADC1RH prevents the ADC from transferring subsequent conversion results into the  
result registers until ADC1RL is read. If ADC1RL is not read until after the next conversion is completed,  
then the intermediate conversion result will be lost. In 8-bit mode there is no interlocking with ADC1RL.  
In the case that the MODE bits are changed, any data in ADC1RH becomes invalid.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
ADR9  
ADR8  
Reset:  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 14-6. Data Result High Register (ADC1RH)  
14.4.4 Data Result Low Register (ADC1RL)  
ADC1RL contains the lower eight bits of the result of a 10-bit conversion, and all eight bits of an 8-bit  
conversion. This register is updated each time a conversion completes except when automatic compare is  
enabled and the compare condition is not met. In 10-bit mode, reading ADC1RH prevents the ADC from  
transferring subsequent conversion results into the result registers until ADC1RL is read. If ADC1RL is  
not read until the after next conversion is completed, then the intermediate conversion results will be lost.  
In 8-bit mode, there is no interlocking with ADC1RH. In the case that the MODE bits are changed, any  
data in ADC1RL becomes invalid.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
242  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
ADR7  
ADR6  
ADR5  
ADR4  
ADR3  
ADR2  
ADR1  
ADR0  
Reset:  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 14-7. Data Result Low Register (ADC1RL)  
14.4.5 Compare Value High Register (ADC1CVH)  
This register holds the upper two bits of the 10-bit compare value. These bits are compared to the upper  
two bits of the result following a conversion in 10-bit mode when the compare function is enabled.In 8-bit  
operation, ADC1CVH is not used during compare.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
ADCV9  
ADCV8  
Reset:  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 14-8. Compare Value High Register (ADC1CVH)  
14.4.6 Compare Value Low Register (ADC1CVL)  
This register holds the lower 8 bits of the 10-bit compare value, or all 8 bits of the 8-bit compare value.  
Bits ADCV7:ADCV0 are compared to the lower 8 bits of the result following a conversion in either 10-bit  
or 8-bit mode.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
ADCV7  
ADCV6  
ADCV5  
ADCV4  
ADCV3  
ADCV2  
ADCV1  
ADCV0  
Reset:  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 14-9. Compare Value Low Register(ADC1CVL)  
14.4.7 Configuration Register (ADC1CFG)  
ADC1CFG is used to select the mode of operation, clock source, clock divide, and configure for low power  
or long sample time.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
243  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
ADLPC  
ADIV  
ADLSMP  
MODE  
ADICLK  
Reset:  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 14-10. Configuration Register (ADC1CFG)  
Table 14-5. ADC1CFG Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Low Power Configuration — ADLPC controls the speed and power configuration of the successive  
approximation converter. This is used to optimize power consumption when higher sample rates are not required.  
0 High speed configuration  
ADLPC  
1 Low power configuration: {FC31}The power is reduced at the expense of maximum clock speed.  
6:5  
Clock Divide Select — ADIV select the divide ratio used by the ADC to generate the internal clock ADCK.  
ADIV  
Table 14-6 shows the available clock configurations.  
4
Long Sample Time Configuration — ADLSMP selects between long and short sample time. This adjusts the  
ADLSMP sample period to allow higher impedance inputs to be accurately sampled or to maximize conversion speed for  
lower impedance inputs. Longer sample times can also be used to lower overall power consumption when  
continuous conversions are enabled if high conversion rates are not required.  
0 Short sample time  
1 Long sample time  
3:2  
Conversion Mode Selection — MODE bits are used to select between 10- or 8-bit operation. See Table 14-7.  
MODE  
1:0  
Input Clock Select — ADICLK bits select the input clock source to generate the internal clock ADCK. See  
ADICLK  
Table 14-8.  
Table 14-6. Clock Divide Select  
ADIV  
Divide Ratio  
Clock Rate  
00  
01  
10  
11  
1
2
4
8
Input clock  
Input clock ÷ 2  
Input clock ÷ 4  
Input clock ÷ 8  
Table 14-7. Conversion Modes  
Mode Description  
MODE  
00  
01  
10  
11  
8-bit conversion (N=8)  
Reserved  
10-bit conversion (N=10)  
Reserved  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
244  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
Table 14-8. Input Clock Select  
ADICLK  
Selected Clock Source  
00  
01  
10  
11  
Bus clock  
Bus clock divided by 2  
Alternate clock (ALTCLK)  
Asynchronous clock (ADACK)  
14.4.8 Pin Control 1 Register (APCTL1)  
The pin control registers are used to disable the I/O port control of MCU pins used as analog inputs.  
APCTL1 is used to control the pins associated with channels 0–7 of the ADC module.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
ADPC7  
ADPC6  
ADPC5  
ADPC4  
ADPC3  
ADPC2  
ADPC1  
ADPC0  
Reset:  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 14-11. Pin Control 1 Register (APCTL1)  
Table 14-9. APCTL1 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
ADC Pin Control 7 — ADPC7 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD7.  
0 AD7 pin I/O control enabled  
ADPC7  
1 AD7 pin I/O control disabled  
6
ADC Pin Control 6 — ADPC6 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD6.  
0 AD6 pin I/O control enabled  
ADPC6  
1 AD6 pin I/O control disabled  
5
ADC Pin Control 5 — ADPC5 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD5.  
0 AD5 pin I/O control enabled  
ADPC5  
1 AD5 pin I/O control disabled  
4
ADC Pin Control 4 — ADPC4 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD4.  
0 AD4 pin I/O control enabled  
ADPC4  
1 AD4 pin I/O control disabled  
3
ADC Pin Control 3 — ADPC3 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD3.  
0 AD3 pin I/O control enabled  
ADPC3  
1 AD3 pin I/O control disabled  
2
ADC Pin Control 2 — ADPC2 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD2.  
0 AD2 pin I/O control enabled  
ADPC2  
1 AD2 pin I/O control disabled  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
245  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
Table 14-9. APCTL1 Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
1
ADC Pin Control 1 — ADPC1 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD1.  
0 AD1 pin I/O control enabled  
ADPC1  
1 AD1 pin I/O control disabled  
0
ADC Pin Control 0 — ADPC0 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD0.  
0 AD0 pin I/O control enabled  
ADPC0  
1 AD0 pin I/O control disabled  
14.4.9 Pin Control 2 Register (APCTL2)  
APCTL2 is used to control channels 8–15 of the ADC module.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
ADPC15  
ADPC14  
ADPC13  
ADPC12  
ADPC11  
ADPC10  
ADPC9  
ADPC8  
Reset:  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 14-12. Pin Control 2 Register (APCTL2)  
Table 14-10. APCTL2 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
ADC Pin Control 15 — ADPC15 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD15.  
ADPC15 0 AD15 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD15 pin I/O control disabled  
6
ADC Pin Control 14 — ADPC14 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD14.  
ADPC14 0 AD14 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD14 pin I/O control disabled  
5
ADC Pin Control 13 — ADPC13 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD13.  
ADPC13 0 AD13 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD13 pin I/O control disabled  
4
ADC Pin Control 12 — ADPC12 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD12.  
ADPC12 0 AD12 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD12 pin I/O control disabled  
3
ADC Pin Control 11 — ADPC11 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD11.  
ADPC11 0 AD11 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD11 pin I/O control disabled  
2
ADC Pin Control 10 — ADPC10 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD10.  
ADPC10 0 AD10 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD10 pin I/O control disabled  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
246  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
Table 14-10. APCTL2 Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
1
ADC Pin Control 9 — ADPC9 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD9.  
ADPC9 0 AD9 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD9 pin I/O control disabled  
0
ADC Pin Control 8 — ADPC8 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD8.  
ADPC8 0 AD8 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD8 pin I/O control disabled  
14.4.10 Pin Control 3 Register (APCTL3)  
APCTL3 is used to control channels 16–23 of the ADC module.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
ADPC23  
ADPC22  
ADPC21  
ADPC20  
ADPC19  
ADPC18  
ADPC17  
ADPC16  
Reset:  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 14-13. Pin Control 3 Register (APCTL3)  
Table 14-11. APCTL3 Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
ADC Pin Control 23 — ADPC23 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD23.  
ADPC23 0 AD23 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD23 pin I/O control disabled  
6
ADC Pin Control 22 — ADPC22 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD22.  
ADPC22 0 AD22 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD22 pin I/O control disabled  
5
ADC Pin Control 21 — ADPC21 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD21.  
ADPC21 0 AD21 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD21 pin I/O control disabled  
4
ADC Pin Control 20 — ADPC20 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD20.  
ADPC20 0 AD20 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD20 pin I/O control disabled  
3
ADC Pin Control 19 — ADPC19 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD19.  
ADPC19 0 AD19 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD19 pin I/O control disabled  
2
ADC Pin Control 18 — ADPC18 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD18.  
ADPC18 0 AD18 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD18 pin I/O control disabled  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
247  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
Table 14-11. APCTL3 Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
1
ADC Pin Control 17 — ADPC17 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD17.  
ADPC17 0 AD17 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD17 pin I/O control disabled  
0
ADC Pin Control 16 — ADPC16 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD16.  
ADPC16 0 AD16 pin I/O control enabled  
1 AD16 pin I/O control disabled  
14.5 Functional Description  
The ADC module is disabled during reset or when the ADCH bits are all high. The module is idle when a  
conversion has completed and another conversion has not been initiated. When idle, the module is in its  
lowest power state.  
The ADC can perform an analog-to-digital conversion on any of the software selectable channels. The  
selected channel voltage is converted by a successive approximation algorithm into an 11-bit digital result.  
In 8-bit mode, the selected channel voltage is converted by a successive approximation algorithm into a  
9-bit digital result.  
When the conversion is completed, the result is placed in the data registers (ADC1RH and ADC1RL).In  
10-bit mode, the result is rounded to 10 bits and placed in ADC1RH and ADC1RL. In 8-bit mode, the  
result is rounded to 8 bits and placed in ADC1RL. The conversion complete flag (COCO) is then set and  
an interrupt is generated if the conversion complete interrupt has been enabled (AIEN = 1).  
The ADC module has the capability of automatically comparing the result of a conversion with the  
contents of its compare registers. The compare function is enabled by setting the ACFE bit and operates  
in conjunction with any of the conversion modes and configurations.  
14.5.1 Clock Select and Divide Control  
One of four clock sources can be selected as the clock source for the ADC module. This clock source is  
then divided by a configurable value to generate the input clock to the converter (ADCK). The clock is  
selected from one of the following sources by means of the ADICLK bits.  
The bus clock, which is equal to the frequency at which software is executed. This is the default  
selection following reset.  
The bus clock divided by 2. For higher bus clock rates, this allows a maximum divide by 16 of the  
bus clock.  
ALTCLK, as defined for this MCU (See module section introduction).  
The asynchronous clock (ADACK) – This clock is generated from a clock source within the ADC  
module. When selected as the clock source this clock remains active while the MCU is in wait or  
stop3 mode and allows conversions in these modes for lower noise operation.  
Whichever clock is selected, its frequency must fall within the specified frequency range for ADCK. If the  
available clocks are too slow, the ADC will not perform according to specifications. If the available clocks  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
248  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
are too fast, then the clock must be divided to the appropriate frequency. This divider is specified by the  
ADIV bits and can be divide-by 1, 2, 4, or 8.  
14.5.2 Input Select and Pin Control  
The pin control registers (APCTL3, APCTL2, and APCTL1) are used to disable the I/O port control of the  
pins used as analog inputs.When a pin control register bit is set, the following conditions are forced for the  
associated MCU pin:  
The output buffer is forced to its high impedance state.  
The input buffer is disabled. A read of the I/O port returns a zero for any pin with its input buffer  
disabled.  
The pullup is disabled.  
14.5.3 Hardware Trigger  
The ADC module has a selectable asynchronous hardware conversion trigger, ADHWT, that is enabled  
when the ADTRG bit is set. This source is not available on all MCUs. Consult the module introduction for  
information on the ADHWT source specific to this MCU.  
When ADHWT source is available and hardware trigger is enabled (ADTRG=1), a conversion is initiated  
on the rising edge of ADHWT. If a conversion is in progress when a rising edge occurs, the rising edge is  
ignored. In continuous convert configuration, only the initial rising edge to launch continuous conversions  
is observed. The hardware trigger function operates in conjunction with any of the conversion modes and  
configurations.  
14.5.4 Conversion Control  
Conversions can be performed in either 10-bit mode or 8-bit mode as determined by the MODE bits.  
Conversions can be initiated by either a software or hardware trigger. In addition, the ADC module can be  
configured for low power operation, long sample time, continuous conversion, and automatic compare of  
the conversion result to a software determined compare value.  
14.5.4.1 Initiating Conversions  
A conversion is initiated:  
Following a write to ADC1SC1 (with ADCH bits not all 1s) if software triggered operation is  
selected.  
Following a hardware trigger (ADHWT) event if hardware triggered operation is selected.  
Following the transfer of the result to the data registers when continuous conversion is enabled.  
If continuous conversions are enabled a new conversion is automatically initiated after the completion of  
the current conversion. In software triggered operation, continuous conversions begin after ADC1SC1 is  
written and continue until aborted. In hardware triggered operation, continuous conversions begin after a  
hardware trigger event and continue until aborted.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
249  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
14.5.4.2 Completing Conversions  
A conversion is completed when the result of the conversion is transferred into the data result registers,  
ADC1RH and ADC1RL. This is indicated by the setting of COCO. An interrupt is generated if AIEN is  
high at the time that COCO is set.  
A blocking mechanism prevents a new result from overwriting previous data in ADC1RH and ADC1RL  
if the previous data is in the process of being read while in 10-bit MODE (the ADC1RH register has been  
read but the ADC1RL register has not). When blocking is active, the data transfer is blocked, COCO is not  
set, and the new result is lost. In the case of single conversions with the compare function enabled and the  
compare condition false, blocking has no effect and ADC operation is terminated. In all other cases of  
operation, when a data transfer is blocked, another conversion is initiated regardless of the state of ADCO  
(single or continuous conversions enabled).  
If single conversions are enabled, the blocking mechanism could result in several discarded conversions  
and excess power consumption. To avoid this issue, the data registers must not be read after initiating a  
single conversion until the conversion completes.  
14.5.4.3 Aborting Conversions  
Any conversion in progress will be aborted when:  
A write to ADC1SC1 occurs (the current conversion will be aborted and a new conversion will be  
initiated, if ADCH are not all 1s).  
A write to ADC1SC2, ADC1CFG, ADC1CVH, or ADC1CVL occurs. This indicates a mode of  
operation change has occurred and the current conversion is therefore invalid.  
The MCU is reset.  
The MCU enters stop mode with ADACK not enabled.  
When a conversion is aborted, the contents of the data registers, ADC1RH and ADC1RL, are not altered  
but continue to be the values transferred after the completion of the last successful conversion. In the case  
that the conversion was aborted by a reset, ADC1RH and ADC1RL return to their reset states.  
14.5.4.4 Power Control  
The ADC module remains in its idle state until a conversion is initiated. If ADACK is selected as the  
conversion clock source, the ADACK clock generator is also enabled.  
Power consumption when active can be reduced by setting ADLPC. This results in a lower maximum value  
for f  
(see the electrical specifications).  
ADCK  
14.5.4.5 Total Conversion Time  
The total conversion time depends on the sample time (as determined by ADLSMP), the MCU bus  
frequency, the conversion mode (8-bit or 10-bit), and the frequency of the conversion clock (fADCK). After  
the module becomes active, sampling of the input begins. ADLSMP is used to select between short and  
long sample times.When sampling is complete, the converter is isolated from the input channel and a  
successive approximation algorithm is performed to determine the digital value of the analog signal. The  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
250  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
result of the conversion is transferred to ADC1RH and ADC1RL upon completion of the conversion  
algorithm.  
If the bus frequency is less than the f  
frequency, precise sample time for continuous conversions  
ADCK  
cannot be guaranteed when short sample is enabled (ADLSMP=0). If the bus frequency is less than 1/11th  
of the f frequency, precise sample time for continuous conversions cannot be guaranteed when long  
ADCK  
sample is enabled (ADLSMP=1).  
The maximum total conversion time for different conditions is summarized in Table 14-12.  
Table 14-12. Total Conversion Time vs. Control Conditions  
Conversion Type  
ADICLK  
ADLSMP  
Max Total Conversion Time  
Single or first continuous 8-bit  
Single or first continuous 10-bit  
Single or first continuous 8-bit  
Single or first continuous 10-bit  
Single or first continuous 8-bit  
Single or first continuous 10-bit  
Single or first continuous 8-bit  
Single or first continuous 10-bit  
0x, 10  
0x, 10  
0x, 10  
0x, 10  
11  
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
20 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles  
23 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles  
40 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles  
43 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles  
5 μs + 20 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles  
5 μs + 23 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles  
5 μs + 40 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles  
5 μs + 43 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles  
17 ADCK cycles  
11  
11  
11  
Subsequent continuous 8-bit;  
xx  
fBUS > fADCK  
Subsequent continuous 10-bit;  
xx  
xx  
xx  
0
1
1
20 ADCK cycles  
37 ADCK cycles  
40 ADCK cycles  
fBUS > fADCK  
Subsequent continuous 8-bit;  
fBUS > fADCK/11  
Subsequent continuous 10-bit;  
fBUS > fADCK/11  
The maximum total conversion time is determined by the clock source chosen and the divide ratio selected.  
The clock source is selectable by the ADICLK bits, and the divide ratio is specified by the ADIV bits. For  
example, in 10-bit mode, with the bus clock selected as the input clock source, the input clock divide-by-1  
ratio selected, and a bus frequency of 8 MHz, then the conversion time for a single conversion is:  
23 ADCK cyc  
8 MHz/1  
5 bus cyc  
8 MHz  
= 3.5 μs  
Conversion time =  
+
Number of bus cycles = 3.5 μs x 8 MHz = 28 cycles  
NOTE  
The ADCK frequency must be between f  
maximum to meet ADC specifications.  
minimum and f  
ADCK  
ADCK  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
251  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
14.5.5 Automatic Compare Function  
The compare function can be configured to check for either an upper limit or lower limit. After the input  
is sampled and converted, the result is added to the two’s complement of the compare value (ADC1CVH  
and ADC1CVL). When comparing to an upper limit (ACFGT = 1), if the result is greater-than or equal-to  
the compare value, COCO is set. When comparing to a lower limit (ACFGT = 0), if the result is less than  
the compare value, COCO is set. The value generated by the addition of the conversion result and the two’s  
complement of the compare value is transferred to ADC1RH and ADC1RL.  
Upon completion of a conversion while the compare function is enabled, if the compare condition is not  
true, COCO is not set and no data is transferred to the result registers. An ADC interrupt is generated upon  
the setting of COCO if the ADC interrupt is enabled (AIEN = 1).  
NOTE  
The compare function can be used to monitor the voltage on a channel while  
the MCU is in either wait or stop3 mode. The ADC interrupt will wake the  
MCU when the compare condition is met.  
14.5.6 MCU Wait Mode Operation  
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in a lower power-consumption standby mode from which recovery  
is very fast because the clock sources remain active. If a conversion is in progress when the MCU enters  
wait mode, it continues until completion. Conversions can be initiated while the MCU is in wait mode by  
means of the hardware trigger or if continuous conversions are enabled.  
The bus clock, bus clock divided by two, and ADACK are available as conversion clock sources while in  
wait mode. The use of ALTCLK as the conversion clock source in wait is dependent on the definition of  
ALTCLK for this MCU. Consult the module introduction for information on ALTCLK specific to this  
MCU.  
A conversion complete event sets the COCO and generates an ADC interrupt to wake the MCU from wait  
mode if the ADC interrupt is enabled (AIEN = 1).  
14.5.7 MCU Stop3 Mode Operation  
The STOP instruction is used to put the MCU in a low power-consumption standby mode during which  
most or all clock sources on the MCU are disabled.  
14.5.7.1 Stop3 Mode With ADACK Disabled  
If the asynchronous clock, ADACK, is not selected as the conversion clock, executing a STOP instruction  
aborts the current conversion and places the ADC in its idle state. The contents of ADC1RH and ADC1RL  
are unaffected by stop3 mode.After exiting from stop3 mode, a software or hardware trigger is required to  
resume conversions.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
252  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
14.5.7.2 Stop3 Mode With ADACK Enabled  
If ADACK is selected as the conversion clock, the ADC continues operation during stop3 mode. For  
guaranteed ADC operation, the MCU’s voltage regulator must remain active during stop3 mode. Consult  
the module introduction for configuration information for this MCU.  
If a conversion is in progress when the MCU enters stop3 mode, it continues until completion. Conversions  
can be initiated while the MCU is in stop3 mode by means of the hardware trigger or if continuous  
conversions are enabled.  
A conversion complete event sets the COCO and generates an ADC interrupt to wake the MCU from stop3  
mode if the ADC interrupt is enabled (AIEN = 1).  
NOTE  
It is possible for the ADC module to wake the system from low power stop  
and cause the MCU to begin consuming run-level currents without  
generating a system level interrupt. To prevent this scenario, software  
should ensure that the data transfer blocking mechanism (discussed in  
Section 14.5.4.2, “Completing Conversions) is cleared when entering stop3  
and continuing ADC conversions.  
14.5.8 MCU Stop1 and Stop2 Mode Operation  
The ADC module is automatically disabled when the MCU enters either stop1 or stop2 mode. All module  
registers contain their reset values following exit from stop1 or stop2. Therefore the module must be  
re-enabled and re-configured following exit from stop1 or stop2.  
14.6 Initialization Information  
This section gives an example which provides some basic direction on how a user would initialize and  
configure the ADC module. The user has the flexibility of choosing between configuring the module for  
8-bit or 10-bit resolution, single or continuous conversion, and a polled or interrupt approach, among many  
other options. Refer to Table 14-6, Table 14-7, and Table 14-8 for information used in this example.  
NOTE  
Hexadecimal values designated by a preceding 0x, binary values designated  
by a preceding %, and decimal values have no preceding character.  
14.6.1 ADC Module Initialization Example  
14.6.1.1 Initialization Sequence  
Before the ADC module can be used to complete conversions, an initialization procedure must be  
performed. A typical sequence is as follows:  
1. Update the configuration register (ADCCFG) to select the input clock source and the divide ratio  
used to generate the internal clock, ADCK. This register is also used for selecting sample time and  
low-power configuration.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
253  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
2. Update status and control register 2 (ADCSC2) to select the conversion trigger (hardware or  
software) and compare function options, if enabled.  
3. Update status and control register 1 (ADCSC1) to select whether conversions will be continuous  
or completed only once, and to enable or disable conversion complete interrupts. The input channel  
on which conversions will be performed is also selected here.  
14.6.1.2 Pseudo — Code Example  
In this example, the ADC module will be set up with interrupts enabled to perform a single 10-bit  
conversion at low power with a long sample time on input channel 1, where the internal ADCK clock will  
be derived from the bus clock divided by 1.  
ADCCFG = 0x98 (%10011000)  
Bit 7  
Bit 6:5 ADIV  
Bit 4  
ADLPC  
1
00  
Configures for low power (lowers maximum clock speed)  
Sets the ADCK to the input clock ÷ 1  
Configures for long sample time  
ADLSMP 1  
Bit 3:2 MODE  
10  
Sets mode at 10-bit conversions  
Bit 1:0 ADICLK 00  
Selects bus clock as input clock source  
ADCSC2 = 0x00 (%00000000)  
Bit 7  
Bit 6  
Bit 5  
ADACT  
ADTRG  
ACFE  
0
0
0
Flag indicates if a conversion is in progress  
Software trigger selected  
Compare function disabled  
Bit 4  
ACFGT  
0
Not used in this example  
Bit 3:2  
Bit 1:0  
00  
00  
Unimplemented or reserved, always reads zero  
Reserved for Freescale’s internal use; always write zero  
ADCSC1 = 0x41 (%01000001)  
Bit 7  
Bit 6  
Bit 5  
COCO  
AIEN  
ADCO  
0
1
0
Read-only flag which is set when a conversion completes  
Conversion complete interrupt enabled  
One conversion only (continuous conversions disabled)  
Bit 4:0 ADCH  
00001 Input channel 1 selected as ADC input channel  
ADCRH/L = 0xxx  
Holds results of conversion. Read high byte (ADCRH) before low byte (ADCRL) so that conversion  
data cannot be overwritten with data from the next conversion.  
ADCCVH/L = 0xxx  
Holds compare value when compare function enabled  
APCTL1=0x02  
AD1 pin I/O control disabled. All other AD pins remain general purpose I/O pins  
APCTL2=0x00  
All other AD pins remain general purpose I/O pins  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
254  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
RESET  
INITIALIZE ADC  
ADCCFG = $98  
ADCSC2 = $00  
ADCSC1 = $41  
NO  
CHECK  
COCO=1?  
YES  
READ ADCRH  
THEN ADCRL TO  
CLEAR COCO BIT  
CONTINUE  
Figure 14-14. Initialization Flowchart for Example  
14.7 Application Information  
This section contains information for using the ADC module in applications. The ADC has been designed  
to be integrated into a microcontroller for use in embedded control applications requiring an A/D  
converter.  
14.7.1 External Pins and Routing  
The following sections discuss the external pins associated with the ADC module and how they should be  
used for best results.  
14.7.1.1 Analog Supply Pins  
The ADC module has analog power and ground supplies (V  
and V  
) which are available as  
DDAD  
SSAD  
separate pins on some devices. On other devices, V  
is shared on the same pin as the MCU digital V ,  
SSAD  
SS  
and on others, both V  
and V  
are shared with the MCU digital supply pins. In these cases, there  
SSAD  
DDAD  
are separate pads for the analog supplies which are bonded to the same pin as the corresponding digital  
supply so that some degree of isolation between the supplies is maintained.  
When available on a separate pin, both V  
and V  
must be connected to the same voltage potential  
SSAD  
DDAD  
as their corresponding MCU digital supply (V and V ) and must be routed carefully for maximum  
DD  
SS  
noise immunity and bypass capacitors placed as near as possible to the package.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
255  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
In cases where separate power supplies are used for analog and digital power, the ground connection  
between these supplies must be at the V  
pin. This should be the only ground connection between these  
SSAD  
supplies if possible. The V  
pin makes a good single point ground location.  
SSAD  
14.7.1.2 Analog Reference Pins  
In addition to the analog supplies, the ADC module has connections for two reference voltage inputs. The  
high reference is V  
, which may be shared on the same pin as V  
on some devices. The low  
REFH  
DDAD  
reference is V  
, which may be shared on the same pin as V  
on some devices.  
REFL  
SSAD  
When available on a separate pin, V  
may be connected to the same potential as V  
, or may be  
DDAD  
REFH  
driven by an external source that is between the minimum V  
spec and the V  
potential (V  
DDAD  
DDAD REFH  
must never exceed V  
). When available on a separate pin, V  
must be connected to the same  
DDAD  
REFL  
voltage potential as V  
. Both V  
and V  
must be routed carefully for maximum noise  
SSAD  
REFH  
REFL  
immunity and bypass capacitors placed as near as possible to the package.  
AC current in the form of current spikes required to supply charge to the capacitor array at each successive  
approximation step is drawn through the V  
and V  
loop. The best external component to meet this  
REFH  
REFL  
current demand is a 0.1 μF capacitor with good high frequency characteristics. This capacitor is connected  
between V and V and must be placed as near as possible to the package pins. Resistance in the  
REFH  
REFL  
path is not recommended because the current will cause a voltage drop which could result in conversion  
errors. Inductance in this path must be minimum (parasitic only).  
14.7.1.3 Analog Input Pins  
The external analog inputs are typically shared with digital I/O pins on MCU devices. The pin I/O control  
is disabled by setting the appropriate control bit in one of the pin control registers. Conversions can be  
performed on inputs without the associated pin control register bit set. It is recommended that the pin  
control register bit always be set when using a pin as an analog input. This avoids problems with contention  
because the output buffer will be in its high impedance state and the pullup is disabled. Also, the input  
buffer draws dc current when its input is not at either V or V . Setting the pin control register bits for  
DD  
SS  
all pins used as analog inputs should be done to achieve lowest operating current.  
Empirical data shows that capacitors on the analog inputs improve performance in the presence of noise  
or when the source impedance is high. Use of 0.01 μF capacitors with good high-frequency characteristics  
is sufficient. These capacitors are not necessary in all cases, but when used they must be placed as near as  
possible to the package pins and be referenced to V  
.
SSA  
For proper conversion, the input voltage must fall between V  
and V  
. If the input is equal to or  
REFH  
REFL  
exceeds V  
, the converter circuit converts the signal to $3FF (full scale 10-bit representation) or $FF  
REFH  
(full scale 8-bit representation). If the input is equal to or less than V  
, the converter circuit converts it  
REFL  
to $000. Input voltages between V  
and V  
are straight-line linear conversions. There will be a  
REFH  
REFL  
brief current associated with V  
when the sampling capacitor is charging. The input is sampled for  
REFL  
3.5 cycles of the ADCK source when ADLSMP is low, or 23.5 cycles when ADLSMP is high.  
For minimal loss of accuracy due to current injection, pins adjacent to the analog input pins should not be  
transitioning during conversions.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
256  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
14.7.2 Sources of Error  
Several sources of error exist for A/D conversions. These are discussed in the following sections.  
14.7.2.1 Sampling Error  
For proper conversions, the input must be sampled long enough to achieve the proper accuracy. Given the  
maximum input resistance of approximately 7kΩ and input capacitance of approximately 5.5 pF, sampling  
to within 1/4LSB (at 10-bit resolution) can be achieved within the minimum sample window (3.5 cycles @  
8 MHz maximum ADCK frequency) provided the resistance of the external analog source (R ) is kept  
AS  
below 5 kΩ.  
Higher source resistances or higher-accuracy sampling is possible by setting ADLSMP (to increase the  
sample window to 23.5 cycles) or decreasing ADCK frequency to increase sample time.  
14.7.2.2 Pin Leakage Error  
Leakage on the I/O pins can cause conversion error if the external analog source resistance (R ) is high.  
AS  
N
If this error cannot be tolerated by the application, keep R lower than V  
/ (2 *I  
) for less than  
AS  
DDAD  
LEAK  
1/4LSB leakage error (N = 8 in 8-bit mode or 10 in 10-bit mode).  
14.7.2.3 Noise-Induced Errors  
System noise which occurs during the sample or conversion process can affect the accuracy of the  
conversion. The ADC accuracy numbers are guaranteed as specified only if the following conditions are  
met:  
There is a 0.1 μF low-ESR capacitor from V  
There is a 0.1 μF low-ESR capacitor from V  
to V  
.
REFH  
REFL  
to V  
.
DDAD  
SSAD  
If inductive isolation is used from the primary supply, an additional 1 μF capacitor is placed from  
V
to V  
.
DDAD  
SSAD  
V
(and V  
, if connected) is connected to V at a quiet point in the ground plane.  
REFL SS  
SSAD  
Operate the MCU in wait or stop3 mode before initiating (hardware triggered conversions) or  
immediately after initiating (hardware or software triggered conversions) the ADC conversion.  
— For software triggered conversions, immediately follow the write to the ADC1SC1 with a  
WAIT instruction or STOP instruction.  
— For stop3 mode operation, select ADACK as the clock source. Operation in stop3 reduces V  
noise but increases effective conversion time due to stop recovery.  
DD  
There is no I/O switching, input or output, on the MCU during the conversion.  
There are some situations where external system activity causes radiated or conducted noise emissions or  
excessive V noise is coupled into the ADC. In these situations, or when the MCU cannot be placed in  
DD  
wait or stop3 or I/O activity cannot be halted, these recommended actions may reduce the effect of noise  
on the accuracy:  
Place a 0.01 μF capacitor (C ) on the selected input channel to V  
or V  
(this will  
SSAD  
AS  
REFL  
improve noise issues but will affect sample rate based on the external analog source resistance).  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
257  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
Average the result by converting the analog input many times in succession and dividing the sum  
of the results. Four samples are required to eliminate the effect of a 1LSB, one-time error.  
Reduce the effect of synchronous noise by operating off the asynchronous clock (ADACK) and  
averaging. Noise that is synchronous to ADCK cannot be averaged out.  
14.7.2.4 Code Width and Quantization Error  
The ADC quantizes the ideal straight-line transfer function into 1024 steps (in 10-bit mode). Each step  
ideally has the same height (1 code) and width. The width is defined as the delta between the transition  
points to one code and the next. The ideal code width for an N bit converter (in this case N can be 8 or 10),  
defined as 1LSB, is:  
N
1LSB = (V  
- V  
) / 2  
Eqn. 14-2  
REFH  
REFL  
There is an inherent quantization error due to the digitization of the result. For 8-bit or 10-bit conversions  
the code will transition when the voltage is at the midpoint between the points where the straight line  
transfer function is exactly represented by the actual transfer function. Therefore, the quantization error  
will be 1/2LSB in 8- or 10-bit mode. As a consequence, however, the code width of the first ($000)  
conversion is only 1/2LSB and the code width of the last ($FF or $3FF) is 1.5LSB.  
14.7.2.5 Linearity Errors  
The ADC may also exhibit non-linearity of several forms. Every effort has been made to reduce these  
errors but the system should be aware of them because they affect overall accuracy. These errors are:  
Zero-scale error (E ) (sometimes called offset) — This error is defined as the difference between  
ZS  
the actual code width of the first conversion and the ideal code width (1/2LSB). Note, if the first  
conversion is $001, then the difference between the actual $001 code width and its ideal (1LSB) is  
used.  
Full-scale error (E ) — This error is defined as the difference between the actual code width of  
FS  
the last conversion and the ideal code width (1.5LSB). Note, if the last conversion is $3FE, then the  
difference between the actual $3FE code width and its ideal (1LSB) is used.  
Differential non-linearity (DNL) — This error is defined as the worst-case difference between the  
actual code width and the ideal code width for all conversions.  
Integral non-linearity (INL) — This error is defined as the highest-value the (absolute value of the)  
running sum of DNL achieves. More simply, this is the worst-case difference of the actual  
transition voltage to a given code and its corresponding ideal transition voltage, for all codes.  
Total unadjusted error (TUE) — This error is defined as the difference between the actual transfer  
function and the ideal straight-line transfer function, and therefore includes all forms of error.  
14.7.2.6 Code Jitter, Non-Monotonicity and Missing Codes  
Analog-to-digital converters are susceptible to three special forms of error. These are code jitter,  
non-monotonicity, and missing codes.  
Code jitter is when, at certain points, a given input voltage converts to one of two values when sampled  
repeatedly. Ideally, when the input voltage is infinitesimally smaller than the transition voltage, the  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
258  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
converter yields the lower code (and vice-versa). However, even very small amounts of system noise can  
cause the converter to be indeterminate (between two codes) for a range of input voltages around the  
transition voltage. This range is normally around 1/2LSB and will increase with noise. This error may be  
reduced by repeatedly sampling the input and averaging the result. Additionally the techniques discussed  
in Section 14.7.2.3 will reduce this error.  
Non-monotonicity is defined as when, except for code jitter, the converter converts to a lower code for a  
higher input voltage. Missing codes are those values which are never converted for any input value.  
In 8-bit or 10-bit mode, the ADC is guaranteed to be monotonic and to have no missing codes.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
259  
Chapter 14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
260  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15  
Development Support  
15.1 Introduction  
Development support systems in the HCS08 include the background debug controller (BDC) and the  
on-chip debug module (DBG). The BDC provides a single-wire debug interface to the target MCU that  
provides a convenient interface for programming the on-chip FLASH and other nonvolatile memories. The  
BDC is also the primary debug interface for development and allows non-intrusive access to memory data  
and traditional debug features such as CPU register modify, breakpoints, and single instruction trace  
commands.  
In the HCS08 family, address and data bus signals are not available on external pins (not even in test  
modes). Debug is done through commands fed into the target MCU via the single-wire background debug  
interface. The debug module provides a means to selectively trigger and capture bus information so an  
external development system can reconstruct what happened inside the MCU on a cycle-by-cycle basis  
without having external access to the address and data signals.  
The alternate BDC clock source for MC9S08AW60 Series is the ICGLCLK. See Chapter 8, “Internal  
Clock Generator (S08ICGV4)” for more information about ICGCLK and how to select clock sources.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
261  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
15.1.1 Features  
Features of the BDC module include:  
Single pin for mode selection and background communications  
BDC registers are not located in the memory map  
SYNC command to determine target communications rate  
Non-intrusive commands for memory access  
Active background mode commands for CPU register access  
GO and TRACE1 commands  
BACKGROUND command can wake CPU from stop or wait modes  
One hardware address breakpoint built into BDC  
Oscillator runs in stop mode, if BDC enabled  
COP watchdog disabled while in active background mode  
Features of the ICE system include:  
Two trigger comparators: Two address + read/write (R/W) or one full address + data + R/W  
Flexible 8-word by 16-bit FIFO (first-in, first-out) buffer for capture information:  
— Change-of-flow addresses or  
— Event-only data  
Two types of breakpoints:  
— Tag breakpoints for instruction opcodes  
— Force breakpoints for any address access  
Nine trigger modes:  
— Basic: A-only, A OR B  
— Sequence: A then B  
— Full: A AND B data, A AND NOT B data  
— Event (store data): Event-only B, A then event-only B  
— Range: Inside range (A address B), outside range (address < A or address > B)  
15.2 Background Debug Controller (BDC)  
All MCUs in the HCS08 family contain a single-wire background debug interface that supports in-circuit  
programming of on-chip nonvolatile memory and sophisticated non-intrusive debug capabilities. Unlike  
debug interfaces on earlier 8-bit MCUs, this system does not interfere with normal application resources.  
It does not use any user memory or locations in the memory map and does not share any on-chip  
peripherals.  
BDC commands are divided into two groups:  
Active background mode commands require that the target MCU is in active background mode (the  
user program is not running). Active background mode commands allow the CPU registers to be  
read or written, and allow the user to trace one user instruction at a time, or GO to the user program  
from active background mode.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
262  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
Non-intrusive commands can be executed at any time even while the user’s program is running.  
Non-intrusive commands allow a user to read or write MCU memory locations or access status and  
control registers within the background debug controller.  
Typically, a relatively simple interface pod is used to translate commands from a host computer into  
commands for the custom serial interface to the single-wire background debug system. Depending on the  
development tool vendor, this interface pod may use a standard RS-232 serial port, a parallel printer port,  
or some other type of communications such as a universal serial bus (USB) to communicate between the  
host PC and the pod. The pod typically connects to the target system with ground, the BKGD pin, RESET,  
and sometimes V . An open-drain connection to reset allows the host to force a target system reset,  
DD  
which is useful to regain control of a lost target system or to control startup of a target system before the  
on-chip nonvolatile memory has been programmed. Sometimes V can be used to allow the pod to use  
DD  
power from the target system to avoid the need for a separate power supply. However, if the pod is powered  
separately, it can be connected to a running target system without forcing a target system reset or otherwise  
disturbing the running application program.  
2
GND  
BKGD  
1
NO CONNECT 3  
NO CONNECT 5  
4 RESET  
6 V  
DD  
Figure 15-1. BDM Tool Connector  
15.2.1 BKGD Pin Description  
BKGD is the single-wire background debug interface pin. The primary function of this pin is for  
bidirectional serial communication of active background mode commands and data. During reset, this pin  
is used to select between starting in active background mode or starting the user’s application program.  
This pin is also used to request a timed sync response pulse to allow a host development tool to determine  
the correct clock frequency for background debug serial communications.  
BDC serial communications use a custom serial protocol first introduced on the M68HC12 family of  
microcontrollers. This protocol assumes the host knows the communication clock rate that is determined  
by the target BDC clock rate. All communication is initiated and controlled by the host that drives a  
high-to-low edge to signal the beginning of each bit time. Commands and data are sent most significant bit  
first (MSB first). For a detailed description of the communications protocol, refer to Section 15.2.2,  
“Communication Details.”  
If a host is attempting to communicate with a target MCU that has an unknown BDC clock rate, a SYNC  
command may be sent to the target MCU to request a timed sync response signal from which the host can  
determine the correct communication speed.  
BKGD is a pseudo-open-drain pin and there is an on-chip pullup so no external pullup resistor is required.  
Unlike typical open-drain pins, the external RC time constant on this pin, which is influenced by external  
capacitance, plays almost no role in signal rise time. The custom protocol provides for brief, actively  
driven speedup pulses to force rapid rise times on this pin without risking harmful drive level conflicts.  
Refer to Section 15.2.2, “Communication Details,” for more detail.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
263  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
When no debugger pod is connected to the 6-pin BDM interface connector, the internal pullup on BKGD  
chooses normal operating mode. When a debug pod is connected to BKGD it is possible to force the MCU  
into active background mode after reset. The specific conditions for forcing active background depend  
upon the HCS08 derivative (refer to the introduction to this Development Support section). It is not  
necessary to reset the target MCU to communicate with it through the background debug interface.  
15.2.2 Communication Details  
The BDC serial interface requires the external controller to generate a falling edge on the BKGD pin to  
indicate the start of each bit time. The external controller provides this falling edge whether data is  
transmitted or received.  
BKGD is a pseudo-open-drain pin that can be driven either by an external controller or by the MCU. Data  
is transferred MSB first at 16 BDC clock cycles per bit (nominal speed). The interface times out if  
512 BDC clock cycles occur between falling edges from the host. Any BDC command that was in progress  
when this timeout occurs is aborted without affecting the memory or operating mode of the target MCU  
system.  
The custom serial protocol requires the debug pod to know the target BDC communication clock speed.  
The clock switch (CLKSW) control bit in the BDC status and control register allows the user to select the  
BDC clock source. The BDC clock source can either be the bus or the alternate BDC clock source.  
The BKGD pin can receive a high or low level or transmit a high or low level. The following diagrams  
show timing for each of these cases. Interface timing is synchronous to clocks in the target BDC, but  
asynchronous to the external host. The internal BDC clock signal is shown for reference in counting cycles.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
264  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
Figure 15-2 shows an external host transmitting a logic 1 or 0 to the BKGD pin of a target HCS08 MCU.  
The host is asynchronous to the target so there is a 0-to-1 cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge  
to where the target perceives the beginning of the bit time. Ten target BDC clock cycles later, the target  
senses the bit level on the BKGD pin. Typically, the host actively drives the pseudo-open-drain BKGD pin  
during host-to-target transmissions to speed up rising edges. Because the target does not drive the BKGD  
pin during the host-to-target transmission period, there is no need to treat the line as an open-drain signal  
during this period.  
BDC CLOCK  
(TARGET MCU)  
HOST  
TRANSMIT 1  
HOST  
TRANSMIT 0  
10 CYCLES  
EARLIEST START  
OF NEXT BIT  
SYNCHRONIZATION  
UNCERTAINTY  
TARGET SENSES BIT LEVEL  
PERCEIVED START  
OF BIT TIME  
Figure 15-2. BDC Host-to-Target Serial Bit Timing  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
265  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
Figure 15-3 shows the host receiving a logic 1 from the target HCS08 MCU. Because the host is  
asynchronous to the target MCU, there is a 0-to-1 cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge on  
BKGD to the perceived start of the bit time in the target MCU. The host holds the BKGD pin low long  
enough for the target to recognize it (at least two target BDC cycles). The host must release the low drive  
before the target MCU drives a brief active-high speedup pulse seven cycles after the perceived start of the  
bit time. The host should sample the bit level about 10 cycles after it started the bit time.  
BDC CLOCK  
(TARGET MCU)  
HOST DRIVE  
HIGH-IMPEDANCE  
TO BKGD PIN  
TARGET MCU  
SPEEDUP PULSE  
HIGH-IMPEDANCE  
HIGH-IMPEDANCE  
PERCEIVED START  
OF BIT TIME  
R-C RISE  
BKGD PIN  
10 CYCLES  
10 CYCLES  
EARLIEST START  
OF NEXT BIT  
HOST SAMPLES BKGD PIN  
Figure 15-3. BDC Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 1)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
266  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
Figure 15-4 shows the host receiving a logic 0 from the target HCS08 MCU. Because the host is  
asynchronous to the target MCU, there is a 0-to-1 cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge on  
BKGD to the start of the bit time as perceived by the target MCU. The host initiates the bit time but the  
target HCS08 finishes it. Because the target wants the host to receive a logic 0, it drives the BKGD pin low  
for 13 BDC clock cycles, then briefly drives it high to speed up the rising edge. The host samples the bit  
level about 10 cycles after starting the bit time.  
BDC CLOCK  
(TARGET MCU)  
HOST DRIVE  
TO BKGD PIN  
HIGH-IMPEDANCE  
SPEEDUP  
PULSE  
TARGET MCU  
DRIVE AND  
SPEED-UP PULSE  
PERCEIVED START  
OF BIT TIME  
BKGD PIN  
10 CYCLES  
10 CYCLES  
EARLIEST START  
OF NEXT BIT  
HOST SAMPLES BKGD PIN  
Figure 15-4. BDM Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 0)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
267  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
15.2.3 BDC Commands  
BDC commands are sent serially from a host computer to the BKGD pin of the target HCS08 MCU. All  
commands and data are sent MSB-first using a custom BDC communications protocol. Active background  
mode commands require that the target MCU is currently in the active background mode while  
non-intrusive commands may be issued at any time whether the target MCU is in active background mode  
or running a user application program.  
Table 15-1 shows all HCS08 BDC commands, a shorthand description of their coding structure, and the  
meaning of each command.  
Coding Structure Nomenclature  
This nomenclature is used in Table 15-1 to describe the coding structure of the BDC commands.  
Commands begin with an 8-bit hexadecimal command code in the host-to-target  
direction (most significant bit first)  
/
d
= separates parts of the command  
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
delay 16 target BDC clock cycles  
a 16-bit address in the host-to-target direction  
AAAA  
RD  
8 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction  
8 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction  
16 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction  
16 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction  
the contents of BDCSCR in the target-to-host direction (STATUS)  
8 bits of write data for BDCSCR in the host-to-target direction (CONTROL)  
WD  
RD16  
WD16  
SS  
CC  
RBKP  
16 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction (from BDCBKPT breakpoint  
register)  
WBKP  
=
16 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction (for BDCBKPT breakpoint register)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
268  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
Description  
Table 15-1. BDC Command Summary  
Command  
Mnemonic  
Active BDM/  
Coding  
Non-intrusive  
Structure  
Request a timed reference pulse to determine  
target BDC communication speed  
n/a1  
D5/d  
D6/d  
90/d  
SYNC  
Non-intrusive  
Enable acknowledge protocol. Refer to  
Freescale document order no. HCS08RMv1/D.  
ACK_ENABLE  
ACK_DISABLE  
BACKGROUND  
Non-intrusive  
Non-intrusive  
Non-intrusive  
Disable acknowledge protocol. Refer to  
Freescale document order no. HCS08RMv1/D.  
Enter active background mode if enabled  
(ignore if ENBDM bit equals 0)  
READ_STATUS  
WRITE_CONTROL  
READ_BYTE  
Non-intrusive  
Non-intrusive  
Non-intrusive  
Non-intrusive  
E4/SS  
C4/CC  
Read BDC status from BDCSCR  
Write BDC controls in BDCSCR  
Read a byte from target memory  
Read a byte and report status  
E0/AAAA/d/RD  
READ_BYTE_WS  
E1/AAAA/d/SS/RD  
Re-read byte from address just read and  
report status  
READ_LAST  
Non-intrusive  
E8/SS/RD  
WRITE_BYTE  
WRITE_BYTE_WS  
READ_BKPT  
Non-intrusive  
Non-intrusive  
Non-intrusive  
Non-intrusive  
C0/AAAA/WD/d  
C1/AAAA/WD/d/SS  
E2/RBKP  
Write a byte to target memory  
Write a byte and report status  
Read BDCBKPT breakpoint register  
Write BDCBKPT breakpoint register  
WRITE_BKPT  
C2/WBKP  
Go to execute the user application program  
starting at the address currently in the PC  
GO  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
08/d  
10/d  
18/d  
Trace 1 user instruction at the address in the  
PC, then return to active background mode  
TRACE1  
TAGGO  
Same as GO but enable external tagging  
(HCS08 devices have no external tagging pin)  
READ_A  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
68/d/RD  
Read accumulator (A)  
READ_CCR  
READ_PC  
READ_HX  
READ_SP  
69/d/RD  
Read condition code register (CCR)  
Read program counter (PC)  
Read H and X register pair (H:X)  
Read stack pointer (SP)  
6B/d/RD16  
6C/d/RD16  
6F/d/RD16  
Increment H:X by one then read memory byte  
located at H:X  
READ_NEXT  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
70/d/RD  
Increment H:X by one then read memory byte  
located at H:X. Report status and data.  
READ_NEXT_WS  
71/d/SS/RD  
WRITE_A  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
48/WD/d  
Write accumulator (A)  
WRITE_CCR  
WRITE_PC  
WRITE_HX  
WRITE_SP  
49/WD/d  
Write condition code register (CCR)  
Write program counter (PC)  
Write H and X register pair (H:X)  
Write stack pointer (SP)  
4B/WD16/d  
4C/WD16/d  
4F/WD16/d  
Increment H:X by one, then write memory byte  
located at H:X  
WRITE_NEXT  
Active BDM  
Active BDM  
50/WD/d  
Increment H:X by one, then write memory byte  
located at H:X. Also report status.  
WRITE_NEXT_WS  
51/WD/d/SS  
1
The SYNC command is a special operation that does not have a command code.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
269  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
The SYNC command is unlike other BDC commands because the host does not necessarily know the  
correct communications speed to use for BDC communications until after it has analyzed the response to  
the SYNC command.  
To issue a SYNC command, the host:  
Drives the BKGD pin low for at least 128 cycles of the slowest possible BDC clock (The slowest  
clock is normally the reference oscillator/64 or the self-clocked rate/64.)  
Drives BKGD high for a brief speedup pulse to get a fast rise time (This speedup pulse is typically  
one cycle of the fastest clock in the system.)  
Removes all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance  
Monitors the BKGD pin for the sync response pulse  
The target, upon detecting the SYNC request from the host (which is a much longer low time than would  
ever occur during normal BDC communications):  
Waits for BKGD to return to a logic high  
Delays 16 cycles to allow the host to stop driving the high speedup pulse  
Drives BKGD low for 128 BDC clock cycles  
Drives a 1-cycle high speedup pulse to force a fast rise time on BKGD  
Removes all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance  
The host measures the low time of this 128-cycle sync response pulse and determines the correct speed for  
subsequent BDC communications. Typically, the host can determine the correct communication speed  
within a few percent of the actual target speed and the communication protocol can easily tolerate speed  
errors of several percent.  
15.2.4 BDC Hardware Breakpoint  
The BDC includes one relatively simple hardware breakpoint that compares the CPU address bus to a  
16-bit match value in the BDCBKPT register. This breakpoint can generate a forced breakpoint or a tagged  
breakpoint. A forced breakpoint causes the CPU to enter active background mode at the first instruction  
boundary following any access to the breakpoint address. The tagged breakpoint causes the instruction  
opcode at the breakpoint address to be tagged so that the CPU will enter active background mode rather  
than executing that instruction if and when it reaches the end of the instruction queue. This implies that  
tagged breakpoints can only be placed at the address of an instruction opcode while forced breakpoints can  
be set at any address.  
The breakpoint enable (BKPTEN) control bit in the BDC status and control register (BDCSCR) is used to  
enable the breakpoint logic (BKPTEN = 1). When BKPTEN = 0, its default value after reset, the  
breakpoint logic is disabled and no BDC breakpoints are requested regardless of the values in other BDC  
breakpoint registers and control bits. The force/tag select (FTS) control bit in BDCSCR is used to select  
forced (FTS = 1) or tagged (FTS = 0) type breakpoints.  
The on-chip debug module (DBG) includes circuitry for two additional hardware breakpoints that are more  
flexible than the simple breakpoint in the BDC module.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
270  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
15.3 On-Chip Debug System (DBG)  
Because HCS08 devices do not have external address and data buses, the most important functions of an  
in-circuit emulator have been built onto the chip with the MCU. The debug system consists of an 8-stage  
FIFO that can store address or data bus information, and a flexible trigger system to decide when to capture  
bus information and what information to capture. The system relies on the single-wire background debug  
system to access debug control registers and to read results out of the eight stage FIFO.  
The debug module includes control and status registers that are accessible in the user’s memory map.  
These registers are located in the high register space to avoid using valuable direct page memory space.  
Most of the debug module’s functions are used during development, and user programs rarely access any  
of the control and status registers for the debug module. The one exception is that the debug system can  
provide the means to implement a form of ROM patching. This topic is discussed in greater detail in  
Section 15.3.6, “Hardware Breakpoints.”  
15.3.1 Comparators A and B  
Two 16-bit comparators (A and B) can optionally be qualified with the R/W signal and an opcode tracking  
circuit. Separate control bits allow you to ignore R/W for each comparator. The opcode tracking circuitry  
optionally allows you to specify that a trigger will occur only if the opcode at the specified address is  
actually executed as opposed to only being read from memory into the instruction queue. The comparators  
are also capable of magnitude comparisons to support the inside range and outside range trigger modes.  
Comparators are disabled temporarily during all BDC accesses.  
The A comparator is always associated with the 16-bit CPU address. The B comparator compares to the  
CPU address or the 8-bit CPU data bus, depending on the trigger mode selected. Because the CPU data  
bus is separated into a read data bus and a write data bus, the RWAEN and RWA control bits have an  
additional purpose, in full address plus data comparisons they are used to decide which of these buses to  
use in the comparator B data bus comparisons. If RWAEN = 1 (enabled) and RWA = 0 (write), the CPU’s  
write data bus is used. Otherwise, the CPU’s read data bus is used.  
The currently selected trigger mode determines what the debugger logic does when a comparator detects  
a qualified match condition. A match can cause:  
Generation of a breakpoint to the CPU  
Storage of data bus values into the FIFO  
Starting to store change-of-flow addresses into the FIFO (begin type trace)  
Stopping the storage of change-of-flow addresses into the FIFO (end type trace)  
15.3.2 Bus Capture Information and FIFO Operation  
The usual way to use the FIFO is to setup the trigger mode and other control options, then arm the  
debugger. When the FIFO has filled or the debugger has stopped storing data into the FIFO, you would  
read the information out of it in the order it was stored into the FIFO. Status bits indicate the number of  
words of valid information that are in the FIFO as data is stored into it. If a trace run is manually halted by  
writing 0 to ARM before the FIFO is full (CNT = 1:0:0:0), the information is shifted by one position and  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
271  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
the host must perform ((8 – CNT) – 1) dummy reads of the FIFO to advance it to the first significant entry  
in the FIFO.  
In most trigger modes, the information stored in the FIFO consists of 16-bit change-of-flow addresses. In  
these cases, read DBGFH then DBGFL to get one coherent word of information out of the FIFO. Reading  
DBGFL (the low-order byte of the FIFO data port) causes the FIFO to shift so the next word of information  
is available at the FIFO data port. In the event-only trigger modes (see Section 15.3.5, “Trigger Modes),  
8-bit data information is stored into the FIFO. In these cases, the high-order half of the FIFO (DBGFH) is  
not used and data is read out of the FIFO by simply reading DBGFL. Each time DBGFL is read, the FIFO  
is shifted so the next data value is available through the FIFO data port at DBGFL.  
In trigger modes where the FIFO is storing change-of-flow addresses, there is a delay between CPU  
addresses and the input side of the FIFO. Because of this delay, if the trigger event itself is a change-of-flow  
address or a change-of-flow address appears during the next two bus cycles after a trigger event starts the  
FIFO, it will not be saved into the FIFO. In the case of an end-trace, if the trigger event is a change-of-flow,  
it will be saved as the last change-of-flow entry for that debug run.  
The FIFO can also be used to generate a profile of executed instruction addresses when the debugger is not  
armed. When ARM = 0, reading DBGFL causes the address of the most-recently fetched opcode to be  
saved in the FIFO. To use the profiling feature, a host debugger would read addresses out of the FIFO by  
reading DBGFH then DBGFL at regular periodic intervals. The first eight values would be discarded  
because they correspond to the eight DBGFL reads needed to initially fill the FIFO. Additional periodic  
reads of DBGFH and DBGFL return delayed information about executed instructions so the host debugger  
can develop a profile of executed instruction addresses.  
15.3.3 Change-of-Flow Information  
To minimize the amount of information stored in the FIFO, only information related to instructions that  
cause a change to the normal sequential execution of instructions is stored. With knowledge of the source  
and object code program stored in the target system, an external debugger system can reconstruct the path  
of execution through many instructions from the change-of-flow information stored in the FIFO.  
For conditional branch instructions where the branch is taken (branch condition was true), the source  
address is stored (the address of the conditional branch opcode). Because BRA and BRN instructions are  
not conditional, these events do not cause change-of-flow information to be stored in the FIFO.  
Indirect JMP and JSR instructions use the current contents of the H:X index register pair to determine the  
destination address, so the debug system stores the run-time destination address for any indirect JMP or  
JSR. For interrupts, RTI, or RTS, the destination address is stored in the FIFO as change-of-flow  
information.  
15.3.4 Tag vs. Force Breakpoints and Triggers  
Tagging is a term that refers to identifying an instruction opcode as it is fetched into the instruction queue,  
but not taking any other action until and unless that instruction is actually executed by the CPU. This  
distinction is important because any change-of-flow from a jump, branch, subroutine call, or interrupt  
causes some instructions that have been fetched into the instruction queue to be thrown away without being  
executed.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
272  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
A force-type breakpoint waits for the current instruction to finish and then acts upon the breakpoint  
request. The usual action in response to a breakpoint is to go to active background mode rather than  
continuing to the next instruction in the user application program.  
The tag vs. force terminology is used in two contexts within the debug module. The first context refers to  
breakpoint requests from the debug module to the CPU. The second refers to match signals from the  
comparators to the debugger control logic. When a tag-type break request is sent to the CPU, a signal is  
entered into the instruction queue along with the opcode so that if/when this opcode ever executes, the CPU  
will effectively replace the tagged opcode with a BGND opcode so the CPU goes to active background  
mode rather than executing the tagged instruction. When the TRGSEL control bit in the DBGT register is  
set to select tag-type operation, the output from comparator A or B is qualified by a block of logic in the  
debug module that tracks opcodes and only produces a trigger to the debugger if the opcode at the compare  
address is actually executed. There is separate opcode tracking logic for each comparator so more than one  
compare event can be tracked through the instruction queue at a time.  
15.3.5 Trigger Modes  
The trigger mode controls the overall behavior of a debug run. The 4-bit TRG field in the DBGT register  
selects one of nine trigger modes. When TRGSEL = 1 in the DBGT register, the output of the comparator  
must propagate through an opcode tracking circuit before triggering FIFO actions. The BEGIN bit in  
DBGT chooses whether the FIFO begins storing data when the qualified trigger is detected (begin trace),  
or the FIFO stores data in a circular fashion from the time it is armed until the qualified trigger is detected  
(end trigger).  
A debug run is started by writing a 1 to the ARM bit in the DBGC register, which sets the ARMF flag and  
clears the AF and BF flags and the CNT bits in DBGS. A begin-trace debug run ends when the FIFO gets  
full. An end-trace run ends when the selected trigger event occurs. Any debug run can be stopped manually  
by writing a 0 to ARM or DBGEN in DBGC.  
In all trigger modes except event-only modes, the FIFO stores change-of-flow addresses. In event-only  
trigger modes, the FIFO stores data in the low-order eight bits of the FIFO.  
The BEGIN control bit is ignored in event-only trigger modes and all such debug runs are begin type  
traces. When TRGSEL = 1 to select opcode fetch triggers, it is not necessary to use R/W in comparisons  
because opcode tags would only apply to opcode fetches that are always read cycles. It would also be  
unusual to specify TRGSEL = 1 while using a full mode trigger because the opcode value is normally  
known at a particular address.  
The following trigger mode descriptions only state the primary comparator conditions that lead to a trigger.  
Either comparator can usually be further qualified with R/W by setting RWAEN (RWBEN) and the  
corresponding RWA (RWB) value to be matched against R/W. The signal from the comparator with  
optional R/W qualification is used to request a CPU breakpoint if BRKEN = 1 and TAG determines  
whether the CPU request will be a tag request or a force request.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
273  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
A-Only — Trigger when the address matches the value in comparator A  
A OR B — Trigger when the address matches either the value in comparator A or the value in  
comparator B  
A Then B — Trigger when the address matches the value in comparator B but only after the address for  
another cycle matched the value in comparator A. There can be any number of cycles after the A match  
and before the B match.  
A AND B Data (Full Mode) — This is called a full mode because address, data, and R/W (optionally)  
must match within the same bus cycle to cause a trigger event. Comparator A checks address, the low byte  
of comparator B checks data, and R/W is checked against RWA if RWAEN = 1. The high-order half of  
comparator B is not used.  
In full trigger modes it is not useful to specify a tag-type CPU breakpoint (BRKEN = TAG = 1), but if you  
do, the comparator B data match is ignored for the purpose of issuing the tag request to the CPU and the  
CPU breakpoint is issued when the comparator A address matches.  
A AND NOT B Data (Full Mode) — Address must match comparator A, data must not match the low  
half of comparator B, and R/W must match RWA if RWAEN = 1. All three conditions must be met within  
the same bus cycle to cause a trigger.  
In full trigger modes it is not useful to specify a tag-type CPU breakpoint (BRKEN = TAG = 1), but if you  
do, the comparator B data match is ignored for the purpose of issuing the tag request to the CPU and the  
CPU breakpoint is issued when the comparator A address matches.  
Event-Only B (Store Data) — Trigger events occur each time the address matches the value in  
comparator B. Trigger events cause the data to be captured into the FIFO. The debug run ends when the  
FIFO becomes full.  
A Then Event-Only B (Store Data) — After the address has matched the value in comparator A, a trigger  
event occurs each time the address matches the value in comparator B. Trigger events cause the data to be  
captured into the FIFO. The debug run ends when the FIFO becomes full.  
Inside Range (A Address B) — A trigger occurs when the address is greater than or equal to the value  
in comparator A and less than or equal to the value in comparator B at the same time.  
Outside Range (Address < A or Address > B) — A trigger occurs when the address is either less than  
the value in comparator A or greater than the value in comparator B.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
274  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
15.3.6 Hardware Breakpoints  
The BRKEN control bit in the DBGC register may be set to 1 to allow any of the trigger conditions  
described in Section 15.3.5, “Trigger Modes,” to be used to generate a hardware breakpoint request to the  
CPU. TAG in DBGC controls whether the breakpoint request will be treated as a tag-type breakpoint or a  
force-type breakpoint. A tag breakpoint causes the current opcode to be marked as it enters the instruction  
queue. If a tagged opcode reaches the end of the pipe, the CPU executes a BGND instruction to go to active  
background mode rather than executing the tagged opcode. A force-type breakpoint causes the CPU to  
finish the current instruction and then go to active background mode.  
If the background mode has not been enabled (ENBDM = 1) by a serial WRITE_CONTROL command  
through the BKGD pin, the CPU will execute an SWI instruction instead of going to active background  
mode.  
15.4 Register Definition  
This section contains the descriptions of the BDC and DBG registers and control bits.  
Refer to the high-page register summary in the device overview chapter of this data sheet for the absolute  
address assignments for all DBG registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their  
names. A Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate  
absolute addresses.  
15.4.1 BDC Registers and Control Bits  
The BDC has two registers:  
The BDC status and control register (BDCSCR) is an 8-bit register containing control and status  
bits for the background debug controller.  
The BDC breakpoint match register (BDCBKPT) holds a 16-bit breakpoint match address.  
These registers are accessed with dedicated serial BDC commands and are not located in the memory  
space of the target MCU (so they do not have addresses and cannot be accessed by user programs).  
Some of the bits in the BDCSCR have write limitations; otherwise, these registers may be read or written  
at any time. For example, the ENBDM control bit may not be written while the MCU is in active  
background mode. (This prevents the ambiguous condition of the control bit forbidding active background  
mode while the MCU is already in active background mode.) Also, the four status bits (BDMACT, WS,  
WSF, and DVF) are read-only status indicators and can never be written by the WRITE_CONTROL serial  
BDC command. The clock switch (CLKSW) control bit may be read or written at any time.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
275  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
15.4.1.1 BDC Status and Control Register (BDCSCR)  
This register can be read or written by serial BDC commands (READ_STATUS and WRITE_CONTROL)  
but is not accessible to user programs because it is not located in the normal memory map of the MCU.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
BDMACT  
WS  
WSF  
DVF  
ENBDM  
BKPTEN  
FTS  
CLKSW  
W
Normal  
Reset  
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reset in  
Active BDM:  
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 15-5. BDC Status and Control Register (BDCSCR)  
Table 15-2. BDCSCR Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Enable BDM (Permit Active Background Mode) Typically, this bit is written to 1 by the debug host shortly  
after the beginning of a debug session or whenever the debug host resets the target and remains 1 until a normal  
reset clears it.  
ENBDM  
0 BDM cannot be made active (non-intrusive commands still allowed)  
1 BDM can be made active to allow active background mode commands  
6
Background Mode Active Status — This is a read-only status bit.  
BDMACT 0 BDM not active (user application program running)  
1 BDM active and waiting for serial commands  
5
BDC Breakpoint Enable — If this bit is clear, the BDC breakpoint is disabled and the FTS (force tag select)  
control bit and BDCBKPT match register are ignored.  
0 BDC breakpoint disabled  
BKPTEN  
1 BDC breakpoint enabled  
4
FTS  
Force/Tag Select — When FTS = 1, a breakpoint is requested whenever the CPU address bus matches the  
BDCBKPT match register. When FTS = 0, a match between the CPU address bus and the BDCBKPT register  
causes the fetched opcode to be tagged. If this tagged opcode ever reaches the end of the instruction queue,  
the CPU enters active background mode rather than executing the tagged opcode.  
0 Tag opcode at breakpoint address and enter active background mode if CPU attempts to execute that  
instruction  
1 Breakpoint match forces active background mode at next instruction boundary (address need not be an  
opcode)  
3
Select Source for BDC Communications Clock — CLKSW defaults to 0, which selects the alternate BDC  
CLKSW  
clock source.  
0 Alternate BDC clock source  
1 MCU bus clock  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
276  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
Table 15-2. BDCSCR Register Field Descriptions (continued)  
Field  
Description  
2
WS  
Wait or Stop Status — When the target CPU is in wait or stop mode, most BDC commands cannot function.  
However, the BACKGROUND command can be used to force the target CPU out of wait or stop and into active  
background mode where all BDC commands work. Whenever the host forces the target MCU into active  
background mode, the host should issue a READ_STATUS command to check that BDMACT = 1 before  
attempting other BDC commands.  
0 Target CPU is running user application code or in active background mode (was not in wait or stop mode when  
background became active)  
1 Target CPU is in wait or stop mode, or a BACKGROUND command was used to change from wait or stop to  
active background mode  
1
WSF  
Wait or Stop Failure Status — This status bit is set if a memory access command failed due to the target CPU  
executing a wait or stop instruction at or about the same time. The usual recovery strategy is to issue a  
BACKGROUND command to get out of wait or stop mode into active background mode, repeat the command  
that failed, then return to the user program. (Typically, the host would restore CPU registers and stack values and  
re-execute the wait or stop instruction.)  
0 Memory access did not conflict with a wait or stop instruction  
1 Memory access command failed because the CPU entered wait or stop mode  
0
DVF  
Data Valid Failure Status — This status bit is not used in the MC9S08AW60 Series because it does not have  
any slow access memory.  
0 Memory access did not conflict with a slow memory access  
1 Memory access command failed because CPU was not finished with a slow memory access  
15.4.1.2 BDC Breakpoint Match Register (BDCBKPT)  
This 16-bit register holds the address for the hardware breakpoint in the BDC. The BKPTEN and FTS  
control bits in BDCSCR are used to enable and configure the breakpoint logic. Dedicated serial BDC  
commands (READ_BKPT and WRITE_BKPT) are used to read and write the BDCBKPT register but is  
not accessible to user programs because it is not located in the normal memory map of the MCU.  
Breakpoints are normally set while the target MCU is in active background mode before running the user  
application program. For additional information about setup and use of the hardware breakpoint logic in  
the BDC, refer to Section 15.2.4, “BDC Hardware Breakpoint.”  
15.4.2 System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR)  
This register contains a single write-only control bit. A serial background mode command such as  
WRITE_BYTE must be used to write to SBDFR. Attempts to write this register from a user program are  
ignored. Reads always return 0x00.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
277  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BDFR1  
0
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
1
BDFR is writable only through serial background mode debug commands, not from user programs.  
Figure 15-6. System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR)  
Table 15-3. SBDFR Register Field Description  
Description  
Field  
0
Background Debug Force Reset — A serial active background mode command such as WRITE_BYTE allows  
an external debug host to force a target system reset. Writing 1 to this bit forces an MCU reset. This bit cannot  
be written from a user program.  
BDFR  
15.4.3 DBG Registers and Control Bits  
The debug module includes nine bytes of register space for three 16-bit registers and three 8-bit control  
and status registers. These registers are located in the high register space of the normal memory map so  
they are accessible to normal application programs. These registers are rarely if ever accessed by normal  
user application programs with the possible exception of a ROM patching mechanism that uses the  
breakpoint logic.  
15.4.3.1 Debug Comparator A High Register (DBGCAH)  
This register contains compare value bits for the high-order eight bits of comparator A. This register is  
forced to 0x00 at reset and can be read at any time or written at any time unless ARM = 1.  
15.4.3.2 Debug Comparator A Low Register (DBGCAL)  
This register contains compare value bits for the low-order eight bits of comparator A. This register is  
forced to 0x00 at reset and can be read at any time or written at any time unless ARM = 1.  
15.4.3.3 Debug Comparator B High Register (DBGCBH)  
This register contains compare value bits for the high-order eight bits of comparator B. This register is  
forced to 0x00 at reset and can be read at any time or written at any time unless ARM = 1.  
15.4.3.4 Debug Comparator B Low Register (DBGCBL)  
This register contains compare value bits for the low-order eight bits of comparator B. This register is  
forced to 0x00 at reset and can be read at any time or written at any time unless ARM = 1.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
278  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
15.4.3.5 Debug FIFO High Register (DBGFH)  
This register provides read-only access to the high-order eight bits of the FIFO. Writes to this register have  
no meaning or effect. In the event-only trigger modes, the FIFO only stores data into the low-order byte of  
each FIFO word, so this register is not used and will read 0x00.  
Reading DBGFH does not cause the FIFO to shift to the next word. When reading 16-bit words out of the  
FIFO, read DBGFH before reading DBGFL because reading DBGFL causes the FIFO to advance to the  
next word of information.  
15.4.3.6 Debug FIFO Low Register (DBGFL)  
This register provides read-only access to the low-order eight bits of the FIFO. Writes to this register have  
no meaning or effect.  
Reading DBGFL causes the FIFO to shift to the next available word of information. When the debug  
module is operating in event-only modes, only 8-bit data is stored into the FIFO (high-order half of each  
FIFO word is unused). When reading 8-bit words out of the FIFO, simply read DBGFL repeatedly to get  
successive bytes of data from the FIFO. It isn’t necessary to read DBGFH in this case.  
Do not attempt to read data from the FIFO while it is still armed (after arming but before the FIFO is filled  
or ARMF is cleared) because the FIFO is prevented from advancing during reads of DBGFL. This can  
interfere with normal sequencing of reads from the FIFO.  
Reading DBGFL while the debugger is not armed causes the address of the most-recently fetched opcode  
to be stored to the last location in the FIFO. By reading DBGFH then DBGFL periodically, external host  
software can develop a profile of program execution. After eight reads from the FIFO, the ninth read will  
return the information that was stored as a result of the first read. To use the profiling feature, read the FIFO  
eight times without using the data to prime the sequence and then begin using the data to get a delayed  
picture of what addresses were being executed. The information stored into the FIFO on reads of DBGFL  
(while the FIFO is not armed) is the address of the most-recently fetched opcode.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
279  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
15.4.3.7 Debug Control Register (DBGC)  
This register can be read or written at any time.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
DBGEN  
ARM  
TAG  
BRKEN  
RWA  
RWAEN  
RWB  
RWBEN  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 15-7. Debug Control Register (DBGC)  
Table 15-4. DBGC Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Debug Module Enable — Used to enable the debug module. DBGEN cannot be set to 1 if the MCU is secure.  
DBGEN  
0 DBG disabled  
1 DBG enabled  
6
Arm Control — Controls whether the debugger is comparing and storing information in the FIFO. A write is used  
ARM  
to set this bit (and ARMF) and completion of a debug run automatically clears it. Any debug run can be manually  
stopped by writing 0 to ARM or to DBGEN.  
0 Debugger not armed  
1 Debugger armed  
5
TAG  
Tag/Force Select — Controls whether break requests to the CPU will be tag or force type requests. If  
BRKEN = 0, this bit has no meaning or effect.  
0 CPU breaks requested as force type requests  
1 CPU breaks requested as tag type requests  
4
Break Enable — Controls whether a trigger event will generate a break request to the CPU. Trigger events can  
cause information to be stored in the FIFO without generating a break request to the CPU. For an end trace, CPU  
break requests are issued to the CPU when the comparator(s) and R/W meet the trigger requirements. For a  
begin trace, CPU break requests are issued when the FIFO becomes full. TRGSEL does not affect the timing of  
CPU break requests.  
BRKEN  
0 CPU break requests not enabled  
1 Triggers cause a break request to the CPU  
3
R/W Comparison Value for Comparator A — When RWAEN = 1, this bit determines whether a read or a write  
access qualifies comparator A. When RWAEN = 0, RWA and the R/W signal do not affect comparator A.  
0 Comparator A can only match on a write cycle  
RWA  
1 Comparator A can only match on a read cycle  
2
Enable R/W for Comparator A — Controls whether the level of R/W is considered for a comparator A match.  
0 R/W is not used in comparison A  
RWAEN  
1 R/W is used in comparison A  
1
R/W Comparison Value for Comparator B — When RWBEN = 1, this bit determines whether a read or a write  
access qualifies comparator B. When RWBEN = 0, RWB and the R/W signal do not affect comparator B.  
0 Comparator B can match only on a write cycle  
RWB  
1 Comparator B can match only on a read cycle  
0
Enable R/W for Comparator B — Controls whether the level of R/W is considered for a comparator B match.  
0 R/W is not used in comparison B  
RWBEN  
1 R/W is used in comparison B  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
280  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
15.4.3.8 Debug Trigger Register (DBGT)  
This register can be read any time, but may be written only if ARM = 0, except bits 4 and 5 are hard-wired  
to 0s.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
0
TRGSEL  
BEGIN  
TRG3  
TRG2  
TRG1  
TRG0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 15-8. Debug Trigger Register (DBGT)  
Table 15-5. DBGT Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Trigger Type — Controls whether the match outputs from comparators A and B are qualified with the opcode  
tracking logic in the debug module. If TRGSEL is set, a match signal from comparator A or B must propagate  
through the opcode tracking logic and a trigger event is only signalled to the FIFO logic if the opcode at the match  
address is actually executed.  
TRGSEL  
0 Trigger on access to compare address (force)  
1 Trigger if opcode at compare address is executed (tag)  
6
Begin/End Trigger Select — Controls whether the FIFO starts filling at a trigger or fills in a circular manner until  
a trigger ends the capture of information. In event-only trigger modes, this bit is ignored and all debug runs are  
assumed to be begin traces.  
BEGIN  
0 Data stored in FIFO until trigger (end trace)  
1 Trigger initiates data storage (begin trace)  
3:0  
TRG[3:0]  
Select Trigger Mode — Selects one of nine triggering modes, as described below.  
0000 A-only  
0001 A OR B  
0010 A Then B  
0011 Event-only B (store data)  
0100 A then event-only B (store data)  
0101 A AND B data (full mode)  
0110 A AND NOT B data (full mode)  
0111 Inside range: A address B  
1000 Outside range: address < A or address > B  
1001 – 1111 (No trigger)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
281  
Chapter 15 Development Support  
15.4.3.9 Debug Status Register (DBGS)  
This is a read-only status register.  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
AF  
BF  
ARMF  
0
CNT3  
CNT2  
CNT1  
CNT0  
Reset  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved  
Figure 15-9. Debug Status Register (DBGS)  
Table 15-6. DBGS Register Field Descriptions  
Description  
Field  
7
Trigger Match A Flag — AF is cleared at the start of a debug run and indicates whether a trigger match A  
AF  
condition was met since arming.  
0 Comparator A has not matched  
1 Comparator A match  
6
Trigger Match B Flag — BF is cleared at the start of a debug run and indicates whether a trigger match B  
BF  
condition was met since arming.  
0 Comparator B has not matched  
1 Comparator B match  
5
Arm Flag — While DBGEN = 1, this status bit is a read-only image of ARM in DBGC. This bit is set by writing 1  
to the ARM control bit in DBGC (while DBGEN = 1) and is automatically cleared at the end of a debug run. A  
debug run is completed when the FIFO is full (begin trace) or when a trigger event is detected (end trace). A  
debug run can also be ended manually by writing 0 to ARM or DBGEN in DBGC.  
0 Debugger not armed  
ARMF  
1 Debugger armed  
3:0  
CNT[3:0]  
FIFO Valid Count — These bits are cleared at the start of a debug run and indicate the number of words of valid  
data in the FIFO at the end of a debug run. The value in CNT does not decrement as data is read out of the FIFO.  
The external debug host is responsible for keeping track of the count as information is read out of the FIFO.  
0000 Number of valid words in FIFO = No valid data  
0001 Number of valid words in FIFO = 1  
0010 Number of valid words in FIFO = 2  
0011 Number of valid words in FIFO = 3  
0100 Number of valid words in FIFO = 4  
0101 Number of valid words in FIFO = 5  
0110 Number of valid words in FIFO = 6  
0111 Number of valid words in FIFO = 7  
1000 Number of valid words in FIFO = 8  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
282  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A  
Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.1  
Introduction  
This section contains electrical and timing specifications.  
A.2  
Parameter Classification  
The electrical parameters shown in this supplement are guaranteed by various methods. To give you a  
better understanding, the following classification is used and the parameters are tagged accordingly in the  
tables where appropriate:  
Table A-1. Parameter Classifications  
Those parameters are guaranteed during production testing on each individual device.  
P
C
Those parameters are achieved by the design characterization by measuring a statistically relevant  
sample size across process variations.  
Those parameters are achieved by design characterization on a small sample size from typical devices  
under typical conditions unless otherwise noted. All values shown in the typical column are within this  
category.  
T
Those parameters are derived mainly from simulations.  
D
NOTE  
The classification is shown in the column labeled “C” in the parameter  
tables where appropriate.  
A.3  
Absolute Maximum Ratings  
Absolute maximum ratings are stress ratings only, and functional operation at the maxima is not  
guaranteed. Stress beyond the limits specified in Table A-2 may affect device reliability or cause  
permanent damage to the device. For functional operating conditions, refer to the remaining tables in this  
section.  
This device contains circuitry protecting against damage due to high static voltage or electrical fields;  
however, it is advised that normal precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltages higher than  
maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused  
inputs are tied to an appropriate logic voltage level (for instance, either V or V ).  
SS  
DD  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
283  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
Table A-2. Absolute Maximum Ratings  
Rating  
Symbol  
Value  
Unit  
Supply voltage  
Input voltage  
V
–0.3 to + 5.8  
V
V
DD  
V
– 0.3 to VDD + 0.3  
In  
Instantaneous maximum current  
Single pin limit (applies to all port pins)1, 2, 3  
ID  
25  
mA  
Maximum current into V  
Storage temperature  
IDD  
120  
–55 to +150  
150  
mA  
°C  
DD  
T
stg  
TJ  
Maximum junction temperature  
°C  
1
Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required  
current-limiting resistor, calculate resistance values for positive (VDD) and negative (VSS) clamp  
voltages, then use the larger of the two resistance values.  
2
3
All functional non-supply pins are internally clamped to VSS and VDD  
.
Power supply must maintain regulation within operating VDD range during instantaneous and  
operating maximum current conditions. If positive injection current (VIn > VDD) is greater than  
IDD, the injection current may flow out of VDD and could result in external power supply going  
out of regulation. Ensure external VDD load will shunt current greater than maximum injection  
current. This will be the greatest risk when the MCU is not consuming power. Examples are: if  
no system clock is present, or if the clock rate is very low which would reduce overall power  
consumption.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
284  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.4  
Thermal Characteristics  
This section provides information about operating temperature range, power dissipation, and package  
thermal resistance. Power dissipation on I/O pins is usually small compared to the power dissipation in  
on-chip logic and it is user-determined rather than being controlled by the MCU design. In order to take  
P
into account in power calculations, determine the difference between actual pin voltage and V or  
I/O  
SS  
V
and multiply by the pin current for each I/O pin. Except in cases of unusually high pin current (heavy  
DD  
loads), the difference between pin voltage and V or V will be very small.  
SS  
DD  
Table A-3. Thermal Characteristics  
Rating  
Symbol  
Value  
Unit  
Thermal resistance 1,2,3,4  
64-pin QFP  
1s  
2s2p  
57  
43  
64-pin LQFP  
48-pin QFN  
44-pin LQFP  
1s  
2s2p  
69  
54  
θJA  
°C/W  
1s  
2s2p  
84  
27  
1s  
2s2p  
73  
56  
1
Junction temperature is a function of die size, on-chip power dissipation, package thermal  
resistance, mounting site (board) temperature, ambient temperature, air flow, power dissipation  
of other components on the board, and board thermal resistance.  
2
3
4
Junction to Ambient Natural Convection  
1s - Single Layer Board, one signal layer  
2s2p - Four Layer Board, 2 signal and 2 power layers  
The average chip-junction temperature (T ) in °C can be obtained from:  
J
T = T + (P × θ  
)
Eqn. A-1  
J
A
D
JA  
where:  
T = Ambient temperature, °C  
A
θ = Package thermal resistance, junction-to-ambient, °C/W  
JA  
P = P + P  
D
int  
I/O  
P = I × V , Watts — chip internal power  
int  
DD  
DD  
P
= Power dissipation on input and output pins — user determined  
I/O  
For most applications, P << P and can be neglected. An approximate relationship between P and T  
J
I/O  
int  
D
(if P is neglected) is:  
I/O  
P = K ÷ (T + 273°C)  
Eqn. A-2  
D
J
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
285  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
Solving equations 1 and 2 for K gives:  
2
K = P × (T + 273°C) + θ × (P )  
Eqn. A-3  
D
A
JA  
D
where K is a constant pertaining to the particular part. K can be determined from equation 3 by measuring  
P (at equilibrium) for a known T . Using this value of K, the values of P and T can be obtained by  
D
A
D
J
solving equations 1 and 2 iteratively for any value of T .  
A
A.5  
ESD Protection and Latch-Up Immunity  
Although damage from electrostatic discharge (ESD) is much less common on these devices than on early  
CMOS circuits, normal handling precautions should be used to avoid exposure to static discharge.  
Qualification tests are performed to ensure that these devices can withstand exposure to reasonable levels  
of static without suffering any permanent damage.  
All ESD testing is in conformity with AEC-Q100 Stress Test Qualification for Automotive Grade  
Integrated Circuits. During the device qualification ESD stresses were performed for the Human Body  
Model (HBM), the Machine Model (MM) and the Charge Device Model (CDM).  
A device is defined as a failure if after exposure to ESD pulses the device no longer meets the device  
specification. Complete DC parametric and functional testing is performed per the applicable device  
specification at room temperature followed by hot temperature, unless specified otherwise in the device  
specification.  
Table A-4. ESD and Latch-up Test Conditions  
Model  
Description  
Symbol  
Value  
Unit  
Ω
Series Resistance  
R1  
1500  
Human Body  
Model  
Storage Capacitance  
C
100  
3
pF  
Number of Pulse per pin  
Series Resistance  
R1  
0
Ω
Machine Model  
Latch-Up  
Storage Capacitance  
C
200  
3
pF  
Number of Pulse per pin  
Minimum input voltage limit  
Maximum input voltage limit  
–2.5  
7.5  
V
V
Table A-5. ESD and Latch-Up Protection Characteristics  
Num C  
Rating  
Symbol  
VHBM  
VMM  
Min  
2000  
200  
500  
100  
Max  
Unit  
1
2
3
4
C Human Body Model (HBM)  
V
V
C Machine Model (MM)  
VCDM  
ILAT  
C Charge Device Model (CDM)  
V
Latch-up Current at TA = 125°C  
C
mA  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
286  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.6  
DC Characteristics  
This section includes information about power supply requirements, I/O pin characteristics, and power  
supply current in various operating modes.  
Table A-6. MCU Operating Conditions  
Uni  
Characteristic  
Min  
Typ  
Max  
t
Supply Voltage  
Temperature  
2.7  
5.5  
V
°C  
M
V
C
–40  
–40  
-40  
125  
105  
85  
Table A-7. DC Characteristics  
Num C  
Parameter  
Symbol  
Min  
Typ1  
Max  
Unit  
Output high voltage — Low Drive (PTxDSn = 0)  
5 V, ILoad = –2 mA  
VDD – 1.5  
3 V, ILoad = –0.6 mA  
5 V, ILoad = –0.4 mA  
3 V, ILoad = –0.24 mA  
VDD – 1.5  
VDD – 0.8  
VDD – 0.8  
1
P
VOH  
V
Output high voltage — High Drive (PTxDSn = 1)  
5 V, ILoad = –10 mA  
VDD – 1.5  
VDD – 1.5  
VDD – 0.8  
VDD – 0.8  
3 V, ILoad = –3 mA  
5 V, ILoad = –2 mA  
3 V, ILoad = –0.4 mA  
Output low voltage — Low Drive (PTxDSn = 0)  
5 V, ILoad = 2 mA  
1.5  
1.5  
0.8  
0.8  
3 V, ILoad = 0.6 mA  
5 V, ILoad = 0.4 mA  
3 V, ILoad = 0.24 mA  
2
P
VOL  
V
Output low voltage — High Drive (PTxDSn = 1)  
5 V, ILoad = 10 mA  
1.5  
1.5  
0.8  
0.8  
3 V, ILoad = 3 mA  
5 V, ILoad = 2 mA  
3 V, ILoad = 0.4 mA  
3
4
D Output high current — Max total IOH for all ports  
5V IOHT  
3V  
100  
60  
mA  
mA  
V
D Output low current — Max total IOL for all ports  
5V IOLT  
3V  
100  
60  
5
6
7
8
P Input high voltage; all digital inputs  
P Input low voltage; all digital inputs  
T Input hysteresis; all digital inputs  
P Input leakage current; input only pins2  
VIH  
VIL  
0.65 x VDD  
0.06 x VDD  
0.35 x VDD  
Vhys  
|IIn|  
mV  
0.01  
1
μA  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
287  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
Table A-7. DC Characteristics (continued)  
Num C  
Parameter  
Symbol  
|IOZ  
Min  
Typ1  
Max  
Unit  
9
P High Impedance (off-state) leakage current2  
|
20  
20  
0.01  
45  
1
65  
65  
8
µA  
kΩ  
kΩ  
pF  
V
10 P Internal pullup resistors3  
RPU  
RPD  
CIn  
11 P Internal pulldown resistors4  
12 C Input Capacitance; all non-supply pins  
13 P POR rearm voltage  
45  
VPOR  
tPOR  
0.9  
10  
1.4  
2.0  
14 D POR rearm time  
µs  
15 P Low-voltage detection threshold — high range  
VDD falling VLVDH  
DD rising  
4.2  
4.3  
4.3  
4.4  
4.4  
4.5  
V
V
V
V
V
Low-voltage detection threshold — low range  
DD falling VLVDL  
DD rising  
16  
17  
18  
19  
P
P
P
P
V
V
2.48  
2.54  
2.56  
2.62  
2.64  
2.7  
Low-voltage warning threshold — high range  
DD falling VLVWH  
DD rising  
V
V
4.2  
4.3  
4.3  
4.4  
4.4  
4.5  
Low-voltage warning threshold — low range  
DD falling VLVWL  
DD rising  
V
V
2.48  
2.54  
2.56  
2.62  
2.64  
2.7  
Low-voltage inhibit reset/recover hysteresis  
5V Vhys  
3V  
100  
60  
mV  
V
20 P Bandgap Voltage Reference  
VBG  
1.185  
1.20  
1.215  
Factory trimmed at  
DD = 5.0 V  
Temp = 25 °C  
V
5, 6, 7, 8  
21 D dc injection current  
DC Injection Current  
Single pin limit  
V
IN > VDD  
VIN < VSS  
Total MCU limit, includes sum of all stressed pins  
IN > VDD  
VIN < VSS  
0
0
-
-
2
–0.2  
mA  
mA  
|IIC|  
V
0
0
-
-
25  
–5  
mA  
mA  
1
2
3
4
5
Typical values are based on characterization data at 25°C unless otherwise stated.  
Measured with VIn = VDD or VSS  
Measured with VIn = VSS  
Measured with VIn = VDD  
.
.
.
Power supply must maintain regulation within operating VDD range during instantaneous and operating  
maximum current conditions. If positive injection current (VIn > VDD) is greater than IDD, the injection current  
may flow out of VDD and could result in external power supply going out of regulation. Ensure external VDD  
load will shunt current greater than maximum injection current. This will be the greatest risk when the MCU  
is not consuming power. Examples are: if no system clock is present, or if clock rate is very low which (would  
reduce overall power consumption).  
6
7
All functional non-supply pins are internally clamped to VSS and VDD  
.
Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required current-limiting  
resistor, calculate resistance values for positive and negative clamp voltages, then use the larger of the two  
values.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
288  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
8
IRQ does not have a clamp diode to VDD. Do not drive IRQ above VDD  
.
0.7  
0.6  
0.5  
0.4  
0.3  
0.2  
0.1  
0
0.8  
0.7  
0.6  
0.5  
0.4  
0.3  
0.2  
125ºC  
85ºC  
25ºC  
40ºC  
125ºC  
85ºC  
25ºC  
40ºC  
IOL = 2mA  
VDD = 5V  
0.2  
0.6  
1.2  
1.6  
2.0  
2.4  
3.0  
2.75 3.0 3.25 3.5 3.75 4.0 4.25 4.5 4.75 5.0 5.25 5.5  
I
OL (mA)  
VDD (V)  
Figure A-1. Typical Low-Side Driver (Sink) Characteristics — Low Drive (PTxDS = 0)  
n
0.9  
0.8  
0.7  
0.6  
0.5  
0.4  
0.3  
0.2  
0.1  
0
1.4  
1.3  
125ºC  
85ºC  
25ºC  
40ºC  
125ºC  
IOL = +10mA  
85ºC  
25ºC  
40ºC  
1.2  
1.1  
1.0  
0.9  
0.8  
0.7  
0.6  
0.5  
0.4  
VDD = 5V  
0.2 1.2 1.6 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0  
3.0  
4.0  
5.0  
IOL (mA)  
V
DD (V)  
Figure A-2. Typical Low-Side Driver (Sink) Characteristics — High Drive (PTxDS = 1)  
n
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
289  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
1.2  
1.4  
1.2  
1.0  
0.8  
0.6  
0.4  
0.2  
0
125ºC  
85ºC  
25ºC  
40ºC  
125ºC  
85ºC  
25ºC  
40ºC  
1.0  
0.8  
0.6  
0.4  
0.2  
0
VDD = 5V  
IOH = -2mA  
0.2  
0.6  
1.2  
1.6  
IOH (mA)  
2.0  
2.4  
3.0  
2.75 3.0 3.25 3.5 3.75 4.0 4.25 4.5 4.75 5.0 5.25 5.5  
VDD (V)  
Figure A-3. Typical High-Side (Source) Characteristics — Low Drive (PTxDS = 0)  
n
1.2  
1.0  
0.8  
0.6  
0.4  
0.2  
0
1.5  
1.4  
125ºC  
85ºC  
25ºC  
40ºC  
125ºC  
85ºC  
25ºC  
40ºC  
1.3  
1.2  
1.1  
1.0  
0.9  
0.8  
0.7  
0.6  
VDD = 5V  
IOH = -10mA  
0.2 1.2 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0  
3.0  
4.0  
5.0  
IOH (mA)  
VDD (V)  
Figure A-4. Typical High-Side (Source) Characteristics — High Drive (PTxDSn = 1)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
290  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.7  
Supply Current Characteristics  
Table A-8. Supply Current Characteristics  
VDD  
(V)  
Temp  
(°C)  
Typ1  
Num  
C
Parameter  
Symbol  
Max  
Unit  
Run supply current2 measured at  
(CPU clock = 2 MHz, fBus = 1 MHz)  
5
3
5
3
5
3
0.750  
0.570  
4.90  
3.50  
16.8  
11.5  
0.950  
0.770  
5.10  
3.70  
18.5  
12.5  
1
P
RIDD  
mA  
–40 to 125°C  
–40 to 125°C  
–40 to 125°C  
Run supply current2 measured at  
(CPU clock = 16 MHz, fBus = 8 MHz)  
2
3
P
P
RIDD  
mA  
mA  
Run supply current3 measured at (CPU  
clock = 40 MHz, fBus = 20 MHz)  
RIDD  
Stop2 mode supply current  
18.0  
60  
–40 to 85°C  
–40 to 125°C  
5
3
0.900  
0.720  
μA  
μA  
4
5
6
P
P
C
17.0  
50  
–40 to 85°C  
–40 to 125°C  
S2IDD  
Stop3 mode supply current  
20.0  
90  
–40 to 85°C  
–40 to 125°C  
5
0.975  
μA  
S3IDD  
19.0  
85  
–40 to 85°C  
–40 to 125°C  
3
5
0.825  
300  
μA  
500  
500  
–40 to 85°C  
–40 to 125°C  
nA  
RTI adder to stop2 or stop34  
S23IDDRTI  
500  
500  
–40 to 85°C  
–40 to 125°C  
3
300  
nA  
5
3
110  
90  
180  
160  
μA  
μA  
–40 to 125°C  
–40 to 125°C  
7
8
C
C
LVD adder to stop3 (LVDE = LVDSE = 1)  
S3IDDLVD  
Adder to stop3 for oscillator enabled  
(OSCSTEN =1)5  
5,3  
5
8
μA  
–40 to 125°C  
S3IDDOSC  
1
Typical values are based on characterization data at 25°C unless otherwise stated. See Figure A-5 through Figure A-7 for  
typical curves across voltage/temperature.  
2
3
4
All modules except ADC enabled, but not active. ICG configured for FBE. Does not include any DC loads on port pins.  
All modules except ADC active, ICG configured for FBE and does not include any DC loads on port pins  
Most customers are expected to find that auto-wakeup from stop2 or stop3 can be used instead of the higher current wait  
mode. Wait mode typical is 500 μA at 5 V with fBus = 1 MHz.  
Values given under the following conditions: low range operation (RANGE = 0) with a 32.768 kHz crystal, low power mode  
(HGO = 0), clock monitor disabled (LOCD = 1).  
5
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
291  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
24.0  
20 MHz – FEI Clock Mode, ADC Module Off  
22.0  
20.0  
18.0  
16.0  
14.0  
12.0  
10.0  
8.0  
20 MHz – FBE Clock Mode, ADC Module Off  
8 MHz – FEI Clock Mode, ADC Module Off  
8 MHz – FBE Clock Mode, ADC Module Off  
1 MHz – FEI Clock Mode, ADC Module Off  
1 MHz – FBE Clock Mode, ADC Module Off  
6.0  
4.0  
2.0  
0
2.7 2.9 3.1 3.3 3.5 3.7 3.9 4.1 4.3 4.5 4.7 4.9 5.1 5.3 5.5  
VDD (V)  
Note: All modules except ADC active.  
Figure A-5. Typical Run I for FBE and FEI Modes, I vs. V  
DD  
DD  
DD  
Stop2 I (A)  
DD  
Average of Meas I  
DD  
4.000E–05  
3.500E–05  
3.000E–05  
2.500E–05  
Temp  
–40  
2.000E–05  
1.500E–05  
1.000E–05  
25  
85  
125  
5.000E–06  
0.000E+00  
1.8  
3.5  
(V)  
4.5  
2
2.5  
3
4
5
V
DD  
Figure A-6. Typical Stop 2 I  
DD  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
292  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
Stop3 I (A)  
DD  
Average of Meas I  
DD  
50.0E–6  
45.0E–6  
40.0E–6  
35.0E–6  
30.0E–6  
25.0E–6  
20.0E–6  
15.0E–6  
10.0E–6  
Temp  
–40  
25  
85  
125  
5.0E–6  
000.0E+0  
1.8  
3.5  
(V)  
4.5  
2
2.5  
3
4
5
V
DD  
Figure A-7. Typical Stop3 I  
DD  
A.8  
ADC Characteristics  
Table A-9. 5 Volt 10-bit ADC Operating Conditions  
Characteristic  
Supply voltage  
Conditions  
Symb  
Min  
Typ1  
Max  
Unit  
Absolute  
Delta to VDD (VDD–VDDAD  
VDDAD  
ΔVDDAD  
ΔVSSAD  
VREFH  
2.7  
–100  
–100  
2.7  
5.5  
V
mV  
mV  
V
2
)
0
0
+100  
+100  
VDDAD  
2
Ground voltage  
Ref voltage high  
Delta to VSS (VSS–VSSAD)  
VDDAD  
Ref voltage low  
VREFL  
VSSAD  
VSSAD  
VSSAD  
V
Input voltage  
VADIN  
CADIN  
RADIN  
RAS  
VREFL  
4.5  
3
VREFH  
5.5  
V
Input capacitance  
Input resistance  
pF  
kΩ  
kΩ  
5
Analog source resistance  
External to MCU  
10-bit mode  
fADCK > 4MHz  
ADCK < 4MHz  
5
10  
f
8-bit mode (all valid fADCK  
High speed (ADLPC = 0)  
Low power (ADLPC = 1)  
)
10  
8.0  
4.0  
ADC conversion clock frequency  
fADCK  
0.4  
0.4  
MHz  
1
2
Typical values assume VDDAD = 5.0 V, Temp = 25°C, fADCK = 1.0MHz unless otherwise stated. Typical values are for reference  
only and are not tested in production.  
dc potential difference.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
293  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
SIMPLIFIED  
INPUT PIN EQUIVALENT  
CIRCUIT  
Z
ADIN  
SIMPLIFIED  
CHANNEL SELECT  
CIRCUIT  
Pad  
Z
AS  
leakage  
due to  
input  
ADC SAR  
ENGINE  
R
R
AS  
ADIN  
protection  
+
V
ADIN  
C
AS  
V
+
AS  
R
ADIN  
INPUT PIN  
INPUT PIN  
INPUT PIN  
R
ADIN  
R
ADIN  
C
ADIN  
Figure A-8. ADC Input Impedance Equivalency Diagram  
Table A-10. 10-bit ADC Characteristics (V  
= V  
, V  
= V  
)
SSAD  
REFH  
DDAD REFL  
Characteristic  
Conditions  
C
Symb  
Min  
Typ1  
Max  
Unit  
Supply current  
ADLPC = 1  
ADLSMP = 1  
ADCO = 1  
T
IDDAD  
IDDAD  
IDDAD  
IDDAD  
IDDAD  
133  
μA  
Supply current  
ADLPC = 1  
ADLSMP = 0  
ADCO = 1  
T
T
P
218  
327  
μA  
μA  
μA  
μA  
Supply current  
ADLPC = 0  
ADLSMP = 1  
ADCO = 1  
Supply current  
ADLPC = 0  
ADLSMP = 0  
ADCO = 1  
V
DDAD < 5.5 V  
582  
990  
1
Supply current  
Stop, reset,  
module off  
0.011  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
294  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
Table A-10. 10-bit ADC Characteristics (V  
= V  
, V  
= V  
) (continued)  
SSAD  
REFH  
DDAD REFL  
Characteristic  
Conditions  
High speed  
C
Symb  
Min  
Typ1  
3.3  
Max  
Unit  
ADC asynchronous clock  
source  
tADACK = 1/fADACK  
P
P
P
fADACK  
2
1.25  
5
MHzS  
(ADLPC = 0)  
Low power  
(ADLPC = 1)  
2
20  
3.3  
Conversion time  
(Including sample time)  
Short sample  
(ADLSMP = 0)  
tADC  
ADCK  
cycles  
Long sample  
(ADLSMP = 1)  
40  
Sample time  
Short sample  
(ADLSMP = 0)  
tADS  
3.5  
23.5  
ADCK  
cycles  
Long sample  
(ADLSMP = 1)  
Total unadjusted error  
Includes quantization  
10-bit mode  
8-bit mode  
10-bit mode  
8-bit mode  
P
P
ETUE  
DNL  
1
2.5  
1.0  
1.0  
0.5  
LSB2  
LSB2  
0.5  
0.5  
0.3  
Differential non-linearity  
Monotonicity and no-missing-codes guaranteed  
Integral non-linearity  
Zero-scale error  
10-bit mode  
8-bit mode  
10-bit mode  
8-bit mode  
10-bit mode  
8-bit mode  
10-bit mode  
8-bit mode  
10-bit mode  
8-bit mode  
-40°C - 25°C  
25°C - 125°C  
25°C  
C
P
P
D
D
INL  
EZS  
EFS  
EQ  
0.5  
0.3  
1.0  
0.5  
1.5  
0.5  
1.5  
0.5  
0.5  
0.5  
2.5  
1
LSB2  
LSB2  
LSB2  
LSB2  
LSB2  
mV/°C  
0.5  
VADIN = VSSA  
0.5  
Full-scale error  
ADIN = VDDA  
0.5  
V
0.5  
Quantization error  
Input leakage error  
Pad leakage3 * RAS  
EIL  
0.2  
0.1  
3.266  
3.638  
1.396  
Temp sensor slope  
Temp sensor voltage  
T
m
V
V
TEMP25  
P
1
Typical values assume VDDAD = 5.0V, Temp = 25C, fADCK=1.0 MHz unless otherwise stated. Typical values are for  
reference only and are not tested in production.  
2
3
1 LSB = (VREFH – VREFL)/2N  
Based on input pad leakage current. Refer to pad electricals.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
295  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.9  
Internal Clock Generation Module Characteristics  
ICG  
EXTAL  
XTAL  
RS  
R
F
Crystal or Resonator  
C
1
C
2
Table A-11. ICG DC Electrical Specifications (Temperature Range = –40 to 125°C Ambient)  
Characteristic  
Symbol  
Min  
Typ1  
Max  
Unit  
Load capacitors  
Feedback resistor  
C1  
C2  
See Note 2  
Low range (32k to 100 kHz)  
High range (1M – 16 MHz)  
RF  
10  
1
MΩ  
MΩ  
Series resistor  
Low range  
Low Gain (HGO = 0)  
High Gain (HGO = 1)  
High range  
0
100  
RS  
kΩ  
Low Gain (HGO = 0)  
High Gain (HGO = 1)  
8 MHz  
0
0
10  
20  
4 MHz  
1 MHz  
1
2
Typical values are based on characterization data at VDD = 5.0V, 25°C or is typical recommended value.  
See crystal or resonator manufacturer’s recommendation.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
296  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.9.1  
ICG Frequency Specifications  
Table A-12. ICG Frequency Specifications  
(min) to V (max), Temperature Range = –40 to 125°C Ambient)  
(V  
= V  
DDA  
DDA  
DDA  
Num  
C
Characteristic  
Symbol  
Min  
Typ1  
Max  
Unit  
Oscillator crystal or resonator (REFS = 1)  
(Fundamental mode crystal or ceramic resonator)  
Low range  
flo  
32  
100  
kHz  
High range  
1
T
High Gain, FBE (HGO = 1,CLKS = 10)  
High Gain, FEE (HGO = 1,CLKS = 11)  
Low Power, FBE (HGO = 0, CLKS = 10)  
Low Power, FEE (HGO = 0, CLKS = 11)  
fhi_byp  
fhi_eng  
flp_byp  
flp_eng  
1
2
1
2
16  
10  
8
MHz  
MHz  
MHz  
MHz  
8
Input clock frequency (CLKS = 11, REFS = 0)  
flo  
fhi_eng  
Low range  
High range  
2
T
32  
2
100  
10  
kHz  
MHz  
fExtal  
fICGIRCLK  
tdc  
3
4
5
T
P
P
0
243  
40  
303.75  
60  
MHz  
kHz  
%
Input clock frequency (CLKS = 10, REFS = 0)  
Internal reference frequency (untrimmed)  
Duty cycle of input clock (REFS = 0)  
182.25  
40  
Output clock ICGOUT frequency  
CLKS = 10, REFS = 0  
All other cases  
f
Extal (max)  
fExtal (min)  
flo (min)  
fICGOUT  
6
P
fICGDCLKmax MHz  
(max)  
Minimum DCO clock (ICGDCLK) frequency  
Maximum DCO clock (ICGDCLK) frequency  
Self-clock mode (ICGOUT) frequency 2  
Self-clock mode reset (ICGOUT) frequency  
fICGDCLKmin  
fICGDCLKmax  
fSelf  
7
8
8
MHz  
40  
MHz  
MHz  
MHz  
fICGDCLKmin  
5.5  
fICGDCLKmax  
9
P
P
fSelf_reset  
10  
8
10.5  
Loss of reference frequency 3  
Low range  
High range  
Loss of DCO frequency 4  
Crystal start-up time 5, 6  
Low range  
fLOR  
fLOD  
11  
12  
13  
T
T
T
5
50  
25  
500  
kHz  
0.5  
1.5  
MHz  
t
CSTL  
430  
4
t
ms  
ms  
CSTH  
High range  
7
FLL lock time  
Low range  
High range  
tLockl  
tLockh  
14  
P
5
5
FLL frequency unlock range  
FLL frequency lock range  
nUnlock  
nLock  
15  
16  
T
T
–4*N  
–2*N  
4*N  
2*N  
counts  
counts  
ICGOUT period jitter, 8 measured at fICGOUT Max  
Long term jitter (averaged over 2 ms interval)  
CJitter  
17  
18  
T
T
% fICG  
V
0.2  
Oscillator Amplitude (peak-to-peak)  
Voscamp  
HGO = 0  
HGO = 1  
1
VDD  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
297  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
Table A-12. ICG Frequency Specifications (continued)  
(min) to V (max), Temperature Range = –40 to 125°C Ambient)  
(V  
= V  
DDA  
DDA  
DDA  
Num  
C
Characteristic  
Symbol  
Min  
Typ1  
Max  
Unit  
MC9S08AWxx: Internal oscillator deviation from trimmed frequency9  
VDD = 2.7 – 5.5 V, (constant temperature)  
ACCint  
0.5  
0.5  
C
P
2
2
%
%
VDD = 5.0 V 10%, –40° C to 125°C  
19  
S9S08AWxx: Internal oscillator deviation from trimmed frequency9  
VDD = 2.7 – 5.5 V, (constant temperature)  
ACCint  
0.5  
C
P
P
1.5  
1.5  
2
%
%
%
VDD = 5.0 V 10%, –40° C to 85°C  
VDD = 5.0 V 10%, –40° C to 125°C  
0.5  
0.5  
1
2
3
Typical values are based on characterization data at VDD = 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.  
Self-clocked mode frequency is the frequency that the DCO generates when the FLL is open-loop.  
Loss of reference frequency is the reference frequency detected internally, which transitions the ICG into self-clocked mode if it  
is not in the desired range.  
4
Loss of DCO frequency is the DCO frequency detected internally, which transitions the ICG into FLL bypassed external mode  
(if an external reference exists) if it is not in the desired range.  
5
6
7
This parameter is characterized before qualification rather than 100% tested.  
Proper PC board layout procedures must be followed to achieve specifications.  
This specification applies to the period of time required for the FLL to lock after entering FLL engaged internal or external modes.  
If a crystal/resonator is being used as the reference, this specification assumes it is already running.  
8
Jitter is the average deviation from the programmed frequency measured over the specified interval at maximum fICGOUT  
.
Measurements are made with the device powered by filtered supplies and clocked by a stable external clock signal. Noise  
injected into the FLL circuitry via VDDA and VSSA and variation in crystal oscillator frequency increase the CJitter percentage for  
a given interval.  
9
See Figure A-9.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
298  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
Internal Oscillator Deviation from Trimmed Frequency  
Variable  
5 V  
0.0  
–0.5  
–1.0  
3 V  
–1.5  
–2.0  
–50  
–25  
0
25  
50  
Temp  
75  
100  
125  
Device trimmed at 25°C at 3.0 V.  
Figure A-9. Internal Oscillator Deviation from Trimmed Frequency  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
299  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.10 AC Characteristics  
This section describes ac timing characteristics for each peripheral system. For detailed information about  
how clocks for the bus are generated, see Chapter 8, “Internal Clock Generator (S08ICGV4).”  
A.10.1 Control Timing  
Table A-13. Control Timing  
Num  
C
Parameter  
Bus frequency (tcyc = 1/fBus  
Symbol  
fBus  
Min  
dc  
Typ1  
Max  
20  
Unit  
MHz  
μs  
1
2
3
)
P
tRTI  
Real-time interrupt internal oscillator period  
External reset pulse width2  
700  
1300  
1.5 x  
tSelf_reset  
textrst  
ns  
(tcyc = 1/fSelf_reset  
)
Reset low drive3  
4
trstdrv  
tMSSU  
tMSH  
34 x tcyc  
25  
ns  
ns  
ns  
5
Active background debug mode latch setup time  
Active background debug mode latch hold time  
6
25  
IRQ pulse width  
Asynchronous path2  
Synchronous path4  
tILIH, IHIL  
t
100  
1.5 x tcyc  
ns  
ns  
7
8
KBIPx pulse width  
Asynchronous path2  
Synchronous path3  
tILIH, IHIL  
t
100  
1.5 x tcyc  
Port rise and fall time —  
Low output drive (PTxDS = 0) (load = 50 pF)5  
Slew rate control disabled (PTxSE = 0)  
Slew rate control enabled (PTxSE = 1)  
tRise, tFall  
ns  
ns  
40  
75  
9
T
Port rise and fall time —  
High output drive (PTxDS = 1) (load = 50 pF)  
Slew rate control disabled (PTxSE = 0)  
Slew rate control enabled (PTxSE = 1)  
tRise, tFall  
11  
35  
1
2
Typical values are based on characterization data at VDD = 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.  
This is the shortest pulse that is guaranteed to be recognized as a reset pin request. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to  
override reset requests from internal sources.  
3
4
5
When any reset is initiated, internal circuitry drives the reset pin low for about 34 bus cycles and then samples the level on  
the reset pin about 38 bus cycles later to distinguish external reset requests from internal requests.  
This is the minimum pulse width that is guaranteed to pass through the pin synchronization circuitry. Shorter pulses may or  
may not be recognized. In stop mode, the synchronizer is bypassed so shorter pulses can be recognized in that case.  
Timing is shown with respect to 20% VDD and 80% VDD levels. Temperature range –40°C to 125°C.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
300  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
1300  
1250  
1200  
1150  
1100  
1050  
1000  
950  
+3 SD  
Mean  
–3 SD  
900  
850  
800  
–40  
–20  
0
20  
40  
60  
80  
100  
120  
Temperature (ºC)  
Figure A-10. Typical RTI Clock Period vs. Temperature  
t
extrst  
RESET PIN  
Figure A-11. Reset Timing  
BKGD/MS  
RESET  
t
MSH  
t
MSSU  
Figure A-12. Active Background Debug Mode Latch Timing  
t
IHIL  
IRQ/KBIP7-KBIP4  
IRQ/KBIPx  
t
ILIH  
Figure A-13. IRQ/KBIPx Timing  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
301  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.10.2 Timer/PWM (TPM) Module Timing  
Synchronizer circuits determine the shortest input pulses that can be recognized or the fastest clock that  
can be used as the optional external source to the timer counter. These synchronizers operate from the  
current bus rate clock.  
Table A-14. TPM Input Timing  
Function  
External clock frequency  
External clock period  
Symbol  
fTPMext  
tTPMext  
tclkh  
Min  
dc  
Max  
fBus/4  
Unit  
Hz  
tcyc  
tcyc  
tcyc  
tcyc  
4
External clock high time  
External clock low time  
Input capture pulse width  
1.5  
1.5  
1.5  
tclkl  
tICPW  
t
TPMext  
t
clkh  
TPMxCLK  
t
clkl  
Figure A-14. Timer External Clock  
t
ICPW  
TPMxCHn  
TPMxCHn  
t
ICPW  
Figure A-15. Timer Input Capture Pulse  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
302  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.11 SPI Characteristics  
Table A-15 and Figure A-16 through Figure A-19 describe the timing requirements for the SPI system.  
Table A-15. SPI Electrical Characteristic  
Num1  
C
Characteristic2  
Symbol  
Min  
Max  
Unit  
Operating frequency3  
Master  
Slave  
Hz  
f
/2048  
dc  
f
f
/2  
/4  
f
Bus  
Bus  
Bus  
op  
f
op  
1
2
Cycle time  
Master  
Slave  
2
4
2048  
tcyc  
tcyc  
tSCK  
tSCK  
Enable lead time  
Master  
Slave  
1/2  
t
t
1/2  
t
t
Lead  
Lead  
SCK  
SCK  
3
Enable lag time  
Master  
Slave  
1/2  
t
t
1/2  
t
t
Lag  
Lag  
SCK  
SCK  
4
5
6
Clock (SPSCK) high time  
Master and Slave  
1/2 tSCK – 25  
1/2 tSCK – 25  
ns  
ns  
t
SCKH  
Clock (SPSCK) low time Master  
and Slave  
t
SCKL  
Data setup time (inputs)  
Master  
Slave  
30  
30  
ns  
ns  
t
t
SI(M)  
SI(S)  
7
Data hold time (inputs)  
Master  
Slave  
30  
30  
ns  
ns  
t
t
HI(M)  
HI(S)  
8
9
Access time, slave4  
Disable time, slave5  
0
40  
40  
ns  
ns  
t
A
t
dis  
10  
Data setup time (outputs)  
Master  
Slave  
25  
25  
ns  
ns  
t
t
SO  
SO  
11  
Data hold time (outputs)  
Master  
Slave  
–10  
–10  
ns  
ns  
t
t
HO  
HO  
1
2
Refer to Figure A-16 through Figure A-19.  
All timing is shown with respect to 20% V  
and 70% V , unless noted; 100 pF load on all SPI  
DD  
DD  
pins. All timing assumes slew rate control disabled and high drive strength enabled for SPI output  
pins.  
3
4
5
Maximum baud rate must be limited to 5 MHz due to pad input characteristics.  
Time to data active from high-impedance state.  
Hold time to high-impedance state.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
303  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
1
SS  
(OUTPUT)  
1
2
3
SCK  
(CPOL = 0)  
(OUTPUT)  
5
4
4
5
SCK  
(CPOL = 1)  
(OUTPUT)  
6
7
MISO  
(INPUT)  
2
MSB IN  
10  
BIT 6 . . . 1  
LSB IN  
10  
11  
MOSI  
(OUTPUT)  
2
BIT 6 . . . 1  
LSB OUT  
MSB OUT  
NOTES:  
1. SS output mode (MODFEN = 1, SSOE = 1).  
2. LSBF = 0. For LSBF = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1, ..., bit 6, MSB.  
Figure A-16. SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 0)  
(1)  
SS  
(OUTPUT)  
1
2
3
SCK  
(CPOL = 0)  
(OUTPUT)  
5
4
SCK  
(CPOL = 1)  
5
4
(OUTPUT)  
6
7
MISO  
(INPUT)  
(2)  
MSB IN  
BIT 6 . . . 1  
11  
BIT 6 . . . 1  
LSB IN  
10  
MOSI  
(OUTPUT)  
(2)  
LSB OUT  
MSB OUT  
NOTES:  
1. SS output mode (MODFEN = 1, SSOE = 1).  
2. LSBF = 0. For LSBF = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1, ..., bit 6, MSB.  
Figure A-17. SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 1)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
304  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
SS  
(INPUT)  
3
1
SCK  
5
4
(CPOL = 0)  
4
5
(INPUT)  
2
SCK  
(CPOL = 1)  
(INPUT)  
9
8
11  
10  
MISO  
(OUTPUT)  
SEE  
NOTE  
BIT 6 . . . 1  
BIT 6 . . . 1  
SLAVE LSB OUT  
MSB OUT  
7
SLAVE  
6
MOSI  
(INPUT)  
MSB IN  
LSB IN  
NOTE:  
1. Not defined but normally MSB of character just received  
Figure A-18. SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 0)  
SS  
(INPUT)  
1
3
2
SCK  
(CPOL = 0)  
(INPUT)  
5
4
SCK  
(CPOL = 1)  
5
4
(INPUT)  
10  
11  
9
MISO  
(OUTPUT)  
SEE  
BIT 6 . . . 1  
SLAVE LSB OUT  
LSB IN  
SLAVE MSB OUT  
NOTE  
6
7
8
MOSI  
(INPUT)  
MSB IN  
BIT 6 . . . 1  
NOTE:  
1. Not defined but normally LSB of character just received  
Figure A-19. SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 1)  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
305  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.12 FLASH Specifications  
This section provides details about program/erase times and program-erase endurance for the FLASH  
memory.  
Program and erase operations do not require any special power sources other than the normal V supply.  
DD  
For more detailed information about program/erase operations, see Chapter 4, “Memory.”  
Table A-16. FLASH Characteristics  
Num  
C
P
P
P
P
Characteristic  
Symbol  
Vprog/erase  
VRead  
fFCLK  
Min  
2.7  
2.7  
150  
5
Typ1  
Max  
5.5  
Unit  
1
2
3
4
Supply voltage for program/erase  
Supply voltage for read operation  
V
5.5  
V
Internal FCLK frequency2  
200  
6.67  
kHz  
μs  
tFcyc  
Internal FCLK period (1/FCLK)  
Byte program time (random location)3  
Byte program time (burst mode)3  
Page erase time3  
tprog  
tFcyc  
tFcyc  
tFcyc  
tFcyc  
5
P
9
4
6
C
tBurst  
tPage  
7
P
4000  
Mass erase time3  
8
P
tMass  
20,000  
Program/erase endurance4  
9
C
C
10,000  
100,000  
cycles  
years  
TL to TH = –40°C to + 125°C  
T = 25°C  
Data retention5  
tD_ret  
10  
15  
100  
1
2
3
Typical values are based on characterization data at VDD = 5.0 V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.  
The frequency of this clock is controlled by a software setting.  
These values are hardware state machine controlled. User code does not need to count cycles. This information  
supplied for calculating approximate time to program and erase.  
4
5
Typical endurance for FLASH was evaluated for this product family on the 9S12Dx64. For additional information  
on how Freescale Semiconductor defines typical endurance, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB619/D, Typical  
Endurance for Nonvolatile Memory.  
Typical data retention values are based on intrinsic capability of the technology measured at high temperature and  
de-rated to 25°C using the Arrhenius equation. For additional information on how Freescale Semiconductor defines  
typical data retention, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB618/D, Typical Data Retention for Nonvolatile Memory.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
306  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
A.13 EMC Performance  
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) performance is highly dependant on the environment in which the  
MCU resides. Board design and layout, circuit topology choices, location and characteristics of external  
components as well as MCU software operation all play a significant role in EMC performance. The  
system designer should consult Freescale applications notes such as AN2321, AN1050, AN1263,  
AN2764, and AN1259 for advice and guidance specifically targeted at optimizing EMC performance.  
A.13.1 Radiated Emissions  
Microcontroller radiated RF emissions are measured from 150 kHz to 1 GHz using the TEM/GTEM Cell  
method in accordance with the IEC 61967-2 and SAE J1752/3 standards. The measurement is performed  
with the microcontroller installed on a custom EMC evaluation board while running specialized EMC test  
software. The radiated emissions from the microcontroller are measured in a TEM cell in two package  
orientations (North and East). For more detailed information concerning the evaluation results, conditions  
and setup, please refer to the EMC Evaluation Report for this device.  
The maximum radiated RF emissions of the tested configuration in all orientations are less than or equal  
to the reported emissions levels.  
Table A-17. Radiated Emissions  
Level1  
Parameter  
Symbol  
Conditions  
fOSC/fBUS  
Frequency  
Unit  
(Max)  
4 MHz crystal  
20 MHz Bus  
0.15 – 50 MHz  
50 – 150 MHz  
150 – 500 MHz  
500 – 1000 MHz  
IEC Level  
16  
3
dBμV  
1
0
L
VDD = 5.5V  
SAE Level  
2
TA = +25oC  
package type  
64 QFP  
Radiated emissions,  
electric field  
VRE_TEM  
32 kHz crystal  
8 MHz Bus  
0.15 – 50 MHz  
50 – 150 MHz  
150 – 500 MHz  
500 – 1000 MHz  
IEC Level  
-1  
-6  
-10  
-10  
N
dBμV  
SAE Level  
1
1
Data based on qualification test results.  
A.13.2 Conducted Transient Susceptibility  
Microcontroller transient conducted susceptibility is measured in accordance with an internal Freescale  
test method. The measurement is performed with the microcontroller installed on a custom EMC  
evaluation board and running specialized EMC test software designed in compliance with the test method.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
307  
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics and Timing Specifications  
The conducted susceptibility is determined by injecting the transient susceptibility signal on each pin of  
the microcontroller. The transient waveform and injection methodology is based on IEC 61000-4-4  
(EFT/B). The transient voltage required to cause performance degradation on any pin in the tested  
configuration is greater than or equal to the reported levels unless otherwise indicated by footnotes below  
the table.  
Table A-18. Conducted Susceptibility  
Amplitude1  
fOSC/fBUS  
Parameter  
Symbol  
Conditions  
Result  
Unit  
(Min)  
0
A
B
C
D
2.02  
VDD = 5.5V  
TA = +25oC  
package type  
64 QFP  
2.5  
Conducted susceptibility, electrical  
fast transient/burst (EFT/B)  
32768 Hz  
crystal  
2 MHz Bus  
VCS_EFT  
kV  
3.0  
> 3.0  
1
2
Data based on qualification test results. Not tested in production.  
The RESET pin is susceptible to the minimum applied transient of 220 V. All other pins have a result of A up to a minimum of  
2000V.  
The susceptibility performance classification is described in Table A-19.  
Table A-19. Susceptibility Performance Classification  
Result  
Performance Criteria  
A
B
No failure  
The MCU performs as designed during and after exposure.  
Self-recovering The MCU does not perform as designed during exposure. The MCU returns  
failure  
automatically to normal operation after exposure is removed.  
C
D
E
Soft failure  
The MCU does not perform as designed during exposure. The MCU does not return to  
normal operation until exposure is removed and the RESET pin is asserted.  
Hard failure  
Damage  
The MCU does not perform as designed during exposure. The MCU does not return to  
normal operation until exposure is removed and the power to the MCU is cycled.  
The MCU does not perform as designed during and after exposure. The MCU cannot  
be returned to proper operation due to physical damage or other permanent  
performance degradation.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
308  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Appendix B  
Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings  
B.1  
Ordering Information  
This section contains ordering numbers for MC9S08AW60 Series devices. See below for an example of  
the device numbering system.  
Table B-1. Consumer and Industrial Device Numbering System  
Memory  
Available Packages2  
Type  
Device Number1  
FLASH  
RAM  
MC9S08AW60  
MC9S08AW48  
MC9S08AW32  
63,280  
49,152  
32,768  
64-pin LQFP  
64-pin QFP  
48-pin QFN  
44-pin LQFP  
2048  
1024  
MC9S08AW16  
16,384  
1
2
See Table 1-1 for a complete description of modules included on each device.  
See Table B-3 for package information.  
Table B-2. Automotive Device Numbering System  
Memory  
Available Packages2  
Device Number1  
FLASH  
RAM  
Type  
S9S08AW60  
S9S08AW48  
S9S08AW32  
63,280  
49,152  
32,768  
64-pin LQFP  
48-pin QFN  
44-pin LQFP  
2048  
48-pin QFN  
44-pin LQFP  
S9S08AW16  
16,384  
1024  
1
2
See Table 1-1 for a complete description of modules included on each device.  
See Table B-3 for package information.  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
Freescale Semiconductor  
309  
Appendix B Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings  
B.2  
Orderable Part Numbering System  
B.2.1  
Consumer and Industrial Orderable Part Numbering System  
MC 9 S08 AW 60 C XX E  
Pb free indicator  
Package designator (See Table B-3)  
Status (MC =Consumer &  
Industrial Fully Qualified)  
Memory  
Temperature range  
(C = –40°C to 85°C)  
(M = –40°C to 125°C)  
(9 = FLASH-based)  
Core  
Family  
Memory size designator  
B.2.2  
Automotive Orderable Part Numbering System  
S
9 S08 AW 60 C XX E  
Pb free indicator  
Package designator (See Table B-3)  
Status (S = Automotive  
Fully Qualified)  
Memory  
Temperature range  
(C = –40°C to 85°C)  
(V = –40°C to 105°C)  
(M = –40°C to 125°C)  
(9 = FLASH-based)  
Core  
Family  
Memory size designator  
B.3  
Mechanical Drawings  
This following pages contain mechanical specifications for MC9S08AW60 Series package options. See  
Table B-3 for the document numbers that correspond to each package type.  
Table B-3. Package Information  
Pin Count  
Type  
Designator  
Document No.  
44  
48  
64  
64  
LQFP  
QFN  
FG  
FD  
PU  
FU  
98ASS23225W  
98ARH99048A  
98ASS23234W  
98ASB42844B  
LQFP  
QFP  
MC9S08AW60 Data Sheet, Rev 2  
310  
Freescale Semiconductor  
Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and software implementers to use  
Freescale Semiconductor products. There are no express or implied copyright licenses granted  
hereunder to design or fabricate any integrated circuits or integrated circuits based on the information  
in this document.  
How to Reach Us:  
USA/Europe/Locations not listed:  
Freescale Semiconductor Literature Distribution  
P.O. Box 5405, Denver, Colorado 80217  
1-800-521-6274 or 480-768-2130  
Freescale Semiconductor reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products  
herein. Freescale Semiconductor makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the  
suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Freescale Semiconductor assume any  
liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically disclaims any  
and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. “Typical” parameters  
which may be provided in Freescale Semiconductor data sheets and/or specifications can and do  
vary in different applications and actual performance may vary over time. All operating parameters,  
including “Typicals” must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts.  
Freescale Semiconductor does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others.  
Freescale Semiconductor products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components  
in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or  
sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of the Freescale Semiconductor product  
could create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use  
Freescale Semiconductor products for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall  
indemnify and hold Freescale Semiconductor and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and  
distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney  
fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death associated with such  
unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Freescale Semiconductor was  
negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part.  
Japan:  
Freescale Semiconductor Japan Ltd.  
SPS, Technical Information Center  
3-20-1, Minami-Azabu  
Minato-ku  
Tokyo 106-8573, Japan  
81-3-3440-3569  
Asia/Pacific:  
Freescale Semiconductor H.K. Ltd.  
2 Dai King Street  
Tai Po Industrial Estate  
Tai Po, N.T. Hong Kong  
852-26668334  
Learn More:  
For more information about Freescale  
Semiconductor products, please visit  
http://www.freescale.com  
Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. All other  
product or service names are the property of their respective owners.  
© Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 2005.  
MC9S08AW60, Rev 2  
12/2006  

相关型号:

SI9130DB

5- and 3.3-V Step-Down Synchronous Converters

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9135LG-T1

SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9135LG-T1-E3

SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9135_11

SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9136_11

Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9130CG-T1-E3

Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCs

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9130LG-T1-E3

Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCs

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9130_11

Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCs

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9137

Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile Applications

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9137DB

Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile Applications

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9137LG

Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile Applications

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9122E

500-kHz Half-Bridge DC/DC Controller with Integrated Secondary Synchronous Rectification Drivers

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY